739491
419
Verklein
Vergroot
Pagina terug
1/422
Pagina verder
OWNER'S MANUAL
VÄLKOMMEN!
We hope you will enjoy many years of driving pleasure in your Volvo. The
car has been designed for the safety and comfort of you and your pas-
sengers. Volvo is one of the world's safest passenger vehicles. Your
Volvo is also designed to meet applicable safety and environmental
requirements.
In order to increase your enjoyment of your Volvo, we recommend that
you read the instructions and maintenance information in this owner's
manual. The owner's manual is also available as a mobile app (Volvo
Manual) and on the Volvo Cars support site (support.volvocars.com).
2
INTRODUCTION
This is how you find owner's information 12
Digital owner's manual in the car 13
Volvo Cars support site 15
Reading the owner's manual 16
Recording data 19
Accessories and extra equipment 20
Volvo ID 21
Environmental philosophy 22
The owner's manual and the environment 25
Laminated glass 25
SAFETY
General information on seatbelts 28
Seatbelt - putting on 29
Seatbelt - loosening 30
Seatbelt - pregnancy 30
Seatbelt reminder 31
Seatbelt tensioner 31
Safety - warning symbol 32
Airbag system 33
Airbags on driver's side 34
Passenger airbag 35
Passenger airbag - activating/deac-
tivating*36
Side airbag (SIPS) 38
Inflatable Curtain (IC) 39
General information on WHIPS
(whiplash protection) 40
WHIPS - seating position 41
General information on safety mode 42
Safety mode - attempting to start the car 43
Safety mode - moving the car 43
Pedestrian airbag 44
Pedestrian airbag - moving the car 45
Pedestrian airbag - folding up 45
General information on child safety 46
Child seats 47
Child seats - location 52
Child seat - ISOFIX 53
ISOFIX - size classes 53
ISOFIX - types of child seat 55
Child seats - upper mounting points 57
TABLE OF CONTENTS
3
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
Instruments and controls, left-hand
drive car - overview 60
Instruments and controls, right-hand
drive car - overview 63
Combined instrument panel 66
Analogue combined instrument
panel - overview 66
Digital combined instrument panel -
overview 67
Eco guide & Power guide*70
Combined instrument panel - mean-
ing of indicator symbols 71
Combined instrument cluster -
meaning of warning symbols 73
Outside temperature gauge 75
Trip meter 75
Clock 75
Combined instrument panel - license
agreement 76
Symbols in the display 77
Volvo Sensus 79
Key positions 80
Key positions - functions at different
levels 81
Seats, front 82
Seats, front - electrically operated 84
Seats, rear 85
Steering wheel 87
Light switches 88
Position lamps 90
Daytime running lights 90
Tunnel detection*91
Main/dipped beam 91
Active main beam*92
Active bending lights*94
Headlamps - adjusting headlamp pattern 95
Rear fog lamp 98
Brake lights 98
Hazard warning flashers 99
direction indicators 99
Interior lighting 100
Home safe lighting 102
Approach light duration 102
Wipers and washers 102
Power windows 104
Door mirrors 106
Windows and door mirrors - heating 107
Rearview mirror - interior 108
Glass roof*109
Compass*109
Menu navigation - combined instru-
ment panel 110
Menu overview - analogue combined
instrument panel 111
Menu overview - digital combined
instrument panel 111
Messages 112
Messages - handling 113
MY CAR 113
Trip computer 114
Trip computer - analogue combined
instrument panel 116
Trip computer - digital combined
instrument panel 120
Trip computer - trip statistics*123
4
CLIMATE CONTROL
General information on climate control 126
Actual temperature 127
Sensors - climate control 127
Air quality 127
Air quality - passenger compartment filter 128
Air quality - Clean Zone Interior
Package (CZIP)*128
Air quality - IAQS*128
Air quality - material 129
Menu settings - climate control 129
Air distribution in the passenger
compartment 129
Electronic climate control - ECC*131
Electronic temperature control - ETC 132
Heated front seats*133
Heated rear seat*133
Fan 134
Auto-regulation 134
Temperature control in the passen-
ger compartment 135
Air conditioning 135
Demisting and defrosting the windscreen 136
Air distribution - recirculation 137
Air distribution - table 138
Engine block and passenger com-
partment heater*140
Engine block heater and passenger
compartment heater* - direct start 141
Engine block heater and passenger
compartment heater* - immediate stop 142
Engine block heater and passenger
compartment heater* - timer 142
Engine block heater and passenger
compartment heater* - messages 143
Additional heater*144
Fuel-driven additional heater*144
Electric additional heater*145
LOADING AND STORAGE
Storage spaces 148
Storage compartment driver’s side 150
Tunnel console 150
Tunnel console - armrest 150
Tunnel console - cigarette lighter
and ashtray*151
Glovebox 151
Inlaid mats*151
Vanity mirror 152
Tunnel console - 12 V-sockets 152
Loading 153
Loading - long load 154
Roof load 154
Load retaining eyelets 155
Loading - bag holder 155
Loading - folding bag holder*155
12 V socket - cargo area 156
Cargo net*157
Hat shelf 158
5
LOCKS AND ALARM
Remote control key 160
Remote control key - losing 160
Remote control key - personalisation*161
Locking/unlocking - indicator 162
Remote control key - electronic
immobiliser 163
Remote-controlled immobiliser with
tracking system*163
Remote control key - functions 164
Remote control key - range 165
Remote control key with PCC* -
unique functions 165
Remote control key with PCC* - range 166
Detachable key blade 167
Detachable key blade - detaching/
attaching 167
Detachable key blade - unlocking doors 168
Remote control key/PCC - replacing
the battery 168
Keyless drive*169
Keyless Drive* - range 170
Keyless Drive* - secure handling of
the remote control key 170
Keyless Drive* - interference to
remote control key function 171
Keyless Drive* - locking 171
Keyless Drive* - unlocking 172
Keyless Drive* - unlocking with the
key blade 172
Keyless Drive* - lock settings 173
Keyless Drive* - antenna location 173
Locking/unlocking - from the outside 174
Manual locking of the door 174
Locking/unlocking - from the inside 175
Global opening 176
Locking/unlocking - glovebox 176
Locking/unlocking - tailgate 176
Locking/unlocking - fuel filler flap 178
Deadlocks*178
Child safety locks - manual activation 180
Child safety locks - electrical activation*180
Alarm*181
Alarm indicator*182
Alarm* - automatic re-arming 182
Alarm* - automatic arming 183
Alarm* - remote control key not working 183
Alarm signals*183
Reduced alarm level*184
Type approval - remote control key
system 184
DRIVER SUPPORT
Adjustable steering force*186
Electronic stability control (ESC) -
general 186
Electronic stability control (ESC) -
operation 187
Electronic stability control (ESC) -
symbols and messages 189
Speed limiter*191
Speed limiter* - getting started 191
Speed limiter* - changing speed 192
Speed limiter - temporary deactiva-
tion and standby mode*193
Speed limiter* - alarm for speed
exceeded 194
Speed limiter* - deactivation 194
Cruise control*194
Cruise control* - managing speed 195
Cruise control* temporary deactiva-
tion and standby mode 197
Cruise control* - resume set speed 198
Cruise control* - deactivate 199
Distance Warning*199
Distance Warning* - limitations 201
Distance Warning* - symbols and
messages 202
Adaptive cruise control (ACC)*203
6
Adaptive cruise control* - function 204
Adaptive cruise control* - overview 205
Adaptive cruise control* - managing
speed 206
Adaptive cruise control* - set time
interval 207
Adaptive cruise control* - temporary
deactivation, and standby mode 208
Adaptive cruise control* - overtaking
another vehicle 209
Adaptive cruise control* - deactivate 209
Adaptive Cruise Control* - queue
assistance 210
Adaptive cruise control* - switch
cruise control functionality 212
Adaptive cruise control* - fault trac-
ing and action 213
Adaptive cruise control* - symbols
and messages 214
Radar sensor 216
Radar sensor - limitations 216
Type approval - radar system 218
City Safety221
City Safety - function 222
City Safety - operation 222
City Safety - limitations 223
City Safety - laser sensor 225
City Safety - symbols and messages 227
Collision warning system*228
Collision warning system* - function 229
Collision warning system* - detection
of cyclists 230
Collision warning system* - detection
of pedestrians 231
Collision warning system* - operation 232
Collision warning system* - limitations 234
Collision warning system* - camera
sensor limitations 235
Collision warning system* - symbols
and messages 236
BLIS 238
BLIS - operation 239
CTA*240
BLIS and CTA - symbols and messages 242
Road Sign Information (RSI) 243
Road sign information (RSI)* - operation 243
Road sign information (RSI)* - limitations 245
Driver Alert System*246
Driver Alert Control (DAC)*246
Driver Alert Control (DAC)* - operation 247
Driver Alert Control (DAC)* - symbols
and messages 248
Lane assistance*249
Lane Keeping Aid - function 249
Lane Keeping Aid - operation 251
Lane Keeping Aid - limitations 251
Lane Keeping Aid - symbols and
messages 253
Park Assist*254
Park assist syst* - function 254
Park assist syst* - backward 255
Park assist syst* - forward 256
Park assist syst* - fault indication 257
Park assist syst* - cleaning the sensors 257
Park assist camera 258
Park assist camera - settings 261
Park assist camera - limitations 262
Park Assist Pilot (PAP)*262
Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* - function 263
Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* - operation 264
Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* - limitations 266
Active Park Assist (PAP)* - symbols
and messages 267
7
STARTING AND DRIVING
Starting the engine 270
Switching off the engine 271
Steering lock 271
Jump starting 271
Gearboxes 273
Manual gearbox 273
Gear shift indicator*274
Automatic gearbox - Geartronic*274
Gear selector inhibitor 277
Hill start assist (HSA)*278
Start/Stop*279
Start/Stop* - function and operation 279
Start/Stop* - the engine does not stop 281
Start/Stop* - the engine auto-starts 282
Start/Stop* - the engine does not
auto-start 283
Start/Stop* - involuntary stop manual
gearbox 284
Start/Stop* - symbols and messages 285
Drive mode ECO*287
Foot brake 289
Foot brake - anti-lock braking system 290
Foot brake - emergency brake lights
and automatic hazard warning flashers 290
Foot brake - emergency brake assistance 291
Parking brake 291
Driving in water 292
Overheating 293
Driving with open tailgate 293
Overload - starter battery 294
Before a long journey 294
Winter driving 294
Fuel filler flap - Opening/closing 295
Fuel filler flap - manual opening 295
Filling up with fuel 296
Fuel - handling 296
Fuel - petrol 297
Fuel - diesel 298
Catalytic converters 299
Filling with fuel - with a fuel can 300
Diesel particle filter (DPF) 300
Economical driving 301
Driving with a trailer 302
Driving with a trailer - manual gearbox 303
Driving with a trailer - automatic gearbox 304
Towing bracket 304
Detachable towbar* - storage 305
Detachable towbar* - specifications 305
Detachable towbar* - attachment/
removal 306
Trailer Stability Assist - TSA 309
Towing 310
Towing eye 311
Recovery 311
8
WHEELS AND TYRES
Tyres - maintenance 314
Tyres - direction of rotation 315
Tyres - tread wear indicators 316
Tyres - air pressure 316
Wheel and wheel rim dimensions 317
Tyres - dimensions 317
Tyres - load index 318
Tyres - speed ratings 318
Wheel nuts 319
Winter tyres 320
Spare wheel*320
Changing wheels - taking out the
spare wheel*321
Changing wheels - removing wheels 322
Changing wheels - fitting 324
Warning triangle 325
Jack*326
First aid kit*326
Tyre monitoring (TM)*326
Emergency puncture repair*328
Emergency puncture repair kit* -
overview 329
Emergency puncture repair* - operation 330
Emergency puncture repair* - rechecking 332
Inflating tyres with compressor from
the emergency puncture repair kit*333
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
Volvo service programme 336
Book service and repair*336
Raising the car 339
Bonnet - opening and closing 341
Engine compartment - overview 341
Engine compartment - checking 342
Engine oil - general 342
Engine oil - checking and filling 343
Coolant - level 345
Brake and clutch fluid - level 346
Climate control system - fault tracing
and repair 347
Lamp replacement - general 347
Lamp replacement - location of front
lamps 348
Lamp replacement - headlamps 349
Lamp replacement - cover for main/
dipped beam bulbs 350
Lamp replacement - dipped beam 350
Lamp replacement - main beam 351
Lamp replacement - direction indica-
tors front 351
Lamp replacement - position lamps, front 351
Lamp replacement - daytime running
lights 352
9
Lamp replacement - location of rear
lamps 352
Lamp replacement - direction indica-
tors rear, brake lights and reversing lamp 353
Lamp replacement - rear fog lamp 353
Lamp replacement - vanity mirror lighting 354
Lamps - specifications 354
Wiper blades 355
Washer fluid - filling 357
Starter battery - general 358
Battery - symbols 360
Starter battery - replacement 360
Battery - Start/Stop 361
Electrical system 363
Fuses - general 363
Fuses - in engine compartment 364
Fuses - under glovebox 367
Fuses - under the right-hand front seat 370
Car wash 372
Polishing and waxing 374
Water and dirt-repellent coating 375
Rustproofing 375
Cleaning the interior 376
Paint damage 377
SPECIFICATIONS
Type designations 380
Dimensions 383
Weights 385
Towing capacity and towball load 386
Engine specifications 388
Engine oil - adverse driving conditions 389
Engine oil - grade and volume 390
Coolant - grade and volume 392
Transmission fluid - grade and volume 393
Brake fluid - grade and volume 394
Fuel tank - volume 395
Air conditioning, fluid - volume and grade 396
Fuel consumption and CO2 emissions 398
Wheels and tyres - approved dimensions 402
Load index and speed rating 404
Tyres - approved tyre pressures 405
ALPHABETICAL INDEX
Alphabetical Index 407
INTRODUCTION
INTRODUCTION
12
This is how you find owner's
information
Owner's information is available in several differ-
ent product formats, both digital and printed.
The owner's manual is available in the car's
screen, as a mobile app and on the Volvo Cars
support site. There is a Quick Guide and a sup-
plement to the owner's manual available in the
glovebox, with specifications and fuse informa-
tion, amongst other things. A printed owner's
manual can be ordered.
The car's screen1
A digital version of the owner's
manual is available in the car's
screen. Press the MY CAR but-
ton in the centre console, press
OK/MENU and select
Owner's manual. The infor-
mation is searchable and can
also be subdivided into categories.
Read more in the Digital owner's manual in the
car.
Mobile app
In App Store or Google Play,
search for "Volvo Manual",
download the app to your
smartphone or tablet and select
the car.
The app contains video tutorials
as well as options for visual navigation with exte-
rior and interior images of the car. It is easy to
navigate between the different sections in the
owner's manual and the content is searchable.
Read more about Owner's Manual in mobile devi-
ces.
Volvo Cars support site
Go to support.volvocars.com
and select your country. Here
you can find owner's manuals,
both online and in PDF format.
On the Volvo Cars support site
there are also video tutorials
and further information and
help regarding your Volvo and your car owner-
ship. The page is available for most markets.
Read more on the Volvo Cars support site.
Printed information
There is a supplement to the
owner's manual2 in the glove-
box that contains information
on fuses and specifications, as
well as a summary of important
and practical information.
There is also a Quick Guide available in printed
format that helps you to get started with the most
commonly used functions in the car.
Depending on equipment level selected, market,
etc. additional owner's information may also be
available in printed format in the car.
A printed owner's manual and associated supple-
ment can be ordered. Contact a Volvo dealer to
order. See how the owner's manual is structured
in Reading the owner's manual.
1A complete printed manual is included with the car for markets without owner's manual in the screen.
2A complete printed manual is included with the car for markets without owner's manual in the screen.
INTRODUCTION
}}
13
Changing the language in the car's
screen
Changing the language in the car's display may
mean that some information does not correspond
to national or local laws and regulations. Don't
change to a language that's difficult to under-
stand, it may then be difficult to find your way
back in the structure on the screen.
IMPORTANT
The driver is always responsible that the vehi-
cle is driven safely in traffic and that applica-
ble laws and regulations are followed. It is
also important that the car is maintained and
handled in accordance with Volvo's recom-
mendations in the owner's information.
If there should be a difference between the
information in the screen and the printed
information then it is always the printed infor-
mation that applies.
Related information
Digital owner's manual in the car (p. 13)
Volvo Cars support site (p. 15)
Reading the owner's manual (p. 16)
Digital owner's manual in the car
The owner's manual can be read on the screen
in the car3. The content is searchable and it is
easy to navigate between different sections.
Open the digital owner's manual - press the MY
CAR button in the centre console, press OK/
MENU and select Owner's manual.
For basic navigation, see Operating the system.
See below for a more detailed description.
Owner's manual, start page.
There are four options for finding information in
the digital owner's manual:
Search - Search function for finding an arti-
cle.
Categories - All articles sorted into catego-
ries.
Favourites - Quick access to favourite-
bookmarked articles.
Quick Guide - A selection of articles for
common functions.
Select the information symbol in the lower right-
hand corner in order to obtain information about
the digital owner's manual.
NOTE
The digital owner's manual is not available
while driving.
Search
Searching using the character wheel.
Character list.
Changing the input mode (see following
table).
3Applies to certain car models.
||
INTRODUCTION
14
Use the character wheel to enter a search term,
e.g. "seatbelt".
1. Turn TUNE to the desired letter, press OK/
MENU to confirm. The number and letter
buttons on the control panel in the centre
console can also be used.
2. Continue with the next letter and so on.
3. To change the input mode to numbers or
special characters, or to perform a search,
turn TUNE to one of the options (see explan-
ation in the following table) in the list for
changing the input mode (2), press OK/
MENU.
123/AB
C
Change between letters and num-
bers with OK/MENU.
MORE Change to special characters with
OK/MENU.
OK Perform the search. Turn TUNE to
select a search result article, press
OK/MENU to go to the article.
a|A Changes between lowercase and
uppercase letters with OK/MENU.
| | }Changes from the character wheel
to the search field. Move the cur-
sor with TUNE. Delete any mis-
spelling with EXIT. To return to the
character wheel, press OK/MENU.
Note that the digit and letter but-
tons on the control panel can be
used for editing in the search field.
Enter with the numerical keyboard
Numerical keyboard.
Another way of entering characters is to use the
centre console's buttons 0-9, * and #.
When e.g. 9 is pressed, a bar appears with all
characters4 under the button, e.g. W, x, y, z and
9. Quick presses on the button move the cursor
through these characters.
Stop with the cursor on the desired character
in order to select it - the character is shown
on the enter line.
Delete/undo using EXIT.
To enter a number, hold in the corresponding
number key.
Categories
The articles in the owner's manual are structured
into main categories and subcategories. The
same article can be in several appropriate cate-
gories in order to be found more easily.
Turn TUNE to navigate in the category tree and
press OK/MENU to open a category - selected
- or article - selected . Press EXIT to go
back to the previous view.
Favourites
Located here are the articles that are saved as
favourites. To select an article as a favourite, see
the heading "Navigating in an article" below.
Turn TUNE to navigate in the favourite list and
press OK/MENU to open an article. Press EXIT
to go back to the previous view.
4The character for each button may vary depending on market/country/language.
INTRODUCTION
}}
* Option/accessory. 15
Quick Guide
Located here is a selection of articles for getting
to know the car's most common functions. The
articles can also be accessed via categories, but
are collected here for quick access.
Turn TUNE to navigate in the Quick Guide and
press OK/MENU to open an article. Press EXIT
to go back to the previous view.
Navigating in an article
Home - leads to the start page for the
owner's manual.
Favourite - adds/removes an article as a
favourite. You can also press the FAV button
in the centre console to add/remove an arti-
cle as a favourite.
Highlighted link - leads to linked article.
Special texts - if the article contains warn-
ings, important or note texts then an associ-
ated symbol is shown here as well as the
number of such texts in the article.
Turn TUNE to navigate between the links or
scroll in an article. When the screen has scrolled
to the start/end of an article the home and
favourite options are accessed by scrolling a fur-
ther step up/down. Press OK/MENU to activate
the selection/highlighted link. Press EXIT to go
back to the previous view.
Related information
Volvo Cars support site (p. 15)
Volvo Cars support site
There is additional information regarding your
car on the Volvo Cars website and support
page. From the website, it is also possible to
navigate through to My Volvo, a personal web
page for you and your car.
Support on the Internet
Go to support.volvocars.com or use the QR code
below to visit the page. The support page is avail-
able for most markets.
QR code that leads to the support page.
The information on the support page is searcha-
ble and can also be subdivided into different cat-
egories. Available here is support for options rela-
ted to e.g. Internet connected services and func-
tions, Volvo On Call*, the navigation system* and
apps. Video and step-by-step instructions explain
different procedures, e.g. how the car is con-
nected to the Internet via a mobile phone.
||
INTRODUCTION
* Option/accessory.
16
Downloadable information from the
support page
Maps
For cars equipped with Sensus Navigation*, there
is the facility to download maps from the support
page.
Apps
For selected Volvo models from model year 2014
and 2015, the owner's manual is available in the
form of an app. The Volvo On Call* app can also
be accessed from here.
Owner's manuals from previous model years
Owner's manuals from previous model years are
available here in PDF format. The Quick Guide
and supplement can also be accessed from the
support page. Select car model and model year in
order to download the publication required.
Contact
On the support page there is contact information
for customer support and the nearest Volvo
dealer.
My Volvo on the Internet5
From www.volvocars.com it is possible to navigate
through to My Volvo Web which is a personal
Web page for you and your car.
Create a personal Volvo ID, log in to My Volvo
Web and get an overview of service, agreements
and warranties, amongst other things. At My
Volvo Web there is also information about acces-
sories and software adapted for your car model.
Related information
Volvo ID (p. 21)
Reading the owner's manual
A good way of getting to know your new car is
to read the owner's manual, ideally before your
first journey.
Reading the owner's manual is a good way to
become familiar with new functions, get advice
on how best to handle the car in different situa-
tions and learn how to make the best use of all
the car's features. Please pay attention to the
safety instructions contained in the owner's man-
ual.
Development work is constantly in progress to
improve our product. Modifications may mean
that information, descriptions and illustrations in
the owner's manual differ from the equipment in
the car. We reserve the right to make modifica-
tions without prior notice.
© Volvo Car Corporation
5Applies to certain markets.
INTRODUCTION
}}
* Option/accessory. 17
Owner's Manual in mobile devices
NOTE
The Owner's manual is available for download
as a mobile application (applies for certain car
models and mobile devices), see
www.volvocars.com.
The mobile application also includes video
and searchable content and easy navigation
between different sections.
Options/accessories
All types of option/accessory are marked with an
asterisk*.
In addition to standard equipment, the owner's
manual also describes options (factory fitted
equipment) and certain accessories (retrofitted
extra equipment).
The equipment described in the owner's manual
is not available in all cars - they have different
equipment depending on adaptations for the
needs of different markets and national or local
laws and regulations.
In the event of uncertainty over what is standard
or an option/accessory, contact a Volvo dealer.
Special texts
WARNING
Warning texts appear if there is a risk of
injury.
IMPORTANT
"Important" texts appear if there is a risk of
damage.
NOTE
NOTE texts give advice or tips that facilitate
the use of features and functions for example.
Footnote
There is footnote information in the owner's man-
ual that is located at the bottom of the page. This
information is an addition to the text that it refers
to via a number. If the footnote refers to text in a
table then letters are used instead of numbers
for referral.
Message texts
In the car there are displays that show menu
texts and message texts. In the owner's manual
the appearance of these texts differs from the
normal text. Examples of menu texts and mes-
sage texts: Media, Sending location.
Decals
The car contains different types of decal which
are designed to convey important information in a
simple and clear manner. The decals in the car
have the following descending degree of impor-
tance for the warning/information.
Warning for personal injury
G031590
Black ISO symbols on yellow warning field, white
text/image on black message field. Used to indi-
cate the presence of danger which, if the warning
||
INTRODUCTION
18
is ignored, may result in serious personal injury or
fatality.
Risk of property damage
G031592
White ISO symbols and white text/image on
black or blue warning field and message field.
Used to indicate the presence of danger which, if
the warning is ignored, may result in damage to
property.
Information
G031593
White ISO symbols and white text/image on
black message field.
NOTE
It is not intended that the decals illustrated in
the owner's manual should be exact replicas
of those in the car. They are included to show
their approximate appearance and locations
in the car. The information that applies to your
particular car can be found on the decal on
the car.
Procedure lists
Procedures where action must be taken in a cer-
tain sequence are numbered in the owner's man-
ual.
When there is a series of illustrations for
step-by-step instructions each step is num-
bered in the same way as the corresponding
illustration.
Lists of letters appear adjacent to the series
of illustrations where the order of the instruc-
tions is not significant.
Arrows appear numbered and unnumbered
and are used to illustrate a movement.
Arrows with letters are used to clarify a
movement when the reciprocal order is of no
relevance.
If there is no series of illustrations for step-by-
step instructions then the different steps are
numbered with normal numbers.
Position lists
Red circles containing a number are used in
overview images where different components
are pointed out. The number recurs in the
position list featured in connection with the
illustration that describes the item.
Bulleted lists
A bulleted list is used when there is a list of
points in the owner's manual.
Example:
INTRODUCTION
}}
19
Coolant
Engine oil
Related information
Related information refers to other articles con-
taining closely-associated information.
Images
The manual's images are sometimes schematic
and may deviate from the car's appearance
depending on equipment level and market.
To be continued
}} This symbol is located furthest down to the
right when an article continues on the following
page.
Continued from previous page
|| This symbol is located furthest up to the left
when an article continues from the previous
page.
Related information
The owner's manual and the environment
(p. 25)
Volvo Cars support site (p. 15)
Recording data
As part of Volvo's safety and quality assurance,
certain information about the vehicle's operation,
functionality and incidents are recorded in the
car.
This vehicle is equipped with an "Event Data
Recorder" (EDR). Its primary purpose is to regis-
ter and record data related to traffic accidents or
collision-like situations, such as times when the
airbag deploys or the vehicle strikes an obstacle
in the road. The data is recorded in order to
increase understanding of how vehicle systems
work in these types of situations. The EDR is
designed to record data related to vehicle
dynamics and safety systems for a short time,
usually 30 seconds or less.
The EDR in this vehicle is designed to record
data related to the following in the event of traffic
accidents or collision-like situations:
How the various systems in the car worked
Whether the driver and passenger seatbelts
were fastened/tensioned
The driver's use of the accelerator or brake
pedal
The travel speed of the vehicle
This information can help us better understand
the circumstances in which traffic accidents, inju-
ries and damage occur. The EDR only records
data when a non-trivial collision situation occurs.
The EDR does not record any data during normal
driving conditions. Similarly, the system never
registers who is driving the vehicle or the geo-
graphic location of the accident or near-miss sit-
uation. However, other parties, such as the police,
could use the recorded data in combination with
the type of personally identifiable information
routinely collected after a traffic accident. Special
equipment and access to either the vehicle or the
EDR is required to be able to interpret the regis-
tered data.
In addition to the EDR, the car is equipped with a
number of computers designed to continually
check and monitor the function of the car. They
can record data during normal driving conditions,
but in particular register faults affecting the vehi-
cle's operation and functionality, or upon activa-
tion of the vehicle's active driver support function
(e.g. City Safety and the auto brake function).
Some of the recorded data is required to enable
service and maintenance technicians to diagnose
and remedy any faults that occurred in the vehi-
cle. The registered information is also needed to
enable Volvo to satisfy legal requirements laid out
in laws and by government authorities. Informa-
tion registered in the vehicle is stored in its com-
puter until the vehicle is serviced or repaired.
In addition to the above, the registered informa-
tion can be used in aggregate form for research
and product development with the aim of contin-
uously improving the safety and quality of Volvo
cars.
INTRODUCTION
* Option/accessory.
20
Volvo will not contribute to the above-described
information being disclosed to third parties with-
out the vehicle owner's consent. To comply with
national legislation and regulations, Volvo may be
forced to disclose information of this nature to
the police or other authorities who may assert a
legal right to access such. Special technical
equipment which Volvo and workshops that have
entered into agreements with Volvo have access
to is required to be able to read and interpret the
recorded data. Volvo is responsible that the infor-
mation, which is transferred to Volvo during serv-
icing and maintenance, is stored and handled in a
secure manner and that the handling complies
with applicable legal requirements. For further
information - contact a Volvo dealer.
Accessories and extra equipment
The incorrect connection and installation of
accessories and extra equipment can negatively
affect the car's electronic system.
Certain accessories only function when associ-
ated software is installed in the car's computer
system. Volvo therefore recommends that you
always contact an authorised Volvo workshop
before installing accessories or extra equipment
which are connected to or affect the electrical
system.
Heat-reflecting windscreen*
The windscreen is equipped with a heat-reflect-
ing film (IR) that reduces the solar heat radiation
into the passenger compartment.
The positioning of electronic equipment, such as
a transponder, behind a glass surface with heat-
reflecting film may affect its function and per-
formance.
For the optimal function of electronic equipment,
it should be positioned on the part of the wind-
screen with no heat-reflecting film (see the high-
lighted area in the illustration).
Areas where IR film is not applied.
Dimensions
A 65 mm
B 150 mm
C 125 mm
INTRODUCTION
* Option/accessory. 21
Volvo ID
Volvo ID is your personal ID that provides
access to various services6.
Examples of services:
My Volvo - Your personal web page for you
and your car.
In an Internet-connected car* - Certain func-
tions and services require that you have reg-
istered your car to a personal Volvo ID, for
example to be able to send a new address
from a map service on the Internet directly to
the car.
Volvo On Call* - Volvo ID is used when log-
ging in to the Volvo On Call app.
Advantages of Volvo ID
One user name and one password to access
online services, i.e. only one username and
one password to remember.
When changing the username/password for
a service (e.g. Volvo On Call) it will also be
changed automatically for other services (e.g.
My Volvo Web)
Create a Volvo ID
To create a Volvo ID you need to enter a personal
e-mail address. Then follow the instructions in
the e-mail message that is automatically sent to
the specified address in order to complete the
registration. It is possible to create a Volvo ID via
one of the following services:
My Volvo - Enter your e-mail address and fol-
low the instructions.
For an Internet-connected car* - Enter your
e-mail address in the app that requires Volvo
ID and follow the instructions. Alternatively,
press the Connect button in the centre
console twice and select Apps Settings
and follow the instructions.
Volvo On Call* - Download the latest version
of the Volvo On Call app. Choose to create a
Volvo ID from the start page, enter e-mail
address and follow the instructions.
Related information
Volvo Cars support site (p. 15)
6The services available may vary over time and vary depending on equipment level and market.
INTRODUCTION
22
Environmental philosophy
Volvo Car Corporation is constantly working on
the development of safer and more efficient
products and solutions in order to reduce the
negative impact on the environment.
Environmental care is one of Volvo Cars’ core val-
ues and influences all operations. The environ-
mental work is based on the whole life cycle of
the car and takes into account the environmental
impact it has, from design to scrapping and recy-
cling. Volvo Cars' basic principle is that every new
product developed must have less impact on the
environment than the product it replaces.
Volvo's environmental management work has
resulted in the development of the more efficient
and less polluting Drive-E drivelines. The personal
environment is also important to Volvo - the air
inside a Volvo is, for example, cleaner than the air
outside thanks to the climate control system.
Your Volvo complies with stringent international
environmental standards. All Volvo's manufactur-
ing units must be ISO 14001 certified, and this
supports a systematic approach to the opera-
tion's environmental issues, which leads to con-
tinuous improvement with reduced environmental
impact. Holding the ISO certificate also means
that environmental laws and regulations in force
are complied with. Volvo also requires that its
partners must also meet these requirements.
Fuel consumption
Since a large part of a car's total environmental
impact stems from its use, the emphasis of Volvo
Cars' environmental work is on reducing fuel con-
sumption, carbon dioxide emissions and other air
pollutants. Volvo cars have competitive fuel con-
sumption in each of their respective classes.
Lower fuel consumption generally results in lower
emission of the greenhouse gas, carbon dioxide.
INTRODUCTION
}}
* Option/accessory. 23
Contributing to a better environment
An energy-efficient and fuel-efficient car not only
contributes to a reduced impact on the environ-
ment, but also means reduced costs for the
owner of the car. As the driver, it is easy to
reduce fuel consumption and thereby save
money and contribute to a better environment -
here is some advice:
Plan for an effective average speed. Speeds
above approx. 80 km/h (50 mph) and below
50 km/h (30 mph) lead to increased energy
consumption.
Follow the Service and Warranty Booklet's
recommended intervals for service and main-
tenance of the car.
Avoid letting the engine idle - switch off the
engine when stationary for longer periods.
Pay attention to local regulations.
Plan the journey - a lot of unnecessary stops
and uneven speed contribute to increased
fuel consumption.
If the car is equipped with an engine block
heater*, use it before starting from cold - it
improves starting capacity and reduces wear
in cold weather and the engine reaches nor-
mal operating temperature more quickly,
which lowers consumption and reduces
emissions.
Also remember to always dispose of environmen-
tally hazardous waste, such as batteries and oil, in
an environmentally safe manner. Consult a work-
shop in the event of uncertainty about how this
type of waste should be discarded - an author-
ised Volvo workshop is recommended.
Following this advice can save money, the plan-
et's resources are saved, and the car's durability
is extended. For more information and further
advice, see Eco guide (p. 70), Economical driv-
ing (p. 301) and Fuel consumption (p. 398).
Efficient emission control
Your Volvo is manufactured following the concept
"Clean inside and out" – a concept that encom-
passes a clean interior environment as well as
highly efficient emission control. In many cases
the exhaust emissions are well below the applica-
ble standards.
Clean air in the passenger
compartment
A passenger compartment filter prevents dust
and pollen from entering the passenger compart-
ment via the air intake.
The Interior Air Quality System (IAQS)* ensures
that the incoming air is cleaner than the air in the
traffic outside.
The system cleans the air in the passenger com-
partment from contaminants such as particles,
hydrocarbons, nitrous oxides and ground-level
ozone. If the outside air is contaminated then the
air intake is closed and the air is recirculated.
Such a situation may arise in heavy traffic,
queues and tunnels for example.
IAQS is a part of the Clean Zone Interior Pack-
age (CZIP)*, which also includes a function that
allows the fan to start when the car is unlocked
with the remote control key.
Interior
The material used in the interior of a Volvo is
carefully selected and has been tested in order to
be pleasant and comfortable. Some of the details
are hand-made, such as the seams of the steer-
ing wheel that are sewn by hand. The interior is
monitored in order not to emit strong odours or
substances that cause discomfort in the event of
e.g. high heat and bright light.
Volvo workshops and the environment
Regular maintenance creates the conditions for a
long service life and low fuel consumption for
your car. In this way you also contribute to a
cleaner environment. When Volvo's workshops
are entrusted with the service and maintenance
of your car it becomes part of Volvo's system.
Volvo makes clear demands regarding the way in
which workshop premises shall be designed in
order to prevent spills and discharges into the
environment. The workshop staff have the knowl-
edge and the tools required to guarantee good
environmental care.
Recycling
Since Volvo works from a life cycle perspective, it
is also important that the car is recycled in an
environmentally sound manner. Almost all of the
car can be recycled. The last owner of the car is
||
INTRODUCTION
24
therefore requested to contact a dealer for refer-
ral to a certified/approved recycling facility.
Related information
The owner's manual and the environment
(p. 25)
INTRODUCTION
* Option/accessory. 25
The owner's manual and the
environment
The paper pulp in a printed owner's manual
comes from Forest Stewardship Council® certi-
fied forests or other controlled sources.
The FSC® symbol shows that the paper pulp in a
printed owner's manual comes from FSC® certi-
fied forests or other controlled sources.
Related information
Environmental philosophy (p. 22)
Laminated glass
The glass is reinforced which provides
better protection against break-ins and
improved sound insulation in the pas-
senger compartment. The windscreen
and other windows* have laminated glass.
SAFETY
SAFETY
28
General information on seatbelts
Heavy braking can have serious consequences
if the seatbelts are not used. Ensure that all pas-
sengers are using their seatbelts during the jour-
ney.
Tension the hip strap over the lap by pulling the diagonal
shoulder belt up towards the shoulder. The hip strap
must be positioned low down (not over the abdomen).
It is important that the seatbelt lies against the
body so it can provide maximum protection. Do
not lean the backrest too far back. The seatbelt is
designed to protect in a normal seating position.
Unbelted occupants will be reminded to fasten
their (p. 29) seatbelt by means of an audio and
visual reminder (p. 31).
Remember
Do not use clips or anything else that can
prevent the seatbelt from fitting properly.
The seatbelt must not be twisted or caught
on anything.
WARNING
The seatbelts and airbags interact. If a seat-
belt is not used or is used incorrectly, this may
diminish the protection provided by the airbag
in the event of a collision.
WARNING
Each seatbelt is designed for only one person.
WARNING
Never modify or repair the seatbelts yourself.
Volvo recommends that you contact an
authorised Volvo workshop.
If the seatbelt has been subjected to a major
load, such as in conjunction with a collision,
the entire seatbelt must be replaced. Some of
the seatbelt's protective properties may have
been lost even if the seatbelt does not appear
damaged. The seatbelt must also be replaced
if it shows signs of wear or damage. The new
seatbelt must be type-approved and designed
for installation at the same location as the
replaced seatbelt.
Related information
Seatbelt - pregnancy (p. 30)
Seatbelt - loosening (p. 30)
Seatbelt tensioner (p. 31)
SAFETY
29
Seatbelt - putting on
Put on the seatbelt (p. 28) before driving starts.
Pull the belt out slowly and secure it by pressing
its locking tab into the seatbelt buckle. A loud
"click" indicates that the belt has locked.
Correctly fitted seatbelt.
Incorrectly fitted seatbelt. The belt must rest on the
shoulder.
Seatbelt height adjustment. Press the button and move
the belt vertically. Position the belt as high as possible
without it chafing against your throat.
The locking tab at the centre rear seat only fits
into the intended seatbelt buckle.
Remember
The seatbelt locks and cannot be withdrawn:
if it is pulled out too quickly
during braking and acceleration
if the car leans heavily.
Related information
Seatbelt - pregnancy (p. 30)
Seatbelt - loosening (p. 30)
Seatbelt tensioner (p. 31)
Seatbelt reminder (p. 31)
SAFETY
30
Seatbelt - loosening
Loosen the seatbelt (p. 28) when the car is sta-
tionary.
Press the red button on the seatbelt buckle and
then let the belt retract. If the seatbelt does not
retract fully, feed it in by hand so that it does not
hang loose.
Related information
Seatbelt - putting on (p. 29)
Seatbelt reminder (p. 31)
Seatbelt - pregnancy
Seatbelt (p. 28) must always be worn during
pregnancy. But it is crucial that it be worn in the
correct way.
G020998
The diagonal section should wrap over the shoul-
der then be routed between the breasts and to
the side of the abdomen.
The lap section should lay flat over the thighs and
as low as possible under the abdomen. – It must
never be allowed to ride upward. Remove the
slack from the seatbelt and ensure that it fits as
close to the body as possible. In addition, check
that there are no twists in the seatbelt.
As the pregnancy progresses, pregnant drivers
must adjust the seat (p. 82) and steering wheel
(p. 87) such that they can easily maintain con-
trol of the vehicle as they drive (which means that
they must be able to easily operate the foot ped-
als and steering wheel). The aim should be to
position the seat with as large a distance as pos-
sible between abdomen and steering wheel.
Related information
Seatbelt - putting on (p. 29)
Seatbelt - loosening (p. 30)
SAFETY
31
Seatbelt reminder
Unbelted occupants will be reminded to fasten
their (p. 29) seatbelt by means of an audio and
visual reminder.
The audio reminder is speed dependent, and in
some cases time dependent. The visual reminder
is located in the roof console and in the com-
bined instrument panel (p. 66).
Child seats are not covered by the seatbelt
reminder system.
Rear seat
The seatbelt reminder in the rear seat has two
subfunctions:
Provides information on which seatbelts
(p. 28) are being used in the rear seat. A
message appears in the combined instru-
ment panel when the seatbelts are in use, or
if one of the rear doors has been opened.
The message is acknowledged automatically
after approximately 30 seconds driving or
after pressing the indicator stalk OK button
(p. 110). If anyone is unbelted then the mes-
sage can only be acknowledged manually by
pressing the indicator stalk OK button.
Provides a warning if one of the rear seat-
belts is unfastened during travel. This warn-
ing takes the form of a message in the com-
bined instrument panel along with the audio/
visual signal. The warning stops when the
seatbelt is re-fastened, or it can also be
acknowledged manually by pressing the OK
button.
The combined instrument panel's information dis-
play shows which seatbelts are in use. This infor-
mation is always available.
Seatbelt tensioner
Seatbelts (p. 28) on the driver's side, the pas-
senger side and at the outer rear seats are fitted
with seatbelt tensioners. A mechanism in the
seatbelt tensioner tightens the seatbelt in the
event of a sufficiently violent collision. The seat-
belt then provides more effective restraint for the
occupants.
WARNING
Never insert the tongue of the passenger's
seatbelt into the buckle on the driver's side.
Always insert the tongue of the seatbelt into
the buckle on the correct side. Do not make
any damages on seatbelts nor insert any for-
eign objects into a buckle. The seatbelts and
buckles would then possibly not function as
intended in the event of a collision. There is a
risk of serous injury.
Related information
General information on seatbelts (p. 28)
SAFETY
32
Safety - warning symbol
The warning symbol is shown if a fault is
detected during fault tracing or if a system has
been activated. Where required, the warning
symbol is shown together with a message in the
combined instrument panel (p. 66) information
display.
Warning triangle and warning symbol for the airbag sys-
tem (p. 33) in the analogue combined instrument
panel.
Warning triangle and warning symbol for the airbag sys-
tem in the digital combined instrument panel.
The warning symbol in the combined instrument
panel is switched on with the remote control key
in key position II (p. 81), fault tracing is per-
formed each time the ignition is switched on. The
symbol clears after approx. 6 seconds provided
the airbag system is fault-free.
The warning symbol is shown if a fault is
detected during fault tracing or if a system has
been activated. Where required, the warning sym-
bol is shown together with a message in the dis-
play. If the warning symbol malfunctions, the
warning triangle illuminates and SRS airbag
Service required or SRS airbag Service
urgent appears in the display. Volvo recom-
mends that you contact an authorised Volvo
workshop immediately.
WARNING
If the warning symbol for the airbag system
remains illuminated or illuminates while driv-
ing, it means that the airbag system does not
have full functionality. The symbol indicates a
fault in the airbag system, the belt tensioner
system, SIPS, the IC system or some other
fault in the system. Volvo recommends that
you contact an authorised Volvo workshop
immediately.
Related information
General information on safety mode (p. 42)
SAFETY
}}
33
Airbag system
In the event of a frontal collision the airbag sys-
tem helps to protect the head, face and chest of
the driver and passenger.
G018665
Airbag system viewed from above, left-hand-drive car.
G018666
Airbag system viewed from above, right-hand-drive car.
The system consists of airbags and sensors. A
sufficiently violent collision trips the sensors and
the airbag(s) are inflated and become hot. The
airbag cushions the initial collision impact for the
occupant. The airbag deflates when compressed
by the collision. When this occurs, smoke
escapes into the car. This is completely normal.
The entire process, including inflation and defla-
tion of the airbag, occurs within tenths of a sec-
ond.
If the airbags have deployed, the following is rec-
ommended:
Recovering the car. Volvo recommends that
you have it conveyed to an authorised Volvo
workshop. Do not drive with deployed air-
bags.
Volvo recommends that you engage an
authorised Volvo workshop to handle the
replacement of components in the car's
safety systems.
Always contact a doctor.
WARNING
The airbag system's control module is located
in the centre console. If the centre console is
drenched with water or other liquid, discon-
nect the battery cables. Do not attempt to
start the car since the airbags may deploy.
Recovering the car. Volvo recommends that
you have it conveyed to an authorised Volvo
workshop.
WARNING
Never drive with deployed airbags. They can
make steering difficult. Other safety systems
may also be damaged. The smoke and dust
created when the airbags are deployed can
cause skin and eye irritation/injury after inten-
sive exposure. In case of irritation, wash with
cold water. The rapid deployment sequence
and airbag fabric may cause friction and skin
burns.
WARNING
Volvo recommends that you contact an
authorised Volvo workshop for repair. Defec-
tive work in the airbag system could cause
malfunction and result in serious personal
injury.
NOTE
The detectors react differently depending on
the nature of the collision and whether or not
the seatbelt is fastened. Applies to all seat-
belt positions apart from centre seat rear.
It is therefore possible that only one (or none)
of the airbags may inflate in a collision. The
detectors sense the force of the collision on
the vehicle and the action is adapted accord-
ingly so that one or more airbags are
deployed.
||
SAFETY
34
Related information
Airbags on driver's side (p. 34)
Passenger airbag (p. 35)
Safety - warning symbol (p. 32)
Airbags on driver's side
To supplement the protection afforded by the
seatbelt (p. 28) on the driver side, the car is
equipped with two airbags (p. 33).
One of the airbags is folded up into the centre of
the steering wheel. The steering wheel is marked
AIRBAG.
Knee airbag on the driver's side in a left-hand-drive car.
The second airbag (at knee level) is fitted in the
lower part of the instrument panel on the driver's
side; this panel is labelled AIRBAG.
WARNING
The seatbelts and airbags interact. If the belt
is not used or is used incorrectly, this may
diminish the protection provided by the air-
bags in the event of a collision.
Related information
Passenger airbag (p. 35)
SAFETY
}}
35
Passenger airbag
To supplement the protection afforded by the
seatbelt (p. 28) on the passenger side, the car
is equipped with an airbag (p. 33).
The airbag is folded up into a compartment
above the glovebox. Its cover panel is marked
AIRBAG.
Location of the front passenger airbag in a left-hand
drive car.
Location of the front passenger airbag in a right-hand
drive car.
Label for passenger airbag
Label on the passenger side's sun visor.
Label on the passenger side's door pillar. The label
becomes visible when the passenger door is opened.
The warning label for the passenger airbag is
positioned as shown above.
WARNING
Never use a rear-facing child seat on a seat
protected by an activated airbag. Failure to
follow this advice can lead to death or serious
injury to the child.
||
SAFETY
* Option/accessory.
36
WARNING
The seatbelts and airbags interact. If the belt
is not used or is used incorrectly, this may
diminish the protection provided by the airbag
in the event of a collision.
To minimise the risk of injury if the airbag
deploys, passengers must sit as upright as
possible with their feet on the floor and backs
against the backrest. Seatbelts must be
secured.
WARNING
Do not put objects in front of or above the
dashboard where the passenger airbag is
located.
WARNING
Never allow anybody to stand or sit in front of
the front passenger seat.
Never use a rear-facing child seat on the front
passenger seat if the passenger airbag is
activated.
Front-facing passengers (children and adults)
must never sit on the front passenger seat if
the passenger airbag is deactivated.
Failure to follow the advice given above can
endanger life or lead to serious personal
injury.
Switch - PACOS*
The front passenger airbag can be deactivated
(p. 36) if the car is equipped with a switch,
PACOS (Passenger Airbag Cut Off Switch).
WARNING
If the car is equipped with an airbag for the
front passenger seat, but does not have a
switch PACOS (Passenger Airbag Cut Off
Switch), then the airbag will always be acti-
vated.
Related information
Airbags on driver's side (p. 34)
Child seats (p. 47)
Passenger airbag - activating/
deactivating*
The front passenger airbag (p. 35) can be deac-
tivated if the car is equipped with a switch,
PACOS (Passenger Airbag Cut Off Switch).
Switch - PACOS
The switch for the passenger airbag (PACOS) is
located on the passenger end of the instrument
panel and is accessible when the passenger door
is open.
Check that the switch is in the required position.
The remote control key's key blade (p. 167)
should be used to change position.
Location of airbag switch.
ON- the airbag is activated. With the switch
in this position, all front-facing passengers
SAFETY
}}
37
(children and adults) can sit safely on the
passenger seat.
OFF - the airbag is deactivated. With the
switch in this position, children in rear-facing
child seats can sit safely on the front pas-
senger seat.
WARNING
Activated airbag (passenger seat):
Never use a rear-facing child seat on the front
passenger seat when the passenger airbag is
activated.
Deactivated airbag (passenger seat):
Front-facing passengers (children and adults)
must never sit on the front passenger seat
when the passenger airbag is deactivated.
Failure to follow the advice given above can
endanger life or lead to serious personal
injury.
NOTE
When the remote control key is in key posi-
tion II (p. 81) the warning symbol (p. 32) for
the airbag is shown in the combined instru-
ment panel for approx. 6 seconds.
Following which, the indicator in the roof con-
sole is illuminated showing the correct status
for the front passenger seat airbag.
Indicator showing that the passenger airbag is activated.
A text message and a warning symbol in the roof
console indicate that the airbag for the front pas-
senger seat is activated (see preceding illustra-
tion).
WARNING
Never use a rear-facing child seat on the front
seat if the passenger airbag is activated and
the symbol in the roof console is illumi-
nated to indicate this. Failure to follow this
advice could endanger the life of the child.
Indicator showing that the passenger airbag is deacti-
vated.
A text message and a symbol in the roof console
indicate that the airbag for the front passenger
seat is deactivated (see preceding illustration).
WARNING
Do not allow anyone to sit in the front pas-
senger seat if the message in the roof con-
sole indicates that the airbag is deactivated,
and if the warning symbol (p. 32) for the air-
bag system is also displayed on the combined
instrument panel. This indicates that there has
been a severe malfunction. Visit a workshop
as soon as possible. Volvo recommends that
you contact an authorised Volvo workshop.
WARNING
Failure to follow the advice given above can
endanger the lives of passengers in the car.
||
SAFETY
38
Related information
Child seats (p. 47)
Side airbag (SIPS)
In a side impact collision a large proportion of
the collision force is transferred by the SIPS
(Side Impact Protection System) to beams, pil-
lars, the floor, the roof and other structural parts
of the body. The side airbags at the driver's and
front passenger seats protect the chest area and
the hip and are an important part of the SIPS.
The SIPS bag system consists of two main com-
ponents, side airbag and sensors. The side air-
bags are located in the front seat's backrests.
A sufficiently violent collision trips the sensors
and the side airbags are inflated. The airbag
inflates between the occupant and the door
panel and thereby cushions the initial impact. The
airbag deflates when compressed by the collision.
The side airbag is normally only deployed on the
side of the collision.
Driver's seat, left-hand drive.
Front passenger seat, left-hand drive.
SAFETY
39
WARNING
Volvo recommends that repairs are only
carried out by an authorised Volvo work-
shop. Defective work in the SIPS-bag
system could cause malfunction and
result in serious personal injury.
Do not put objects in the area between
the outside of the seat and the door
panel, since this area is required by the
side airbag.
Volvo recommends the use only of car
seat covers approved by Volvo. Other seat
covers may impede the operation of the
side airbags.
Side airbags are a supplement the seat-
belts. Always use a seatbelt.
SIPS and child seats
The protection provided by the car to children
seated in a child seat or on a booster cushion is
not diminished by the side airbag.
Related information
Airbags on driver's side (p. 34)
Passenger airbag (p. 35)
Inflatable Curtain (IC) (p. 39)
Inflatable Curtain (IC)
The inflatable curtain helps to prevent the driver
and passengers from striking their heads on the
inside of the car during a collision.
The inflatable curtain IC (Inflatable Curtain) is
part of the SIPS system (p. 38). It is fitted along
the headlining on both sides and helps protect
the driver and passengers in the car's outer
seats. A sufficiently violent collision trips the sen-
sors and the inflatable curtain is inflated.
WARNING
Never hang or attach heavy items onto the
handles in the roof. The hook is only designed
for light clothing (not for solid objects such as
umbrellas for example).
Do not screw or install anything onto the car's
headlining, door pillars or side panels. This
could compromise the intended protection.
Volvo recommends that you only ever use
Volvo genuine parts that are approved for
placement in these areas.
WARNING
Do not load the car higher than 50 mm under
the top edge of the windows in the doors.
Otherwise, the intended protection of the
inflatable curtain, which is concealed in the
headlining, may be compromised.
WARNING
The inflatable curtain is a supplement to the
seatbelts.
Always use a seatbelt.
Related information
General information on seatbelts (p. 28)
Airbag system (p. 33)
Side airbag (SIPS) (p. 38)
SAFETY
40
General information on WHIPS
(whiplash protection)
WHIPS (Whiplash Protection System) is a pro-
tection against whiplash injuries. The system
consists of energy absorbing backrests and
specially designed head restraints in the front
seats.
The WHIPS system is actuated by a rear-end col-
lision, where the angle and speed of the collision,
and the nature of the colliding vehicle all have an
influence.
WARNING
The WHIPS system is a supplement to the
seatbelts. Always use a seatbelt.
Seat properties
When the WHIPS system is deployed, the front
seat backrests are lowered backward to change
the seating position of the driver and front seat
passenger. This reduces the risk of whiplash
injury.
WARNING
Never modify or repair the seat or WHIPS
system yourself. Volvo recommends that you
contact an authorised Volvo workshop.
WHIPS and child seats
The protection provided by the car to children
seated in a child seat or on a booster cushion is
not diminished by the WHIPS system.
Related information
WHIPS - seating position (p. 41)
General information on seatbelts (p. 28)
SAFETY
41
WHIPS - seating position
In order to obtain optimum protection from the
WHIPS system (p. 40) the driver and passenger
must have the correct seating position and make
sure that the system's function is not obstructed.
Seating position
Set the correct seating position in the front seat
(p. 82) before driving starts.
Driver and front seat passenger should sit in the
centre of the seat with as little space as possible
between the head and the head restraint.
Function
Do not leave any objects on the floor behind the driver's
seat/passenger seat that may prevent the WHIPS sys-
tem from functioning.
WARNING
Do not squeeze rigid objects between the
rear seat cushion and the front seat's back-
rest. Make sure you do not to obstruct the
function of the WHIPS system.
Do not place objects on the rear seat that may prevent
the WHIPS system from functioning.
WARNING
If a rear seat backrest is folded down, the cor-
responding front seat must be moved forward
so that it does not touch the folded backrest.
WARNING
If a seat has been subjected to extreme
forces, such as due to a rear-end collision, the
WHIPS system must be checked. Volvo rec-
ommends that it is checked by an authorised
Volvo workshop.
Part of the WHIPS system's protective
capacity may have been lost even if the seat
appears to be undamaged.
Volvo recommends that you contact an
authorised Volvo workshop to have the sys-
tem checked even after a minor rear-end col-
lision.
SAFETY
42
General information on safety mode
Safety mode is a protective state that is trig-
gered when a collision may have damaged any
of the car's vital functions, such as the fuel lines,
sensors for any of the safety systems, or the
brake system.
Warning triangle in the analogue combined instrument
panel.
Warning triangle in the digital combined instrument
panel.
If the car is involved in a collision, the text Safety
mode See manual may appear in the combined
instrument panel (p. 66) information display.
This means that the car has reduced functional-
ity.
WARNING
Never attempt to repair your car or reset the
electronics yourself if the car has been in
safety mode. This could result in personal
injury or the car not functioning as normal.
Volvo recommends that you engage an
authorised Volvo workshop to check and
restore the car to normal status after Safety
mode See manual has been displayed.
Related information
Safety mode - attempting to start the car
(p. 43)
Safety mode - moving the car (p. 43)
SAFETY
43
Safety mode - attempting to start
the car
If the car is set in safety mode (p. 42) then an
attempt to start the car can be made if every-
thing seems normal and the absence of fuel
leakage has been checked.
First, check that no fuel is leaking from the car.
There must be no smell of fuel either.
If everything seems normal and you have
checked for indications of fuel leakage, you may
attempt to start the car.
Remove the remote control key and open the
driver's door. If a message is now shown to the
effect that the ignition is on, press the start but-
ton. Then close the door and reinsert the remote
control key. The car's electronics will now try to
reset themselves to normal mode. Then try to
start the car.
If the message Safety mode See manual is
still shown on the display, then the car must not
be driven or towed, but a vehicle recovery service
(p. 311) must be used instead. Even if the car
appears to be driveable, hidden damage may
make the car impossible to control once moving.
WARNING
Never, under any circumstances, attempt to
restart the car if it smells of fuel when the
Safety mode See manual message is dis-
played. Leave the car at once.
WARNING
If the car is in safety mode it must not be
towed. It must be transported from its loca-
tion. Volvo recommends that it is transported
to an authorised Volvo workshop.
Related information
Safety mode - moving the car (p. 43)
Safety mode - moving the car
If Normal mode is shown after Safety mode
See manual has been reset after attempting to
start the car (p. 43) , the car can be moved care-
fully out of a dangerous position.
Do not move the car further than necessary.
Related information
General information on safety mode (p. 42)
SAFETY
44
Pedestrian airbag
The airbag for pedestrians (Pedestrian Airbag)
contributes in certain frontal collisions to alleviat-
ing the collision of the pedestrian with the car.
The pedestrian airbag (Pedestrian Airbag) is fit-
ted under the bonnet near the windscreen. In the
event of certain frontal collisions with a pedes-
trian, the sensors in the front bumper react and
the airbag inflates if required, based on the force
of the impact. The sensors are active at a speed
of approx. 20-50 km/h (12-30 mph) and an
ambient temperature between -20 and +70°C.
The sensors are designed to detect a collision
with an object that has similar properties to those
of the human leg.
NOTE
There may be objects in the traffic environ-
ment that prompt a signal to the sensors that
is similar to a collision with a pedestrian. It is
possible that the system will be activated in
the event of a collision with such an object.
If the airbag is activated (Pedestrian Airbag)
the rear part of the bonnet is raised and
locked in this position
the hazard warning flashers are activated
the brake system is prepared for the upcom-
ing emergency braking.
WARNING
Do not fit any accessories or change anything
in the front. Incorrect intervention at the front
may cause incorrect function in the system
and lead to serious injury and damage to the
car.
Volvo recommends that genuine wiper arms
are used and that you only use genuine parts
for them.
WARNING
Volvo recommends contacting an authorised
Volvo workshop in the event of damage to the
bumper in order to ensure that the system is
intact.
Related information
Pedestrian airbag - moving the car (p. 45)
Pedestrian airbag - folding up (p. 45)
SAFETY
45
Pedestrian airbag - moving the car
The car may be moved if it has not been set in
safety mode (p. 42).
If any of the other airbags in the passenger com-
partment were activated then the car remains in
safety mode.
If only the pedestrian airbag (p. 44) (Pedestrian
Airbag) has been activated:
1. Move the car to a safe location as close as
possible.
2. Fold up the airbag in accordance with the
instructions (p. 45).
3. Seek the nearest workshop.
WARNING
Volvo recommends that, after activation of the
airbag, you contact an authorised Volvo work-
shop as soon as possible.
Related information
Pedestrian airbag (p. 44)
Pedestrian airbag - folding up
Pedestrian airbag (p. 44) (Pedestrian Airbag)
must be folded up before the car is moved.
Airbag
Airbag housing
Velcro strap, right-hand side
Velcro strap, left-hand side
The airbag may feel warm and give off smoke.
This is normal. Fold the airbag as follows:
1. Find the Velcro strap on the
left-hand side (4).
2. Gather the airbag fabric along its length on
the left-hand side. Then fold the gathered
fabric towards the centre. Wind the Velcro
strap (double sided) around as much fabric
as possible and fasten it.
3. Press the rolled up portion of the airbag into
the airbag housing (2).
4. Repeat points 1-3 for the right-hand side. It
may be necessary to fold the gathered fabric
twice on this side in order to wind the Velcro
strap around it.
5. The airbag housing cover will be open
slightly. This is completely normal.
Related information
Pedestrian airbag - moving the car (p. 45)
SAFETY
46
General information on child safety
Volvo has child safety equipment (child seats,
booster cushions & attachment devices) which
is designed for fitting in this particular car.
Using Volvo's child safety equipment, the opti-
mum conditions are obtained for the child to
travel safely in the car. In addition, the child safety
equipment fits well and is simple to use.
Children of all ages and sizes must always sit
correctly secured in the car. Never allow a child to
sit on the knee of a passenger.
Volvo recommends that children travel in rear-
facing child seats until as late an age as possible,
at least up to 3-4 years of age, and then in front-
facing booster cushions/child seats until the
child is 140 cm tall.
NOTE
Legal provisions about the type of child seat
that must be used for children of different
ages and heights vary from country to coun-
try. Check what does apply.
NOTE
In the event of questions when fitting child
safety products, contact the manufacturer for
clearer instructions.
Child safety locks
The controls for operating the rear door power
windows and the rear door opening handles can
be blocked (p. 180) from opening from the
inside.
Related information
Child seats (p. 47)
Child seats - location (p. 52)
Child seat - ISOFIX (p. 53)
Child seats - upper mounting points (p. 57)
SAFETY
}}
47
Child seats
Children should sit comfortably and safely. Make
sure that the child seat is being used correctly.
NOTE
When using child safety products it is impor-
tant to read the installation instructions
included.
WARNING
Do not secure the straps of the child seat to
the seat's horizontal adjustment bar, springs
or the rails and beams under the seat. Sharp
edges may damage the straps.
Look in the installation instructions for the child
seat for the correct fitting.
||
SAFETY
48
Recommended child seats1
Weight Front seat (with deactivated air-
bag, only rear-facing child seats)
Front seat (with activated air-
bag, only front-facing child
seats)
Outer rear seat Centre rear seat
Group 0
max 10 kg
Group 0+
max 13 kg
Volvo infant seat (Volvo Infant Seat) - rear-
facing child seat, secured with the ISOFIX fix-
ture system.
Type approval: E1 04301146
(L)
Group 0
max 10 kg
Group 0+
max 13 kg
Volvo infant seat (Volvo Infant
Seat) - rear-facing child seat,
secured with the car's seatbelt.
Type approval: E1 04301146
(U)
Volvo infant seat (Volvo Infant Seat) - rear-
facing child seat, secured with the car's seat-
belt.
Type approval: E1 04301146
(U)
Volvo infant seat
(Volvo Infant Seat) -
rear-facing child seat,
secured with the car's
seatbelt.
Type approval: E1
04301146
(U)
Group 0
max 10 kg
Group 0+
max 13 kg
Child seats which are universally
approved.A
(U)
Child seats which are universally approved.
(U)
1With regard to other child seats your car should be included in the manufacturer's enclosed list of vehicles or be universally approved in accordance with the ECE R44 legal requirement.
SAFETY
}}
49
Weight Front seat (with deactivated air-
bag, only rear-facing child seats)
Front seat (with activated air-
bag, only front-facing child
seats)
Outer rear seat Centre rear seat
Group 1
9-18 kg
Volvo turnable child seat (Volvo
Convertible Child Seat) – rear-fac-
ing child seat, secured with the
car's seatbelt and straps.
Type approval: E5 04192
(L)
Volvo turnable child seat (Volvo Convertible
Child Seat) – rear-facing child seat, secured
with the car's seatbelt and straps.
Type approval: E5 04192
(L)
Group 1
9-18 kg
Volvo rear-facing child seat
Type approval: E5 04212
(L)
Volvo rear-facing child seat
Type approval: E5 04212
(L)
Group 1
9-18 kg
Front-facing child seats which
are universally approved.A, B
(UF)
Child seats which are universally approved.
(U)
Group 2
15-25 kg
Volvo turnable child seat (Volvo
Convertible Child Seat) – rear-fac-
ing child seat, secured with the
car's seatbelt and straps.
Type approval: E5 04192
(L)
Volvo turnable child seat (Volvo Convertible
Child Seat) – rear-facing child seat, secured
with the car's seatbelt and straps.
Type approval: E5 04192
(L)
Group 2
15-25 kg
Volvo rear-facing child seat
Type approval: E5 04212
(L)
Volvo rear-facing child seat
Type approval: E5 04212
(L)
||
SAFETY
50
Weight Front seat (with deactivated air-
bag, only rear-facing child seats)
Front seat (with activated air-
bag, only front-facing child
seats)
Outer rear seat Centre rear seat
Group 2
15-25 kg
Volvo turnable child seat (Volvo
Convertible Child Seat) - front-
facing child seat, secured with
the car's seatbelt.
Type approval: E5 04191
(U)
Volvo turnable child seat (Volvo Convertible
Child Seat) - front-facing child seat, secured
with the car's seatbelt.
Type approval: E5 04191
(U)
Group 2/3
15-36 kg
Volvo booster seat with back-
rest (Volvo Booster Seat with
backrest).
Type approval: E1 04301169
(UF)
Volvo booster seat with backrest (Volvo
Booster Seat with backrest).
Type approval: E1 04301169
(UF)
Group 2/3
15-36 kg
Volvo booster seat
Type approval: E1 04301312
(UF)
Volvo booster seat
Type approval: E1 04301312
(UF, L)
SAFETY
51
Weight Front seat (with deactivated air-
bag, only rear-facing child seats)
Front seat (with activated air-
bag, only front-facing child
seats)
Outer rear seat Centre rear seat
Group 2/3
15-36 kg
Booster cushion with and with-
out backrest (Booster Cushion
with and without backrest).
Type approval: E5 04216
(UF)
Booster cushion with and without backrest
(Booster Cushion with and without backrest).
Type approval: E5 04216
(UF)
L: Suitable for specific child seats. These child seats may be intended for use in a special car model, limited or semi-universal categories.
U: Suitable for universally approved child seats in this weight class.
UF: Suitable for front-facing universally approved child seats in this weight class.
B: Built-in child seats approved for this weight class.
AOnly for rear-facing child seat. Set the seat's backrest in upright position.
BVolvo recommends rear-facing child seat for children in this mass group.
Related information
Child seats - location (p. 52)
Child seats - upper mounting points (p. 57)
Child seat - ISOFIX (p. 53)
General information on child safety (p. 46)
SAFETY
52
Child seats - location
The position of a child in the car and the choice
of equipment are dictated by the child's weight
and size.
G020739
Rear-facing child seat and airbag are not compatible.
Always fit rear-facing child seats (p. 47) in the
rear seat if the passenger airbag is activated
(p. 36). If a child is sitting on the front passenger
seat then he/she could suffer serious injury if the
airbag deploys.
If the passenger airbag is deactivated then rear-
facing child seats can be fitted on the front pas-
senger seat.
Label for passenger airbag
Label on the passenger side's sun visor.
Label on the passenger side's door pillar. The label
becomes visible when the passenger door is opened.
The warning label for the passenger airbag is
positioned as shown above.
You may place:
a rear-facing child seat on the front passen-
ger seat when the passenger airbag is deac-
tivated.
a front-facing child seat/booster cushion on
the front passenger seat when the passen-
ger airbag is activated.
one or more child seats/booster cushions in
the rear seat.
WARNING
Never use a rear-facing child seat on a seat
protected by an activated airbag. Failure to
follow this advice can lead to death or serious
injury to the child.
WARNING
Never allow anybody to stand or sit in front of
the front passenger seat.
Never use a rear-facing child seat on the front
passenger seat if the passenger airbag is
activated.
Front-facing passengers (children and adults)
must never sit on the front passenger seat if
the passenger airbag is deactivated.
Failure to follow the advice given above can
endanger life or lead to serious personal
injury.
SAFETY
}}
53
WARNING
Booster cushions/child seats with steel
braces or some other design that could rest
on the seatbelt buckle's opening button must
not be used, as they could cause the seatbelt
buckle to open accidentally.
Do not allow the upper section of the child
seat to rest against the windscreen.
NOTE
Regulations regarding the placement of chil-
dren in cars vary from country to country.
Check what does apply.
Related information
General information on child safety (p. 46)
Child seats - upper mounting points (p. 57)
Child seat - ISOFIX (p. 53)
Child seat - ISOFIX
ISOFIX is a fixture system for car child seats
(p. 47) that is based on an international stand-
ard.
Mounting points for the ISOFIX fixture system are
located at the lower section of the rear seat
backrest, in the outer seats.
The location of the mounting points is indicated
by symbols in the backrest upholstery (see pre-
ceding illustration).
Always follow the manufacturer's installation
instructions when connecting a child seat to the
ISOFIX mounting points.
Related information
ISOFIX - size classes (p. 53)
ISOFIX - types of child seat (p. 55)
General information on child safety (p. 46)
ISOFIX - size classes
There is a size classification for child seats using
the ISOFIX (p. 53) fixture system in order to
assist users in choosing the correct type of child
seat (p. 55).
Size
class
Description
A Full size, front-facing child seat
B Reduced size (alt. 1), front-facing
child seat
B1 Reduced size (alt.2), front-facing
child seat
C Full size, rear-facing child seat
D Reduced size, rear-facing child
seat
E Rear-facing infant seat
F Transverse infant seat, left-hand
G Transverse infant seat, right-hand
WARNING
Never use a rear-facing child seat on the pas-
senger seat if the passenger airbag is acti-
vated.
||
SAFETY
54
NOTE
If an ISOFIX child seat has no size classifica-
tion, the car model must be included on the
vehicle list for the child seat.
NOTE
Volvo recommends that you contact an
authorised Volvo dealer for recommendations
about which ISOFIX child seats Volvo recom-
mends.
Related information
ISOFIX - types of child seat (p. 55)
SAFETY
}}
55
ISOFIX - types of child seat
Child seats are in different sizes – cars are in dif-
ferent sizes. This means that not all child seats
are suitable for all seats in all car models.
Type of child seat Weight Size class Passenger seats for ISOFIXA installation of child seats
Front seat Outer rear seat
Infant seat transverse max 10 kg F X X
G X X
Infant seat, rear-facing max 10 kg E X OK
(IL)
Infant seat, rear-facing max 13 kg E X OK
(IL)
D X OK
(IL)
C X OK
(IL)
Child seat, rear-facing 9-18 kg D X OK
(IL)
C X OK
(IL)
||
SAFETY
56
Type of child seat Weight Size class Passenger seats for ISOFIXA installation of child seats
Front seat Outer rear seat
Front-facing child seat 9-18 kg B X OKB
(IUF)
B1 X OKB
(IUF)
A X OKB
(IUF)
X: The ISOFIX position is not suitable for ISOFIX child seats in this weight class and/or size class.
IL: Suitable for specific ISOFIX child seats. These child seats may be intended for a particular car model, limited or semi-universal categories.
IUF: Suitable for front-facing ISOFIX child seats that are universally approved in this weight class.
AISOFIX is a fixture system for car child seats that is based on an international standard.
BVolvo recommends rear-facing child seats for this group.
Make sure you select the right size class (p. 53)
of child seat with ISOFIX fixture system.
Related information
Child seat - ISOFIX (p. 53)
SAFETY
57
Child seats - upper mounting points
The car is equipped with upper mounting points
for certain front-facing child seats (p. 47). These
mounting points are located on the rear of the
seat.
Upper mounting points
The upper mounting points are primarily intended
for use with front-facing child seats. Volvo recom-
mends that small children should sit in rear-fac-
ing child seats to as late an age as possible.
NOTE
Fold the head restraints in order to facilitate
fitting this type of child seat in cars with fold-
ing head restraints on the outer seats.
NOTE
In cars with a cargo cover over the luggage
compartment, this must be removed before
child seats can be attached to the securing
points.
For detailed information on how the child seat
should be tensioned in the upper mounting
points, see the seat manufacturer's instructions.
WARNING
The child seat's straps must always be drawn
through the hole in the head restraint leg
before they are tensioned at the attachment
point.
Related information
General information on child safety (p. 46)
Child seats - location (p. 52)
Child seat - ISOFIX (p. 53)
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
60
Instruments and controls, left-hand
drive car - overview
The overview shows where the car's displays
and controls are located.
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
}}
61
Overview, left-hand drive cars
||
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory.
62
Function See
Menus and mes-
sages, direction indi-
cators, main/dipped
beam, trip computer
(p. 110),
(p. 113),
(p. 99),
(p. 91) and
(p. 114).
Manual gear chang-
ing in an automatic
gearbox*
(p. 274).
Cruise control*(p. 194) and
(p. 203).
Horn, airbags (p. 87) and
(p. 33).
Combined instrument
panel
(p. 66).
Menu navigation,
audio control, phone
control*
(p. 113) and the
Sensus Infotain-
ment supple-
ment.
START/STOP
ENGINE button
(p. 270).
Ignition switch (p. 80).
Screen for infotain-
ment and display of
menus
(p. 113) and the
Sensus Infotain-
ment supple-
ment.
Function See
Door handle
Control panel (p. 175),
(p. 180),
(p. 104) and
(p. 106).
Hazard warning
flashers
(p. 99).
Control panel for
infotainment system
and menu navigation
(p. 113) and the
Sensus Infotain-
ment supple-
ment.
Control panel for cli-
mate control
(p. 131) or
(p. 132).
Gear selector (p. 273) or
(p. 274).
Parking brake (p. 291).
Wipers and washing (p. 102).
Steering wheel
adjustment
(p. 87).
Bonnet opener (p. 341).
Light switch, opener
for tailgate
(p. 88) and
(p. 176).
Seat adjustment*(p. 84).
Related information
Outside temperature gauge (p. 75)
Trip meter (p. 75)
Clock (p. 75)
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
}}
63
Instruments and controls, right-
hand drive car - overview
The overview shows where the car's displays
and controls are located.
||
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
64
Overview, right-hand drive cars
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory. 65
Function See
Wipers and washing (p. 102).
Manual gear chang-
ing in an automatic
gearbox*
(p. 274).
Menu navigation,
audio control, phone
control*
(p. 113) and the
Sensus Infotain-
ment supple-
ment.
Horn, airbags (p. 87) and
(p. 33).
Combined instrument
panel
(p. 66).
Cruise control*(p. 194) and
(p. 203).
START/STOP
ENGINE button
(p. 270).
Ignition switch (p. 80).
Screen for infotain-
ment and display of
menus
(p. 113) and the
Sensus Infotain-
ment supple-
ment.
Door handle
Function See
Control panel (p. 175),
(p. 180),
(p. 104) and
(p. 106).
Bonnet opener (p. 341).
Hazard warning
flashers
(p. 99).
Control panel for
infotainment system
and menu navigation
(p. 113) and the
Sensus Infotain-
ment supple-
ment.
Control panel for cli-
mate control
(p. 131) or
(p. 132).
Gear selector (p. 273) or
(p. 274).
Parking brake (p. 291).
Menus and mes-
sages, direction indi-
cators, main/dipped
beam, trip computer
(p. 110),
(p. 113),
(p. 99),
(p. 91) and
(p. 114).
Steering wheel
adjustment
(p. 87).
Function See
Light switch, opener
for tailgate
(p. 88) and
(p. 176).
Seat adjustment*(p. 84).
Related information
Outside temperature gauge (p. 75)
Trip meter (p. 75)
Clock (p. 75)
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
66
Combined instrument panel
The combined instrument panel's information
display shows information on some of the car's
functions, as well as messages.
Analogue combined instrument panel - over-
view (p. 66)
Digital combined instrument panel - overview
(p. 67)
Combined instrument panel - meaning of
indicator symbols (p. 71)
Combined instrument cluster - meaning of
warning symbols (p. 73)
Analogue combined instrument
panel - overview
The combined instrument panel's information
display shows information on some of the car's
functions, as well as messages.
Information display
Information display, analogue instrument panel.
There are further descriptions under the func-
tions that use the display.
Gauges and indicators
Fuel gauge. When the indicator lowers to
only one white marking1, the yellow indicator
symbol for low level in the fuel tank is illumi-
nated. See also Trip computer (p. 114) and
Filling up with fuel (p. 296).
Eco meter The meter provides an indication
of how economically the car is being driven.
The higher the reading on the scale, the
more economically the car is driven.
Speedometer
1When the display's message Distance to empty fuel tank: starts to show ----, the marking becomes red.
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
}}
* Option/accessory. 67
Tachometer. The meter indicates engine
speed in thousands of revolutions per minute
(rpm).
Gear shift indicator2 / Gear position indica-
tor3. See also Gear shift indicator* (p. 274)
or Automatic gearbox - Geartronic* (p. 274).
Indicator and warning symbols
Indicator and warning symbols, analogue instrument
panel.
Indicator symbols
Indicator and warning symbols
Warning symbols4
Functionality check
All indicator and warning symbols, apart from
symbols in the centre of the information display,
illuminate in key position II or when the engine is
started. When the engine has started, all the
symbols should go out except the parking brake
symbol, which only goes out when the brake is
disengaged.
If the engine does not start or if the functionality
check is carried out in key position II then all
symbols go out within a few seconds except the
symbol for faults in the car's emissions system
and the symbol for low oil pressure.
Related information
Combined instrument panel (p. 66)
Combined instrument panel - meaning of
indicator symbols (p. 71)
Combined instrument cluster - meaning of
warning symbols (p. 73)
Digital combined instrument panel - overview
(p. 67)
Digital combined instrument panel -
overview
The combined instrument panel's information
display shows information on some of the car's
functions, as well as messages.
Information display
Information display, digital instrument panel*.
There are further descriptions under the func-
tions that use the display.
Gauges and indicators
Various themes can be selected for the digital
combined instrument panel. Possible themes are
"Elegance", "Eco" and "Performance".
2Manual gearbox.
3Automatic gearbox.
4Certain engine variants do not have systems to warn of oil pressure loss. In cars with these variants the symbol for low oil pressure is not used. Warning for low oil level is via display text. For more information, see
Engine oil - general (p. 342).
||
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory.
68
A theme can only be selected when the engine is
running.
To select the theme, press the left-hand stalk
switch's OK button and select the Themes
menu option by turning the thumbwheel on the
lever. Press the OK button. Turn the thumbwheel
to select the theme and confirm the selection by
pressing the OK button.
On certain model variants, the appearance of the
centre console's screen follows the theme
selected for the combined instrument panel.
The contrast mode and colour mode for the
instrument can also be set using the left-hand
stalk switch.
For more information on menu navigation, see
Menu navigation - combined instrument panel
(p. 110).
The choice of theme and setting of contrast
mode and colour mode can be stored for each
remote control key in the car key memory*, see
Remote control key - personalisation* (p. 161).
Theme "Elegance"
Gauges and indicators, theme "Elegance".
Fuel gauge. When the indicator lowers to
only one white marking5, the yellow indicator
symbol for low level in the fuel tank is illumi-
nated. See also Trip computer (p. 114) and
Filling up with fuel (p. 296).
Temperature gauge for engine coolant
Speedometer
Tachometer. The meter indicates engine
speed in thousands of revolutions per minute
(rpm).
Gear shift indicator6 / Gear position indica-
tor7. See also Gear shift indicator* (p. 274)
or Automatic gearbox - Geartronic* (p. 274).
Theme "Eco"
Gauges and indicators, theme "Eco".
Fuel gauge. When the indicator lowers to
only one white marking5, the yellow indicator
symbol for low level in the fuel tank is illumi-
nated. See also Trip computer (p. 114) and
Filling up with fuel (p. 296).
Eco guide. See also Eco guide & Power
guide* (p. 70).
Speedometer
Tachometer. The meter indicates engine
speed in thousands of revolutions per minute
(rpm).
5When the display's message Distance to empty fuel tank: starts to show ----, the marking becomes red.
6Manual gearbox.
7Automatic gearbox.
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory. 69
Gear shift indicator6 / Gear position indica-
tor7. See also Gear shift indicator* (p. 274)
or Automatic gearbox - Geartronic* (p. 274).
Theme "Performance"
Gauges and indicators, theme "Performance".
Fuel gauge. When the indicator lowers to
only one white marking5, the yellow indicator
symbol for low level in the fuel tank is illumi-
nated. See also Trip computer (p. 114) and
Filling up with fuel (p. 296).
Temperature gauge for engine coolant
Speedometer
Tachometer. The meter indicates engine
speed in thousands of revolutions per minute
(rpm).
Power guide. See also Eco guide & Power
guide* (p. 70).
Gear shift indicator6 / Gear position indica-
tor7. See also Gear shift indicator* (p. 274)
or Automatic gearbox - Geartronic* (p. 274).
Indicator and warning symbols
Indicator and warning symbols, digital instrument panel.
Indicator symbols
Indicator and warning symbols
Warning symbols8
Functionality check
All indicator and warning symbols, apart from
symbols in the centre of the information display,
illuminate in key position II or when the engine is
started. When the engine has started, all the
symbols should go out except the parking brake
symbol, which only goes out when the brake is
disengaged.
If the engine does not start or if the functionality
check is carried out in key position II then all
symbols go out within a few seconds except the
symbol for faults in the car's emissions system
and the symbol for low oil pressure.
Related information
Combined instrument panel (p. 66)
Combined instrument panel - meaning of
indicator symbols (p. 71)
Combined instrument cluster - meaning of
warning symbols (p. 73)
Analogue combined instrument panel - over-
view (p. 66)
6Manual gearbox.
7Automatic gearbox.
5When the display's message Distance to empty fuel tank: starts to show ----, the marking becomes red.
8Certain engine variants do not have systems to warn of oil pressure loss. In cars with these variants the symbol for low oil pressure is not used. Warning for low oil level is via display text. For more information, see
Engine oil - general (p. 342).
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory.
70
Eco guide & Power guide*
Eco guide and Power guide are two combined
instrument panel (p. 66) instruments which help
the driver to drive the car with optimum driving
economy.
The car also stores statistics of journeys made,
which can be viewed in the form of a block dia-
gram; see Trip computer - trip statistics*
(p. 123).
Eco guide
This instrument provides an indication of how
economically the car is being driven.
To view this function, select the theme "Eco"; see
Digital combined instrument panel - overview
(p. 67).
Instantaneous value
Average value
Instantaneous value
The instantaneous value is shown here - the
higher the reading on the scale, the better.
The instantaneous value is calculated based on
speed, engine speed, engine power utilised plus
use of the foot brake.
Optimum speed (50-80 km/h (30-50 mph)) and
low engine speeds are encouraged. The pointers
fall during acceleration and braking.
Very low instantaneous values illuminate the red
zone on the meter (with a short delay), which
means poor driving economy and hence should
be avoided.
Average value
The average value slowly follows the instantane-
ous value and describes how the car has been
driven most recently. The higher the pointers on
the scale, the better the economy achieved by
the driver.
Power guide
This instrument shows the relationship between
how much power (Power) is being taken from the
engine and how much power is available.
To view this function, select the theme
"Performance"; see Digital combined instrument
panel - overview (p. 67).
Available engine power
Engine power utilised
Available engine power
The smaller, upper pointer shows the available
engine power9. The higher the reading on the
scale, the more power is available in the current
gear.
Engine power utilised
The larger, lower pointer shows the engine power
utilised9. The higher the reading on the scale, the
more power is being taken from the engine.
A large gap between the two pointers indicates a
large power reserve.
9Power is dependent on engine speed.
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
}}
* Option/accessory. 71
Combined instrument panel -
meaning of indicator symbols
The indicator symbols alert the driver that a func-
tion is activated, that the system is operating, or
that an error or failure has occurred.
Indicator symbols
Symbol Specification
ABL fault
Emissions system
ABS fault
Rear fog lamp on
Stability system, see Electronic sta-
bility control (ESC) - general
(p. 186)
Stability system, sport mode, see
Electronic stability control (ESC) -
operation (p. 187)
Engine preheater (diesel)
Low level in fuel tank
Information, read display text
Symbol Specification
Main beam On
Left-hand direction indicator
Right-hand direction indicator
Eco- function on, see Drive mode
ECO* (p. 287)
Start/Stop, the engine auto-stop-
ped; see Start/Stop* - function and
operation (p. 279)
Tyre pressure system , see Tyre
monitoring (TM)* (p. 326)
ABL fault
The symbol illuminates if a fault has arisen in the
ABL function (Active Bending Lights).
Emissions system
If the symbol illuminates after the engine has
been started then it may be due to a fault in the
car's emissions system. Drive to a workshop for
checking. Volvo recommends that you seek
assistance from an authorised Volvo workshop.
ABS fault
If this symbol illuminates then the system is not
working. The car's regular brake system contin-
ues to work, but without the ABS function.
1. Stop the car in a safe place and turn off the
engine.
2. Restart the engine.
3. If the symbol remains illuminated, drive to a
workshop to have the ABS system checked.
Volvo recommends that you seek assistance
from an authorised Volvo workshop.
Rear fog lamp on
This symbol illuminates when the rear fog lamp is
switched on. There is only one rear fog lamp - it
is located on the driver's side.
Stability system
A flashing symbol indicates that the stability sys-
tem is operating. If the symbol illuminates with
constant glow then there is a fault in the system.
Stability system, sport mode
The symbol illuminates when the sport mode is
activated. Sport mode allows for a more active
driving experience. The system then detects
whether the accelerator pedal, steering wheel
movements and cornering are more active than in
normal driving and then allows controlled skid-
ding of the rear section up to a certain level
before it intervenes and stabilises the car.
Engine preheater (diesel)
This symbol illuminates during engine preheating.
Preheating mostly takes place due to low tem-
perature.
||
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory.
72
Low level in fuel tank
When the symbol illuminates the level in the fuel
tank is low, refuel as soon as possible.
Information, read display text
When one of the car's systems does not behave
as intended, this information symbol illuminates
and a text appears on the information display.
The message text is cleared with the OK button,
see Menu navigation - combined instrument
panel (p. 110), or it disappears automatically
after a time (time depending on which function is
indicated). The information symbol can also illu-
minate in conjunction with other symbols.
NOTE
When a service message is shown, the sym-
bol and message are cleared using the OK
button, or disappear automatically after a
time.
Main beam On
The symbol illuminates when main beam is on
and with main beam flash.
Left/right-hand direction indicator
Both direction indicator symbols flash when the
hazard warning flashers are used.
Eco function on
This symbol illuminates when the Eco function is
activated.
Start/Stop
The symbol shines when the engine is auto-stop-
ped.
Tyre pressure system
The symbol illuminates in the event of low tyre
pressure, or if a fault arises in the tyre pressure
system.
Reminder – doors not closed
If one of the doors is not closed properly then the
information or warning symbol illuminates
together with an explanatory image in the infor-
mation display. Stop the car in a safe place as
soon as possible and close the door that is open.
If the car is driven at a speed lower than
approx. 7 km/h (approx. 4 mph) then the
information symbol illuminates.
If the car is driven at a speed higher than
approx. 7 km/h (approx. 4 mph) then the
warning symbol illuminates.
If the bonnet10 is not closed properly then the
warning symbol illuminates together with an
explanatory image in the information display. Stop
the car in a safe place as soon as possible and
close the bonnet.
If the tailgate is not closed properly then the
information symbol illuminates together with an
explanatory image in the information display. Stop
the car in a safe place as soon as possible and
close the tailgate.
Related information
Combined instrument panel (p. 66)
Combined instrument cluster - meaning of
warning symbols (p. 73)
Analogue combined instrument panel - over-
view (p. 66)
Digital combined instrument panel - overview
(p. 67)
10 Only cars with alarm*.
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
}}
73
Combined instrument cluster -
meaning of warning symbols
The warning symbols alert the driver that an
important function is activated, or that a serious
error or a serious failure has occurred.
Warning symbols
Symbol Specification
Low oil pressureA
Parking brake applied, digital
instrument panel
Parking brake applied, analogue
instrument panel
Airbags – SRS
Seatbelt reminder
Alternator not charging
Fault in brake system
Warning
ACertain engine variants do not have systems to warn of oil pres-
sure loss. In cars with these variants the symbol for low oil pres-
sure is not used. Warning for low oil level is via display text. For
more information, see Engine oil - general (p. 342).
Low oil pressure
If this symbol illuminates during driving then the
engine's oil pressure is too low. Stop the engine
immediately and check the engine oil level, top
up if necessary. If the symbol illuminates and the
oil level is normal, contact a workshop. Volvo rec-
ommends that you seek assistance from an
authorised Volvo workshop.
Parking brake applied
This symbol illuminates with a constant glow
when the parking brake is applied. The symbol is
illuminated during application. For more informa-
tion, see Parking brake (p. 291).
Airbags – SRS
If the symbol remains illuminated or illuminates
while driving, a fault has been detected in one of
the car's safety systems. Drive to a workshop for
checking as soon as possible. Volvo recommends
that you seek assistance from an authorised
Volvo workshop.
Seatbelt reminder
This symbol flashes if someone in a front seat
has not put on their seatbelt or if someone in a
rear seat has taken off their seatbelt.
Alternator not charging
This symbol illuminates during driving if a fault
has occurred in the electrical system. Visit a
workshop. Volvo recommends that you seek
assistance from an authorised Volvo workshop.
Fault in brake system
If this symbol illuminates, the brake fluid level
may be too low. Stop the car in a safe place and
check the level in the brake fluid reservoir; see
Brake and clutch fluid - level (p. 346).
If the brake and ABS symbols illuminate at the
same time, there may be a fault in the brake
force distribution system.
1. Stop the car in a safe place and turn off the
engine.
2. Restart the engine.
If both symbols extinguish, continue driv-
ing.
If the symbols remain illuminated, check
the level in the brake fluid reservoir; see
Brake and clutch fluid - level (p. 346). If
the brake fluid level is normal but the
symbols are still illuminated, the car can
be driven, with great care, to a workshop
to have the brake system checked. Volvo
recommends that you seek assistance
from an authorised Volvo workshop.
||
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory.
74
WARNING
If the brake fluid is below the MIN level in the
brake fluid reservoir, do not drive further
before topping up the brake fluid.
The loss of brake fluid must be investigated
by a workshop. Volvo recommends that you
contact an authorised Volvo workshop.
WARNING
If the BRAKE and ABS symbols are lit at the
same time, there is a risk that the rear end will
skid during heavy braking.
Warning
The red warning symbol illuminates when a fault
has been indicated which could affect the safety
and/or driveability of the car. An explanatory text
is shown on the information display at the same
time. The symbol remains visible until the fault
has been rectified but the text message can be
cleared with the OK button; see Menu navigation
- combined instrument panel (p. 110). The warn-
ing symbol can also illuminate in conjunction with
other symbols.
Action:
1. Stop in a safe place. Do not drive the car fur-
ther.
2. Read the information on the information dis-
play. Implement the action in accordance
with the message in the display. Clear the
message using the OK button.
Reminder – doors not closed
If one of the doors is not closed properly then the
information or warning symbol illuminates
together with an explanatory image in the infor-
mation display. Stop the car in a safe place as
soon as possible and close the door that is open.
If the car is driven at a speed lower than
approx. 7 km/h (approx. 4 mph) then the
information symbol illuminates.
If the car is driven at a speed higher than
approx. 7 km/h (approx. 4 mph) then the
warning symbol illuminates.
If the bonnet11 is not closed properly then the
warning symbol illuminates together with an
explanatory image in the information display. Stop
the car in a safe place as soon as possible and
close the bonnet.
If the tailgate is not closed properly then the
information symbol illuminates together with an
explanatory image in the information display. Stop
the car in a safe place as soon as possible and
close the tailgate.
Related information
Combined instrument panel (p. 66)
Combined instrument panel - meaning of
indicator symbols (p. 71)
Analogue combined instrument panel - over-
view (p. 66)
Digital combined instrument panel - overview
(p. 67)
11 Only cars with alarm*.
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
75
Outside temperature gauge
The display for the outside temperature gauge
appears in the combined instrument panel.
Display for outside temperature gauge, digi-
tal instrument panel
Display for outside temperature gauge, ana-
logue instrument panel
When the temperature lies between +2 °C to -5
°C a snowflake symbol illuminates in the display.
This warns of icy roads. If the car has been sta-
tionary, the gauge may display a reading that is
too high.
Related information
Combined instrument panel (p. 66)
Trip meter
The trip meter display appears in the combined
instrument panel.
Trip meter, digital instrument.
Display for trip meter12
The two trip meters T1 and T2 are used for
measuring short distances. The distance is
shown in the display.
Turn the left stalk switch thumbwheel to show
the required meter.
A long press (until the change occurs) on the
left-hand stalk switch's RESET button resets the
trip meter shown. For more information, see Trip
computer (p. 114).
Related information
Combined instrument panel (p. 66)
Clock
The clock display appears in the combined
instrument panel.
Clock, digital instrument panel.
Display for showing the time13
Set the clock
The clock can be adjusted in the menu system
MY CAR, see MY CAR (p. 113).
Related information
Combined instrument panel (p. 66)
12 Display appearance may differ depending on instrument variant.
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
76
Combined instrument panel -
license agreement
A license is an agreement for the right to oper-
ate a certain activity or the right to use someone
else's entitlement according to the terms and
conditions in the agreement. The following text is
Volvo's agreement with the manufacturer/devel-
oper.
Combined Instrument Panel Software
Open Source Software Notice
This product uses certain free / open source and
other software originating from third parties, that
is subject to the GNU Lesser General Public
License version 2 (LGPLv2), The FreeType
Project License ("FreeType License") and other
different and/or additional copy right licenses,
disclaimers and notices. The links to access the
exact terms of LGPLv2, and the other open
source software licenses, disclaimers,
acknowledgements and notices are provided to
you below. Please refer to the exact terms of the
relevant License, regarding your rights under said
licenses. Volvo Car Corporation (VCC) offers to
provide the source code of said free/open source
software to you for a charge covering the cost of
performing such distribution, such as the cost of
media, shipping and handling, upon written
request. Please contact your nearest Volvo
Dealer.
The offer is valid for a period of at least three (3)
years from the date of the distribution of this
product by VCC / or for as long as VCC offers
spare parts or customer support.
Portions of this product uses software
copyrighted © 2007 The FreeType Project
(www.freetype.org). All rights reserved.
Portions of this product uses software with
Copyright © 1994–2013 Lua.org, PUC-Rio
(http://www.lua.org/)
This product includes software under
following licenses:
LGPL v2.1: http://www.gnu.org/licenses/old-
licenses/lgpl-2.1.html
GNU FriBidi
DevIL
The FreeType Project License: http://
git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/freetype/freetype2.git/
tree/docs/FTL.TXT
FreeType 2
MIT License: http://opensource.org/licenses/
mit-license.html
Lua
13 The time is shown in the middle of the instrument panel when an analogue instrument panel is fitted.
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
}}
* Option/accessory. 77
Symbols in the display
There are a variety of different symbols in the
display in the car. The symbols are divided into
warning, indicator and information symbols.
Shown below are the most common symbols with
their meanings and a reference to where in the
manual further information can be found.
- Red warning symbol, illuminates when a
fault has been indicated which could affect the
safety and/or driveability of the car. An explana-
tory text is shown on the information display in
the combined instrument panel at the same time.
- When one of the car's systems does not
behave as intended, this information symbol illu-
minates, and a text appears on the information
display in the combined instrument panel. The
yellow information symbol can also illuminate in
conjunction with other symbols.
Warning symbols in the combined
instrument panel
Symbol Specification See
Low oil pressure (p. 73)
Parking brake
applied, digital
instrument panel
(p. 73),
(p. 291)
Symbol Specification See
Parking brake
applied, analogue
instrument panel
(p. 73)
Airbags – SRS (p. 32),
(p. 73)
Seatbelt reminder (p. 28),
(p. 73)
Alternator not charg-
ing
(p. 73)
Fault in brake sys-
tem
(p. 73),
(p. 289)
Warning, safety
mode
(p. 32),
(p. 42),
(p. 73)
Control symbols in the combined
instrument panel
Symbol Specification See
ABL fault*(p. 71),
(p. 94)
Emissions system (p. 71)
ABS fault (p. 71),
(p. 289)
Symbol Specification See
Rear fog lamp on (p. 71),
(p. 98)
Stability system,
ESC (Electronic
Stability Control),
Trailer stability
assist*
(p. 71),
(p. 189),
(p. 309)
Stability system,
sport mode
(p. 71),
(p. 189)
Engine preheater
(diesel)
(p. 71)
Low level in fuel
tank
(p. 71),
(p. 143)
Information, read
display text
(p. 71)
Main beam On (p. 71),
(p. 91)
Left-hand direction
indicators
(p. 71)
Right-hand direc-
tion indicators
(p. 71)
Start/Stop*, engine
auto-stopped
(p. 71),
(p. 279)
||
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory.
78
Symbol Specification See
ECO function* on (p. 71),
(p. 287)
Tyre pressure sys-
tem*
(p. 71), Tyre
monitoring
(TM)*
(p. 326)
Information symbols in the combined
instrument panel
Symbol Specification See
Main beam with auto
dimming - AHB*
(p. 92)
Camera sensor*,
Laser sensor*
(p. 92),
(p. 227),
(p. 236),
(p. 248),
(p. 253)
Adaptive cruise con-
trol*
(p. 214)
Adaptive cruise con-
trol*
(p. 206),
(p. 214)
Adaptive cruise con-
trol*, Distance Warn-
ing* (Distance Alert)
(p. 214),
(p. 199)
Adaptive cruise con-
trol*
(p. 205)
Symbol Specification See
Cruise control*(p. 194)
Speed limiter (p. 191)
Radar sensor*(p. 214),
(p. 202),
(p. 236)
Start/Stop*(p. 285)
Start/Stop*(p. 285)
Start/Stop*(p. 285)
Distance warning*
(Distance Alert), City
SafetyTM, Collision
warning system*,
Auto-brake*
(p. 202),
(p. 227),
(p. 236)
Engine block and
passenger compart-
ment heater*
(p. 143)
Symbol Specification See
Engine block heater
and passenger com-
partment heater*
Service required
(p. 143)
Activated timer*(p. 143)
Activated timer*(p. 143)
ABL system*(p. 94)
Low battery (p. 143)
Park Assist Pilot -
PAP*
(p. 262)
Rain sensor*(p. 102)
Lane assistance*(p. 251)
Driver Alert System*,
Lane assistance*
(p. 253)
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
}}
* Option/accessory. 79
Symbol Specification See
Driver Alert System*,
Lane assistance*
(p. 248),
(p. 253)
Driver Alert System*,
Time for a break
(p. 247)
Driver Alert System*,
Time for a break
(p. 248)
Gear shift indicator (p. 274)
Gear positions (p. 274)
Recorded speed
information*
(p. 243)
Measuring the oil
level
(p. 343)
Information symbols in the roof console
display
Symbol Specification See
Seatbelt reminder (p. 31)
Airbag, passenger seat,
activated
(p. 36)
Airbag, passenger seat,
deactivated
(p. 36)
Related information
Combined instrument panel - meaning of
indicator symbols (p. 71)
Combined instrument cluster - meaning of
warning symbols (p. 73)
Messages - handling (p. 113)
Volvo Sensus
Volvo Sensus is the heart of the personal Volvo
experience and connects you with the car and
outside world. Sensus provides information,
entertainment and assistance when it is needed.
Sensus consists of intuitive functions that both
enhance the car journey and simplifies owner-
ship of the car.
An intuitive navigation structure makes it possible
to receive relevant support, information and
entertainment when it is necessary, without dis-
tracting the driver.
Sensus covers all the car's solutions that enable
connection* to the outside world and provides
you with intuitive control over all the car's capabil-
ities.
Volvo Sensus combines and presents many func-
tions in several of the car's systems on the centre
console's screen. With Volvo Sensus the car can
be personalised by means of an intuitive user
||
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory.
80
interface. Settings can be made in Car settings,
Audio and media, Climate control, etc.
With the centre console buttons and controls or
the steering wheel's right-hand keypad* functions
can be activated or deactivated and many differ-
ent settings can be made.
With a press on MY CAR all settings related to
the driving and control of the car are presented,
such as City Safety, locks and alarm, automatic
fan speed, setting the clock, etc.
With a press on the respective function RADIO,
MEDIA, TEL*, *, NAV* and CAM14 other
sources, systems and functions can be activated,
e.g. AM, FM, CD, DVD*, TV*, Bluetooth®*, naviga-
tion* and park assist camera*.
For more information about all functions/
systems, see the relevant section in the owner's
manual or its supplement.
Overview
Control panel in centre console. The figure is schematic
- the number of functions and layout of the buttons both
vary, depending on the equipment selected and the mar-
ket.
Navigation* - NAV, see separate supplement
(Sensus Navigation).
Audio and media - RADIO, MEDIA, TEL*, see
separate supplement (Sensus Infotainment).
Internet-connected car - *, see separate
supplement (Sensus Infotainment).
Climate control system (p. 126).
Function settings - MY CAR, see MY CAR
(p. 113).
Key positions
The remote control key can be used to set the
vehicle's electrical system in different modes/
levels so that different functions are available;
see Key positions - functions at different levels
(p. 81).
Ignition switch with remote control key extracted/
inserted.
NOTE
For cars with the keyless start and lock sys-
tem* function the key does not need to be
inserted into the ignition switch but can be
stored in e.g. a pocket. For more information
on the keyless start and lock system, see
Keyless drive* (p. 169).
14 Applies to certain car models.
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
}}
81
Insert the key
1. Hold the end of the remote control key with
the detachable key blade and insert the key
in the ignition switch.
2. Then press the key in the lock up to its end
position.
IMPORTANT
Foreign objects in the ignition switch can
impair the function or destroy the lock.
Do not press in the remote control key incor-
rectly turned - Hold the end with the detacha-
ble key blade; see Detachable key blade -
detaching/attaching (p. 167).
Withdraw the key
Grip the remote control key and pull it out from
the ignition switch.
Key positions - functions at different
levels
To enable the use of a limited number of func-
tions with the engine switched off, the car's elec-
trical system can be set in 3 different levels - 0, I
and II - with the remote control key. This owner's
manual describes these levels throughout using
the denomination "key positions".
The following table shows the functions available
in each key position/level.
Level Functions
0Odometer, clock and temperature
gauge are illuminated.
Electrically operated seats can be
adjusted.
The audio system can be used for
a limited time - see the Sensus
Infotainment supplement.
ISunroof, power windows, 12 V
socket in the passenger compart-
ment, navigation, phone, ventilation
fan and windscreen wipers can be
used.
II The headlamps come on.
Warning/indicator lamps illuminate
for 5 seconds.
Several other systems are acti-
vated. However, electric heating in
seat cushions and the rear window
can only be activated after starting
the engine.
This key position consumes a lot of
current from the starter battery and
should therefore be avoided!
||
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory.
82
Selecting key position/level
Key position 0 - Unlock the car - This
means that the car's electrical system is at
level 0.
NOTE
To reach level I or II without starting the
engine - do not depress the brake/clutch
pedal when these key positions are due to be
selected.
Key position I - With the remote control key
fully inserted into the ignition switch15 -
Briefly press START/STOP ENGINE.
Key position II - With the remote control
key fully inserted into the ignition switch15 -
Give a long16 press on START/STOP
ENGINE.
Back to key position 0 - To return to key
position 0 from position II and I - Briefly
press on START/STOP ENGINE.
Audio system
For information on audio system functions with
remote control key removed, see the Sensus
Infotainment supplement.
Starting and stopping the engine
For information about starting/switching off the
engine, see Starting the engine (p. 270).
Towing
For important information about the remote con-
trol key during towing, see Towing (p. 310).
Related information
Key positions (p. 80)
Seats, front
The car's front seats have different setting
options for optimum seating comfort.
To adjust lumbar support*, turn the wheel17.
Forward/backward: lift the handle to adjust
the distance to the steering wheel and ped-
als. Check that the seat is locked after
adjusting position.
To raise/lower the front edge of seat cush-
ion*, pump up/down.
Adjust backrest rake, turn the wheel.
Raise/lower the seat*, pump up/down.
Control panel for power seat*, see Seats,
front - electrically operated (p. 84).
15 Not required for cars with keyless start and lock system*.
16 Approx. 2 seconds.
17 Also applies to electrically operated seat.
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory. 83
WARNING
Adjust the position of the driver's seat before
setting off, never while driving. Make sure that
the seat is in locked position in order to avoid
personal injury in the event of heavy braking
or an accident.
Adjusting the front seat head restraints
The height of the head restraints can be adjusted.
Adjust the head restraint based on the person's
height so that the whole of the back of the head
is covered if possible.
To adjust the height, the button (see illustration)
must be pressed while the restraint is moved up
or down.
The head restraint can be adjusted in three dif-
ferent positions.
Lowering the passenger seat backrest*
The passenger seat backrest can be folded for-
ward to make room for long loads.
Move the seat as far back/down as possible.
Adjust the backrest to an upright position.
Lift the catches on the rear of the backrest
and fold it forward.
4. Push the seat forward so that the head
restraint "locks" in under the glovebox.
Raising takes place in reverse order.
WARNING
Do not use the seat behind the passenger
seat, or the rear centre seat, when the pas-
senger seat's backrest is lowered.
WARNING
Grasp the backrest and make sure that it is
properly locked after being folded up in order
to avoid personal injury in the event of sudden
braking or an accident.
Related information
Seats, front - electrically operated (p. 84)
Seats, rear (p. 85)
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory.
84
Seats, front - electrically operated
The car's front seats have different setting
options for optimum seating comfort. The power
seat can be moved forward/backward and up/
down. The front edge of the seat cushion can be
raised/lowered. The backrest angle can be
changed.
Electrically operated seat*
Front edge of seat cushion up/down
Raise/lower seat
Seat, forward/backward
Backrest rake
The power seats have overload protection which
is tripped if a seat is blocked by an object. If this
should happen, set the car's electrical system in
key position I or 0 and wait a short time before
adjusting the seat again.
Only one movement (forward/back/up/down)
can be made at a time.
Preparations
The seat can be adjusted for a certain time after
unlocking the door with the remote control key
without the key in the ignition switch. Seat adjust-
ment is normally made in key position I and can
always be made when the engine is running.
Seat with memory function*
The memory function stores settings for the seat
and the door mirrors.
Store setting
Memory button
Memory button
Memory button
Button for storing settings
1. Adjust the seat and the door mirrors.
2. Press and hold button M while pressing but-
ton 1, 2 or 3 simultaneously. Hold the but-
tons depressed until the acoustic signal is
heard and the text is shown the combined
instrument panel.
The seat must be adjusted again before a new
memory can be set.
Using a stored setting
Press one of the memory buttons 1-3 until the
seat and the door mirrors stop. If the button is
released, the movement of the seat and door mir-
rors will be interrupted.
Key memory* in remote control key
All remote control keys can be used by different
drivers to store the settings for the driver's seat
and door mirrors18, see Remote control key - per-
sonalisation* (p. 161).
18 Only if the car is equipped with power seat with memory and retractable power door mirrors.
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
}}
* Option/accessory. 85
Emergency stop
If the seat accidentally begins to move, press one
of the setting buttons for the seat or memory
buttons in order to stop the seat.
WARNING
Risk of crushing! Make sure that children do
not play with the controls. Check that there
are no objects in front of, behind or under the
seat during adjustment. Make sure that none
of the passengers in the rear seat is in danger
of becoming trapped.
Heated seats
For heated seats, see Heated front seats*
(p. 133) and Heated rear seat* (p. 133).
Related information
Seats, front (p. 82)
Seats, rear (p. 85)
Seats, rear
The rear seat backrest and the outer seat head
restraints can be folded. The centre seat head
restraint can be adjusted to suit the height of the
passenger.
Head restraint, centre seat, rear
Adjust the head restraint according to passenger
height so that the whole of the back of the head
is covered if possible. Slide it up as required.
To lower the head restraint again, the button (see
illustration) must be pressed while the restraint is
carefully moved down.
The head restraint can be adjusted in five differ-
ent positions.
WARNING
The centre seat head restraint must be in its
lowest position when the centre seat is not
used. When the centre seat is used, the head
restraint must be correctly adjusted to the
height of the passenger so that it covers the
whole of the back of the head if possible.
Manual lowering of the outer head
restraints, rear seat
Pull the locking handle closest to the head
restraint to fold the head restraint forward.
The head restraint is moved back manually.
WARNING
The head restraint must be in locked position
after being folded up.
||
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
86
Lowering the rear seat backrest
IMPORTANT
When the backrest is to be folded, the rear
seat cup holder must not be open and there
must be no objects in the rear seat. Nor may
the seat belts be connected. Otherwise there
is a risk of damage to the rear seat uphols-
tery.
NOTE
The front seats may need to be pushed for-
wards, and/or the backrests adjusted
upwards, in order that the rear backrests can
be fully folded forward.
Both sections can be folded separately.
If the entire backrest is to be folded then the
different sections should be folded sepa-
rately.
If the right-hand section is being lowered -
release and adjust head restraint for the cen-
tre seat, see the earlier section "Head
restraint, centre seat, rear".
The outer head restraints are lowered auto-
matically when the backrests are lowered.
Pull up the backrest's locking handle
while folding the backrest forward at the
same time. A red indicator on the lock catch
shows that the backrest is no longer
locked in place.
NOTE
When the backrests have been lowered the
head restraints must be moved forward
slightly so as not to make contact with the
seat cushion.
Raising takes place in reverse order.
NOTE
When the backrest has been raised, the red
indicator should no longer be showing. If it is
still showing then the backrest is not locked
in place.
WARNING
Check that the backrests and head restraints
in the rear seat are locked properly after
being folded up.
Related information
Seats, front (p. 82)
Seats, front - electrically operated (p. 84)
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
}}
* Option/accessory. 87
Steering wheel
The steering wheel can be adjusted in different
positions and has controls for horn and cruise
control, as well as menu, audio and phone con-
trol.
Adjusting
Adjusting the steering wheel.
Lever - releasing the steering wheel
Possible steering wheel positions
The steering wheel can be adjusted for both
height and depth:
1. Push the lever forwards to release the steer-
ing wheel.
2. Adjust the steering wheel to the position that
suits you.
3. Pull the lever back to fix the steering wheel
in place. If the lever is stiff, press the steering
wheel lightly at the same time as you push
the lever back.
WARNING
Adjust the steering wheel and fix it before
driving away.
With speed related power steering* the level of
steering force can be adjusted, see Adjustable
steering force* (p. 186).
Keypads* and paddles*
Keypads and paddles in the steering wheel.
Cruise control* (p. 194)* and Adaptive cruise
control (ACC)* (p. 203)*.
Paddle for manual gear changing in an auto-
matic gearbox, see Automatic gearbox -
Geartronic* (p. 274).
Audio and phone control, see supplement,
Sensus Infotainment.
||
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory.
88
Horn
Horn.
Press the centre of the steering wheel to signal.
Light switches
The headlamp control activates and adjusts the
external lighting. It is also used to adjust display
and instrument lighting and ambience lights
(p. 100).
Overview, light switches.
Thumbwheel for adjusting display and instru-
ment lighting as well as ambience lights*
Button for rear fog lamp
Knob for lighting while driving and parking
Thumbwheel for headlamp levelling
A car with LED19 headlamps* has automatic
headlamp levelling and therefore does not have
the thumbwheel for headlamp levelling.
Knob positions
Position Specification
Daytime running lightsA when the
car's electrical system is in key
position II or the engine is running.
Main beam flash can be used.
Daytime running lights, side marker
lamps rear and position lamps
when the car's electrical system is
in key position II or the engine is
running.
Side marker lamps rear and posi-
tion lamps when the car is parkedB.
Main beam flash can be used.
Daytime running lights, side marker
lamps rear and position lamps in
daylight when the car's electrical
system is in key position II or the
engine is running.
Dipped beam, side marker lamps
rear and position lamps in weak
daylight or darkness, or when rear
fog lamps are activated.
The tunnel detection (p. 91)*
function is activated.
19 LED (Light Emitting Diode)
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory. 89
Position Specification
The Active main beam (p. 92)*
function can be used.
Main beam can be activated when
dipped beam is switched on.
Main beam flash can be used.
Dipped beam, side marker lamps
rear and position lamps.
Main beam can be activated.
Main beam flash can be used.
AFitted in or under the front bumper.
BAlso at idle when the engine is running, provided that the knob
is moved to this position from another position.
Volvo recommends that mode is used
when the car is driven.
WARNING
The car's audio system is not able to deter-
mine when daylight is too weak or sufficiently
strong, e.g. in fog and rain, in all situations.
The driver is always responsible for ensuring
that the car is driven with a beam pattern suit-
able for the traffic situation and in accordance
with applicable traffic regulations.
Display and instrument lighting
Different display and instrument lighting is
switched on depending on key position; see Key
positions - functions at different levels (p. 81).
The display lighting is automatically subdued in
darkness - the sensitivity is set with the thumb-
wheel.
The intensity of the instrument lighting is
adjusted with the thumbwheel.
Headlamp levelling
The load in the car changes the vertical align-
ment of the headlamp beam, which could dazzle
oncoming motorists. Avoid this by adjusting the
height of the beam. Lower the beam if the car is
heavily laden.
1. Leave the engine running, or have the car's
electrical system in key position I.
2. Roll the thumbwheel up/down to raise/lower
beam alignment.
Thumbwheel positions for different load cases.
Only driver
Driver and passenger in the front passenger
seat
Occupants in all seats
Occupants in all seats and maximum load in
the cargo area
Driver and maximum load in the cargo area
Related information
Position lamps (p. 90)
Daytime running lights (p. 90)
Main/dipped beam (p. 91)
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
90
Position lamps
Position lamps are switched on using the head-
lamp control's knob.
Knob for headlamp control in the position for position
lamps.
Turn the knob to the position for (number
plate lighting is switched on at the same time).
If the car's electrical system is in key position II or
the engine is running then the daytime running
lights also switch on.
When it is dark outside and the tailgate is
opened the rear position lamps illuminate to alert
traffic behind. This takes place irrespective of
what position the knob is in or what key position
the car's electrical system is in.
When driving for more than 30 seconds at max.
10 km/h (approx. 6 mph), or if the speed
exceeds 10 km/h (approx. 6 mph), the daytime
running lights are switched on and Reset light
switch position is shown in the combined
instrument panel, which prompts you to turn to a
mode other than .
Related information
Light switches (p. 88)
Daytime running lights
With the knob for headlamp control in
position, and the car's electrical system in key
position II or the engine running, the daytime
running lights are activated automatically in day-
light.
Daytime running lights during the day.
DRL
Knob for headlamp control in AUTO position.
With the knob for headlamp control in
position the daytime running lights (Daytime
Running Lights - DRL) are activated automati-
cally when the car is driven in daylight. A light
sensor on the top of the instrument panel
changes from daytime running lights to dipped
beam at twilight or when daylight becomes too
weak. Switching to dipped beam also takes place
when the rear fog lamps are activated.
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
}}
* Option/accessory. 91
WARNING
This system help to save energy - it cannot
determine in all situations when daylight is too
weak or sufficiently strong, e.g. in mist and
rain.
The driver is always responsible for ensuring
that the car is driven with the correct beam
pattern for the traffic situation and in accord-
ance with applicable traffic regulations.
Related information
Main/dipped beam (p. 91)
Light switches (p. 88)
Tunnel detection*
Tunnel detection changes the lighting from day-
time running lights to dipped beam when the car
is driven into a tunnel.
The tunnel detection function is available in cars
with rain sensor*. The sensor detects the
entrance to a tunnel and resets the lighting from
daytime running lights to dipped beam. Approx.
20 seconds after the car has left the tunnel, the
lighting returns to daytime running lights. If the
car is driven into another tunnel within this time
period then dipped beam is kept switched on.
This prevents frequent changes to the car's beam
pattern.
Note that the headlamp control's knob must
remain in position for tunnel detection to
work.
Related information
Main/dipped beam (p. 91)
Light switches (p. 88)
Main/dipped beam
With the knob for headlamp control in position
and the car's electrical system in key posi-
tion II or the engine running, the dipped beam is
activated automatically in poor light conditions.
Stalk switch and knob for headlamp control.
Position for main beam flash
Position for main beam
Dipped beam
With the knob in position, dipped beam is
activated automatically at dusk or when daylight
becomes too weak. Dipped beam is also acti-
vated automatically if the rear fog lamp is acti-
vated.
With the knob in position, dipped beam is
always switched on when the engine is running
or when key position II is active.
||
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory.
92
Main beam flash
Move the stalk switch gently towards the steering
wheel to the position for main beam flash. Main
beam comes on until the stalk switch is released.
Main beam
Main beam can be activated when the knob is in
position 20 or . Activate/deactivate
main beam by moving the stalk switch towards
the steering wheel to the end position and then
releasing. Alternatively, the main beam can be
deactivated by a light press of the stalk switch
toward the steering wheel.
When main beam has been activated the
symbol illuminates in the combined instrument
panel.
Related information
Active bending lights* (p. 94)
Active main beam* (p. 92)
Light switches (p. 88)
Headlamps - adjusting headlamp pattern
(p. 95)
Tunnel detection* (p. 91)
Active main beam*
Active main beam function detects the headlamp
beams from oncoming traffic or the rear lights of
vehicles in front, and switches the lighting from
main beam to dipped beam. The lighting returns
to main beam when the incoming light has stop-
ped.
Active main beam - AHB
Active main beam (Active High Beam - AHB) is a
function which uses a camera sensor at the top
edge of the windscreen to detect the headlamp
beams from oncoming traffic or the rear lights of
vehicles in front, and then switches from main
beam to dipped beam. The function can also take
streetlights into account.
The lighting returns to main beam about a sec-
ond after the camera sensor no longer detects
the headlamp beams from oncoming traffic or the
rear lights from vehicles in front.
Activating/deactivating
AHB can be activated when the headlamp con-
trol's knob is in position (provided that the
function has not been deactivated in the menu
system MY CAR, see MY CAR (p. 113)).
Stalk switch and knob for headlamp control in AUTO
position.
The function can start while driving in the dark
when the car's speed is approx. 20 km/h
(12 mph) or higher.
Activate/deactivate AHB by moving the left-hand
stalk switch towards the steering wheel to the
end position and then releasing. Deactivation
when main beam is on means that the lights are
reset directly to dipped beam.
Car with analogue combined instrument
panel
When AHB is activated the symbol illumi-
nates in the instrument's information display.
20 When dipped beam is activated.
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory. 93
When main beam has been switched on the
symbol also illuminates in the combined
instrument panel.
Car with digital combined instrument panel
When AHB is activated the symbol turns
white in the instrument's information display.
When main beam is activated, the symbol shines
blue.
Manual operation
NOTE
Keep the windscreen surface in front of the
camera sensor free from ice, snow, mist and
dirt.
Do not stick or attach anything to the wind-
screen in front of the camera sensor as this
may reduce effectiveness or cause one or
more of the systems dependent on the cam-
era to stop working.
If the message Active main beam Temporary
unavailable Switch manually is shown in the
combined instrument panel's information display
then you have to switch manually between main
and dipped beam. However, the knob for head-
lamp control can still remain in position .
The same applies if the message Windscreen
sensors blocked See manual and the
symbol are shown. The symbol goes out
when these messages are shown.
AHB may be temporarily unavailable e.g. in situa-
tions with dense fog or heavy rain. When AHB
becomes available again, or the windscreen sen-
sors are no longer blocked, the message goes
out and the symbol illuminates.
WARNING
AHB is an aid for using the optimum beam
pattern when conditions are favourable.
The driver always bears responsibility for man-
ually switching between main and dipped
beam when traffic situations or weather con-
ditions so require.
IMPORTANT
Examples of when manual switching between
main and dipped beam may be required:
In heavy rain or dense fog
In freezing rain
In snow flurries or slush
In moonlight
When driving in poorly lit built-up areas
When the traffic ahead has weak lighting
If there are pedestrians on or beside the
road
If there are highly reflective objects such
as signs in the vicinity of the road
When the lighting from oncoming traffic
is obscured by e.g. a crash barrier
When there is traffic on connecting roads
On the brow of a hill or in a hollow
In sharp bends.
For more information on the limitations of the
camera sensor, see Collision warning system* -
camera sensor limitations (p. 235).
Related information
Main/dipped beam (p. 91)
Light switches (p. 88)
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory.
94
Active bending lights*
Active bending lights are designed to provide
maximum illumination in bends and junctions.
Cars with LED21 headlamps* can have active
bending lights, depending on the car's equip-
ment level.
Headlamp pattern with function deactivated (left) and
activated (right) respectively.
The LED headlamps can include the Active bend-
ing lights function, depending on the car's equip-
ment level. Active bending lights follow steering
wheel movements to provide maximum illumina-
tion in bends and junctions and thereby increase
safety.
The function is activated automatically when the
car is started (provided that it has not been deac-
tivated in the menu system MY CAR, see MY
CAR (p. 113)). In the event of a fault in the func-
tion the symbol illuminates in the com-
bined instrument panel at the same time as the
information display shows an explanatory text and
a further illuminated symbol.
Symbol Message Specification
Headlamp
system
malfunction
Service
required
The system is dis-
engaged. Visit a
workshop if the
message remains.
Volvo recommends
that you contact an
authorised Volvo
workshop.
The function is only active in twilight or darkness
and only when the car is moving.
The function22 can be deactivated/activated in
the menu system MY CAR, see MY CAR
(p. 113).
Related information
Main/dipped beam (p. 91)
Active main beam* (p. 92)
Light switches (p. 88)
21 LED (Light Emitting Diode)
22 Activated on delivery from the factory.
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
}}
* Option/accessory. 95
Headlamps - adjusting headlamp
pattern
The halogen headlamp pattern must be adjusted
to avoid dazzling oncoming motorists and can
be set for right or left-hand traffic.
LED headlamps*
The light pattern does not need to be adjusted.
The headlamp pattern is designed in such a way
that oncoming traffic is not dazzled.
Halogen headlamps
The headlamp pattern for halogen headlamps is
readjusted by masking the headlamp lens. The
headlamp pattern may not be as good.
Masking the headlamps
1. Copy the A and B templates for left-hand
drive cars or the C and D templates for right-
hand drive cars, see later section "Templates
for halogen headlamps". The templates have
a scale of 1:2. Use a photocopier with a
zoom function for example, and copy the
templates at 200 %:
A = LHD Right (left-hand drive, right lens)
B = LHD Left (left-hand drive, left lens)
C = RHD Right (right-hand drive, right
lens)
D = RHD Left (right-hand drive, left lens)
2. Transfer the template to a self-adhesive
waterproof material and cut it out.
3. Start from the design lines on the headlamp
lenses; see the lines in the following figure.
Position the self-adhesive templates at the
design lines with the help of the illustration.
||
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
96
Upper row: left-hand drive cars, templates A and B. Lower row: right-hand drive cars, templates C and D.
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
97
Templates for halogen headlamps
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
98
Rear fog lamp
When visibility is reduced by fog the rear fog
lamp can be used so that other road users can
detect the vehicle in front at an early stage.
Button for rear fog lamp.
The rear fog lamp consists of a lamp on the left-
hand side in a left-hand drive car, or on the right-
hand side in a right-hand drive car.
The rear fog lamp can only be switched on when
key position II is active or the engine is running
and the headlamp control's knob is in position
or .
Press the button for On/Off. The indicator sym-
bol in the combined instrument panel and
the light in the button both illuminate when the
rear fog lamp is switched on.
The rear fog lamp is switched off automatically
when the START/STOP ENGINE button is
depressed or when the headlamp control's knob
is turned to position or .
NOTE
Regulations on the use of rear fog lamps vary
from country to country.
Related information
Light switches (p. 88)
Brake lights
The brake light automatically comes on during
braking.
The brake light is switched on when the brake
pedal is depressed. In addition, it is switched on
when one of driving support systems Adaptive
cruise control (p. 203), City Safety (p. 221) or
Collision warning system (p. 228) brakes the car.
Related information
Foot brake - emergency brake lights and
automatic hazard warning flashers (p. 290)
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
}}
99
Hazard warning flashers
The hazard warning flashers warn other road
users by means of all of the car's direction indi-
cator lamps flashing simultaneously when this
function is activated.
Button for hazard warning flashers.
Press the button to activate the hazard warning
flashers. Both direction indicator symbols in the
combined instrument panel flash when the haz-
ard warning flashers are used.
The hazard warning flashers are activated auto-
matically when the car has been braked so sud-
denly that the emergency brake lights have been
activated and speed is below approx. 10 km/h
(6 mph). The hazard warning flashers remain
active when the car has stopped and are deacti-
vated automatically when you start driving again;
they can also be deactivated by pressing the but-
ton.
Related information
direction indicators (p. 99)
Foot brake - emergency brake lights and
automatic hazard warning flashers (p. 290)
direction indicators
The car's direction indicators are operated with
the left-hand stalk switch. The direction indicator
lamps flash three times or continuously, depend-
ing on how far up or down the stalk switch is
moved.
Direction indicators.
Short flash sequence
Move the stalk switch up or down to the first
position and release. The direction indicator
lamps flash three times. The function can be
activated/deactivated in the menu system
MY CAR, see MY CAR (p. 113).
Continuous flash sequence
Move the stalk switch up or down to its end
position.
||
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory.
100
The stalk switch remains in its position and is
moved back manually, or automatically by the
steering wheel movement.
Direction indicator symbols
For direction indicator symbols, see Combined
instrument panel - meaning of indicator symbols
(p. 71).
Related information
Hazard warning flashers (p. 99)
Interior lighting
The passenger compartment lighting is acti-
vated/deactivated with the buttons in the con-
trols above the front seats and the rear seat.
Controls in roof console for the front reading lamps and
passenger compartment lighting.
Reading lamp, left-hand side
Passenger compartment lighting (floor
lamps* and ceiling lamps) - On/Off
Auto function for passenger compartment
lighting
Reading lamp, right-hand side
All lighting in the passenger compartment can be
switched on and off manually within 30 minutes
from when:
the engine has been switched off and the
car's electrical system is in key position 0
the car has been unlocked but the engine
has not been started.
Front reading lamps*
The reading lamps are switched on or off by
briefly pressing the relevant button in the roof
console.
Brightness is adjusted by holding the button
pressed in.
Rear reading lamps*
Rear reading lamps.
The lamps are switched on or off by briefly press-
ing the relevant button.
Brightness is adjusted by holding the button
pressed in.
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory. 101
Floor lighting as ambient light*
To make the interior brighter while driving the
floor lighting can be activated at dimmed level.
Floor lamp intensity can be changed in the menu
system MY CAR, see MY CAR (p. 113).
Lighting in the front door storage
compartments*
Lighting in the front door storage compartments
comes on when the engine starts.
Glovebox lighting
Glovebox lighting is switched on and off respec-
tively when the lid is opened or closed.
Vanity mirror lighting
The lighting for the vanity mirror (p. 152) is
switched on and off respectively when the cover
is opened or closed.
Lighting in the cargo area
The lighting in the cargo area is switched on and
off respectively when the tailgate is opened or
closed.
Auto function for passenger
compartment lighting
The auto function is activated when the lamp in
the AUTO button is lit.
The passenger compartment lighting is then
switched on and off as indicated below.
The passenger compartment lighting is switched
on and remains on for 30 seconds if:
the car is unlocked with the remote control
key or key blade, see Remote control key -
functions (p. 164) or Detachable key blade -
unlocking doors (p. 168)
the engine has been switched off and the
car's electrical system is in key position 0.
Passenger compartment lighting is switched off
when:
the engine is started
the car is locked.
The passenger compartment lighting is switched
on and off respectively when a side door is
opened or closed.
It remains switched on for two minutes if one of
the doors is open.
If any lighting is switched on manually and the
car is locked then it will be switched off automati-
cally after two minutes.
Ambience lights*
When the normal passenger compartment light-
ing is switched off and the engine is running, an
LED illuminates in the front and rear roof console
respectively in order to provide a low light and
enhance the ambience while driving. The light
also makes it easier during dark periods of the
day to see objects in storage compartments, etc.
This lighting switches off when the engine is
switched off. The intensity and colour of the light
can be changed in the menu system MY CAR,
see MY CAR (p. 113).
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
102
Home safe lighting
Home safe lighting consists of dipped beam,
position lamps, lamps in the outside handles and
number plate lighting.
Some of the exterior lighting can be kept
switched on to work as home safe lighting after
the car has been locked.
1. Remove the remote control key from the
ignition switch.
2. Move the left-hand stalk switch toward the
steering wheel to the end position and
release it. The function can be activated in
the same way as with main beam flash; see
Main/dipped beam (p. 91).
3. Get out of the car and lock the door.
When the function is activated, dipped beam,
position lamps, lamps in the outside handles and
number plate lighting are switched on.
The length of time for which the home safe light-
ing should be kept on can be set in the menu
system MY CAR, see MY CAR (p. 113).
Related information
Approach light duration (p. 102)
Approach light duration
Approach lighting consists of position lamps,
lamps in the door mirrors, number plate lighting,
interior roof lighting as well as floor lighting.
Approach lighting is switched on with the remote
control key, see Remote control key - functions
(p. 164), and is used to switch on the car's light-
ing at a distance.
When the function is activated with the remote
control key, position lamps, lamps in the outside
handles, number plate lighting, interior roof light-
ing and floor lighting are switched on.
The length of time for which the approach light-
ing should be kept on can be set in the menu
system MY CAR, see MY CAR (p. 113).
Related information
Home safe lighting (p. 102)
Wipers and washers
Wipers and washers clean the windscreen and
rear window. The headlamps are cleaned with
high-pressure washing.
Windscreen wipers23
Windscreen wipers and windscreen washers.
Rain sensor, On/Off
Thumbwheel sensitivity/frequency
Windscreen wipers off
Move the stalk switch to position 0 to
switch off the windscreen wipers.
Single sweep
Raise the stalk switch and release to
make one sweep.
23 For replacing the wiper blades and service position wiper blades, see Wiper blades (p. 355). For filling washer fluid, see Washer fluid - filling (p. 357).
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
}}
* Option/accessory. 103
Intermittent wiping
Set the number of sweeps per time
unit with the thumbwheel when inter-
mittent wiping is selected.
Continuous wiping
The wipers sweep at normal speed.
The wipers sweep at high speed.
IMPORTANT
Before activating the wipers - ensure that the
wiper blades are not frozen in, and that any
snow or ice on the windscreen (and rear win-
dow) is scraped away.
IMPORTANT
Use plenty of washer fluid when the wipers
are cleaning the windscreen. The windscreen
must be wet when the windscreen wipers are
operating.
Service position wiper blade
For cleaning the windscreen/wiper blades and
replacement of wiper blades, see Car wash
(p. 372) and Wiper blades (p. 355).
Rain sensor*
The rain sensor automatically starts the wind-
screen wipers based on how much water it
detects on the windscreen. The sensitivity of the
rain sensor can be adjusted using the thumb-
wheel.
When the rain sensor is activated a lamp in the
button is illuminated and the rain sensor symbol
is shown in the combined instrument
panel.
Activating and setting the sensitivity
When activating the rain sensor, the car must be
running or the remote control key in position I or
II while the windscreen wiper stalk switch must
be in position 0 or in the position for a single
sweep.
Activate the rain sensor by pressing the rain sen-
sor button . The windscreen wipers make
one sweep.
Press the stalk switch up for the wipers to make
an extra sweep.
Turn the thumbwheel upward for higher sensitiv-
ity and downward for lower sensitivity. (An extra
sweep is made when the thumbwheel is turned
upward.)
Deactivate
Deactivate the rain sensor by pressing the rain
sensor button or move the stalk switch
down to another wiper program.
The rain sensor is automatically deactivated when
the remote control key is removed from the igni-
tion switch or five minutes after the engine has
been switched off.
IMPORTANT
The windscreen wipers could start and be
damaged in an automatic car wash. Switch off
the rain sensor while the car is in motion or
when the remote control key is in position I or
II. The symbol in the combined instrument
panel and the light in the button go out.
Washing the headlamps and windows
Washing function.
Washing the windscreen
Move the stalk switch toward the steering wheel
to start the windscreen and headlamp washers.
The windscreen wipers will make several more
sweeps and the headlamps are washed once the
stalk switch has been released.
||
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory.
104
High-pressure headlamp washing*
High-pressure headlamp washing consumes a
large quantity of washer fluid. To save fluid, the
headlamps are washed automatically at every
fifth windscreen wash cycle.
Reduced washing
If only approx. 1 litre of washer fluid remains in
the reservoir and the message that you should fill
the washer fluid is shown in the combined instru-
ment panel, then the supply of washer fluid to the
headlamps is switched off. This is in order to pri-
oritise cleaning the windscreen and the visibility
through it.
Wiping and washing the rear window
Rear window wiper – intermittent wiping
Rear window wiper – continuous speed
Press the stalk switch forward (see the arrow in
the illustration above) to initiate rear window
washing and wiping.
NOTE
The rear window wiper is equipped with over-
heating protection which means that the
motor is switched off if it overheats. The rear
window wiper works again after a cooling
period (30 seconds or longer, depending on
the heat in the motor and the outside tem-
perature).
Wiper – reversing
Engaging reverse gear while the windscreen wip-
ers are on initiates intermittent rear window wip-
ing24. The function stops when reverse gear is
disengaged.
If the rear window wiper is already on at continu-
ous speed, no change is made.
NOTE
On cars with rain sensors, the rear wiper is
activated during reversing if the sensor is
activated and it is raining.
Related information
Washer fluid - filling (p. 357)
Power windows
All power windows can be operated using the
control panel for the driver's door - the control
panels for the other doors operate their respec-
tive power window.
Driver's door control panel.
Electric child safety locks that prevent chil-
dren from being able to open the rear doors
from inside* and open/close the rear win-
dows, see Child safety locks - electrical acti-
vation* (p. 180).
Controls for rear windows
Controls for front windows
24 This function (intermittent wiping when reversing) can be deactivated. Visit a workshop. Volvo recommends an authorised Volvo workshop.
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
}}
105
WARNING
Check that children or other passengers are
not trapped when the windows are closed
from the driver's door.
WARNING
Check that children or other passengers are
not trapped if/when the windows are closed
using the remote control key.
WARNING
If there are children in the car - remember to
always switch off the power supply to the
power windows by selecting key position 0
and then take the remote control key with you
when leaving the car. For information on key
positions - see Key positions - functions at
different levels (p. 81).
Operating
Operating the power windows.
Operating without auto
Operating with auto
All power windows can be operated using the
control panel for the driver's door - the control
panels for the other doors can only operate their
respective power window. Only one control panel
can be operated at a time.
In order for the power windows to be used, the
key position must be at least I - see Key posi-
tions - functions at different levels (p. 81). The
power windows can be operated for a few
minutes after the engine has been switched off
and after the remote control key has been
removed - although not after a door has been
opened.
Closing of the windows is stopped and the win-
dow is opened if anything prevents its movement.
It is possible to override the pinch protection
when closing has been interrupted, e.g. if there is
ice forming. After two successive closing inter-
ruptions the pinch protection will be forced and
the automatic function deactivated for a short
while, now it is possible to close by continually
holding the button pulled up.
NOTE
One way to reduce the pulsating wind noise
when the rear windows are open is to also
open the front windows slightly.
Operating without auto
Move one of the controls up/down gently. The
power windows move up/down as long as the
control is held in position.
Operating with auto
Move one of the controls up/down to the end
position and release it. The window runs auto-
matically to its end position.
Operating with the remote control key or
central locking button
To operate the power windows from the outside
with the remote control key or from inside with
the central locking button, see Remote control
key - functions (p. 164) or Locking/unlocking -
from the inside (p. 175).
||
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory.
106
Resetting
If the battery is disconnected then the function
for automatic opening must be reset so that it
can work correctly.
1. Gently raise the front section of the button to
raise the window to its end position and hold
it there for one second.
2. Release the button briefly.
3. Raise the front section of the button again
for one second.
WARNING
A reset must take place for pinch protection
to work.
Door mirrors
The door mirror positions are adjusted with the
joystick in the driver's door controls.
Controls for door mirrors.
Adjusting
1. Press the L button for the left-hand door mir-
ror or the R button for the right-hand door
mirror. The light in the button illuminates.
2. Adjust the position with the joystick in the
centre.
3. Press the L or R button again. The light
should no longer be illuminated.
WARNING
Both mirrors are the wide-angle type to pro-
vide optimal vision. Objects may appear fur-
ther away than they actually are.
Storing settings25
The settings for the door mirrors and the posi-
tions of the driver's seat can be stored for each
remote control key in the car key memory*, see
Remote control key - personalisation* (p. 161).
Angling the door mirror when parking25
The door mirror can be angled down for the
driver to view the side of the road when parking
for example.
Engage reverse gear and press the L or R
button.
When reverse gear is disengaged the mirror
automatically returns to its original position after
approx. 10 seconds, or earlier by pressing the
button labelled L or R respectively.
Automatic angling of the door mirror
when parking25
When reverse gear is engaged the door mirror is
automatically angled down so that the driver can
see the side of the road when parking for exam-
ple. When reverse gear is disengaged the mirror
25 Only in combination with power seat with memory, see Seats, front - electrically operated (p. 84).
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
}}
* Option/accessory. 107
automatically returns to its original position after
a short time.
The function can be activated/deactivated in the
menu system MY CAR, see MY CAR (p. 113).
Automatic retraction when locking*
When the car is locked/unlocked with the remote
control key the door mirrors are automatically
retracted/extended.
The function can be activated/deactivated in the
menu system MY CAR, see MY CAR (p. 113).
Resetting to neutral
Mirrors that have been moved out of position by
an external force must be reset electrically to the
neutral position for electric retracting/extending
to work correctly:
1. Retract the mirrors with the L and R buttons.
2. Fold them out again with the L and R but-
tons.
3. Repeat the above procedure as necessary.
The mirrors are now reset in neutral position.
Retractable power door mirrors*
The mirrors can be retracted for parking/driving
in narrow spaces:
1. Depress the L and R buttons simultaneously
(key position must be at least I).
2. Release them after approximately 1 second.
The mirrors automatically stop in the fully
retracted position.
Fold out the mirrors by pressing down the L and
R buttons simultaneously. The mirrors automati-
cally stop in the fully extended position.
Home safe and approach lighting
The lamp on the door mirrors illuminates when
approach lighting (p. 102) or home safe lighting
(p. 102) is selected.
Related information
Rearview mirror - interior (p. 108)
Windows and door mirrors - heating (p. 107)
Windows and door mirrors - heating
The defroster is used to quickly remove misting
and ice from the windscreen, rear window and
door mirrors.
Heated windscreen*, rear window and
door mirrors
Heating, windscreen
Heating, rear window and door mirrors
The function is used to remove ice and misting
from the windscreen, rear window and door mir-
rors.
One press of the respective button starts the
heating. The light in the button indicates that the
function is active. Switch off the heating as soon
as the ice/misting is cleared in order not to load
the battery unnecessarily. However, the function
is switched off automatically after a certain time.
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory.
108
See also Demisting and defrosting the wind-
screen (p. 136).
The door mirrors and rear window are demisted/
defrosted automatically if the car is started in an
outside temperature lower than +7 °C. Automatic
defrosting can be selected in the menu system
MY CAR, see MY CAR (p. 113).
The compass (p. 109) is deactivated when the
heated windscreen is activated. When the heated
windscreen is deactivated, the compass is reacti-
vated.
Rearview mirror - interior
The interior rearview mirror can be dimmed with
a control in the mirror's lower edge. Alternatively,
the rearview mirror dims automatically.
Control for dimming
Manual dimming
Bright light from behind could be reflected in the
rearview mirror and dazzle the driver. Use dim-
ming with the dimming control when lights from
behind are distracting:
1. Use dimming by moving the control in
towards the passenger compartment.
2. Return to normal position by moving the con-
trol towards the windscreen.
Automatic dimming*
Bright light from behind is automatically dimmed
by the rearview mirror. The control for manual
dimming is not available on mirrors with auto-
matic dimming.
The rearview mirror contains two sensors - one
forward facing and one rearward facing - that
work together to identify and eliminate dazzling
light. The forward facing sensor detects ambient
light, while the rearward facing sensor detects
the light from vehicle headlights behind.
NOTE
If the sensors are obscured by e.g. parking
permits, transponders, sun visors or objects in
the seats or in the cargo area in such a way
that light is prevented from reaching the sen-
sors, then the dimming function of the rear-
view mirror is reduced.
Only rearview mirror with automatic dimming can
be equipped with compass (p. 109).
Related information
Door mirrors (p. 106)
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
}}
* Option/accessory. 109
Glass roof*
The glass roof's blind can be operated with the
control in the roof console.
The glass roof is fixed but the power operated
roller blind can be operated in key position I or II
with the control in the roof console. For informa-
tion on key positions - see Key positions - func-
tions at different levels (p. 81).
Automatic opening to end position
Manual opening until the button is released
Manual closing until the button is released
Automatic closing to end position
IMPORTANT
Avoid touching the blind because it may
then be damaged.
Only use the control in the roof console
to operate the blind.
Compass*
The upper right-hand corner of the rearview mir-
ror contains a display that shows the compass
direction in which the front of the car is pointing.
Operation
Rearview mirror with compass.
Eight different directions are shown with English
abbreviations: N (north), NE (north east), E (east),
SE (south east), S (south), SW (south west), W
(west) and NW (north west).
The compass is activated automatically when the
car is started or when key position II is active, see
Key positions - functions at different levels
(p. 81). To deactivate/activate the compass -
press in the button on the rear side of the mirror
using a paper clip for example.
The compass is deactivated when the heated
windscreen is activated. When the heated wind-
screen is deactivated, the compass is reactivated.
||
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
110
Calibration
The earth is divided into 15 magnetic zones. The
compass is set for the geographic area to which
the car was delivered. The compass should be
calibrated if the car is moved across several mag-
netic zones. Proceed as follows:
1. Stop the car in a large open area free from
steel structures and high-voltage power lines.
2. Start the car.
NOTE
For the best calibration, switch off all electri-
cal equipment (climate control system, wipers,
etc.) and makes sure that all doors are closed.
3. Hold the button on the underside of the rear-
view mirror depressed approx. 3 seconds.
The number of the current magnetic zone is
shown.
Magnetic zones.
4. Press the button repeatedly until the
required magnetic zone (1–15) is shown.
See the map of magnetic zones for the com-
pass.
5. Wait until the display returns to showing the
character C, or hold the button on the bot-
tom of the rearview mirror depressed for
approx. 6 seconds (use e.g. a paper clip) until
the character C is shown.
6. Drive slowly in a circle at a speed of no more
than 10 km/h (6 mph) until a compass direc-
tion is shown in the display, indicating that
calibration is complete. Then drive a further 2
circles to fine-tune calibration.
7. Repeat the above procedure as necessary.
Menu navigation - combined
instrument panel
The menus shown on the information display in
the combined instrument panel (p. 66) are con-
trolled with the left-hand stalk switch. Which
menus are shown depends on the key position
(p. 81).
Information display (analogue combined instrument
panel) and menu navigation controls.
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory. 111
Information displays (digital combined instrument panel)
and controls for menu navigation.
OK - access the menu, acknowledge mes-
sages and confirm menu selections.
Thumbwheel – browse between menu
options.
RESET - reset data in the selected trip com-
puter step and go back in the menu struc-
ture.
If there is a message (p. 112) then it must be
acknowledged with OK in order that the menus
shall be shown.
Related information
Messages - handling (p. 113)
Menu overview - analogue combined instru-
ment panel (p. 111)
Menu overview - digital combined instrument
panel (p. 111)
Menu overview - analogue
combined instrument panel
Which menus are shown in the combined instru-
ment panel's information display depends on the
key position (p. 81).
Some of the following menu options require the
function and hardware to be installed in the car.
Digital speed
Parking heater*
Additional heater*
TC options
Service status
Oil level26
Messages (##)27
Related information
Menu navigation - combined instrument
panel (p. 110)
Menu overview - digital combined instrument
panel (p. 111)
Combined instrument panel (p. 66)
Menu overview - digital combined
instrument panel
Which menus are shown in the combined instru-
ment panel's information display depends on the
key position (p. 81).
Some of the following menu options require the
function and hardware to be installed in the car.
Settings*
Themes
Contrast mode/Colour mode
Service status
Messages28
Oil level29
Parking heater*
Trip computer reset
Related information
Menu navigation - combined instrument
panel (p. 110)
Menu overview - analogue combined instru-
ment panel (p. 111)
Combined instrument panel (p. 66)
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
112
Messages
When a warning, information or indicator symbol
illuminates, a corresponding message appears
on the information display.
Message Specification
Stop safelyAStop and switch off the
engine. Serious risk of dam-
age - consult a workshopB.
Stop engineAStop and switch off the
engine. Serious risk of dam-
age - consult a workshopB.
Service
urgentA
Contact a workshopB to
check the car immediately.
Service
requiredA
Contact a workshopB to
check the car as soon as
possible.
See manualARead the owner's manual.
Book time for
maintenance
Time to book regular service
- contact a workshopB.
Message Specification
Time for reg-
ular mainte-
nance
Time for regular service -
contact a workshopB. The
timing is determined by the
number of kilometres driven,
number of months since the
last service, engine running
time and oil grade.
Maintenance
overdue
If the service intervals are
not followed then the war-
ranty does not cover any
damaged parts - contact a
workshopB.
Transmission
Oil change
needed
Contact a workshopB to
check the car as soon as
possible.
Transmission
Reduced per-
formance
Transmission cannot handle
full capacity. Drive with care
until the message clearsC.
If shown repeatedly - con-
tact a workshopB.
Message Specification
Transmission
hot Reduce
speed
Drive more smoothly or stop
the car in a safe manner.
Disengage the gear and run
the engine at idling speed
until the message clearsC.
Transmission
hot Stop
safely Wait for
cooling
Critical fault. Stop the car
immediately in a safe man-
ner and contact a work-
shopB.
Temporarily
offA
A function has been tempo-
rarily switched off and is
reset automatically while
driving or after starting
again.
Low battery
charge Power
save mode
The audio system is
switched off to save energy.
Charge the battery.
APart of message, shown together with information on where the
problem has arisen.
BAn authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.
CFor more messages concerning automatic gearbox.
Related information
Messages - handling (p. 113)
Menu navigation - combined instrument
panel (p. 110)
26 Certain engines.
27 The number of messages is indicated in brackets.
28 The number of messages is indicated in brackets.
29 Certain engines.
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
}}
* Option/accessory. 113
Messages - handling
Use the left-hand stalk switch to acknowledge
and browse among messages (p. 112) that are
shown in the information display of the com-
bined instrument panel.
When a warning, information or indicator symbol
illuminates, a corresponding message is shown in
the display. An error message is stored in a mem-
ory list until the fault has been rectified.
Press OK on the left-hand stalk switch to
acknowledge30 a message. Scroll through mes-
sages with the thumbwheel (p. 110).
NOTE
If a warning message appears while you are
using the trip computer, the message must be
read (press OK) before the previous activity
can be resumed.
Related information
Menu overview - analogue combined instru-
ment panel (p. 111)
Menu overview - digital combined instrument
panel (p. 111)
MY CAR
MY CAR is a menu source that handles many of
the car's functions, e.g. City Safety, locks and
alarm, automatic fan speed, setting the clock,
etc.
Certain functions are standard, others are
optional - the range also varies depending on the
market.
Operation
Navigation in the menus is carried out using but-
tons in the centre console or with the steering
wheel's right-hand keypad*.
Control panel in centre console and steering wheel key-
pad. The figure is schematic - the number of functions
30 A message can also be acknowledged via the thumbwheel or RESET button.
||
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory.
114
and layout of the buttons both vary, depending on the
equipment selected and the market.
MY CAR - opens the menu system MY CAR.
TUNE - turn the knob in the centre console
or the thumbwheel on the steering wheel to
scroll up/down through the menu options.
OK/MENU - press the button in the centre
console or the thumbwheel on the steering
wheel to select/tick in the highlighted menu
option or store the selected function in the
memory.
EXIT
EXIT functions
Depending on the function the cursor is on when
EXIT is depressed briefly, and on which menu
level, one of the following may occur:
phone call is rejected
current function is interrupted
input characters are deleted
most recent selections are undone
leads up in the menu system.
A long press on EXIT leads to the normal view
for MY CAR or if you are in the normal view, to
the highest menu level (main source menu).
Menu options and search paths
For a description of the menu options and search
paths in MY CAR, see the Sensus Infotainment
supplement.
Trip computer
The car's trip computer records and calculates
vales such as e.g. distance, fuel consumption
and average speed whilst driving.
Trip computer content and appearance varies
depending on whether the combined instrument
panel is analogue or digital:
Trip computer - analogue combined instru-
ment panel (p. 116)
Trip computer - digital combined instrument
panel (p. 120) The information from the trip computer can be shown in
the combined instrument panel's information display31.
Trip meter
The trip computer has two trip meters and one
odometer for the total mileage.
Average
Average fuel consumption is calculated from the
last resetting.
NOTE
There may be a slight deviation if a fuel-driven
heater* has been used.
Average speed
The average speed is calculated for the driving
distance driven since the last reset to zero.
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory. 115
Instantaneous
The information for current fuel consumption is
updated continuously - approximately once per
second. When the car is driven at low speed the
consumption is shown per time unit - at a higher
speed it is shown related to mileage.
Different units (km/miles) can be selected for the
display - see section below."Change unit"
(p. 114)
Range - distance to empty tank
The trip computer shows the approximate dis-
tance that can be driven with the fuel quantity
remaining in the tank.
No guaranteed range remains when the heading
Distance to empty shows "----".
In which case, refuel as soon as possible.
The calculation is based on the average fuel con-
sumption over the last 30 km and the remaining
driveable fuel quantity.
NOTE
There may be a slight deviation if the driving
style has been changed.
An economic driving style generally results in a
longer driving distance. For more information on
how fuel consumption can be influenced, see
Environmental philosophy (p. 22).
Digital speed display in another unit32
If the main instrument is graduated in mph, the
equivalent digital speed is shown as km/h.
Change unit
Distance and fuel unit can be changed in the
menu system MY CAR, see MY CAR (p. 113).
NOTE
In addition to in the trip computer, these units
are also changed in Volvo's navigation sys-
tem*.
Related information
Trip computer - analogue combined instru-
ment panel (p. 116)
Trip computer - digital combined instrument
panel (p. 120)
Trip computer - trip statistics* (p. 123)
31 The appearance and showing of the display may vary depending on the instrument variant.
32 Only digital combined instrument panel and certain markets.
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
116
Trip computer - analogue combined
instrument panel
The information from the trip computer can be
shown in the combined instrument panel and
operated with the controls on the left-hand stalk
switch and with the combined instrument panel's
menu.
Checking and settings can be made immediately
after the combined instrument panel is automati-
cally illuminated in connection with unlocking. If
none of the trip computer's controls are actuated
within approx. 30 seconds after the driver's door
has been opened then the instrument extin-
guishes, after which either key position II or
engine starting is required in order to operate the
trip computer.
NOTE
If a warning message appears when the trip
computer is used then the message must first
be acknowledged before the trip computer
can be reactivated.
Acknowledge the message by briefly
pressing the indicator stalk OK button.
Controls
Information display and controls.
OK - opens the combined instrument panel's
menu, confirms messages or menu selec-
tions.
Thumbwheel - browses between menu
options or trip computer options.
RESET - resets the current trip meter or
goes back out of the menu structure.
Trip computer alternative
Choose which trip computer should be shown:
1. To ensure that no control is in the middle of
a sequence - reset them first with
two presses on RESET.
2. Turn the thumbwheel to browse between the
options and stop at the required heading.
The trip computer display in the combined instru-
ment panel can be shifted to another option at
any time during the journey. One of the options
means that no trip computer is shown.
Trip computer heading in combined instrument panel Information
Trip meter T1 and total dist. Long press on RESET resets trip meter T1.
Trip meter T2 and total dist. Long press on RESET resets trip meter T2.
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
}}
117
Trip computer heading in combined instrument panel Information
Distance to empty For more information - see the section"Range - distance to empty tank" (p. 114).
Fuel consumption Current consumption.
Average speed Long press on RESET resets Average speed.
No trip computer information. This option shows a blank display and it also indicates the beginning/end of the loop.
Resetting the trip computer
1. Turn the thumbwheel and stop at the trip
computer heading to be reset: T1 and total
dist., T2 and total dist. or Average speed.
2. One long press on RESET resets the value
for the selected heading.
Each heading must be zeroed individually.
Functions in the combined instrument
panel's menu
The combined instrument panel's menu includes
setting options for trip computer. Open the menu
to check/adjust the functions in the table below.
1. To ensure that no control is in the middle of
a sequence - reset them first with
two presses on RESET.
2. Press OK.
3. Browse through the functions with the
thumbwheel and select/confirm with OK.
4. Finish by pressing twice on RESET after
completed checking/adjustment.
||
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory.
118
Functions Information
Digital speed
km/h
mph
No display
Shows the car's speed digitally in the centre of the combined instrument panel.
Parking heater*
DIRECT START
Timer 1
Timer 2
For a description of programming the timer, see Engine block heater and passenger compartment
heater* - timer (p. 142).
Additional heater*
Auto On
Off
For more information, see Additional heater* (p. 144).
TC options
Distance to empty tank
Fuel consumption
Average speed
Trip meter T1 and total dist.
Trip meter T2 and total dist.
Here you can activate the options that you want to be available as selectable headings in the trip
computer. The symbols for the options already selected are white with a "tick" - others are grey
and have no "tick".
Service status Shows the number of months and the distance until the next service.
Oil levelAFor more information, see Engine oil - checking and filling (p. 343).
Messages (##) For more information, see Messages (p. 112).
ACertain engines.
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory. 119
Related information
Trip computer (p. 114)
Trip computer - trip statistics* (p. 123)
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
120
Trip computer - digital combined
instrument panel
The information from the trip computer can be
shown in the combined instrument panel and
operated with the controls on the left-hand stalk
switch and with the combined instrument panel's
menu.
Checking and settings can be made immediately
after the combined instrument panel is automati-
cally illuminated in connection with unlocking. If
none of the trip computer's controls are actuated
within approx. 30 seconds after the driver's door
has been opened then the instrument extin-
guishes, after which either key position II or
engine starting is required in order to operate the
trip computer.
NOTE
If a warning message appears when the trip
computer is used then the message must first
be acknowledged before the trip computer
can be reactivated.
Acknowledge the message by briefly
pressing the indicator stalk OK button.
Controls
Three trip computer options can be displayed simultane-
ously - one in each "window".
OK - opens the combined instrument panel's
menu, confirms messages or menu selec-
tions.
Thumbwheel - browses between menu
options or trip computer options.
RESET - resets the current trip meter or
goes back out of the menu structure.
Trip computer alternative
Choose which trip computer should be shown:
1. To ensure that no control is in the middle of
a sequence - reset them first with
two presses on RESET.
2. Turn the thumbwheel to browse between the
heading combinations.
3. Stop at the required combination for the con-
stant display of this trip data in the combined
instrument panel.
The trip computer display in the combined instru-
ment panel can be shifted to another option at
any time during the journey. One of the options
means that no trip computer is shown.
Heading combinations Information
Average Trip meter T1 + Meter reading Average speed Long press on RESET resets trip meter T1.
Instantaneous Trip meter T2 + Meter reading Distance to empty tank Long press on RESET resets trip meter T2.
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
}}
121
Heading combinations Information
Instantaneous Meter reading km/h<>mphAkm/h<>mph - "Reverse digital speed display", see Trip computer (p. 114).
No trip computer information. This option extinguishes all three trip computer displays and it also indicates the
beginning/end of the loop.
AOnly certain markets.
Resetting the trip computer
Trip meter
1. Turn the thumbwheel and stop at the head-
ing combination with the trip meter to be
reset.
2. One long press on RESET resets the value
for the selected heading.
Average speed and average consumption
1. Press OK to open the combined instrument
panel's menu.
2. Browse to the Trip computer reset menu
option with the thumbwheel and confirm with
OK.
3. Choose to reset average consumption, aver-
age speed or to reset both, and confirm your
selection with OK.
4. Finish by pressing RESET.
Functions in the combined instrument
panel's menu
The combined instrument panel's menu includes
setting options for trip computer. Open the menu
to check/adjust the functions in the table below.
1. To ensure that no control is in the middle of
a sequence - reset them first with
two presses on RESET.
2. Press OK.
3. Browse through the functions with the
thumbwheel and select/confirm with OK.
4. Finish by pressing twice on RESET after
completed checking/adjustment.
Functions Information
Trip computer reset
Average
Average speed
Reset the value of average fuel consumption and average speed.
Note that this function does not reset both trip meters T1 and T2.
Messages For more information, see Messages (p. 112).
||
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory.
122
Functions Information
Themes Select the theme for the appearance of the combined instrument panel, see Digital combined instrument panel -
overview (p. 67).
Settings*Select Auto On or Off.
For more information, see Additional heater* (p. 144).
Contrast mode/Colour mode Adjusting the combined instrument panel's brightness and colour intensity.
Parking heater*
Direct start
Timer 1
Timer 2
For a description of programming the timer, see Engine block heater and passenger compartment heater* - timer
(p. 142).
Service status Shows the number of months and the distance until the next service.
Oil levelAFor more information, see Engine oil - checking and filling (p. 343).
ACertain engines.
Related information
Trip computer (p. 114)
Trip computer - trip statistics* (p. 123)
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS
* Option/accessory. 123
Trip computer - trip statistics*
Trip statistics from the trip computer can be
shown in the centre console's screen and pro-
vide a graphic overview of fuel consumption.
Function
Open the menu system MY CAR (p. 113)
and select Trip statistics in order to see the
bar chart.
Trip statistics33.
Each bar symbolises 1 km or 10 km driven dis-
tance, depending on the scale selected - the bar
at the far right shows the value for the current kil-
ometre or 10 km.
The TUNE knob can be used to change the scale
for each bar between 1 km and 10 km - the cur-
sor at the far right changes position between up
and down depending on the scale selected.
Settings
Different settings can be made in the menu sys-
tem MY CAR - Trip statistics.
Reset when vehicle has been off for
minimum 4h - highlight the box by select-
ing ENTER and go back out of the menu by
selecting EXIT. With this option selected, all
statistics are deleted automatically after fin-
ishing driving and the car has been stationary
for more than 4 hours. The journey statistics
start again from zero the next time the
engine is started.
Start new trip - ENTER is used to delete all
previous statistics, back out of the menu by
selecting EXIT. If a new driving cycle shall be
started before 4 hours have elapsed then the
current period must first be deleted manually
with this option.
See also information on Eco guide (p. 70).
Related information
Trip computer (p. 114)
Trip computer - analogue combined instru-
ment panel (p. 116)
Trip computer - digital combined instrument
panel (p. 120)
33 The figure is schematic - layout may vary depending on updated software and market.
CLIMATE CONTROL
CLIMATE CONTROL
* Option/accessory.
126
General information on climate
control
The car is equipped with electronic climate con-
trol. The climate control system cools or heats as
well as dehumidifies the air in the passenger
compartment.
There are two different climate control systems:
Electronic temperature control (ETC)
(p. 132)
Electronic climate control (ECC) (p. 131)
NOTE
Air conditioning (AC) (p. 135) can be
switched off, but to ensure the best possible
climate comfort in the passenger compart-
ment, and to prevent the windows from mist-
ing, it should always be switched on.
To bear in mind
To ensure that the air conditioning works
optimally, the side windows must be closed.
Global opening (p. 176) opens/closes all
side windows simultaneously and can be
used for example to quickly air the car during
hot weather.
Remove ice and snow from the climate con-
trol system air intake (the grille between the
bonnet and the windscreen).
In warm weather, condensation from the air
conditioning may drip under the car. This is
normal.
When the engine requires full power, e.g. for
full acceleration, the air conditioning can be
temporarily switched off. There may then be
a temporary increase in temperature in the
passenger compartment.
Remove misting on the insides of the win-
dows primarily by using the defroster func-
tion (p. 136). To reduce the risk of misting,
keep the windows clean and use window
cleaner.
Cars with Start/Stop*
With an auto-stopped (p. 279) engine certain
equipment may have its function temporarily
reduced, e.g. climate control fan speed (p. 134).
Cars with ECO*
Certain equipment may have its function tempo-
rarily reduced or deactivated when the ECO
(p. 287) function is activated, e.g. the air condi-
tioning (p. 135).
NOTE
When the ECO function is activated, several
parameters in the climate control system's
settings are changed, and several electricity
consumer functions are reduced. Certain set-
tings can be reset manually, but full function-
ality is only restored by deactivating the ECO
function.
Related information
Actual temperature (p. 127)
Sensors - climate control (p. 127)
Menu settings - climate control (p. 129)
Air distribution in the passenger compart-
ment (p. 129)
Air quality (p. 127)
Heated front seats* (p. 133)
Heated rear seat* (p. 133)
CLIMATE CONTROL
* Option/accessory. 127
Actual temperature
The temperature you select in the passenger
compartment corresponds to the physical expe-
rience with reference to factors such as ambient
temperature, air speed, humidity and solar radia-
tion etc. in and around the car at the time.
The system includes a sun sensor (p. 127) which
detects on which side the sun is shining into the
passenger compartment. This means1 that the
temperature can differ between the right and left-
hand air vents despite the controls being set for
the same temperature on both sides.
Related information
General information on climate control
(p. 126)
Temperature control in the passenger com-
partment (p. 135)
Sensors - climate control
The climate control system has a number of sen-
sors to help control the temperature (p. 127) in
the car.
The sun sensor is located on the top side of
the dashboard.
The temperature sensor for the passenger
compartment is located below the climate
control panel.
The outside temperature sensor is located in
the door mirror.
NOTE
Do not cover or block the sensors with cloth-
ing or other objects.
Related information
General information on climate control
(p. 126)
Air quality
The interior in a passenger compartment is
designed to be pleasant and comfortable, even
for people with contact allergies and for asthma
sufferers.
Passenger compartment filter (p. 128)
Material in the passenger compartment
(p. 129)
Clean Zone Interior Package (CZIP)
(p. 128)*
Interior Air Quality System (IAQS) (p. 128)*
Related information
General information on climate control
(p. 126)
1Only applies to ECC.
CLIMATE CONTROL
* Option/accessory.
128
Air quality - passenger
compartment filter
All air entering the car's passenger compartment
is cleaned with a filter.
The filter must be replaced at regular intervals.
Follow the Volvo Service Programme for the rec-
ommended replacement intervals. If the car is
used in a severely contaminated environment, it
may be necessary to replace the filter more often.
NOTE
There are different types of passenger com-
partment filter. Make sure that the correct fil-
ter is fitted.
Related information
Air quality (p. 127)
Air quality - Clean Zone Interior
Package (CZIP)*
CZIP comprises a series of modifications that
keep the passenger compartment even clearer
from allergy and asthma-inducing substances.
The following is included:
An enhanced fan function that means that
the fan starts when the car is opened with
the remote control key. The fan fills the pas-
senger compartment with fresh air. The func-
tion starts when required and is disengaged
automatically after a time or when one of the
passenger compartment doors is opened.
The amount of time the fan runs is reduced
gradually due to reduced need up until the
car is 4 years old.
The air quality system IAQS (p. 128) is a fully
automatic system that cleans the air in the
passenger compartment from contaminants
such as particles, hydrocarbons, nitrous
oxides and ground-level ozone.
Related information
General information on climate control
(p. 126)
Air quality (p. 127)
Air quality - IAQS*
The air quality system IAQS separates gases
and particles to reduce the levels of odours and
pollution in the passenger compartment.
If the outside air is contaminated then the air
intake is closed in order to shut out hydrocar-
bons, nitrous oxides and ground-level ozone. The
air is recirculated in the passenger compartment.
It is possible to activate/deactivate the function
in the menu system MY CAR. For a description of
the menu system, see MY CAR (p. 113).
NOTE
The air quality sensor must always be enabled
to ensure the best air in the passenger com-
partment.
In a cold climate, automatic recirculation is
limited so as to prevent misting.
Related information
General information on climate control
(p. 126)
Air quality (p. 127)
Air quality - Clean Zone Interior Package
(CZIP)* (p. 128)
CLIMATE CONTROL
}}
* Option/accessory. 129
Air quality - material
Tested materials have been developed in order
to minimise the quantity of dust in the passenger
compartment and to contribute to making the
passenger compartment easier to keep clean.
The carpets in both the passenger compartment
and the cargo area are removable and easy to
remove and clean. Use cleaning agents and car
care products recommended by Volvo to clean
the interior (p. 376).
Related information
Air quality (p. 127)
Menu settings - climate control
It is possible to activate/deactivate or change
the default settings for four of the climate control
system's functions via the centre console.
Fan level during automatic climate control*
(p. 134).
Recirculation timer (p. 137).
Automatic start of rear window defroster
(p. 107).
Interior air quality system* (p. 128).
The climate control system's functions can be
reset to the default settings via the menu system
in MY CAR. For a description of the menu sys-
tem, see MY CAR (p. 113).
Related information
General information on climate control
(p. 126)
Air distribution in the passenger
compartment
The incoming air is divided between a number of
different vents in the passenger compartment.
Air distribution is fully automatic in AUTO mode*.
If necessary it can be controlled manually; see
the air distribution table (p. 138).
||
CLIMATE CONTROL
130
Air vents in the dashboard
Open
Closed
Lateral airflow
Vertical airflow
Aim the vents at the side windows to remove
misting.
NOTE
Remember that small children may be sensi-
tive to air flows and draughts.
Air distribution
Air distribution - defroster windscreen
Air distribution - air vent instrument panel
Air distribution - ventilation floor
The figure consists of three buttons. When press-
ing the buttons the corresponding figure is illumi-
nated in the display screen (see figure below)
and an arrow in front of each part of the figure
shows the air distribution that is selected. For
more information, see the air distribution table
(p. 138).
The selected air distribution is shown in the centre con-
sole display screen.
Related information
General information on climate control
(p. 126)
Auto-regulation (p. 134)
Air distribution - recirculation (p. 137)
CLIMATE CONTROL
* Option/accessory. 131
Electronic climate control - ECC*
ECC (Electronic Climate Control) maintains the
temperature selected in the passenger compart-
ment and can be set separately for the driver's
side and passenger side.
The auto function is used to automatically con-
trol temperature, air conditioning, fan speed,
recirculation and air distribution.
Fan (p. 134)
AUTO - Automatic climate control (p. 134)
Electrically heated front seat (p. 133), left
side
Heated windscreen* and max. defroster
(p. 136)
Air distribution (p. 129) - ventilation floor
Air distribution - air vent instrument panel
Air distribution - defroster windscreen
Rear window and door mirror defrosters
(p. 107)
Setting, left/right-hand side for temperature
control (p. 135)
Electrically heated front seat (p. 133), right
side
Temperature control (p. 135)
Recirculation (p. 137)
ECO* (p. 287)
AC - Air conditioning on/off (p. 135)
Related information
General information on climate control
(p. 126)
CLIMATE CONTROL
* Option/accessory.
132
Electronic temperature control -
ETC
With ETC (Electronic Temperature Control) the
temperature is regulated automatically while air
distribution and fan control are handled man-
ually.
Fan (p. 134)
Electrically heated front seat (p. 133), left
side
AC - Air conditioning on/off (p. 135)
Heated windscreen and max. defroster*
Air distribution (p. 129) - ventilation floor
Air distribution - air vent instrument panel
Air distribution - defroster windscreen
Rear window and door mirror defrosters
(p. 107)
Recirculation (p. 137)
Electrically heated front seat (p. 133), right
side
Temperature control (p. 135)
ECO* (p. 287)
Related information
General information on climate control
(p. 126)
CLIMATE CONTROL
}}
* Option/accessory. 133
Heated front seats*
The front seat heating has three positions for
increasing the comfort for driver and passenger
when it is cold.
Current heat level is shown in the centre console display
screen.
Press the button repeatedly to
change between the different
levels or to deactivate the func-
tion.
There are three heat levels that give different
heating outputs:
Highest heat level - three orange fields illu-
minate in the centre console's screen (see
figure above).
Lower heat level - two orange fields illumi-
nate in the screen.
Lowest heat level - one orange field illumi-
nates in the screen.
Switch off the heat - no field illuminates.
WARNING
Heated seats must not be used by people
who find it difficult to perceive an increase in
temperature due to a lack of sensation or who
otherwise have problems operating the con-
trols for the heated seats. Otherwise they may
suffer burn injuries.
Related information
General information on climate control
(p. 126)
Heated rear seat* (p. 133)
Heated rear seat*
The heating for the rear seat's outer positions
has three positions for increasing the comfort for
passengers when it is cold.
Current heat level is shown in the pushbutton's lamps:
Press the button repeatedly to change between
the different levels or to deactivate the function.
There are three heat levels that give different
heating outputs:
Highest heat level - three lamps illuminate.
Lower heat level - two lamps illuminate.
Lowest heat level - one lamp illuminates.
Switch off the heat - no lamp illuminates.
||
CLIMATE CONTROL
* Option/accessory.
134
WARNING
Heated seats must not be used by people
who find it difficult to perceive an increase in
temperature due to a lack of sensation or who
otherwise have problems operating the con-
trols for the heated seats. Otherwise they may
suffer burn injuries.
Related information
General information on climate control
(p. 126)
Heated front seats* (p. 133)
Fan
The fan should always be activated in order to
avoid misting on the windows.
NOTE
If the fan is fully switched off then the air con-
ditioning is not engaged - which can cause a
risk of misting on the windows.
With ECC*
Turn the knob to increase or
decrease fan speed, AUTO is
disengaged. If AUTO is
selected, then the fan speed is
regulated automatically
(p. 134) - the fan speed previ-
ously set is disengaged.
With ETC
Turn the knob to increase or
decrease fan speed.
Related information
General information on climate control
(p. 126)
Electronic climate control - ECC* (p. 131)
Electronic temperature control - ETC
(p. 132)
Auto-regulation
Auto-regulation is only possible in electronic cli-
mate control (ECC) (p. 131).
The auto function automatically
regulates temperature (p. 135),
air conditioning (p. 135), fan
speed (p. 134), recirculation
(p. 137) and air distribution
(p. 129).
If you select one or more manual functions, the
other functions continue to be controlled auto-
matically. All manual settings are disengaged
when AUTO is pressed. The display screen
shows AUTO CLIMATE.
Fan speed in automatic mode can be set in the
menu system MY CAR. For a description of the
menu system, see MY CAR (p. 113).
Related information
General information on climate control
(p. 126)
CLIMATE CONTROL
* Option/accessory. 135
Temperature control in the
passenger compartment
When the car is started, the most recent tem-
perature setting is resumed.
NOTE
Heating or cooling cannot be hastened by
selecting a higher or lower temperature than
the actual desired temperature.
With ECC*
Current temperature for each side is shown in the centre
console's display screen.
The temperatures on the driver
and passenger sides can be
set independently. Repeatedly
press L/R in the button to
select the setting for left, right
or both sides. Set the tempera-
ture using the knob - the
selected temperature for either side is displayed
in the centre console display.
With ETC
The temperature in the passen-
ger compartment can be
adjusted with the knob.
Related information
General information on climate control
(p. 126)
Actual temperature (p. 127)
Electronic temperature control - ETC
(p. 132)
Electronic climate control - ECC* (p. 131)
Air conditioning
The air conditioning cools and dehumidifies
incoming air as required.
When the lamp in the AC but-
ton illuminates, the air condi-
tioning is controlled by the sys-
tem's automatic function.
When the lamp in the AC but-
ton is switched off the air con-
ditioning is disconnected. Other functions are still
controlled automatically. When the max. defroster
function (p. 136) is activated, the air conditioning
is switched on automatically so that the air is
dehumidified at the maximum setting.
CLIMATE CONTROL
* Option/accessory.
136
Demisting and defrosting the
windscreen
Heated windscreen* and max. defroster are
used to quickly remove misting and ice from the
windscreen and side windows.
The selected setting is shown in the centre console dis-
play screen.
Heated windscreen*
Max. defroster
The light in the defroster but-
ton illuminates when the func-
tion is active.
Press the button repeatedly to
change between the different
levels or to deactivate the func-
tion.
For cars without heated windscreen there is one
defrost level:
Air flows to the windows - symbol (2) illumi-
nates in the screen.
Switch off the function - no symbol illumi-
nates.
For cars with heated windscreen there are two
defrost levels:
Start the heating for the windscreen2 - sym-
bol (1) illuminates in the screen.
Start the heating for the windscreen2 and air
flow to the windows - symbols (1) and (2)
illuminate in the screen.
Switch off the function - no symbol illumi-
nates.
NOTE
Heated windscreen and IR window (p. 20)
may have an impact on the performance of
transponders and other communication
equipment.
NOTE
A triangular area at the end of each side of
the windscreen is not electrically heated,
where de-icing may take longer.
NOTE
Electrically heated windscreen is not available
when the engine is auto-stopped (p. 279).
The following also takes place when the function
is active in order to provide maximum dehumidifi-
cation in the passenger compartment:
the air conditioning is automatically engaged
recirculation and the air quality system are
automatically disengaged.
NOTE
The noise level increases as the fan is operat-
ing at max.
When the defroster is switched off the climate
control returns to the previous settings.
Related information
General information on climate control
(p. 126)
2The compass goes off when the heated windscreen is active.
CLIMATE CONTROL
137
Air distribution - recirculation
Select recirculation to shut out bad air, exhaust
gases etc. from the passenger compartment, i.e.
no outside air is taken into the car when this
function is activated.
When recirculation is engaged
the orange lamp in the button
illuminates.
IMPORTANT
If the air in the car recirculates for too long,
there is a risk of misting on the insides of the
windows.
Timer
With the timer function activated the system will
exit manually activated recirculation mode
according to a time that depends on the outside
temperature. This reduces the risk of ice, misting
and bad air.
It is possible to activate/deactivate the function
in the menu system MY CAR. For a description of
the menu system, see MY CAR (p. 113).
NOTE
When max. defroster is selected, recirculation
is always deactivated.
Related information
General information on climate control
(p. 126)
Air distribution in the passenger compart-
ment (p. 129)
Air distribution - table (p. 138)
CLIMATE CONTROL
138
Air distribution - table
Three buttons are used to select the distribution
(p. 129) of the air.
Air distribution Use
A large amount of hot air flows to the windows. to remove ice and misting quickly.
Air to windscreen, via defroster vent, and side windows. Some air
flows from the air vents.
to avoid misting and icing in a cold and humid climate (to
achieve this the fan level must not be too low).
Airflow to windows and from dashboard air vents. to ensure good comfort in warm, dry weather.
Airflow to the head and chest from the dashboard air vents. to ensure efficient cooling in warm weather.
CLIMATE CONTROL
139
Air distribution Use
Air to the floor and windows. Some air flows from the dashboard air
vents.
to ensure comfortable conditions and good demisting in cold or
humid weather.
Air to floor and from dashboard air vents. in sunny weather with cool outside temperatures.
Air to floor. Some air flows to the dashboard air vents and windows. to direct heat or cold to the floor.
Airflow to windows, from dashboard air vents and to the floor. to provide cooling along the floor in hot, dry weather or warming
upwards in cold weather.
Related information
General information on climate control
(p. 126)
Air distribution - recirculation (p. 137)
CLIMATE CONTROL
* Option/accessory.
140
Engine block and passenger
compartment heater*
Preconditioning prepares the heater, engine and
passenger compartment before departure so
that both wear and energy needs during the jour-
ney are reduced. Warming up your car will also
extend the driving distance.
The heater can be started directly (p. 141) or
with a timer (p. 142).
The heater cannot start if the outside tempera-
ture exceeds 15 °C. The heater's maximum run-
ning time is 50 minutes.
WARNING
Do not use the fuel-driven heater indoors.
Exhaust gases are secreted.
NOTE
When the fuel-driven auxiliary heater is active
there may be smoke from underneath the car,
which is perfectly normal.
Refuelling
Warning label on fuel filler flap.
WARNING
Fuel which spills out could be ignited. Switch
off the fuel-driven auxiliary heater before star-
ting to refuel.
Check in the combined instrument panel that
the heater is switched off. The heat symbol is
shown when it is operating.
Parking on a hill
If the car is parked on a steep hill, the front of the
car should point downhill to ensure that there is a
supply of fuel to the fuel-driven heater.
Battery and fuel
If the battery has insufficient charge or the fuel
level is too low, the heater will be switched off
automatically and a message appears in the dis-
play. Acknowledge the message by pressing the
indicator stalk (p. 110) OK button once.
IMPORTANT
Repeated use of the heater in combination
with short driving distances may cause low
charge level in the starter battery, this can
lead to the heater stopping or never starting.
In the worst case, engine starting will not be
possible.
The car should be driven for the same time as
the heater is used to ensure that the starter
battery is recharged adequately to replace the
energy consumed by the heater when it is
used on a regular basis. The heater is used
for a maximum of 50 minutes each time.
Related information
Engine block heater and passenger compart-
ment heater* - messages (p. 143)
Additional heater* (p. 144)
CLIMATE CONTROL
* Option/accessory. 141
Engine block heater and passenger
compartment heater* - direct start
The engine block heater and passenger com-
partment heater can be started directly.
Direct start can be performed via:
information display
remote control key*
mobile*.
Upon direct start of the engine block and pas-
senger compartment heater (p. 140), it will run
for 50 minutes.
Heating of the passenger compartment will begin
as soon as the engine coolant has reached the
correct temperature.
NOTE
The car can be started and driven while the
heater is running.
Direct start via the information display
1. Press OK to access the menu.
2. Scroll with the thumbwheel to Parking
heater and select with OK.
3. Scroll forward in the next menu to Direct
start in order to activate the heater and
select with OK.
4. Exit the menu with RESET.
Direct start via the remote control key*
Indicator lamp on remote control key with PCC*.
The engine block heater and passenger compart-
ment heater can be activated via the remote con-
trol key:
Hold the button for approach lighting
depressed for 2 seconds.
Hazard warning flashers provide information
in accordance with the following:
5 short flashes followed by a constant
glow for approx. 3 seconds - the signal
has reached the car and the heater has
been activated.
5 short flashes - the signal has reached
the car but the heater has not been acti-
vated.
Hazard warning flashers remain switched
off - the signal has not reached the car.
If the button for information is depressed
when the heater is active then the indicator lamp
will show the status for this - at the same time
the car's lock status (p. 165) is shown. While the
status is being investigated the indicator lamp
emits a pair of short flashes followed by a con-
stant glow if the heater is active.
Status is also shown in the trip computer during
heating.
Direct start via a mobile*
Activation and information on selected settings
are available via the Volvo On Call* app.
Related information
Engine block heater and passenger compart-
ment heater* - timer (p. 142)
Engine block heater and passenger compart-
ment heater* - immediate stop (p. 142)
Engine block heater and passenger compart-
ment heater* - messages (p. 143)
CLIMATE CONTROL
* Option/accessory.
142
Engine block heater and passenger
compartment heater* - immediate
stop
The engine block heater and passenger com-
partment heater can be deactivated directly via
the information display.
1. Press OK to access the menu.
2. Scroll with the thumbwheel to Parking
heater and select with OK.
3. Scroll forward in the next menu to Stop in
order to deactivate the heater and select with
OK.
4. Exit the menu with RESET.
Related information
Engine block heater and passenger compart-
ment heater* - direct start (p. 141)
Engine block heater and passenger compart-
ment heater* - timer (p. 142)
Engine block heater and passenger compart-
ment heater* - messages (p. 143)
Engine block heater and passenger
compartment heater* - timer
The timer of the engine block and passenger
compartment heater (p. 140) is connected to
the car's clock.
Two different times can be selected using the
timer. Here, time refers to the time when the car
is heated and ready. The car's electronic system
calculates when heating should be started based
on the outside temperature.
NOTE
All timer programming will be cleared if the
car's clock is reset.
Adjusting
1. Press OK to access the menu.
2. Scroll with the thumbwheel (p. 110) to
Parking heater and select with OK.
3. Select one of the two timers using the
thumbwheel and confirm with OK.
4. Briefly press OK to move to the lit hours set-
ting.
5. Select the required hour using the thumb-
wheel.
6. Briefly press OK to move to the lit minutes
setting.
7. Select the required minute using the thumb-
wheel.
8. Press OK3 to confirm the setting.
9. Go back in the menu structure using RESET.
10. Select the other time (continue from step 2)
or exit the menu with RESET.
Starting
1. Press OK to access the menu.
2. Scroll with the thumbwheel to Parking
heater and select with OK.
3. Select one of the two timers using the
thumbwheel and activate with OK.
4. Exit the menu with RESET.
Switching off
A timer-started heater can be switched off man-
ually before the set time has elapsed. Proceed as
follows:
1. Press OK to access the menu.
2. Scroll with the thumbwheel to Parking
heater and select with OK.
> If a timer is set but not activated, a clock
icon is shown next to the set time.
3. Select one of the two timers using the
thumbwheel and confirm with OK.
3Press OK again to activate the timer.
CLIMATE CONTROL
}}
* Option/accessory. 143
4. Deactivate the timer as follows:
long press on OK or
short press on OK to continue in the
menu. Then select to stop the timer and
confirm with OK.
5. Exit the menu with RESET.
A timer-started heater can be switched off
directly (p. 141).
Related information
Engine block heater and passenger compart-
ment heater* - messages (p. 143)
Engine block heater and passenger
compartment heater* - messages
Symbols and messages regarding the engine
block and passenger compartment heater
(p. 140) differ depending on whether the com-
bined instrument panel is analogue (p. 66) or
digital (p. 67).
When the heater has been activated
the heat symbol illuminates in the
information display.
When one of the timers is activated the symbol
for activated timer illuminates in the information
display at the same time as the set time is shown
next to the symbol.
Symbol for activated timer in analogue
combined instrument panel.
Symbol for activated timer in digital
combined instrument panel.
The table shows symbols and display texts that
appear.
Symbol Message Specification
The heater is
switched on and run-
ning.
The heater's timer is
activated after the
remote control key
has been removed
from the ignition
switch and leaving
the car - the engine
and passenger com-
partment are heated
at the set time.
Fuel
operated
heater
stopped
Battery
saving
mode
The heater has been
stopped by the car's
electronics in order to
facilitate starting the
engine.
||
CLIMATE CONTROL
* Option/accessory.
144
Symbol Message Specification
Fuel
operated
heater
stopped
Low fuel
level
Setting the heater is
not possible due to
fuel level being too
low - this is in order
to facilitate starting
the engine as well as
approx. 50 km driving.
Fuel
operated
heater
Service
required
Heater not working.
Contact a workshop
for repair. Volvo rec-
ommends that you
contact an authorised
Volvo workshop.
A display text clears automatically after a time or
after one press on the indicator stalk (p. 110) OK
button.
Related information
Engine block heater and passenger compart-
ment heater* - direct start (p. 141)
Engine block heater and passenger compart-
ment heater* - timer (p. 142)
Additional heater*
For cars with diesel engines sold in cold climate
zones4 an additional heater may be required to
obtain the correct operating temperature in the
engine and to obtain sufficient heating in the
passenger compartment.
In such instances, the car is equipped with either
electric additional heater (p. 145) or
fuel-driven additional heater (p. 144)5.
Related information
Engine block and passenger compartment
heater* (p. 140)
Fuel-driven additional heater*
The car is equipped with either an electric
(p. 145) or a fuel-driven additional heater
(p. 144).
The heater starts automatically when extra heat is
required when the engine is running.
The heater is switched off automatically when the
correct temperature is reached or when the
engine is switched off.
NOTE
When the auxiliary heater is active there may
be smoke from underneath the car, which is
perfectly normal.
Auto mode or shutdown
Automatic start of the additional heater can be
deactivated if required.
NOTE
Volvo recommends that the fuel-driven addi-
tional heater should be switched off for short
distances.
1. Before starting the engine: Select key posi-
tion I (p. 81).
4An authorised Volvo dealer has information regarding the geographical areas concerned.
5For cars equipped with parking heater (p. 140).
CLIMATE CONTROL
* Option/accessory. 145
2. Press OK to access the menu.
3. Scroll with the thumbwheel to Additional
heater6 or Settings7 and select with OK.
4. Select one of the options ON or OFF using
the thumbwheel and confirm with OK.
5. Exit the menu with RESET.
NOTE
The menu options are only visible in key posi-
tion I - any adjustments must therefore be
made before starting the engine.
Related information
Engine block and passenger compartment
heater* (p. 140)
Electric additional heater*
The car is equipped with either a fuel-driven
(p. 144) or an electric additional heater (p. 144).
The heater cannot be controlled manually but is
instead activated automatically after the engine
has been started in outside temperatures below
9 °C and is switched off after the set passenger
compartment temperature has been reached.
Related information
Engine block and passenger compartment
heater* (p. 140)
6Analogue combined instrument panel.
7Digital combined instrument panel.
LOADING AND STORAGE
LOADING AND STORAGE
148
Storage spaces
Overview of storage spaces in the passenger
compartment.
LOADING AND STORAGE
* Option/accessory. 149
Storage compartment1 in door panel
Storage compartment, driver’s side (p. 150)
Ticket clip
Storage compartment
Glovebox (p. 151)
Storage compartment, cup holder (p. 150)
Cup holder* in rear seat
Storage pocket2
Storage compartment, rear seat
WARNING
Keep loose objects such as mobile phones,
cameras, remote controls for accessories, etc.
in the glove compartment or other compart-
ments. Otherwise they may injure people in
the car in the event of sudden braking or a
collision.
1With ice scraper holder on the driver’s side.
2Not applicable to textile upholstery.
LOADING AND STORAGE
* Option/accessory.
150
Storage compartment driver’s side
This storage compartment (p. 148) is located on
the driver's side, to the left under the lighting
panel.
WARNING
Do not keep any sharp objects in the com-
partment, or objects which protrude.
Tunnel console
The tunnel console is located between the front
seats.
Storage compartment (e.g. for CDs) and
USB*/AUX input under the armrest.
Includes cup holder for driver and passenger.
(If ashtray and cigarette lighter (p. 151) are
specified, then there is a cigarette lighter in
the 12 V socket (p. 152) for the front seat,
and a detachable ashtray in the cup holder.)
Related information
Storage spaces (p. 148)
Tunnel console - armrest (p. 150)
Tunnel console - armrest
The tunnel console is located between the front
seats.
When closed, the tunnel console's armrest can
be adjusted* longitudinally.
Related information
Tunnel console - 12 V-sockets (p. 152)
Tunnel console - cigarette lighter and ash-
tray* (p. 151)
LOADING AND STORAGE
* Option/accessory. 151
Tunnel console - cigarette lighter
and ashtray*
A detachable ashtray is fitted in the cup holder
under the armrest. The cigarette lighter is fitted
in the 12 V socket (p. 152) for the front seat.
The ashtray in the tunnel console (p. 150) is
detached by lifting the tray straight up.
Activate the lighter by pushing in the button. The
button pops out when the lighter is hot. Pull out
the lighter and light a cigarette on the heated
coils.
Related information
Storage spaces (p. 148)
Glovebox
The glovebox is located on the passenger side.
The owner's manual and maps can be kept in
here for example. There are also holders for pens
on the inside of the lid. The glovebox can be
locked* (p. 176), using the key blade (p. 167).
Related information
Storage spaces (p. 148)
Inlaid mats*
Inlay mats collect e.g. rubbish and slush. Volvo
supplies specially manufactured inlay mats.
WARNING
Only use one inlaid mat at each seat, and
check before setting off that the mat by the
driver's seat is firmly affixed and secured in
the pins so that it does not get caught adja-
cent to and under the pedals.
Related information
Cleaning the interior (p. 376)
LOADING AND STORAGE
* Option/accessory.
152
Vanity mirror
The vanity mirror is located on the rear of the sun
visor.
Vanity mirror with lighting.
The light illuminates automatically when the cover
is lifted.
Related information
Lamp replacement - vanity mirror lighting
(p. 354)
Tunnel console - 12 V-sockets
The electrical sockets (12 V) are located in the
tunnel console's storage compartment and
beside the cup holder3.
12 V socket in tunnel console, front seat.
The electrical sockets can be used for various
accessories designed for 12 V, e.g. screens,
music players and mobile phones. For the socket
to supply current, the remote control key must be
in at least key position I (p. 81).
WARNING
Always leave the plug in the socket when the
socket is not in use.
NOTE
Optional equipment and accessories - e.g.
display screens, music players and mobile
phones - which are connected to one of the
passenger compartment's 12V electrical
sockets could be activated by the climate
control system, even when the remote control
key has been removed or when the car is
locked, for example, when the engine block
and passenger compartment heater* is acti-
vated at a preset time.
For this reason remove the plugs from the
electrical sockets for optional equipment or
accessories when not in use because the bat-
tery could be drained in the event of such an
occurrence!
IMPORTANT
Max. power takeoff is 10 A (120 W) in either
socket.
NOTE
The compressor for emergency puncture
repair (p. 328) has been tested and approved
by Volvo.
3If ashtray and cigarette lighter are specified then there is no cup holder and adjacent 12 V socket.
LOADING AND STORAGE
}}
* Option/accessory. 153
Related information
Tunnel console - cigarette lighter and ash-
tray* (p. 151)
12 V socket - cargo area (p. 156)
Loading
Payload depends on the car's kerb weight.
Payload depends on the car's kerb weight. The
total of the weight of the passengers and all
accessories reduces the car's payload by a cor-
responding weight.
For more detailed information on weights, see
Weights (p. 385).
The tailgate is opened via a button on
the lighting panel or the remote control
key, see Locking/unlocking - tailgate
(p. 176).
WARNING
The car’s driving properties change depend-
ing on the weight and positioning of the load.
To bear in mind when loading
Position the load firmly against the rear
seat's backrest.
Note that objects must not prevent the function
of the WHIPS system for the front seats if any of
the rear seat's backrests is folded down, see
WHIPS - seating position (p. 41).
Centre the load.
Heavy objects should be placed as low as
possible. Avoid placing heavy loads on low-
ered backrests.
Cover sharp edges with something soft to
avoid damaging the upholstery.
Secure all loads to the load retaining eyelets
with straps or web lashings.
WARNING
A loose object weighing 20 kg can, in a
frontal collision at a speed of 50 km/h
(30 mph) carry the impact of an item weigh-
ing 1000 kg.
WARNING
The protection provided by the inflatable cur-
tain in the headlining may be compromised or
eliminated by high loads.
Never load cargo above the backrest.
WARNING
Always secure the load. Always secure the
load. During heavy braking the load may oth-
erwise shift, causing personal injury to the
car's occupants.
Cover sharp edges and sharp corners with
something soft.
Switch off the engine and apply the parking
brake when loading/unloading long items.
Otherwise you may accidentally knock the
gear lever or gear selector with the load into a
drive position - and the car could then move
off.
||
LOADING AND STORAGE
* Option/accessory.
154
Related information
Load retaining eyelets (p. 155)
Cargo net* (p. 157)
Loading - long load (p. 154)
Roof load (p. 154)
Loading - long load
To simplify loading in the cargo area, the rear
seat backrest can be folded down. The passen-
ger seat backrest can also be folded for an extra
long load.
Folding the passenger seat
See Seats, front (p. 82).
Lowering the rear seat backrest
See (p. 86).
Related information
Loading (p. 153)
Roof load
The load carriers recommended for roof loads
are the ones developed by Volvo. This is in order
to avoid damage to the car and in order to
achieve the maximum possible safety during a
journey.
Carefully follow the installation instructions sup-
plied with the carriers.
Check periodically that the load carriers and
load are properly secured. Lash the load
securely with retaining straps.
Distribute the load evenly over the load carri-
ers. Put the heaviest objects at the bottom.
The size of the area exposed to the wind, and
therefore fuel consumption, increase with the
size of the load.
Drive gently. Avoid quick acceleration, heavy
braking and hard cornering.
WARNING
The car's centre of gravity and driving charac-
teristics are altered by roof loads.
For information about the maximum permitted
load on the roof, including load carriers and
any space box, see Weights (p. 385).
Related information
Loading (p. 153)
LOADING AND STORAGE
}}
* Option/accessory. 155
Load retaining eyelets
The load retaining eyelets are used to fasten
straps in order to anchor items in the cargo area.
WARNING
Hard, sharp and/or heavy objects which pro-
trude may cause injury under violent braking.
Always secure large and heavy objects with a
seatbelt or cargo retaining straps.
Related information
Loading (p. 153)
Loading - bag holder
The bag holders keep carrier bags in place and
prevent them from overturning and spreading
their contents around the cargo area. The holder
has a capacity of max. 3 kg.
Bag holder
Related information
Loading (p. 153)
Loading - folding bag holder* (p. 155)
Loading - folding bag holder*
A folding bag holder in the floor keeps bags in
place and prevents them from overturning and
spreading their contents in the cargo area, and
can be opened up in three positions.
Folding bag holder
It can be set to two adjustment positions and one
service position, as it is known, where it is fully
unfolded. There are also two floor combination
variants, one with adjustment positions in a tub
under the floor and one with adjustment posi-
tions in plastic rails. The raising below shows the
adjustment position in a tub under the floor.
The load on the central holder is max. 3 kg and
max. 10 kg on the outer holder.
||
LOADING AND STORAGE
* Option/accessory.
156
Folding up
Lift the handle* on the upper floor and fold
up the floor.
Move the floor forwards to an appropriate
position and place it in the adjustment
groove.
3. In service position, the floor is moved all the
way forwards towards the rear seat back and
placed in the plastic support in the centre.
Related information
Loading (p. 153)
Loading - bag holder (p. 155)
12 V socket - cargo area
The electrical socket can be used for various
accessories designed for 12 Volts, e.g. display
screens, music players and mobile phones.
Lower the cover to access the electrical socket.
The socket also provides voltage when the
remote control key is not in the ignition
switch.
IMPORTANT
Max. socket current is 10 A (120 W).
NOTE
Remember that using the electrical socket
with the engine switched off involves the risk
of discharging the car's battery.
NOTE
The compressor for emergency puncture
repair (p. 328) has been tested and approved
by Volvo.
Related information
Tunnel console - 12 V-sockets (p. 152)
LOADING AND STORAGE
}}
* Option/accessory. 157
Cargo net*
A cargo net prevents cargo from being thrown
forward in the passenger compartment in the
event of heavy braking.
The cargo net is fitted into four mounting points.
For safety reasons, the cargo net must always be
correctly fastened and secured. The mesh is
made of a strong nylon fabric and secured
behind the front seat backrests.
WARNING
Loads in the luggage compartment must be
anchored well, and also have a correctly fitted
safety net.
Attaching
NOTE
The easiest way to fit the safety net is via one
of the rear doors.
WARNING
It is necessary to ensure that the upper secur-
ing points of the safety net are fitted correctly
and that the puller-straps are secured prop-
erly. Damaged nets must not be used.
1. Hook the hooks into the roof mounting with
the anchoring strap locks turned towards
you.
Thread the cargo net's anchoring straps
through the eyes on the rear of the seat slide
rails - it is easier if the backrests are straight-
ened and the seats are moved forward
slightly.
Pay attention to make sure that you do not
press the seat/backrest hard against the net
when the seat/backrest is moved back again
- only adjust until the seat/backrest makes
contact with the net.
IMPORTANT
If a seat/backrest is pushed backwards hard
into the safety net then the net and/or its
roof mounts may be damaged.
||
LOADING AND STORAGE
158
2. Depress the button in the anchoring strap's
lock and thread the anchoring strap from
below through the lock.
Tension the cargo net with the anchoring
straps.
Removal and storage
1. Release the tension in the cargo net by
pressing in the button on the anchoring
strap's lock and feeding out the strap.
2. Unhook the hooks from the roof mountings.
3. Fold up the cargo net and place it in the
storage bag in the cargo area.
Related information
Loading (p. 153)
Load retaining eyelets (p. 155)
Hat shelf
The hat shelf can be removed to provide addi-
tional cargo space.
Hat shelf removal
Undo the hat shelf lifting eyes on both sides.
Unhook the front edge of the hat shelf and
remove it.
Related information
Loading (p. 153)
Loading - long load (p. 154)
LOCKS AND ALARM
LOCKS AND ALARM
* Option/accessory.
160
Remote control key
Amongst other things, the remote control key is
used for locking/unlocking and starting the
engine.
There are three variants of key available -
Remote control key in basic version, Remote con-
trol key without PCC* and Remote control key
with PCC*.
Functionality BasicAwithout
PCCA
with
PCCB
Locking/
unlocking and
detachable key
blade
x x x
Keyless lock-
ing/unlocking x x
Keyless engine
starting x x
Information but-
ton and indica-
tor lamps
x
A5-button key
B6-button key
More information
Remote Control Key Basic - is a key in the
basic version, see Remote control key - func-
tions (p. 164) for a description of its func-
tions.
Remote control key without PCC - with Key-
less Drive* (p. 169) and keyless locking
(p. 171) and unlocking (p. 172).
Remote control key with PCC - also has an
information button and indicator lamps. Read
more about these unique functions (p. 165).
All remote control keys have a detachable key
blade (p. 167) made of metal. The visible section
is available in two versions so that it is possible to
distinguish between the remote control keys.
More remote control keys can be ordered - but
not variants other than the one supplied with the
car. Up to six keys can be programmed and used
for one single car.
The car is supplied with two remote control keys.
WARNING
If there are children in the car:
Remember to switch off the supply to the
power windows by removing the remote con-
trol key if the driver leaves the car.
Remote control key - losing
If you lose a remote control key (p. 160) then a
new one can be ordered at a workshop - an
authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.
The remaining remote control keys must be
taken to the Volvo workshop. The code of the
missing remote control key must be erased from
the system as a theft prevention measure. The
current number of keys registered to the car can
be checked in the menu system MY CAR. For a
description of the menu system, see MY CAR
(p. 113).
Related information
Remote control key - functions (p. 164)
Remote control key - range (p. 165)
LOCKS AND ALARM
}}
* Option/accessory. 161
Remote control key -
personalisation*
The key memory in the remote control key means
that certain settings in the car can be individually
adapted for different people.
The key memory function is available in combina-
tion with, for example, power* driver's seat (p. 84).
Settings for door mirrors (p. 106), driver's seat,
steering force (p. 186) and the combined instru-
ment panel's theme, contrast and colour mode
(p. 67) can be stored in the key memory, depend-
ing on the car's equipment level.
The function1 can be activated/deactivated in the
menu system MY CAR. For a description of the
menu system, see MY CAR (p. 113).
When the function is activated, the settings are
automatically linked to the key memory. This
means that a change in a setting will automati-
cally be saved in the specific remote control key's
memory.
Storing settings
Proceed as follows in order to store the settings
and use the key memory in the remote control
key:
1. Unlock the car with the remote control key in
whose memory the setting2 shall be stored.
2. Make sure that the key memory function is
activated in the menu system MY CAR.
3. Make the desired settings for e.g. the seat
and the door mirrors.
4. The settings are stored in the current remote
control key's memory.
The next time the car is unlocked with the same
remote control key, the positions that are stored
in the key memory will be set automatically - pro-
viding that they have been changed since the last
time the current remote control key was used.
Emergency stop
If the seat accidentally begins to move, press one
of the setting buttons for the seat or memory
buttons in order to stop the seat.
Restarting to reach the seat position stored in
the key memory is performed by pressing the
unlock button on the remote control key. The
driver's door must then be open.
WARNING
Risk of crushing! Make sure that children do
not play with the controls. Check that there
are no objects in front of, behind or under the
seat during adjustment. Make sure that none
of the passengers in the rear seat is in danger
of becoming trapped.
Changing settings
If several people each with a remote control key
approach the car, then the settings for e.g. seat
and door mirrors are implemented for the person
whose remote control key unlocks the driver's
door.
If the driver's door has been opened by person A
with remote control key A, but person B with
remote control key B shall drive, then the settings
can be changed as follows:
Standing by the driver's door, or sitting
behind the steering wheel, person B presses
the button for unlocking on his/her remote
control key.
Select one of three possible memories for
seat adjustment with seat button 1-3.
Adjust the seat and door mirrors manually.
1Known as Car key memory in MY CAR.
2This setting does not affect settings that have been stored in the power seat's memory function.
||
LOCKS AND ALARM
* Option/accessory.
162
Related information
Remote control key - functions (p. 164)
Remote control key with PCC* - unique func-
tions (p. 165)
Locking/unlocking - indicator
When the car is locked or unlocked using the
remote control key (p. 160) the direction indica-
tors confirm that locking/unlocking was correctly
performed.
Locking - one flash and the door mirrors are
folded3 in.
Unlocking - two flashes and the door mirrors
are folded3 out.
NOTE
Be aware of the risk of locking the remote
control key in the car.
When locking, indication is given only if all locks
have been locked and all doors are closed. Indi-
cation is given when the last door has been
closed.
Selecting the function
Different options for indicating locking/unlocking
with light can be set in the menu system MY
CAR. For a description of the menu system, see
MY CAR (p. 113).
Lock indicator
A flashing LED by the windscreen verifies that
the car is locked.
Same LED as alarm indicator (p. 182).
NOTE
Cars that are not equipped with alarm also
have this indicator.
Related information
Keyless drive* (p. 169)
Alarm indicator* (p. 182)
3Only for cars with retractable power door mirrors.
LOCKS AND ALARM
* Option/accessory. 163
Remote control key - electronic
immobiliser
The electronic immobiliser is a theft protection
system that prevents the vehicle from being
started (p. 270) by an unauthorised person.
Each remote control key (p. 160) has a unique
code. The car can only be started with the correct
remote control key with the correct code.
The following error messages in the combined
instrument panel's information display are related
to the electronic immobiliser:
Message Specification
Insert car
key
Error when reading the remote
control key during starting -
Remove the key from the igni-
tion switch, press it in again and
make a new start attempt.
Car key
not
foundA
Error reading the remote control
key during starting - Try to start
again.
If the error persists: Insert the
remote control key into the igni-
tion switch and try to start again.
Immobi-
liser Try
to start
again
Error in immobiliser system dur-
ing starting. If the error persists:
Contact a workshop - an author-
ised Volvo workshop is recom-
mended.
AOnly applies to cars with keyless start and lock system.
Related information
Remote-controlled immobiliser with tracking
system* (p. 163)
Keyless drive* (p. 169)
Remote-controlled immobiliser with
tracking system*
Remote-controlled immobiliser with tracking sys-
tem4 makes it possible to track and locate the
car, and to remotely activate the immobiliser.
Contact your nearest Volvo dealer for more infor-
mation and assistance with activating the system.
Related information
Remote control key (p. 160)
Remote control key - electronic immobiliser
(p. 163)
4Only certain markets and in combination with Volvo On Call*.
LOCKS AND ALARM
* Option/accessory.
164
Remote control key - functions
The remote control key has functions such as
locking and unlocking the doors.
Functions
Remote control key in basic version.
Locking
Unlocking
Approach light duration
Tailgate
Panic function
Remote control key with PCC* (Personal Car
Communicator).
Information button - see Remote control
key with PCC* - unique functions (p. 165)
for a description of its functionality.
Function buttons
Locking – Locks the doors and tailgate
while the alarm is activated, see Locking/unlock-
ing - from the outside (p. 174).
Press and hold to close all windows simultane-
ously. For more information, see Global opening
(p. 176).
WARNING
If windows are closed using the remote con-
trol key, check that nobody's hands are trap-
ped.
Unlocking (p. 174) - Unlocks the doors
and tailgate while the alarm is deactivated.
Press and hold to open all windows simultane-
ously. For more information, see Global opening
(p. 176).
The function can be changed from unlocking all
doors simultaneously, to unlocking the driver's
door only with one press of the button and, after
a further press of the button - within ten seconds
- unlocking the remaining doors.
The function can be changed in the menu system
MY CAR. For a description of the menu system,
see MY CAR (p. 113).
Approach light duration (p. 102) - Used
to switch on the car's lighting at a distance.
Tailgate (p. 176) - Unlocks and disarms
the alarm for the tailgate only.
Panic function – Used to attract attention
in an emergency.
Press and hold the button for at least three sec-
onds or press it twice within three seconds to
activate the direction indicators and the horn.
The function can be turned off with the same
button once it has been active for at least five
seconds. Otherwise the function switches off
automatically after approx. three minutes.
Related information
Remote control key (p. 160)
LOCKS AND ALARM
}}
* Option/accessory. 165
Remote control key - range
Remote control key functions (in its basic ver-
sion) have a range of approx. 20 metres from
the car.
If the car does not verify a button being pressed -
move closer and try again.
NOTE
The remote control key functions may be dis-
rupted by surrounding radio waves, buildings,
topographical conditions, etc. The car can
always be locked/unlocked with the key blade
(p. 168).
If the remote control key is removed from the car
when the engine is running or key position I or II
(p. 80) is active, and all doors are closed, then a
warning message is shown in the information dis-
play in the combined instrument panel and a
short audio reminder signal sounds at the same
time.
The message extinguishes when the remote con-
trol key is returned to the car, followed by a press
of the OK button, or when all doors are closed.
Related information
Remote control key (p. 160)
Remote control key - functions (p. 164)
Remote control key with PCC* -
unique functions
A remote control key with PCC* has enhanced
functionality compared with a remote control key
in basic version (p. 160) in the form of an infor-
mation button and indicator lamps.
Remote control key with PCC.
Information button
Indicator lamps
Using the information button enables access to
certain information from the car via the indicator
lamps.
Using the information button
Press the information button .
> All indicator lamps flash for approximately
7 seconds and the light travels around on
the PCC. This indicates that information
from the car has been read.
If any of the other buttons are pressed
during this time then the reading is inter-
rupted.
NOTE
If none of the indicator lamps illuminates
with repeated use of the information button
and in different locations (as well as after 7
seconds and after the light has travelled
around on the PCC), contact a workshop - an
authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.
Indicator lamps display information in accordance
with the following illustration:
||
LOCKS AND ALARM
* Option/accessory.
166
Green continuous light – the car is locked.
Yellow continuous light – the car is unlocked.
Red continuous light – the alarm has been
triggered since the car was locked.
Red light flashing alternately in both indicator
lamps – The alarm was triggered less than 5
minutes ago.
Related information
Remote control key with PCC* - range
(p. 166)
Remote control key with PCC* -
range
The range of a remote control key with PCC
(Personal Car Communicator) for unlocking the
doors and tailgate is approx. 20 metres from the
car - the other functions are up to approx. 100
metres. If the car does not verify a button being
pressed - move closer and try again.
NOTE
The information button function may be dis-
rupted by surrounding radio waves, buildings,
topographical conditions, etc.
Out of range
If the remote control key is too far away from the
car for the information to be read then the status
the car was last left in is shown, without the light
travelling around on the remote control key.
If several remote control keys are used for the
car then it is only the remote control key last
used for locking/unlocking that shows the cor-
rect status.
NOTE
If none of the indicator lamps illuminates
with repeated use of the information button
and in different locations (as well as after 7
seconds and after the light has travelled
around on the PCC), contact a workshop - an
authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.
Related information
Keyless Drive* - range (p. 170)
Remote control key - range (p. 165)
LOCKS AND ALARM
* Option/accessory. 167
Detachable key blade
The remote control key contains a detachable
key blade of metal with which some functions
can be activated and some operations carried
out.
The key blade's unique code is provided by
authorised Volvo workshops, which are recom-
mended when ordering new key blades.
Key blade functions
Using the remote control key's detachable key
blade:
the left-hand front door can be unlocked
manually (p. 168) if central locking cannot
be activated with the remote control key.
the rear doors' mechanical child safety locks
can be activated/deactivated (p. 180).
the right-hand front door and the rear doors
can be locked manually, e.g. in the event of
power failure.
the glovebox lock* can be unlocked.
the airbag for front passenger seat
(PACOS*) can be activated/deactivated.
Related information
Manual locking of the door (p. 174)
Locking/unlocking - glovebox (p. 176)
Passenger airbag - activating/deactivating*
(p. 36)
Detachable key blade - detaching/
attaching
Detaching/attaching the detachable key blade
(p. 167) is carried out as follows:
Removing the key blade
Slide the spring-loaded catch to the side.
At the same time pull the key blade straight
out backwards.
Attaching the key blade
Carefully refit the key blade into its location in the
remote control key (p. 160).
1. Hold the remote control key with the slot
pointed up and lower the key blade into its
slot.
2. Lightly press the key blade. You should hear
a "click" when the key blade is locked in.
Related information
Detachable key blade - unlocking doors
(p. 168)
Child safety locks - manual activation
(p. 180)
Passenger airbag - activating/deactivating*
(p. 36)
LOCKS AND ALARM
* Option/accessory.
168
Detachable key blade - unlocking
doors
The detachable key blade can be used if the
central locking cannot be activated with the
remote control key - e.g. if the remote control
key's battery (p. 168) has been discharged.
The left-hand front door can be opened as fol-
lows:
1. Unlock the left-hand front door with the key
blade in the door handle's lock cylinder. For
more information, see Keyless Drive* -
unlocking with the key blade (p. 172).
NOTE
When the door has been unlocked using the
key blade and is opened, the alarm is trig-
gered.
2. Deactivate the alarm by inserting the remote
control key in the ignition switch.
For cars with keyless start and lock system, see
Keyless Drive* - unlocking with the key blade
(p. 172).
Related information
Detachable key blade (p. 167)
Remote control key (p. 160)
Remote control key/PCC - replacing
the battery
The battery5 in the remote control key may need
to be replaced.
The battery for the remote control key should be
replaced if:
the information symbol is illuminated and the
display in the combined instrument panel
shows Car key battery low See manual
and/or
the locks repeatedly do not react to signals
from the remote control key within 20 metres
from the car.
Opening
Slide the spring-loaded catch to the side.
At the same time pull the key blade
straight out backwards.
Insert a 3 mm slot screwdriver in the hole
behind the spring-loaded catch and gently
prize the remote control key up.
5Remote control key with PCC has two batteries.
LOCKS AND ALARM
* Option/accessory. 169
NOTE
Turn the remote control key over with the but-
tons facing up, this is to avoid the batteries
falling out when it is opened.
IMPORTANT
Avoid touching new batteries and their con-
tact surfaces with your fingers as this may
impair their function.
Battery replacement
NOTE
Volvo recommends that the batteries to be
used in the remote control key/PCC fulfil UN
Manual of Test and Criteria, Part III, sub-
section 38.3. Batteries fitted in the factory or
replaced by an authorised Volvo workshop
fulfil the above criteria.
Closely study how the battery/batteries are
secured on the inside of the cover, with
regard to their (+) and () sides.
Remote control key with one battery
1. Carefully prize out the battery.
2. Install a new one with the (+) side down.
Remote control key with PCC* with two
batteries
1. Carefully prize out the batteries.
2. First install one new one with the (+) side up.
3. Position the white plastic tab in between and
finally install a second new battery with the
(+) side down.
Battery type
Use batteries with designation CR2430, 3 V.
Assembly
1. Press the remote control key together.
2. Hold the remote control key with the slot
pointed up and lower the key blade into its
slot.
3. Lightly press the key blade. You should hear
a "click" when the key blade is locked in.
IMPORTANT
Make sure that exhausted batteries are dis-
posed of in a manner which is kind to the
environment.
Related information
Remote control key (p. 160)
Remote control key - functions (p. 164)
Keyless drive*
Cars equipped with Keyless Drive have a star-
ting and locking system that can be operated
keylessly.
With the keyless start and lock system the car
can be started, locked and unlocked without the
remote control key (p. 160) inserted in the igni-
tion switch6. It is enough to have the remote con-
trol key with you in a pocket. The system makes it
easier and more convenient to e.g. open the car
when your hands are full.
Both of the remote control keys included with the
car have keyless functionality. It is possible to
order more remote control keys.
The car's electrical system can be set to three
different levels - key position 0, I and II (p. 81) -
with the remote control key.
Related information
Keyless Drive* - range (p. 170)
Keyless Drive* - secure handling of the
remote control key (p. 170)
Keyless Drive* - interference to remote con-
trol key function (p. 171)
6Does not apply to Remote Control Key Basic.
LOCKS AND ALARM
* Option/accessory.
170
Keyless Drive* - range7
In order to unlock the doors or tailgate automati-
cally without pressing a button on the remote
control key, a remote control key must be within
approx. 1.5 metres from the car's door handle or
tailgate.
The person who wishes to lock or unlock a door
must have the remote control key with him or her.
It is not possible to lock or unlock a door if the
remote control key is on the opposite side of the
car.
The red rings in the above figure indicate the
range covered by the system's antennas.
If all remote control keys are removed from the
car when the engine is running or key position I
or II (p. 81) is active, and if a door has been
opened and then closed, then a warning mes-
sage is shown in the information display in the
combined instrument panel and an audio
reminder signal sounds at the same time.
When the remote control key has been returned
to the car, the warning message goes off and the
audible reminder ceases once either/or:
a door has been opened and closed
the remote control key has been inserted in
the ignition switch
The OK button on the direction indicator
stalk.
Related information
Keyless drive* (p. 169)
Keyless Drive* - antenna location (p. 173)
Keyless Drive* - secure handling of
the remote control key
It is important to handle all remote control keys
with great care.
If one of the remote control keys8 has been left
in the car then the keyless functions are deacti-
vated in case the car is e.g. locked with the other
remote control key that belongs to the car. This
prevents unauthorised entry.
The next time the car is unlocked with the other
remote control key the forgotten remote control
key is reactivated again.
IMPORTANT
Avoid leaving the remote control key with
PCC behind in the car. If someone breaks into
your car and takes the remote control key, it
will e.g. be possible to start the car by press-
ing the remote control key in the ignition
switch and then pressing the START/STOP
ENGINE button.
Related information
Keyless drive* (p. 169)
7Does not apply to cars with keyless starting
8Applies to remote control key with PCC (Personal Car Communicator).
LOCKS AND ALARM
* Option/accessory. 171
Keyless Drive* - interference to
remote control key function
Electromagnetic fields and screening can inter-
fere with the remote control key's keyless func-
tions (p. 169).
NOTE
Do not place/store the remote control key
with keyless function near a mobile phone or
metal object - no closer than 10-15 cm.
If interference is experienced nonetheless, use
the remote control key and the key blade like a
remote control key in basic version (p. 160).
Related information
Remote control key/PCC - replacing the bat-
tery (p. 168)
Keyless Drive* - secure handling of the
remote control key (p. 170)
Keyless Drive* - range (p. 170)
Keyless Drive* - locking
Cars equipped with keyless start and lock sys-
tem have a touch-sensitive area on the outside
handle of the doors and a rubberised button
next to the tailgate's rubberised pressure plate.
Lock the doors and the tailgate by grasping one
of the door handles or pressing the smaller of the
tailgate's two rubberised buttons - the lock indi-
cator (p. 162) in the windscreen confirms that
locking has been completed by starting to flash.
All doors and the tailgate must be closed before
the car can be locked - otherwise the car is not
locked.
NOTE
In cars with automatic gearbox selectors, the
gear selector must be set to the P position;
otherwise the car can be neither locked nor
alarmed.
Related information
Keyless drive* (p. 169)
Alarm indicator* (p. 182)
LOCKS AND ALARM
* Option/accessory.
172
Keyless Drive* - unlocking9
Unlocking takes place when a hand grasps a
door handle or the tailgate's rubberised pressure
plate is actuated - open the door or tailgate as
normal.
NOTE
The door handles normally register a hand
that takes hold of the handle, but with thick
gloves on or after a very quick hand move-
ment a second attempt may be required, or
with the glove taken off.
Related information
Keyless drive* (p. 169)
Keyless Drive* - locking (p. 171)
Keyless Drive* - unlocking with the
key blade
If central locking cannot be activated with the
remote control key, e.g. if the batteries are dis-
charged, then the left-hand front door is
unlocked with the remote control key's detacha-
ble key blade (p. 167).
Hole for key blade - to loosen the cover.
To access the lock cylinder, the door handle's
plastic cover must be removed - this is also done
with the key blade:
1. Press the key blade approx. 1 cm straight up
into the hole on the underside of the door
handle/cover - do not prize.
> The plastic cover loosens automatically by
means of the torque when the blade is
pushed straight up and into the opening.
2. Then insert the key blade in the lock cylinder
and unlock the door.
3. Refit the plastic cover after unlocking.
NOTE
When the left-hand front door is unlocked
using the key blade and is opened, this trig-
gers the alarm (p. 181). It is switched off by
inserting the remote control key in the ignition
switch, see Alarm* - remote control key not
working (p. 183).
Related information
Keyless drive* (p. 169)
Detachable key blade - detaching/attaching
(p. 167)
9Does not apply to remote control keys with keyless starting.
LOCKS AND ALARM
* Option/accessory. 173
Keyless Drive* - lock settings
Lock settings for cars equipped with keyless
start and lock system can be adapted by indicat-
ing in the menu system MY CAR which doors
are to be unlocked.
For a description of the menu system, see MY
CAR (p. 113).
Related information
Keyless drive* (p. 169)
Keyless Drive* - antenna location
Cars equipped with keyless start and lock sys-
tem have a number of built-in antennas posi-
tioned at different locations in the car.
Rear bumper, centre
Door handle, left rear
Cargo area, central and furthest in under the
floor
Door handle, right rear
Centre console, under the rear section
Centre console, under the front section.
WARNING
People with pacemaker operations should not
come closer than 22 cm to the keyless sys-
tem's antennae with their pacemaker. This is
to prevent interference between the pace-
maker and the keyless system.
Related information
Keyless drive* (p. 169)
LOCKS AND ALARM
* Option/accessory.
174
Locking/unlocking - from the
outside
Locking/unlocking from the outside is carried
out using the remote control key (p. 164). The
remote control key can lock/unlock all doors, the
tailgate and the fuel filler flap. Different sequen-
ces for unlocking can be selected.
In order that the lock sequence can be activated,
the driver's door must be closed - if any of the
other doors or the tailgate is open, then it/they
is/are locked and the alarm is activated only
when it/they are closed. For cars equipped with
keyless locking system* all doors and the tailgate
must be closed, see Keyless Drive* - locking
(p. 171) and Keyless Drive* - unlocking (p. 172).
NOTE
Be aware of the risk of locking the remote
control key in the car.
If it is not possible to lock/unlock with the remote
control key, the battery may be discharged - lock
or unlock the left-hand front door with the
detachable key blade (p. 167).
NOTE
Remember that the alarm is triggered when
the door is opened after being unlocked with
the key blade - the alarm is switched off when
the remote control key is inserted into the
ignition switch.
WARNING
Be aware of the risk of being locked in the
car when it is locked from the outside using
the remote control key - it is then not possible
to open any of the doors from the inside with
the door controls. For more information, see
Deadlocks* (p. 178).
Automatic relocking
If none of the doors or the tailgate is opened
within two minutes of unlocking, all are locked
again automatically. This function prevents the
car from being left unlocked unintentionally. For
cars with alarm, see Alarm* (p. 181).
Related information
Locking/unlocking - from the inside (p. 175)
Remote control key - functions (p. 164)
Manual locking of the door
In certain situations the car must be lockable
manually, e.g. in the event of power failure.
The left-hand front door can be locked with its
lock cylinder and the remote control key's
detachable key blade (p. 172).
Other doors have no lock cylinders and instead
have a lock switch on the end of each door which
must be depressed using the key blade - they are
then mechanically locked/blocked to prevent
them being opened from outside. The doors can
still be opened from the inside.
Manual locking of the door. Not to be mixed up with
child safety locks (p. 180).
Remove the detachable key blade (p. 167)
from the remote control key. Insert the key
blade in the hole for lock reset and press the
key in until the key bottoms, approx. 12 mm.
LOCKS AND ALARM
* Option/accessory. 175
The door can be opened from both the out-
side and the inside.
The door is blocked against opening from
the outside. To return to position A, the inner
door handle must be opened.
The doors can also be unlocked with the unlock
button on the remote control key (p. 160) or with
the central locking button on the driver's door.
NOTE
A door's lock reset only locks that partic-
ular door - not all doors simultaneously.
A manually locked rear door with acti-
vated manual child safety locks (p. 180)
cannot be opened from either the outside
or the inside. A rear door that is locked in
this way can only be unlocked with the
remote control key or central locking but-
ton.
Related information
Remote control key/PCC - replacing the bat-
tery (p. 168)
Locking/unlocking - from the inside
Locking/unlocking can be performed using the
driver's door button for central locking. All doors
and tailgate (p. 176) can be locked or unlocked
simultaneously.
Central locking
Press one side of the button to lock -
the other side to unlock.
Lamp in lock button
When the lamp in the central locking button for
the driver's door is illuminated it means that all
doors are locked.
Unlocking
A door can be unlocked from the inside in two
different ways:
Press the central locking button .
A long press also opens all the side windows*
simultaneously (see also section Global opening
(p. 176)).
Pull the door handle and open the door - the
door is unlocked and opened in one opera-
tion.
Locking
Both front doors must be closed for the cen-
tral locking to be activated. Press the central
locking button - all doors are locked. If
any of the rear doors is open, it will lock
when it is closed.
A long press also closes all the side windows
simultaneously (see also section Global opening
(p. 176)).
Automatic locking
The doors and tailgate are locked automatically
when the car starts to move.
The function can be activated/deactivated in the
menu system MY CAR. For a description of the
menu system, see MY CAR (p. 113).
Related information
Locking/unlocking - from the outside
(p. 174)
Alarm* (p. 181)
LOCKS AND ALARM
176
Global opening
The global opening function opens or closes all
side windows simultaneously and can be used
for example to quickly air the car during hot
weather.
Central locking button
A long press on the symbol in the central
locking button or on the remote control key
opens all side windows simultaneously. The
same procedure on the button closes all
side windows simultaneously.
Related information
Locking/unlocking - from the inside (p. 175)
Power windows (p. 104)
Locking/unlocking - glovebox
The glovebox (p. 151) can only be locked/
unlocked using the detachable key blade from
the remote control key (p. 160).
For information on the key blade, see Detachable
key blade - detaching/attaching (p. 167).
Locking the glovebox:
Insert the key blade in the glovebox lock cyl-
inder.
Turn the key blade 90 degrees clockwise.
The keyhole is horizontal in the locked posi-
tion.
Pull out the key blade.
Unlock by carrying this out in reverse order.
Related information
Remote control key - functions (p. 164)
Locking/unlocking - tailgate
The tailgate can be opened, locked and
unlocked in a number of different ways.
Manual opening
Rubber plate with electrical contact.
The tailgate is held closed by an electrical lock.
To open:
1. Push down gently on the wider of the two
rubberised pressure plates under the outer
handle - the lock is released.
2. Lift the outside handle in order to fully open
the tailgate.
LOCKS AND ALARM
}}
* Option/accessory. 177
IMPORTANT
Minimal force is required to release the
rear hatch lock - just gently press the
rubberised panel.
Do not place the lift force on the rubber
panel when opening the rear hatch - lift
the handle. Using too much force may
damage the electrical contacts on the
rubber panel.
Unlocking with the remote control key
Using the remote control key (p. 160) button
the alarm for the tailgate can be disarmed* and
the tailgate unlocked on its own.
The lock indicator (p. 162) on the instrument
panel stops flashing in order to show that not all
of the car is locked and the alarm's* level and
movement sensors and the sensors for opening
the tailgate are disconnected.
The doors remain locked and armed.
The tailgate can be opened in two different ways
using the remote control key:
One press - The tailgate is unlocked, but
remains closed - press lightly on the rubberised
pressure plate under the outer handle and lift the
tailgate. If the tailgate is not opened within
2 minutes then it is relocked and the alarm is re-
armed.
Two presses (within 3 seconds) - The tailgate is
unlocked and the lock is disengaged at which
point the tailgate opens about a centimetre - lift
the outer handle to open. Rain, cold, frost or
snow could however prevent the tailgate from
disengaging from the lock.
NOTE
When the boot lid/tailgate is unlocked
with 2 presses from the remote control
key or from the car interior, automatic
relocking does not take place because
the boot lid/tailgate is open - it must be
closed manually.
After the boot lid/tailgate has been
closed it is unlocked and the alarm is not
armed - relock it and re-arm the alarm
with the remote control key's lock button
.
Opening the car from inside
Unlocking, tailgate
To open the tailgate:
Press the button (1) on the headlamp control
panel.
> The lock releases and the tailgate opens
by a few centimetres.
Locking with the remote control key
Press the remote control key (p. 164) button
for locking .
> The lock indicator on the instrument panel
starts flashing, which means that the car
is locked and the alarm* has been acti-
vated.
||
LOCKS AND ALARM
* Option/accessory.
178
Related information
Locking/unlocking - from the inside (p. 175)
Locking/unlocking - from the outside
(p. 174)
Locking/unlocking - fuel filler flap
The fuel filler flap is unlocked with the remote
control key (p. 160) button for unlocking ( ).
The fuel filler flap remains unlocked until the car
is locked with the remote control key's button for
locking ( ). If the car is locked while driving or
with the interior buttons then the fuel filler flap
remains unlocked.
The fuel filler flap's locking logic also follows the
locking or unlocking of the keyless system and
the central locking system.
Related information
Fuel filler flap - Opening/closing (p. 295)
Fuel filler flap - manual opening (p. 295)
Deadlocks*
Deadlocks10 means that all door handles are
mechanically disengaged, which prevents doors
being opened from the inside.
The deadlocks are activated with the remote con-
trol key (p. 160) and are set after an approx. ten
seconds delay after the doors have been locked.
NOTE
If a door is opened within the delay time then
the sequence is interrupted and the alarm is
deactivated.
The car can only be unlocked with the remote
control key when the deadlocks function is acti-
vated. The front left door can also be unlocked
with the detachable key blade (p. 167).
WARNING
Do not allow anyone to remain in the car with-
out first deactivating the deadlocks in order to
avoid the risk of anyone being locked in.
10 Only in combination with alarm.
LOCKS AND ALARM
* Option/accessory. 179
Temporary deactivation
Active menu options are indicated with a cross.
MY CAR
OK MENU
TUNE knob control
EXIT
If someone is going to stay in the car but the
doors must be locked from the outside, then the
deadlocks function can be temporarily switched
off, which is carried out in the menu system MY
CAR. For a detailed description of the menu sys-
tem, see MY CAR (p. 113).
In MY CAR one of the following options can be
selected:
Activate once: - The combined instrument
panel then shows Locks and alarm
Reduced guard and deadlocks are
switched off when the car is locked, only at
this time. (Note that the alarm's movement
and tilt detectors* are switched off at the
same time.)
During the next time the engine is started, the
system is reset to zero and the combined instru-
ment panel shows the message Locks and
alarm Full guard at which the deadlocks and
the alarm's movement and tilt detectors are re-
engaged.
Ask on exit: - Each time the engine is
switched off, the driver must answer the
question Activate Reduced Guard until
engine has started again?.
If the deadlocks function shall be switched
off
Press OK/MENU and lock the car. (Note
that the alarm's movement and tilt detectors*
are switched off at the same time.)
> The next time the engine is started, the
system is reset to zero and the combined
instrument panel shows the message
Locks and alarm Full guard at which
the deadlocks function and the alarm's
movement and tilt detectors are re-
engaged.
If the locking system shall not be changed
Press EXIT and lock the car.
NOTE
Remember that the alarm is activated
when the car is locked.
If any of the doors are opened from the
inside then the alarm is triggered.
The above applies if the deadlocks have not
been deactivated temporarily.
Related information
Keyless Drive* - unlocking with the key blade
(p. 172)
LOCKS AND ALARM
* Option/accessory.
180
Child safety locks - manual
activation
The child safety locks prevent children from
being able to open a rear door from the inside.
The child safety locks are located on the trailing
edge of the rear doors and are only accessible
when the doors are open.
Activate/deactivate child safety locks
Manual child safety locks. Not to be mixed up with man-
ual door lock (p. 174).
Use the remote control key's detachable key
blade (p. 167) to turn the knob.
The door is blocked against opening from
the inside.
The door can be opened from both the out-
side and the inside.
NOTE
A door's knob control only blocks that
particular door - not both rear doors
simultaneously.
Cars with an electric child safety lock do
not have a manual child lock.
Related information
Child safety locks - electrical activation*
(p. 180)
Locking/unlocking - from the inside (p. 175)
Child safety locks - electrical
activation*
The child safety locks prevent children from
being able to open a rear door from the inside.
Activation
The electrical child safety locks can be activated/
deactivated in all key positions (p. 80) higher
than 0. Activation/deactivation can be performed
up to 2 minutes after switching off the engine,
provided that no door is opened.
Control panel driver's door.
1. Start the engine or choose a key position
higher than 0.
LOCKS AND ALARM
}}
* Option/accessory. 181
2. Press the button in the driver's door control
panel.
> The information display shows the mes-
sage Rear child lock activated and the
button's lamp illuminates - the locks are
active.
When the electric child safety lock is active then
the rear:
windows can only be opened with the driver's
door control panel
doors cannot be opened from inside.
The current setting is stored when the engine is
switched off - if the child safety locks are acti-
vated at engine shutdown, the function will
remain activated the next time the engine is
started.
Related information
Child safety locks - manual activation
(p. 180)
Locking/unlocking - from the inside (p. 175)
Alarm*
The alarm is a device that warns in the event of
e.g. a break-in in the car.
Activated alarm is triggered if:
a door, the bonnet or the tailgate is opened11
a movement is detected in the passenger
compartment (if fitted with a movement
detector*)
the car is raised or towed away (if fitted with
a tilt detector*)
the starter battery's cable is disconnected
the siren is disconnected.
If there is a fault in the alarm system then the
information display in the combined instrument
panel shows a message. In which case, contact a
workshop - an authorised Volvo workshop is rec-
ommended.
NOTE
The movement sensors trigger an alarm in
the event of movement in the passenger
compartment - air currents are also regis-
tered. For this reason the alarm is triggered if
the car is left with a window open or if the
passenger compartment heater is used.
To avoid this: Close the window when leaving
the car. If the car's integrated passenger
compartment heater (or a portable electric
heater) shall be used - direct the airflow from
the air vents so that they are not pointing
upwards in the passenger compartment.
Alternatively, reduced alarm level can be used,
Reduced alarm level* (p. 184).
NOTE
Do not attempt to repair or alter components
in the alarm system yourself. Any such
attempts may affect the terms of the insur-
ance.
Arming the alarm
Press the remote control key lock button.
Deactivate the alarm
Press the remote control key unlock button.
11 Applies to certain markets.
||
LOCKS AND ALARM
* Option/accessory.
182
Deactivating a triggered alarm
Press the remote control key unlock button
or insert the remote control key in the igni-
tion switch.
Related information
Alarm* - automatic re-arming (p. 182)
Alarm* - remote control key not working
(p. 183)
Alarm indicator*
The alarm indicator shows alarm system (p. 181)
status.
Same LED as lock indicator (p. 162).
A red LED on the instrument panel indicates the
alarm system's status:
LED not lit – Alarm not armed
The LED flashes once every other second –
Alarm is armed
The LED flashes rapidly after disarming the
alarm (and until the remote control key is
inserted in the ignition switch and key posi-
tion I is selected) – Alarm has been trig-
gered.
Alarm* - automatic re-arming
Automatic re-arming of the alarm (p. 181) pre-
vents the car being left with the alarm disarmed
unintentionally.
If the car is unlocked with the remote control key
(p. 160)(and the alarm is disarmed) but none of
the doors or the tailgate is opened within 2
minutes, then the alarm is automatically re-
armed. The car is relocked at the same time.
Related information
Alarm* - automatic arming (p. 183)
LOCKS AND ALARM
* Option/accessory. 183
Alarm* - automatic arming
In certain countries the alarm(p. 181) is acti-
vated after a certain delay if the driver's door
was opened and closed but the car was not re-
locked.
Related information
Alarm signals* (p. 183)
Alarm* - remote control key not
working
If the alarm (p. 181) cannot be deactivated with
the remote control key, e.g. if the key's battery
(p. 168) is discharged - the car can be
unlocked, disarmed and the engine started as
follows:
1. Open the left-hand front door with the
detachable key blade (p. 172).
> The alarm is triggered, the direction indi-
cators flash and the siren sounds.
2. Insert the remote control key in the ignition
switch.
> The alarm is deactivated.
Alarm signals*
When the alarm (p. 181) is triggered a siren
sounds and all direction indicators flash.
A siren sounds for 30 seconds or until the
alarm is switched off. The siren has its own
battery and works independently of the car's
starter battery.
The direction indicators flash for 5 minutes
or until the alarm is switched off.
LOCKS AND ALARM
* Option/accessory.
184
Reduced alarm level*
Reduced guard means that the movement and
tilt detectors can be temporarily deactivated.
To avoid accidental triggering of the alarm - e.g. if
a dog is left in a locked car or during transport on
a car train or car ferry - temporarily deactivate the
movement and tilt detectors.
The procedure is the same as with the temporary
disengaging of deadlocks, see Deadlocks*
(p. 178).
Related information
Alarm* (p. 181)
Alarm indicator* (p. 182)
Type approval - remote control key
system
Type approval for the remote control key system
can be read in the table.
Lock system, standard
Country/Area
EU, China
Keyless lock system (Keyless drive)
Country/Area
EU
Korea
Country/Area
China
Hong Kong
Related information
Remote control key (p. 160)
DRIVER SUPPORT
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
186
Adjustable steering force*
Speed related power steering causes the steer-
ing wheel force to increase with the speed of the
car in order to give the driver enhanced sensitiv-
ity.
On motorways the steering feels firmer. Steering
is light and requires no extra effort when parking
and at low speed.
The driver can choose between three different
levels of steering force for road responsiveness
or steering sensitivity in the menu system MY
CAR (p. 113):
Once there, search for Steering force level
and select Low, Medium or High.
This menu is not accessible when the car is mov-
ing.
NOTE
In certain situations the power steering may
become too hot and then needs to be tempo-
rarily cooled - during this time the power
steering operates with reduced power and
turning the steering wheel may then be per-
ceived to be slightly heavier.
In parallel with the temporarily reduced steer-
ing assistance the combined instrument panel
shows a message.
Related information
MY CAR (p. 113)
Electronic stability control (ESC) -
general
Stability system ESC (Electronic Stability
Control) helps the driver to avoid skidding and
improves the car's traction.
The activation of the ESC system dur-
ing braking may be noticed as a throb-
bing sound. The car may accelerate
slower than expected when the accel-
erator pedal is depressed.
WARNING
The stability system ESC is supplementary
assistance - it cannot handle all situations in
all road conditions.
The driver always bears responsibility that the
vehicle is driven safely and that applicable
road traffic rules and regulations are followed.
The ESC system consists of the following func-
tions:
Active Yaw Control
Spin Control
Traction control system
Engine drag control - EDC
Corner Traction Control - CTC
Driver Steering Recommendation – DSR
Trailer Stability Assist* - TSA
DRIVER SUPPORT
}}
* Option/accessory. 187
Active Yaw Control
The function checks the driving and brake force
of the wheels individually in order to stabilise the
car.
Spin Control
The function reduces engine power if the drive
wheels slip against the underlying surface in
order to maintain stability and traction.
Traction control system
The function is active at low speed and transfers
power from the driving wheel that is spinning to
the one that is not.
Engine drag control - EDC
EDC (Engine Drag Control) prevents involuntary
wheel locking, e.g. after shifting down or engine
braking when driving in low gears on slippery
road surfaces.
Involuntary wheel locking while driving can,
amongst other things, impair the driver's ability to
steer the car.
Corner Traction Control - CTC
CTC (Corner Traction Control) compensates for
understeer and allows higher than normal accel-
eration in a bend without wheelspin on the inner
wheel, e.g. on an arcing motorway entrance road
to quickly reach the prevailing traffic speed.
Driver Steering Recommendation –
DSR
DSR (Driver Steering Recommendation) helps
the driver steer the car in the right direction when
there is reduced traction or when the ABS sys-
tem engages.
The primary role of the DSR function is to help
the driver steer in the right direction when the car
is skidding.
DSR engages by applying slight torque to the
steering wheel in the direction in which the car
should be steered to maintain/achieve maximum
possible traction and stabilise the car.
Trailer Stability Assist* - TSA1
Trailer stability assist (p. 309) function is to sta-
bilise the car and trailer combination if it begins
to snake. For more information, see Driving with a
trailer (p. 302).
NOTE
The function is deactivated if the driver
selects Sport mode.
Related information
Electronic stability control (ESC) - operation
(p. 187)
Electronic stability control (ESC) - symbols
and messages (p. 189)
Electronic stability control (ESC) -
operation
Selection of level - Sport mode
The ESC system is always activated - it cannot be
deactivated.
However, the driver can select
the Sport mode, which allows
for a more active driving experi-
ence.
In Sport mode the system
detects whether the accelera-
tor pedal, steering wheel movements and corner-
ing are more active than in normal driving and
then allows controlled skidding with the rear sec-
tion up to a certain level before it intervenes and
stabilises the car.
If the driver stops a controlled skid by releasing
the accelerator pedal, for example, then the ESC
system intervenes and stabilises the car.
With Sport mode, maximum traction is also
obtained if the car has become stuck, or when
driving on a loose surface - e.g. sand or deep
snow.
Proceed as follows to select Sport mode:
Sport mode is selected in the menu system MY
CAR. For a description of the menu system, see
MY CAR (p. 113).
1Trailer Stability Assist is included in the installation of the Volvo genuine towbar.
||
DRIVER SUPPORT
188
Sport mode is indicated in the com-
bined instrument panel by means of
this symbol illuminating with a constant
glow until the driver deselects the
function or until the engine is switched off - after
the next time the engine is started the ESC sys-
tem is back in its normal mode once again.
Related information
Electronic stability control (ESC) - general
(p. 186)
Electronic stability control (ESC) - symbols
and messages (p. 189)
MY CAR (p. 113)
DRIVER SUPPORT
}}
189
Electronic stability control (ESC) -
symbols and messages
Table
Symbol Message Specification
ESC Temporarily OFF ESC system has been temporarily reduced due to excessive brake disc temperature - the function is reactivated
automatically when the brakes have cooled.
ESC Service required ESC system disengaged.
Stop the car in a safe place, switch off the engine and start it again.
Visit a workshop if the message remains - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.
and
"Message" There is a message in the combined instrument panel - read it!
Constant glow for
2 seconds.
System check when the engine is started.
Flashing light. ESC system is being activated.
Constant glow. Sport mode is activated.
NOTE: The ESC system is not deactivated in this mode - it is partially reduced.
||
DRIVER SUPPORT
190
Related information
Electronic stability control (ESC) - general
(p. 186)
Electronic stability control (ESC) - operation
(p. 187)
DRIVER SUPPORT
}}
* Option/accessory. 191
Speed limiter*
A (Speed Limiter) can be regarded as a reverse
cruise control - the driver regulates the speed
using the accelerator pedal but is prevented
from accidentally exceeding a pre-selected/set
speed by the speed limiter.
Steering wheel keypad and combined instrument panel
Digital and Analogue.
Speed limiter - On/Off.
Standby mode ceases and the stored speed
is resumed.
Standby mode
Activate and adjust the max. speed.
Selected speed
Speed limiter active
Related information
Speed limiter* - getting started (p. 191)
Speed limiter - temporary deactivation and
standby mode* (p. 193)
Speed limiter* - alarm for speed exceeded
(p. 194)
Speed limiter* - deactivation (p. 194)
Speed limiter* - getting started
A (Speed Limiter) can be regarded as a reverse
cruise control - the driver regulates the speed
using the accelerator pedal but is prevented
from accidentally exceeding a pre-selected/set
speed by the speed limiter.
Steering wheel keypad and combined instrument panel
Digital and Analogue.
Speed limiter - On/Off.
Standby mode ceases and the stored speed
is resumed.
Standby mode
Activate and adjust the max. speed.
Selected speed
Speed limiter active
||
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
192
Switch on and activate
When the speed limiter is active, its symbol (6) is
shown in combination with a mark (5) by the set
maximum speed in the combined instrument
panel.
Selection and storage of the highest possible
speed in the memory can be made both during a
journey and while stationary.
While driving
1. Press the steering wheel button to switch
on the speed limiter.
> The symbol (6) for speed limiter illumi-
nates in the combined instrument panel.
2. When the car is moving at the desired high-
est possible speed: Press one of the steering
wheel buttons or until the combined
instrument panel shows a mark (5) next to
the desired maximum speed.
> The speed limiter is then active and the
selected max. speed is stored in the
memory.
When stationary
1. Press the steering wheel button to switch
on the speed limiter.
2. Scroll with the button until the combined
instrument panel shows a mark (5) by the
desired maximum speed.
> The speed limiter is then active and the
selected max. speed is stored in the
memory.
Related information
Speed limiter* (p. 191)
Speed limiter* - changing speed
Changing the stored speed
Stored max. speed is changed with short or long
presses on the or steering wheel button.
To adjust +/- 5 km/h (+/- 5 mph):
Use short presses - each press gives
+/- 5 km/h (+/- 5 mph).
To adjust +/- 1 km/h (+/- 1 mph):
Hold down the button and release it at the
required max. speed.
Last press made is stored in the memory.
Related information
Speed limiter* (p. 191)
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory. 193
Speed limiter - temporary
deactivation and standby mode*
A Speed Limiter (Speed Limiter) can be regar-
ded as a reverse cruise control - the driver regu-
lates the speed using the accelerator pedal but
is prevented from accidentally exceeding a pre-
selected/set speed by the speed limiter.
Steering wheel keypad and instrument panel Digital and
Analogue.
Speed limiter - On/Off.
Standby mode ceases and the stored speed
is resumed.
Standby mode
Activate and adjust the max. speed.
Selected speed
Speed limiter active
Temporary deactivation - standby mode
To temporarily deactivate the speed limiter and
set it in standby mode:
Press .
> The combined instrument panel's
mark (5) changes colour from GREEN to
WHITE (Digital) or from WHITE to GREY
(Analogue) and the driver can temporarily
exceed the set maximum speed.
The speed limiter is reactivated with one
press on . The mark (5) then changes
colour from WHITE to GREEN (Digital) or
GREY to WHITE (Analogue) and the car's
maximum speed is limited again.
Temporary deactivation with the
accelerator pedal
The speed limiter can also be set in standby
mode with the accelerator pedal, e.g. for rapidly
accelerating the car out of a situation:
Depress the accelerator pedal fully.
> The combined instrument panel shows
the stored maximum speed with a col-
oured mark (5) and the driver can tempo-
rarily exceed the set maximum speed –
the mark (5) changes colour from GREEN
to WHITE (Digital) or WHITE to GREY
(Analogue) during that time.
The speed limiter is automatically reacti-
vated after the accelerator pedal is
released and the car's speed is slowed
down to below the selected/stored maxi-
mum speed - the mark (5) changes colour
from WHITE to GREEN (Digital) or GREY
to WHITE (Analogue) and the car's maxi-
mum speed is again limited.
Related information
Speed limiter* (p. 191)
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
194
Speed limiter* - alarm for speed
exceeded
A Speed Limiter (Speed Limiter) can be regar-
ded as a reverse cruise control - the driver regu-
lates the speed using the accelerator pedal but
is prevented from accidentally exceeding a
pre-selected/set speed by the speed limiter.
On steep roads the speed limiter's engine brak-
ing effect may be inadequate and the selected
maximum speed is exceeded. The driver is aler-
ted about this with an acoustic signal. The signal
is active until the driver has slowed to below the
selected maximum speed.
NOTE
The alarm is only activated after 5 seconds if
the speed has been exceeded by at least
3 km/h (approx. 2 mph), provided that neither
of the or buttons has been depressed
during the last half minute.
Related information
Speed limiter* (p. 191)
Speed limiter* - deactivation
A (Speed Limiter) can be regarded as a reverse
cruise control - the driver regulates the speed
using the accelerator pedal but is prevented
from accidentally exceeding a pre-selected/set
speed by the speed limiter.
To deactivate the speed limiter:
Press the steering wheel button .
> The combined instrument panel's (p. 191)
symbol for the speed limiter and the mark
for the set speed are extinguished. The
selected and stored speed are thus
deleted from the memory and cannot be
resumed with the button.
The driver can then use the accelerator
pedal to choose a speed without limita-
tion.
Related information
Speed limiter* (p. 191)
Cruise control*
The cruise control (CC – Cruise Control) helps
the driver maintain an even speed, resulting in
more relaxing driving on motorways and long,
straight roads with regular traffic flows.
Overview
The steering wheel buttons and combined instrument
panel in cars without speed limiter2.
2A Volvo dealer has updated information about what applies in each respective market.
DRIVER SUPPORT
}}
* Option/accessory. 195
The steering wheel buttons and combined instrument
panel in cars with speed limiter2.
Cruise control - On/Off.
Standby mode ceases and the stored speed
is resumed.
Standby mode
Activate and adjust the speed.
Selected speed (GREY = Standby mode).
Cruise control active - WHITE symbol (GREY
= Standby mode).
WARNING
The driver must always be observant with
regard to the traffic conditions and intervene
when the cruise control is not maintaining a
suitable speed and/or suitable distance.
The driver always bears ultimate responsibility
for ensuring that the vehicle is driven safely.
Related information
Cruise control* - managing speed (p. 195)
Cruise control* temporary deactivation and
standby mode (p. 197)
Cruise control* - resume set speed (p. 198)
Cruise control* - deactivate (p. 199)
Adaptive cruise control (ACC)* (p. 203)
Cruise control* - managing speed
It is possible to activate, set and change the
stored speed.
Activating and setting the speed
The steering wheel buttons and display in cars without
speed limiter3.
2A Volvo dealer has updated information about what applies in each respective market.
3A Volvo dealer has updated information about what applies in each respective market.
||
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
196
The steering wheel buttons and display in cars with
speed limiter3.
To start the cruise control:
Press the steering wheel button for CRUISE
(without speed limiter) or (with speed
limiter).
> The cruise control symbol (6) in the com-
bined instrument panel illuminates - Cruise
control is in standby mode.
To activate cruise control:
At the required speed - press the steering
wheel button or .
> The current speed is stored in the memory
and the combined instrument panel's
marking (5) illuminates at the selected speed
and the symbol (6) changes from GREY to
WHITE - the car then follows the stored
speed.
NOTE
Cruise Control cannot be enabled at speeds
below 30 km/h (20 mph).
Changing the stored speed
Stored speed is changed with short or long
presses on the or steering wheel button.
To adjust +/- 5 km/h (+/- 5 mph):
Use short presses - each press gives
+/- 5 km/h (+/- 5 mph).
To adjust +/- 1 km/h (+/- 1 mph):
Hold down the button and release it at the
required speed.
Last press made is stored in the memory.
If speed is increased using the accelerator pedal
prior to pressing the / button, then it is the
car's current speed when the button is pressed
that is stored.
A temporary increase in speed with the accelera-
tor pedal, e.g. during overtaking, does not affect
the cruise control setting - the car returns to the
last stored speed when the accelerator pedal is
released.
NOTE
If any of the Cruise Control buttons are held
depressed for several minutes then it is
blocked and deactivated. To be able to reacti-
vate Cruise Control, the car must be stopped
and the engine restarted.
Related information
Cruise control* (p. 194)
3A Volvo dealer has updated information about what applies in each respective market.
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory. 197
Cruise control* temporary
deactivation and standby mode
The function can be temporarily deactivated and
set in standby mode.
Temporary deactivation - standby mode
The steering wheel buttons and display in cars without
speed limiter4.
The steering wheel buttons and display in cars with
speed limiter4.
To temporarily disengage cruise control and set it
in standby mode:
Press .
> The combined instrument panel's
marking (5) and symbol (6) change colour
from WHITE to GREY - Cruise control is tem-
porarily disengaged.
Standby mode due to driver
intervention
Cruise control is temporarily disengaged and set
automatically in standby mode if:
the foot brake is used
the clutch pedal is depressed for longer than
1 minute5
the gear lever/selector is moved to N posi-
tion
the driver maintains speed higher than the
stored speed for longer than 1 minute.
The driver must then regulate the speed.
A temporary increase in speed with the accelera-
tor pedal, e.g. during overtaking, does not affect
the setting - the car returns to the last stored
speed when the accelerator pedal is released.
Automatic standby mode
Cruise control is temporarily disengaged and set
in standby mode if:
wheels lose traction
engine speed is too low/high
speed falls below 30 km/h (20 mph).
The driver must then regulate the speed.
Related information
Cruise control* (p. 194)
Cruise control* - managing speed (p. 195)
Cruise control* - resume set speed (p. 198)
Cruise control* - deactivate (p. 199)
4A Volvo dealer has updated information about what applies in each respective market.
5Disengaging and selecting a higher or lower gear does not involve standby mode.
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
198
Cruise control* - resume set speed
The cruise control (p. 194) (CC – Cruise
Control) helps the driver to maintain an even
speed.
After temporary deactivation and standby
mode (p. 197) it is possible to resume the set
speed.
The steering wheel buttons and display in cars without
speed limiter6.
The steering wheel buttons and display in cars with
speed limiter6.
To reactivate the cruise control from standby
mode:
Press the steering wheel button .
> The combined instrument panel's
marking (5) and symbol (6) change colour
from GREY to WHITE - the car then follows
the last stored speed.
NOTE
A marked speed increase may occur once the
speed has been resumed by selecting .
Related information
Cruise control* (p. 194)
Cruise control* - managing speed (p. 195)
Cruise control* temporary deactivation and
standby mode (p. 197)
Cruise control* - deactivate (p. 199)
6A Volvo dealer has updated information about what applies in each respective market.
DRIVER SUPPORT
}}
* Option/accessory. 199
Cruise control* - deactivate
How it is deactivated is described here.
The steering wheel buttons and display in cars without
speed limiter7.
The steering wheel buttons and display in cars with
speed limiter7.
The cruise control is switched off with the steer-
ing wheel button (1) or by switching off the
engine - the stored speed is deleted from the
memory and cannot be resumed with the but-
ton.
Related information
Cruise control* (p. 194)
Cruise control* - managing speed (p. 195)
Cruise control* temporary deactivation and
standby mode (p. 197)
Cruise control* - resume set speed (p. 198)
Distance Warning*
The Distance Warning function (Distance Alert)
warns the driver if the time interval to the vehicle
ahead becomes too short.
Distance Warning is active at speeds above
30 km/h (20 mph) and only reacts to vehicles
driving in front of the car, in the same direction.
No distance information is provided for oncoming,
slow or stationary vehicles.
Orange-coloured warning lamp8.
An orange-coloured warning lamp in the wind-
screen illuminates with a constant glow if the dis-
tance to the vehicle in front is shorter than the
set time interval.
7A Volvo dealer has updated information about what applies in each respective market.
8NOTE: The illustration is schematic - details may vary depending on car model.
||
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
200
NOTE
Distance warning is deactivated during the
time the adaptive cruise control is active.
WARNING
Distance warning only reacts if the distance
to the vehicle ahead is shorter than the preset
value - the speed of the driver's vehicle is not
affected.
Operation
Press the button in the centre console to switch
the function on or off. The function is switched on
if one lamp is illuminated in the button.
Some combinations of the selected equipment
leave no vacant space for a button in the centre
console - in which case, the function is operated
in the car's menu system MY CAR (p. 113) -
once there, search for the Distance Alert func-
tion.
Set time interval
Controls and symbol for time interval.
Time interval - Increase/decrease.
Time interval - On.
Different time intervals to the
vehicle in front can be selected
and shown in the combined
instrument panel as 1-5 hori-
zontal lines - the more lines the
longer the time interval. One
line corresponds to
approximately 1 second to the vehicle in front,
5 lines approximately 3 seconds.
The same symbol is also shown when adaptive
cruise control (p. 203) is activated.
NOTE
The higher the speed the longer the calcula-
ted distance in metres for a given time inter-
val.
The set time interval is also used by the func-
tion adaptive cruise control (p. 204).
Only use the time intervals permitted by local
traffic regulations.
Related information
Distance Warning* - limitations (p. 201)
Distance Warning* - symbols and messages
(p. 202)
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory. 201
Distance Warning* - limitations
This function, which uses the same radar sensor
as Adaptive cruise control (p. 203) and Collision
warning with auto brake (p. 228), has certain lim-
itations.
NOTE
Strong sunlight, reflections or strong varia-
tions in light intensity, as well as wearing sun-
glasses, could mean that the warning light in
the windscreen cannot be seen.
Poor weather or winding roads could affect
the radar sensor's capacity to detect vehicles
in front.
The size of other vehicles could also affect
detection capacity, e.g. motorcycles. This
could mean that the warning lamp illuminates
at a shorter distance than the setting or that
the warning is temporarily absent.
Extremely high speeds can also cause the
lamp to illuminate at a shorter distance than
that set due to limitations in sensor range.
For further information on radar sensor limita-
tions, see Radar sensor - limitations (p. 216) and
Collision warning system* - operation (p. 232).
Related information
Distance Warning* (p. 199)
Distance Warning* - symbols and messages
(p. 202)
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
202
Distance Warning* - symbols and
messages
The function has certain symbols and messages
that can be shown in the combined instrument
panel if the function is reduced due to its limita-
tions (p. 201).
SymbolAMessage Specification
Radar blocked See
manual
Distance Warning temporarily disengaged.
Radar sensor (p. 216) is blocked and cannot detect other vehicles. For example, in the event of heavy rain or
if slush has collected in front of the radar sensor.
For information, see Radar sensor - limitations (p. 216).
Collision warning
Service required
Distance Warning and Collision Warning with Auto Brake (p. 233) fully or partially disengaged.
Visit a workshop if the message remains - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.
AThe symbols are schematic.
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory. 203
Adaptive cruise control (ACC)*
The adaptive cruise control (ACC – Adaptive
Cruise Control) helps the driver to maintain an
even speed combined with a pre-selected time
interval to the vehicle ahead.
The adaptive cruise control provides a more
relaxing driving experience on long journeys on
motorways and long straight main roads in
smooth traffic flows.
The driver sets the desired speed (p. 206) and
time interval to the car in front. When the radar
detector detects a slower vehicle in front of the
car, the speed is automatically adapted to that.
When the road is clear again the car returns to
the selected speed.
If the adaptive cruise control is switched off or
set to standby mode and the car comes too close
to a vehicle in front, then the driver is warned
instead by a Distance Alert (p. 199) about the
short distance.
WARNING
The driver must always be observant with
regard to the traffic conditions and intervene
when the adaptive cruise control is not main-
taining a suitable speed or suitable distance.
The adaptive cruise control cannot handle all
traffic, weather and road conditions.
Read all the sections about the adaptive
cruise control in the owner's manual in order
to learn about its limitations, of which the
driver should be aware before it is used.
The driver always bears responsibility for
maintaining the correct distance and speed,
even when the adaptive cruise control is
being used.
IMPORTANT
Maintenance of adaptive cruise control com-
ponents must only be performed at a work-
shop - an authorised Volvo workshop is rec-
ommended.
Automatic gearbox
Cars with automatic gearbox have enhanced
functionality with the adaptive cruise control's
Queue assistance (p. 210) function.
Related information
Adaptive cruise control* - function (p. 204)
Adaptive cruise control* - overview (p. 205)
Adaptive cruise control* - managing speed
(p. 206)
Adaptive cruise control* - set time interval
(p. 207)
Adaptive cruise control* - temporary deacti-
vation, and standby mode (p. 208)
Adaptive cruise control* - overtaking another
vehicle (p. 209)
Adaptive cruise control* - deactivate (p. 209)
Adaptive Cruise Control* - queue assistance
(p. 210)
Adaptive cruise control* - switch cruise con-
trol functionality (p. 212)
Radar sensor (p. 216)
Radar sensor - limitations (p. 216)
Adaptive cruise control* - fault tracing and
action (p. 213)
Adaptive cruise control* - symbols and mes-
sages (p. 214)
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
204
Adaptive cruise control* - function
Adaptive cruise control consists of a cruise con-
trol system and a coordinated spacing system.
Function overview
Function overview9.
Warning lamp - braking by driver required
Steering wheel (p. 87) keypad
Radar sensor (p. 216)
Adaptive cruise control consists of a cruise con-
trol system and a coordinated spacing system.
WARNING
Adaptive cruise control is not a collision avoid-
ance system. The driver must intervene if the
system does not detect a vehicle in front.
The adaptive cruise control does not brake for
humans or animals, and not for small vehicles
such as bicycles and motorcycles. Nor for
oncoming, slow or stationary vehicles and
objects.
Do not use the adaptive cruise control, for
example, in city traffic, in dense traffic, at junc-
tions, on slippery surfaces, with a lot of water
or slush on the road, in heavy rain/snow, in
poor visibility, on winding roads or on slip
roads.
The distance to the vehicle ahead is mainly
measured by a radar sensor. The cruise control
function regulates the speed with acceleration
and braking. It is normal for the brakes to emit a
low sound when they are being used by the
adaptive cruise control.
WARNING
The brake pedal moves when the adaptive
cruise control brakes. Do not rest your foot
beneath the brake pedal - it may then
become trapped.
The adaptive cruise control aims to follow the
vehicle ahead in the same lane according to what
the driver set for time interval (p. 207). If the
radar sensor cannot see any vehicle in front then
the car will instead maintain the speed set and
stored by the driver. This also takes place if the
speed of the vehicle in front exceeds the stored
speed.
The adaptive cruise control aims to control the
speed in a smooth way. In situations that demand
sudden braking the driver must brake himself/
herself. This applies with large differences in
speed, or if the vehicle in front brakes heavily.
Due to limitations in the radar sensor (p. 216)
braking may come unexpectedly or not at all.
The adaptive cruise control can be activated to
follow another vehicle at speeds from 30 km/h10
(20 mph) up to 200 km/h (125 mph). If the
speed falls below 30 km/h (20 mph) or if the
engine speed becomes too low, the cruise con-
trol is set in standby mode at which automatic
braking ceases - the driver must then take over
himself/herself to maintain a safe distance to the
vehicle in front.
9NOTE: The illustration is schematic - details may differ depending on car model.
10 Queue Assist (p. 210) in cars with automatic gearbox can operate in the range 0-200 km/h (0-125 mph).
DRIVER SUPPORT
}}
* Option/accessory. 205
Warning lamp - braking by driver
required
Adaptive cruise control has a braking capacity
that is equivalent to approx. 40% of the car's
braking capacity.
Audio-visual warning signal in the event of a collision
risk11.
If the car needs to be braked more heavily than
the adaptive cruise control capacity and the driver
does not brake, then the warning lamp and warn-
ing sound from the Collision warning system
(p. 228) are used in order to alert the driver that
immediate intervention is required.
NOTE
The warning lamp may be difficult to see in
strong sunlight or when wearing sunglasses.
WARNING
The adaptive cruise control only warns of
vehicles which the radar sensor has detected.
Hence the warning may not be given, or it
may be given with a certain delay. Do not wait
for a warning without braking when so
required.
Steep roads and/or heavy load
Bear in mind that the adaptive cruise control is
primarily intended for use when driving on level
road surfaces. It may have difficulty in keeping
the correct distance from the vehicle ahead when
driving on steep downhill slopes, with a heavy
load or with a trailer - in which case, be extra
attentive and ready to slow down.
Related information
Adaptive cruise control (ACC)* (p. 203)
Adaptive cruise control* - overview (p. 205)
Cruise control* (p. 194)
Adaptive cruise control* - overview
Operation of the adaptive cruise control (p. 203)
and steering wheel keypad varies depending on
whether or not the car is equipped with speed
limiter (p. 191)12.
Adaptive cruise control with Speed
limiter
Cruise control - On/Off.
Standby mode ceases and the stored speed
is resumed.
Standby mode
Time interval - Increase/decrease.
Activate and adjust the speed.
11 NOTE: The illustration is schematic - details may vary depending on car model.
12 A Volvo dealer has updated information about what applies in each respective market.
||
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
206
Green marking at stored speed (WHITE =
standby mode).
Time distance
ACC is active at the GREEN symbol (WHITE
= standby mode).
Adaptive cruise control without Speed
limiter
Standby mode ceases and the stored speed
is resumed.
Cruise control - On/Off or Standby mode.
Time interval - Increase/decrease.
Activate and adjust the speed.
(Not used)
Green marking at stored speed (WHITE =
standby mode).
Time distance
ACC is active at the GREEN symbol (WHITE
= standby mode).
Related information
Adaptive cruise control (ACC)* (p. 203)
Adaptive cruise control* - managing speed
(p. 206)
Adaptive cruise control* - set time interval
(p. 207)
Adaptive cruise control* - temporary deacti-
vation, and standby mode (p. 208)
Cruise control* (p. 194)
Adaptive cruise control* - managing
speed
To start the ACC:
Press the steering wheel button - a simi-
lar WHITE symbol illuminates in the com-
bined instrument panel (8) which shows that
the adaptive cruise control is in standby
mode (p. 208).
To activate ACC:
At the required speed - press the steering
wheel button or .
> The current speed is stored in the memory,
the combined instrument panel shows a
"magnifying glass" (6) around the stored
speed for a second or so and its marking
changes from WHITE to GREEN.
When this symbol changes colour from
WHITE to GREEN, ACC is active and
the car maintains the stored speed.
Only when the symbol shows
an image of another vehicle is
the distance to the vehicle in
front controlled by ACC.
DRIVER SUPPORT
}}
* Option/accessory. 207
At the same time a speed
range is marked:
the higher speed with GREEN marking is the
pre-programmed speed
the lower speed is the speed of the vehicle
in front.
Changing the stored speed
Stored speed is changed with short or long
presses on the or steering wheel button.
To adjust +/- 5 km/h (+/- 5 mph):
Use short presses - each press gives
+/- 5 km/h (+/- 5 mph).
To adjust +/- 1 km/h (+/- 1 mph):
Hold down the button and release it at the
required speed.
Last press made is stored in the memory.
If speed is increased using the accelerator pedal
prior to pressing the / button, then it is the
car's current speed when the button is pressed
that is stored.
A temporary increase in speed with the accelera-
tor pedal, e.g. during overtaking, does not affect
the setting - the car returns to the last stored
speed when the accelerator pedal is released.
NOTE
If any of the adaptive cruise control buttons
are held depressed for several minutes then
the function is blocked and deactivated. To be
able to reactivate it, the car must be stopped
and the engine restarted.
In certain situations it cannot be reactivated -
in which case, the combined instrument panel
(p. 214) shows Adaptive cruise control
unavailable.
Related information
Adaptive cruise control (ACC)* (p. 203)
Adaptive cruise control* - overview (p. 205)
Cruise control* (p. 194)
Adaptive cruise control* - set time
interval
Different time intervals to the
vehicle in front can be selected
and shown in the combined
instrument panel as 1-5 hori-
zontal lines - the more lines the
longer the time interval. One
line corresponds to
approximately 1 second to the vehicle in front,
5 lines approximately 3 seconds.
To set/change the time distance:
Turn the steering wheel button set's thumb-
wheel (or use the / buttons for cars
without Speed limiters).
At low speed, when the distances are short, the
adaptive cruise control increases the time interval
slightly.
The adaptive cruise control allows the time inter-
val to vary noticeably in certain situations in order
to allow the car to follow the vehicle in front
smoothly and comfortably.
Note that a short time interval only allows the
driver a short time to react and take action if any
unforeseen traffic problem should arise.
The same symbol is also shown when Distance
Alert (p. 199) is activated.
||
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
208
NOTE
Only use the time intervals permitted by local
traffic regulations.
If the adaptive cruise control does not appear
to react when activated, this may be because
the time distance to the vehicle in front is pre-
venting an increase in speed.
The higher the speed the longer the calcula-
ted distance in metres for a given time inter-
val.
Read more how speed is handled (p. 206).
Related information
Adaptive cruise control (ACC)* (p. 203)
Adaptive cruise control* - overview (p. 205)
Cruise control* (p. 194)
Adaptive cruise control* - temporary
deactivation, and standby mode
The adaptive cruise control can be temporarily
deactivated and set in standby mode.
Temporary deactivation/standby mode
- with speed limiter
To temporarily disengage adaptive cruise control
and set it in standby mode:
Press the steering wheel button
This symbol and stored speed marking
then changes colour from GREEN to
WHITE.
Temporary deactivation/standby mode
- without speed limiter
To temporarily disengage adaptive cruise control
and set it in standby mode:
Press the steering wheel button
Standby mode due to driver
intervention
The adaptive cruise control is temporarily disen-
gaged and set automatically in standby mode if:
the foot brake is used
the clutch pedal is depressed for longer than
1 minute13
the gear selector is moved to N position
(automatic gearbox)
the driver maintains speed higher than the
stored speed for longer than 1 minute.
The driver must then regulate the speed.
A temporary increase in speed with the accelera-
tor pedal, e.g. during overtaking, does not affect
the setting - the car returns to the last stored
speed when the accelerator pedal is released.
For more information, see the sections Managing
speed (p. 206) and Overtaking another vehicle
(p. 209).
Automatic standby mode
The adaptive cruise control is dependent on
other systems, e.g. Stability system ESC (p. 186).
If any of these systems stops working, the adap-
tive cruise control is deactivated automatically.
In the event of automatic deactivation a signal will
sound and the message Adaptive cruise
control cancelled is shown in the combined
instrument panel. The driver must then intervene
and adapt the speed and distance to the vehicle
ahead.
An automatic deactivation can be due to:
the driver opens the door
the driver takes off his seatbelt
engine speed is too low/high
13 Disengaging and selecting a higher or lower gear does not involve standby mode.
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory. 209
speed has fallen below 30 km/h14 (20 mph)
wheels lose traction
brake temperature is high
the radar sensor is covered e.g. by wet snow
or heavy rain (radar waves blocked).
For more information on symbols, messages and
their meaning, see section Symbols and mes-
sages in the display (p. 214).
Resume set speed
Adaptive cruise control in standby mode is reacti-
vated with one press on the steering wheel but-
ton - the speed is then set to the last stored
speed.
NOTE
A marked speed increase may occur once the
speed has been resumed by selecting .
Related information
Adaptive cruise control (ACC)* (p. 203)
Adaptive cruise control* - overview (p. 205)
Cruise control* (p. 194)
Adaptive cruise control* - overtaking
another vehicle
ACC can also assist during overtaking.
When the car is following another vehicle and the
driver indicates an impending overtaking
manoeuvre with the direction indicator15, the
adaptive cruise control helps to briefly accelerate
the car towards the vehicle in front.
The function is active at speeds above 70 km/h
(43 mph).
Read more about the different time inter-
vals (p. 207) to the vehicle in front.
Read more about how you manage the
speed (p. 206).
WARNING
Be aware that this function can be activated
in more situations other than during overtak-
ing, e.g. when a direction indicator is used to
indicate a change of lane or exit to another
road - the car will then accelerate briefly.
Related information
Adaptive cruise control (ACC)* (p. 203)
Adaptive cruise control* - overview (p. 205)
Cruise control* (p. 194)
Adaptive cruise control* - deactivate
Keypad with Speed limiter
The adaptive cruise control is disengaged with a
short press of the steering wheel button . The
set speed is cleared and cannot be resumed with
the button.
Keypad without Speed limiter
A short press on the steering wheel button
sets the adaptive cruise control in standby mode.
With a further short press it is deactivated. The
set speed is cleared and cannot be resumed with
the button.
Related information
Adaptive cruise control (ACC)* (p. 203)
Adaptive cruise control* - overview (p. 205)
Cruise control* (p. 194)
14 Does not apply to a car with Queue Assist - it can go all the way down to 0 km/h.
15 On left flash only in left-hand-drive car, or right flash in right-hand-drive car.
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
210
Adaptive Cruise Control* - queue
assistance
Queue assistance also provides the adaptive
cruise control with enhanced functionality at
speeds lower than 30 km/h (20 mph).
In cars with automatic gearbox the adaptive
cruise control is supplemented with the queue
assistance function (also referred to as "Queue
Assist").
Queue assistance has the following functions:
Extended speed range - also at lower than
30 km/h (20 mph) and at stationary
Change of target
Automatic braking ceases when stationary
Note that the lowest programmable speed for the
adaptive cruise control is 30 km/h (20 mph) -
even though the cruise control is capable of fol-
lowing another vehicle down to 0 km/h, a lower
speed cannot be selected.
Learn more about how you manage the speed
(p. 203) and different time intervals to the vehicle
in front (p. 207).
Extended speed range
NOTE
In order to activate the cruise control the driv-
er's door must be closed and the driver must
be wearing the seatbelt.
With an automatic gearbox, the adaptive cruise
control can follow another vehicle within the
range 0-200 km/h (0-125 mph).
NOTE
Activation of the cruise control below
30 km/h (20 mph) requires a vehicle in front
within a reasonable distance.
For shorter stops in connection with inching in
slow traffic or at traffic lights driving is automati-
cally resumed if the stops do not exceed
approx. 3 seconds - if it takes longer before the
car in front starts moving again then the cruise
control is set in standby mode (p. 208) with auto-
matic braking. The driver must then reactivate it
in one of the following ways:
Press the steering wheel button
...or...
Depress the accelerator pedal.
> The cruise control will then resume following
the vehicle in front.
NOTE
The Queue Assist function can keep the car
stationary for a maximum of 4 minutes - then
the brakes release.
See more information under the heading
"Termination of automatic braking at a stand-
still".
Change of target
If the target vehicle in front suddenly turns then there
may be stationary traffic in front.
When the adaptive cruise control is following
another vehicle at speeds lower than 30 km/h
(20 mph) and the target is changed from a mov-
ing vehicle to a stationary vehicle, the cruise con-
trol will brake for the stationary vehicle.
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory. 211
WARNING
When the adaptive cruise control is following
a vehicle in front at speeds in excess of
30 km/h (20 mph) and the target is changed
from a vehicle in front to a stationary vehicle,
the adaptive cruise control will ignore the sta-
tionary vehicle and instead select the stored
speed.
The driver must intervene him/herself and
brake.
Automatic standby mode with change
of target
The adaptive cruise control is disengaged and set
in standby mode:
when the speed is below 5 km/h (5 mph)
and the cruise control is uncertain whether
the target object is a stationary vehicle or
some other object, e.g. a speed bump.
when the speed is below 5 km/h (5 mph)
and the vehicle in front turns off so the
cruise control no longer has a vehicle to fol-
low.
Termination of automatic braking at a
standstill
In the following situations, queue assistance
stops automatic braking at a standstill:
the driver opens the door
the driver takes off his seatbelt.
This means that the brakes are released and the
car will start to roll - the driver must therefore
intervene and brake the car himself in order to
maintain its position.
IMPORTANT
Queue Assist can keep the car stationary for
a maximum of 4 minutes - then the brakes
release.
The driver's attention is drawn to this over
several stages, with increasing intensity:
1. Acoustic alarm (pinging) and text mes-
sage.
2. A warning lamp in the windscreen also
starts to flash.
3. "Stabbing" braking occurs.
For more information on symbols, messages
and their meaning, see the section Symbols
and messages in the display (p. 214).
Queue assistance releases the foot brake and is
set to standby mode in these situations as well:
the driver puts his/her foot on the brake
pedal
the gear selector is moved to P, N or R posi-
tion
the driver sets the cruise control in standby
mode
the parking brake is applied.
Related information
Adaptive cruise control (ACC)* (p. 203)
Adaptive cruise control* - overview (p. 205)
Cruise control* (p. 194)
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
212
Adaptive cruise control* - switch
cruise control functionality
Changing from ACC to CC
A symbol for active cruise control is shown in the
combined instrument panel:
CC
Cruise Control
ACC
Adaptive Cruise Control
Cruise control Adaptive cruise control
With one press of the button the adaptive ele-
ment (spacing system) in the adaptive cruise
control (p. 203) is deactivated, at which point the
car only follows the set/stored speed.
Hold down the steering wheel button -
the combined instrument panel's symbol
changes from to .
> This activates Cruise Control CC.
WARNING
The car no longer brakes automatically after
switching from ACC to CC - it merely follows
the set speed.
Changing back from CC to ACC
Switch off the cruise control (CC) with 1-2
presses on the button. The next time the sys-
tem is switched on it is the adaptive cruise con-
trol (ACC) that is activated.
Related information
Adaptive cruise control (ACC)* (p. 203)
Adaptive cruise control* - overview (p. 205)
Adaptive cruise control* - temporary deacti-
vation, and standby mode (p. 208)
Cruise control* (p. 194)
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory. 213
Adaptive cruise control* - fault
tracing and action
If the combined instrument panel shows the mes-
sage Radar blocked See manual then it
means that the adaptive cruise control's radar
sensor (p. 216) cannot detect other vehicles in
front of the car.
This message indicates that neither of the func-
tions for Distance Alert (p. 199) or Collision
Warning with Auto Brake (p. 228) are working.
The following table presents examples of possi-
ble causes for a message being shown along
with the appropriate action:
Cause Action
The radar surface in the grille is dirty or covered with ice or snow. Clean the radar surface in the grille from dirt, ice and snow.
Heavy rain or snow blocking the radar signals. No action. Sometimes the radar does not work during heavy rain or snowfall.
Water or snow from the road surface swirls up and blocks the radar
signals.
No action. Sometimes the radar does not work on a very wet or snowy road sur-
face.
The radar surface has been cleaned but the message remains. Wait. It could take several minutes for the radar to sense that it is no longer
blocked.
Related information
Adaptive cruise control (ACC)* (p. 203)
Adaptive cruise control* - overview (p. 205)
Cruise control* (p. 194)
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
214
Adaptive cruise control* - symbols
and messages
Sometimes the adaptive cruise control may dis-
play a symbol and/or text message. Here are
some examples - follow the recommendation
given if appropriate:
SymbolAMessage Specification
The symbol is WHITE Adaptive cruise control is set to standby mode (p. 208).
The symbol is GREEN The car maintains the stored speed.
Standard cruise control is selected manually.
Set ESC to Normal to enable
Cruise
The adaptive cruise control cannot be activated until ESC has been set in Normal mode - Stability system
(p. 186).
Adaptive cruise control can-
celled
The adaptive cruise control has been deactivated - the driver has to regulate the speed himself.
Adaptive cruise control
unavailable
The adaptive cruise control cannot be activated.
This could be due to:
brake temperature is high
the radar sensor is blocked by e.g. wet snow or rain.
For more information about fault tracing, see section Fault tracing and action (p. 213)
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory. 215
SymbolAMessage Specification
Radar blocked See manual The adaptive cruise control is temporarily disengaged.
The radar sensor is blocked and cannot detect other vehicles. For example, in the event of heavy rain or if
slush has collected in front of the radar sensor.
The driver can then choose to switch to normal Cruise control (p. 194) (CC) - a text message provides infor-
mation on appropriate alternatives.
Read more about radar sensor limitations (p. 216).
Adaptive cruise control Serv-
ice required
The adaptive cruise control is disengaged.
Contact a workshop - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.
Press brake to hold vehicle +
acoustic alarm + warning light in
windscreen + "pulling" brakesB
The car is at a standstill and the adaptive cruise control will release the foot brake, which is why the car may
start rolling soon.
The driver must brake himself/herself. The message remains and the alarm sounds until the driver
depresses the brake pedal or uses the accelerator pedal.
Below 30 km/h Lead vehicle
requiredB
Shown in the event of attempts to activate the adaptive cruise control at speeds below 30 km/h (20 mph)
without a vehicle in front within the activation distance.
AThe symbols are schematic.
BOnly with Queue Assist.
Related information
Adaptive cruise control (ACC)* (p. 203)
Adaptive cruise control* - overview (p. 205)
Cruise control* (p. 194)
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
216
Radar sensor
The function of the radar sensor is to detect cars
or larger vehicles in the same direction, in the
same lane.
The radar sensor is used by the following func-
tions:
Distance Warning*
Adaptive cruise control*
Collision Warning with Auto Brake and
Pedestrian Detection*
IMPORTANT
In the event of visible damage to the car's
grille, or if you suspect that the radar sensor
may be damaged:
Contact a workshop - an authorised
Volvo workshop is recommended.
The function may completely or partially dis-
appear - or malfunction - if the grille, the
radar sensor or its bracket is damaged or has
loosened.
Modification of the radar sensor could result in it
being illegal to use.
Related information
Radar sensor - limitations (p. 216)
Adaptive cruise control (ACC)* (p. 203)
Collision warning system* (p. 228)
Distance Warning* (p. 199)
Radar sensor - limitations
A radar sensor (p. 216) has certain limitations -
due to its limited field of vision for example.
The capacity of the adaptive cruise control to
detect a vehicle in front is significantly reduced if:
the speed of vehicles in front is significantly
different from your own speed
its radar sensor becomes blocked - e.g. in
heavy rain or slush, or if other objects have
collected in front of the radar sensor.
NOTE
Keep the surface in front of the radar sensor
clean.
Field of vision
The radar sensor has a limited field of vision. In
some situations another vehicle is not detected,
or the detection is made later than expected.
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory. 217
ACC field of vision.
Sometimes the radar sensor is late at detect-
ing vehicles at close distances - e.g. a vehicle
that drives in between the car and vehicles in
front.
Small vehicles, such as motorcycles, or vehi-
cles not driving in the centre of the lane can
remain undetected.
In bends the radar sensor may detect the
wrong vehicle or lose a detected vehicle from
view.
WARNING
The driver must always be observant with
regard to the traffic conditions and intervene
when the adaptive cruise control is not main-
taining a suitable speed or suitable distance.
The adaptive cruise control cannot handle all
traffic, weather and road conditions.
Read all the sections about the adaptive
cruise control in the owner's manual in order
to learn about its limitations, of which the
driver should be aware before it is used.
The driver always bears responsibility for
maintaining the correct distance and speed,
even when the adaptive cruise control is
being used.
WARNING
Accessories or other objects such as auxiliary
lamps must not be fitted in front of the grille.
WARNING
Adaptive cruise control is not a collision avoid-
ance system. The driver must intervene if the
system does not detect a vehicle in front.
The adaptive cruise control does not brake for
humans or animals, and not for small vehicles
such as bicycles and motorcycles. Nor for
oncoming, slow or stationary vehicles and
objects.
Do not use the adaptive cruise control, for
example, in city traffic, in dense traffic, at junc-
tions, on slippery surfaces, with a lot of water
or slush on the road, in heavy rain/snow, in
poor visibility, on winding roads or on slip
roads.
Related information
Adaptive cruise control (ACC)* (p. 203)
Collision warning system* (p. 228)
Distance Warning* (p. 199)
DRIVER SUPPORT
218
Type approval - radar system
Type approval for the car's radar units can be
seen in the following table.
Market ACCABLISBSymbol Type approval
Brazil
Este equipamento opera em caráter secundário, isto é, não tem direito à proteção contra
interferência prejudicial, mesmo de estações do mesmo tipo e não pode causar interferência
a sistemas operando em caráter primário.
Modelo: L2C0038TR
1071-10-3451
EAN: 07897843800248
Modelo: L2C0055TR
1500-15-8065
EAN: 07897843840978
Europe
Hereby, Delphi Electronics & Safety declares that L2C0038TR / L2C0055TR are in
compliance with the essential requirements and other relevant provisions of Directive
1999/5/EC.
The Declaration of Conformity may be consulted at Delphi Electronics & Safety / 2151 E.
Lincoln Road / Kokomo, Indiana 46902 USA
The United Arab Emi-
rates
TRA
REGISTERED No: 0018923/09
DEALER No: DA37380/15
TRA
REGISTERED No: ER37357/15
DEALER No: DA37380/15
DRIVER SUPPORT
}}
219
Market ACCABLISBSymbol Type approval
Indonesia 14785/POSTEL/2010 1982
38806/SDPPI/2015 4927
Jordan
Type Approval No.: TRC/LPD/2009/87
Equipment type: Low Power Device (LPD)
Type Approval No.: TRC/LPD/2015/3
Equipment Type: Low Power Device (LPD)
Korea
Certification No.
DPH-L2C0038TR
Certification No.
MSIP-CMI-DPH-L2C0055TR
Morocco
AGREE PAR L'ANRT MAROC
Numero d'agrement : MR 4838 ANRT 2009
Date d'agrement : 22/05/2009
AGREE PAR L’ANRT MAROC
NUMÉRO D’AGRÉMENT: MR 9929 ANRT 2014
DATE D’AGRÉMENT: 26/12/2014
Singapore Complies with IDA Standards DA105753
||
DRIVER SUPPORT
220
Market ACCABLISBSymbol Type approval
South Africa
TA-2009/163
APPROVED
TA-2014/2390
APPROVED
Taiwan
CCAB09LP4590T3
CCAB15LP0680T0
AACC = Adaptive Cruise Control
BBLIS = Blind Spot Information
Related information
Radar sensor (p. 216)
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory. 221
City Safety
City Safety is a function for helping the driver
to avoid a collision when driving in queues,
amongst other things, when changes in the traf-
fic ahead, combined with a lapse in attention,
could lead to an incident.
The City Safety function is active at speeds
below 50 km/h (30 mph) and it helps the driver
by automatically braking the car in the event of
imminent risk of collision with vehicles in front,
should the driver not react in time by braking
and/or steering away.
City Safety is activated in situations where the
driver should have started braking earlier, which
is why it cannot help the driver in every situation.
City Safety is designed to be activated as late
as possible in order to avoid unnecessary inter-
vention.
City Safety must not be used as an excuse for
the driver to change his/her driving style. If the
driver solely relies on City Safety to do the
braking, there might be a risk of a collision
sooner or later.
The driver or passengers normally only notice City
Safety if a situation arises where the car is
extremely close to being in a collision.
If the car is also equipped with Collision Warning
with Auto Brake* (p. 228) these two systems
complement each other.
IMPORTANT
Maintenance and replacement of City
Safety components must only be per-
formed by a workshop - an authorised Volvo
workshop is recommended.
WARNING
City Safety does not engage in all driving
situations or traffic, weather or road condi-
tions.
City Safety does not react to vehicles driv-
ing in a different direction from the car, to
small vehicles and motorcycles or to people
and animals.
City Safety can prevent collision at a speed
difference of less than 15 km/h (9 mph) - at
a higher speed difference, it is only possible
to reduce collision speed. In order to obtain
full brake function, the driver must depress
the brake pedal.
Never wait for City Safety to engage. The
driver always bears responsibility for maintain-
ing the proper distance and speed.
Related information
City Safety - limitations (p. 223)
City Safety - function (p. 222)
City Safety - operation (p. 222)
City Safety - laser sensor (p. 225)
City Safety - symbols and messages
(p. 227)
DRIVER SUPPORT
222
City Safety - function
City Safety detects the traffic in front of the
car with a laser sensor (p. 225) fitted in the top
edge of the windscreen. If there is an imminent
risk of collision, City Safety will automatically
brake the car, which may be experienced as
heavy braking.
Laser sensor transmitter and receiver window16.
If the speed difference is 4-15 km/h (3-9 mph)
in relation to the vehicle in front then City
Safety can completely avoid a collision.
City Safety activates a short, sharp braking and
stops the car in normal circumstances, just
behind the vehicle in front. For most drivers this is
well outside normal driving style and may be
experienced as being uncomfortable.
If the difference in speed between the vehicles is
greater than 15 km/h (9 mph) then City Safety
may not avoid the collision on its own - to obtain
full brake force, the driver must depress the
brake pedal and this could then make it possible
to avoid a collision, even at speed differences
above 15 km/h (9 mph).
When the function is activated and brakes, the
combined instrument panel shows a message
(p. 227) to the effect that the function is/has
been active.
NOTE
When City Safety brakes, the brake lights
come on.
Related information
City Safety (p. 221)
City Safety - operation (p. 222)
City Safety - limitations (p. 223)
City Safety - operation
City Safety is a function for helping the driver
to avoid a collision when driving in queues,
amongst other things, when changes in the traf-
fic ahead, combined with a lapse in attention,
could lead to an incident.
On and Off
NOTE
The City Safety function is activated auto-
matically when the engine is started.
In certain situations, it may advisable to disable
City Safety, e.g. where leafy branches could
sweep over the bonnet and/or windscreen.
City Safety handled in the menu system MY
CAR (p. 113) and after starting the engine the
function can be deactivated as follows:
Search in MY CAR for Driver support
system and select the Off option at City
Safety.
However, the function will be enabled the
next time the engine is started, regardless of
whether the system was enabled or disabled
when the engine was switched off.
16 NOTE: The illustration is schematic - details may vary depending on car model.
DRIVER SUPPORT
}}
223
WARNING
The laser sensor (p. 225) emits laser light
even when City Safety is disabled manually.
To enable City Safety again:
Follow the same procedure as for disabling,
but select the On option.
Related information
City Safety (p. 221)
City Safety - limitations (p. 223)
City Safety - symbols and messages
(p. 227)
City Safety - limitations
The sensor in City Safety is designed to
detect cars and other large vehicles in front of
the car irrespective of whether it is day or night.
However, the function does have some limita-
tions.
The sensor's limitations mean that City Safety
has poorer functionality - or none at all - in e.g.
heavy snowfall or rain, dense fog, dust storms or
white-out situations. Misting, dirt, ice or snow on
the windscreen may also disrupt the function.
Low-hanging objects, e.g. a flag/pennant for pro-
jecting load, or accessories such as auxiliary
lamps and bull bars that are higher than the bon-
net limit the function.
The laser light from the sensor in City Safety
measures how the light is reflected. The sensor
cannot detect objects with low reflection capacity.
The rear sections of the vehicle generally reflect
the light sufficiently thanks to the number plate
and rear light reflectors.
On slippery road surfaces the braking distance is
extended, which may reduce the capacity of City
Safety to avoid a collision. In such situations
the ABS17 and ESC18 systems will provide best
possible braking force with maintained stability.
When your own car is reversing, City Safety is
temporarily deactivated.
City Safety is not activated at low speeds -
below 4 km/h (3 mph), which is why the system
does not intervene in situations where a vehicle
in front is being approached very slowly, e.g.
when parking.
Driver commands are always prioritised, which is
why City Safety does not intervene in situations
where the driver is steering or accelerating in a
clear manner, even if a collision is unavoidable.
When City Safety has prevented a collision
with a stationary object the car remains stationary
for a maximum of 1.5 seconds. If the car is
braked for a vehicle in front that is moving, then
speed is reduced to the same speed as that
maintained by the vehicle in front.
On a car with manual gearbox the engine stops
when City Safety has stopped the car, unless
the driver manages to depress the clutch pedal
beforehand.
17 (Anti-lock Braking System) - Anti-lock braking system.
18 (Electronic Stability Control) - Stability system.
||
DRIVER SUPPORT
224
NOTE
Keep the windscreen surface in front of
the laser sensor (p. 225) free from ice,
snow and dirt. For an illustration of sen-
sor location, see City Safety - function
(p. 222).
Do not affix or mount anything on the
windscreen in front of the laser sensor
Remove ice and snow from the bonnet -
snow and ice must not exceed a height
of 5 cm.
Fault tracing and action
If the message (p. 227) Windscreen sensors
blocked See manual is shown in the combined
instrument panel it indicates that the laser sensor
is blocked and cannot detect vehicles in front of
the car. This means that City Safety is not
operational.
The Windscreen sensors blocked See
manual message is not shown for all situations
in which the laser sensor is blocked. The driver
must therefore be diligent about keeping the
windscreen and area in front of the laser sensor
clean.
The following table presents possible causes for
the message being shown, along with sugges-
tions for appropriate action.
Cause Action
The windscreen surface
in front of the laser sen-
sor is dirty or covered
with ice or snow.
Clean the wind-
screen surface in
front of the sensor
from dirt, ice and
snow.
The laser sensor field of
vision is blocked.
Remove the block-
ing object.
IMPORTANT
If there are cracks, scratches or stone chips in
the windscreen in front of either of the laser
sensor's "windows" and they cover a surface
of approx. 0.5 x 3.0 mm (or larger), then a
workshop must be contacted for replacement
of the windscreen - an authorised Volvo work-
shop is recommended. For an illustration of
sensor location, see City Safety - function
(p. 222).
Failure to take action may result in reduced
performance for City Safety.
To avoid the risk of failed, deficient or
reduced operation for City Safety, the fol-
lowing also applies:
Volvo recommends that you do not repair
cracks, scratches or stone chips in the
area in front of the laser sensor - instead,
the whole windscreen should be
replaced.
Before replacing a windscreen, contact
an authorised Volvo workshop to verify
that the correct windscreen is ordered
and fitted.
The same type or Volvo-approved wind-
screen wipers must be fitted during
replacement.
DRIVER SUPPORT
}}
225
Related information
City Safety (p. 221)
City Safety - function (p. 222)
City Safety - operation (p. 222)
City Safety - laser sensor
The City Safety function includes a sensor
which transmits laser light. Contact a qualified
workshop in the event of a fault or if the laser
sensor needs servicing - an authorised Volvo
workshop is recommended. It is absolutely
essential to follow the prescribed instructions
when handling the laser sensor.
The following two labels relate to the laser sen-
sor:
The upper label in the figure describes the laser
beam's classification:
Laser radiation - Do not look into the laser
beam with optical instruments - Class 1M
laser product.
The lower label in the figure describes the laser
beam's physical data:
IEC 60825-1:1993 + A2:2001. Complies
with FDA (U.S. Food Administration) stand-
ards for laser product design with the excep-
tion of deviations in accordance with "Laser
Notice No. 50" from 26 July 2001.
Radiation data for the laser sensor
The following table specifies the laser sensor's
physical data.
Maximum pulse energy 2.64 µJ
Maximum average output 45 mW
Pulse duration 33 ns
Divergence (horizontal x vertical) 28° × 12°
||
DRIVER SUPPORT
226
WARNING
If any of these instructions are not followed
then there is a risk of eye injury!
Never look into the laser sensor (which
emits spreading invisible laser radiation)
at a distance of 100 mm or closer with
magnifying optics such as a magnifying
glass, microscope, lens or similar optical
instruments.
Testing, repair, removal, adjustment
and/or replacement of the laser sensor's
spare parts must only be carried out by a
qualified workshop - we recommend an
authorised Volvo workshop.
To avoid exposure to harmful radiation, do
not carry out any readjustments or main-
tenance other than those specified here.
The repairer must follow specially drawn
up workshop information for the laser
sensor.
Do not remove the laser sensor (this
includes removing the lenses). A removed
laser sensor fulfils laser class 3B as per
standard IEC 60825-1. Laser class 3B is
not eye-safe and therefore entails a risk
of injury.
The laser sensor's connector must be
unplugged before removal from the wind-
screen.
The laser sensor must be fitted onto the
windscreen before the sensor's connec-
tor is plugged in.
The laser sensor transmits a laser light
when the remote control key is in key
position II (p. 81) even if the engine is
switched off.
Related information
City Safety (p. 221)
DRIVER SUPPORT
227
City Safety - symbols and
messages
In conjunction with automatic braking by the City
Safety (p. 221) system, one or more symbols
(p. 227) may illuminate in the combined instru-
ment panel and a text message may be shown.
A text message can be acknowledged by briefly
pressing the OK button on the direction indica-
tor stalk.
SymbolAMessage Meaning/Action
Auto braking by City Safety City Safety is braking or has automatically braked.
Windscreen sensors blocked See manual The laser sensor is temporarily non-operational because something is blocking it.
Remove the object blocking the sensor and/or clean the windscreen in front of the sensor.
Read about the laser sensor's(p. 223) limitations.
City Safety Service required City Safety is not operational.
Visit a workshop if the message remains - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.
AThe symbols are schematic.
Related information
City Safety (p. 221)
City Safety - function (p. 222)
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
228
Collision warning system*
"Collision Warning with Auto Brake and Cyclist
and Pedestrian Detection" is an aid to assist the
driver when there is a risk of colliding with a
pedestrian, cyclist or vehicle in front that are sta-
tionary or moving in the same direction.
"Collision Warning with Auto Brake and Cyclist
and Pedestrian Detection" is activated in situa-
tions where the driver should have started brak-
ing earlier, which is why it cannot help the driver
in every situation.
"Collision Warning with Auto Brake and Cyclist
and Pedestrian Detection" is designed to be acti-
vated as late as possible in order to avoid unnec-
essary intervention.
"Collision Warning with Auto Brake and Cyclist
and Pedestrian Detection" can prevent a collision
or reduce collision speed.
"Collision Warning with Auto Brake and Cyclist
and Pedestrian Detection" must not be used as
an excuse for the driver to change his/her driving
style. If the driver solely relies on Collision Warn-
ing with Auto Brake to do the braking, there
might be a risk of a collision sooner or later.
Two system levels
Depending on how the car is equipped, the "Col-
lision Warning with Auto Brake and Cyclist and
Pedestrian Detection" function may appear in
two variants:
Level 1
The driver is merely warned19 of occurring obsta-
cles by means of visual and acoustic signals - no
automatic braking intervenes, the driver must
himself brake.
Level 2
The driver is warned of occurring obstacles by
means of visual and acoustic signals - the car is
braked automatically if the driver himself does not
act within a reasonable time.
IMPORTANT
Maintenance of the internal components of
the "Collision Warning with Auto Brake and
Cyclist and Pedestrian Detection" must only
be performed at a workshop - an authorised
Volvo workshop is recommended.
Related information
Collision warning system* - function (p. 229)
Collision warning system* - detection of
pedestrians (p. 231)
Collision warning system* - detection of
cyclists (p. 230)
Collision warning system* - operation
(p. 232)
Collision warning system* - limitations
(p. 234)
Collision warning system* - camera sensor
limitations (p. 235)
Collision warning system* - symbols and
messages (p. 236)
19 No warning for cyclists with "Level 1".
DRIVER SUPPORT
}}
* Option/accessory. 229
Collision warning system* - function
Function overview20.
Audio-visual warning signal in the event of a
collision risk.
Radar sensor21
Camera sensor
Collision Warning with Auto Brake executes
three steps in the following order:
1. Collision warning
2. Brake support21
3. Auto Brake21
The collision warning system and City
Safety (p. 221) complement each other.
1 - Collision warning
The driver is first warned of a potentially immi-
nent collision.
The collision warning system can detect pedes-
trians, cyclists or vehicles that are stationary or
moving in the same direction as your car and are
located in front of you.
If there is a risk of collision with a pedestrian,
cyclist or a vehicle then the driver's attention is
attracted with a flashing red warning signal (1)
and an acoustic signal.
2 - Brake support
If the risk of collision has increased further after
the collision warning then the brake support is
activated.
This means that the brake system is prepared for
rapid braking by applying the brakes lightly, which
may feel like a slight jolt.
If the brake pedal is depressed sufficiently
quickly then full brake function is implemented.
Brake support also reinforces the driver's braking
if the system considers that the braking is not
sufficient to avoid a collision.
3 - Auto Brake
The automatic brake function is activated last.
If in this situation the driver has not yet started to
take evasive action and the risk of collision is
imminent then the automatic braking function is
deployed - this takes place irrespective of
whether or not the driver brakes. Braking then
takes place with full brake force in order to
reduce collision speed, or with limited brake force
if it is sufficient to avoid a collision. For cyclists,
the warning and full brake intervention may come
very late or simultaneously.
20 NOTE: The illustration is schematic - details may vary depending on car model.
21 With system Level 2 only.
||
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
230
WARNING
The collision warning system does not
engage in all driving situations or traffic,
weather or road conditions. The collision
warning system does not react to vehicles or
cyclists driving in another direction to the car
or to animals.
Warning only activated in the event of a high
risk for collision. This section "Function" and
the section "Limitations" inform about limita-
tions that the driver must be aware of before
using the Collision Warning system with Auto
Brake.
Warnings and brake interventions for pedes-
trians and cyclists are deactivated at vehicle
speeds above 80 km/h (50 mph).
Warnings and brake interventions for pedes-
trians and cyclists do not work in darkness
and tunnels - not even when streetlights are
lit.
The auto-brake function can prevent a colli-
sion or reduce collision speed. To ensure full
brake performance, the driver should always
depress the brake pedal - even when the car
auto-brakes.
Never wait for a collision warning. The driver is
always responsible that the correct distance
and speed are maintained - even when the
collision warning system with auto-brake is
used.
Related information
Collision warning system* (p. 228)
Collision warning system* -
detection of cyclists
The function only "sees" cyclists from behind, who are
travelling in the same direction.
Optimal example of what the system interprets as a
cyclist - with clear body and bicycle contours, directly
from behind and in the car's centre line.
Optimal performance of the system requires that
the system function that detects a cyclist
receives as unambiguous information as possible
about the body and bicycle contours - this implies
the opportunity to identify the bicycle, head, arms,
shoulders, legs, upper and lower body combined
with a normal human pattern of movement.
If large parts of the cyclist's body or bicycle are
not visible to the function's camera then the sys-
tem cannot detect a cyclist.
For the function to be able to detect a cyclist,
he/she must be an adult and riding an "adult
bicycle".
The function can only detect cyclists directly
from behind and who are travelling in the
same direction - not at an angle from behind,
not from the side.
DRIVER SUPPORT
}}
* Option/accessory. 231
The bicycle must be equipped with a highly
visible and approved22 rearward-facing red
reflector, fitted at least 70 cm above the
roadway.
Cyclists travelling on the left or right-hand
edge of the car's imagined/extended side
lines may be detected late or not at all.
The function's capacity to detect cyclists at
dusk and dawn is limited - just like the
human eye.
The function's capacity to detect cyclists is
deactivated when driving in darkness and
tunnels - even when streetlights are lit.
For optimum bicycle detection, the City
Safety function must be activated, see City
Safety (p. 221).
WARNING
Collision Warning with Auto Brake & Cyclist
Detection is a means of assistance.
The function cannot detect:
all cyclists in all situations and does not
see partially obscured cyclists, for exam-
ple.
cyclists in clothing that obscures the con-
tours of the body or who are approaching
from the side.
bicycles that have no rearward-facing red
reflector.
bicycles loaded with large objects.
The driver is always responsible that the vehi-
cle is driven properly and with a safety dis-
tance adapted to the speed.
Related information
Collision warning system* (p. 228)
Collision warning system* -
detection of pedestrians
Optimal examples of what the system regards as pedes-
trians with clear body contours.
Optimal performance of the system requires that
the system function that detects pedestrians
receives as unambiguous information as possible
about the contours of the body - this implies the
opportunity to identify the head, arms, shoulders,
legs, upper and lower body combined with a nor-
mal human pattern of movement.
If large parts of the body are not visible to the
function's camera then the system cannot detect
a pedestrian.
22 The reflector must fulfil the recommendations and conditions of the traffic authority in the market in question.
||
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
232
In order for a pedestrian to be detected
he/she must appear full-length and have a
height of at least 80 cm.
The camera sensor's ability to see pedes-
trians at dusk and dawn is limited - just like
the human eye.
The camera sensor's capacity to detect
pedestrians is deactivated when driving in
darkness and tunnels - even when street-
lights are lit.
WARNING
"Collision Warning with Auto Brake and
Cyclist and Pedestrian Detection" is a means
of assistance. The function cannot detect all
pedestrians in all situations and does not see,
for example:
partially obscured pedestrians, people in
clothing that hides their body contour or
pedestrians shorter than 80 cm.
pedestrians who are carrying larger
objects.
The driver is always responsible that the vehi-
cle is driven properly and with a safety dis-
tance adapted to the speed.
Related information
Collision warning system* (p. 228)
Collision warning system* -
operation
Settings for the collision warning system are
made from MY CAR via the centre console
screen and menu system, see MY CAR (p. 113).
Warning signals On and Off
1. Acoustic and visual warning signal in the event of a
collision risk23.
It is possible to select whether the collision warn-
ing system's acoustic and visual warning signals
should be switched on or off.
When starting the engine, the setting that was
selected when the engine was switched off is
obtained automatically.
NOTE
The Brake Support and Auto Brake functions
are always activated - they cannot be deacti-
vated.
Settings for the collision warning system are
made via the centre console's screen and the
menu system MY CAR, see (p. 113).
Light and acoustic signals
When the collision warning system's light and
acoustic warnings are activated, the warning lamp
(no. [1] in previous illustration) is tested each
time the engine is started by briefly illuminating
the warning lamp's separate points of light.
After starting the engine, both light and acoustic
signals are switched off:
Search for Collision warning in Driver
support system in the menu system MY
CAR (p. 113) - and there select to uncheck
the function.
Audible signal
After starting the engine the warning sound can
be activated/deactivated separately:
Search for Warning sound in Collision
warning in the menu system MY CAR
(p. 113) - and there select On or Off.
Following which, the collision warning system is
only indicated with a light signal.
23 The illustration is schematic - car model and details may differ.
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory. 233
Set warning distance
The warning distance regulates the distance at
which the visual and acoustic warnings are
deployed.
Search for Warning distance in Collision
warning in the menu system MY CAR
(p. 113) - and there select Long, Normal or
Short.
The warning distance determines the system's
sensitivity. Warning distance Long provides an
earlier warning. First test with Long and if this
setting produces too many warnings, which could
be perceived as irritating in certain situations,
then change to warning distance Normal.
Only use warning distance Short in exceptional
cases, e.g. for dynamic driving.
NOTE
When the adaptive cruise control is in use the
warning lamp and warning sound will be used
by the cruise control even if the collision
warning system is switched off.
The collision warning system warns the driver
in the event of a risk of a collision, but the
function cannot shorten driver reaction time.
In order for the collision warning system to be
effective, always drive with Distance Alert
(p. 199) set at time interval 4–5.
NOTE
Even if the warning distance has been set to
Long warnings could be perceived as being
late in certain situations, e.g. when there are
large differences in speed or if vehicles in
front brake heavily.
WARNING
No automatic system can guarantee 100 %
correct function in all situations. Therefore,
never test Collision Warning with Auto Brake
by driving at people or vehicles - this may
cause severe damage and injury and risk lives.
Checking settings
The settings required can be controlled on the
centre console display screen.
Search in the menu system MY CAR (p. 113)
for Collision warning in Driver support
system.
Maintenance
Camera and radar sensor24.
For the sensors to work correctly, they must be
kept clear of dirt, ice and snow, and be cleaned
regularly with water and car shampoo.
NOTE
Dirt, ice and snow covering the sensors will
reduce their function and may prevent meas-
urement.
Related information
Collision warning system* (p. 228)
24 NOTE: The illustration is schematic - details may vary depending on car model.
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
234
Collision warning system* -
limitations
The function has certain limitations - for example,
it is not active until 4 km/h (3 mph).
The collision warning system's visual warning sig-
nal may be difficult to notice in the event of
strong sunlight, reflections, when sunglasses are
being worn or if the driver is not looking straight
ahead. The warning sound should therefore
always be activated.
On slippery road surfaces the braking distance is
extended, which may reduce the capacity to avoid
a collision. In such situations the ABS and ESC
(p. 186) systems will provide best possible brak-
ing force with maintained stability.
NOTE
The visual warning signal can be temporarily
disengaged in the event of high passenger
compartment temperature caused by strong
sunlight for example. If this occurs then the
warning sound is activated even if it is deacti-
vated in the menu system.
Warnings may not appear if the distance
to the vehicle in front is small or if steer-
ing wheel and pedal movements are
large, e.g. a very active driving style.
WARNING
Warnings and brake interventions could be
implemented late or not at all if the traffic sit-
uation or external influences mean that the
radar or camera sensor cannot detect a
pedestrian, a vehicle or a cyclist in front cor-
rectly.
The sensor system has a limited range for
pedestrians and cyclists25 - the system can
give effective warnings and brake interven-
tions for them at vehicle speeds up to
50 km/h (30 mph). For stationary or slow-
moving vehicles, warnings and brake interven-
tions are effective at vehicle speeds up to
70 km/h (43 mph).
Warnings for stationary or slow-moving vehi-
cles could be disengaged due to darkness or
poor visibility.
Warnings and brake interventions for pedes-
trians and cyclists are deactivated at vehicle
speeds exceeding 80 km/h (50 mph).
The collision warning system uses the same
radar sensors as the adaptive cruise control
(p. 203).
If warnings are perceived as being too frequent
or disturbing then the warning distance can be
reduced. This then leads to the system providing
a warning at a later stage, which reduces the
total number of warnings; see Collision warning
system - operation (p. 232).
Collision Warning with Auto Brake is temporarily
deactivated with reverse gear engaged.
Collision Warning with Auto Brake is not acti-
vated at low speeds - below 4 km/h (3 mph),
which is why the system does not intervene in sit-
uations where the car is approaching a vehicle in
front very slowly, e.g. when parking.
In situations where the driver demonstrates
active, aware driving behaviour, a collision warn-
ing may be postponed slightly in order to keep
unnecessary warnings to a minimum.
When Auto Brake has prevented a collision with
a stationary object the car remains stationary for
a maximum of 1.5 seconds. If the car is braked
for a vehicle in front that is moving, then speed is
reduced to the same speed as that maintained by
the vehicle in front.
On a car with manual gearbox the engine stops
when Auto Brake has stopped the car, unless the
driver manages to depress the clutch pedal
beforehand.
Related information
Collision warning system* (p. 228)
25 For cyclists, the warning and full brake intervention may come very late or simultaneously.
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory. 235
Collision warning system* - camera
sensor limitations
The function uses the car's camera sensor,
which has certain limitations.
The car’s camera sensor is also used - as well as
by Collision Warning with Auto Brake - by the
functions:
Active main beam (p. 92)
Road sign information (p. 243)
Driver Alert Control - DAC (p. 246)
Lane Keeping Aid (p. 249).
NOTE
Keep the windscreen surface in front of the
camera sensor free from ice, snow, mist and
dirt.
Do not stick or attach anything to the wind-
screen in front of the camera sensor as this
may reduce effectiveness or cause one or
more of the systems dependent on the cam-
era to stop working.
The camera sensors have limitations similar to
the human eye, i.e. they "see" worse in darkness,
heavy snowfall or rain and in thick fog for exam-
ple. Under such conditions the functions of cam-
era-dependent systems could be significantly
reduced or temporarily disengaged.
Strong oncoming light, reflections in the carriage-
way, snow or ice on the road surface, dirty road
surfaces or unclear lane markings could also sig-
nificantly reduce camera sensor function when it
is used to scan the carriageway and detect
pedestrians and other vehicles.
The field of vision of the camera sensor is limited,
which is why pedestrians, cyclists and vehicles
cannot be detected in some situations, or they
are detected later than anticipated.
During very high temperatures the camera is
temporarily switched off for about 15 minutes
after the engine is started in order to protect
camera functionality.
Fault tracing and action
If the display shows the message Windscreen
sensors blocked See manual then this means
that the camera sensor is blocked and cannot
detect pedestrians, cyclists, vehicles or road
markings in front of the car.
At the same time, this means that - besides Colli-
sion Warning with Auto Brake - the following
functions will not have full functionality either:
Active main beam
Driver Alert Control
Lane Keeping Aid
Road sign information
The following table presents possible causes for
a message being shown along with the appropri-
ate action.
Cause Action
The windscreen sur-
face in front of the
camera is dirty or cov-
ered with ice or snow.
Clean the windscreen
surface in front of the
camera from dirt, ice
and snow.
Thick fog, heavy rain
or snow means that
the camera does not
work sufficiently well.
No action. At times
the camera does not
work during heavy rain
or snowfall.
The windscreen sur-
face in front of the
camera has been
cleaned but the mes-
sage remains.
Wait. It may take sev-
eral minutes for the
camera to measure
the visibility.
Dirt has appeared
between the inside of
the windscreen and
the camera.
Visit a workshop to
have the windscreen
inside the camera
cover cleaned - an
authorised Volvo
workshop is recom-
mended.
Related information
Collision warning system* (p. 228)
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
236
Collision warning system* - symbols
and messages
SymbolAMessage Specification
Collision warning system
OFF
Collision warning system switched off.
Shown when the engine is started.
The message clears after about 5 seconds or after one press of the OK button.
Collision warning system
Unavailable
The collision warning system cannot be activated.
Shown when the driver attempts to activate the function.
The message clears after about 5 seconds or after one press of the OK button.
Auto Braking was acti-
vated
Auto Brake has been active.
The message clears after one press of the OK button.
Windscreen sensors
blocked See manual
Camera sensor (p. 235) is temporarily disengaged.
Shown in the event of snow, ice or dirt on the windscreen for example.
Clean the windscreen surface in front of the camera sensor.
Radar blocked See man-
ual
Collision Warning with Auto Brake is temporarily disengaged.
Radar sensor (p. 216) is blocked and cannot detect other vehicles. For example, in the event of heavy rain or if
slush has collected in front of the radar sensor.
Collision warning Service
required
Collision Warning with Auto Brake is fully or partially disengaged.
Visit a workshop if the message remains - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.
ASymbols are schematic - may vary by market and car model.
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory. 237
Related information
Collision warning system* (p. 228)
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
238
BLIS
BLIS (Blind Spot Information System) is a func-
tion designed for providing support for the driver
when driving in dense traffic on roads with sev-
eral lanes in the same direction.
BLIS is a driver's aid intended to provide a warn-
ing about:
vehicles in the car's blind spot
quickly approaching vehicles in the left and
right lanes closest to the car.
WARNING
BLIS is a supplementary aid and does not
work in all situations.
BLIS is no substitute for a safe driving style
and the use of rearview and door mirrors.
BLIS can never replace the driver's responsi-
bility and attention - it is always the driver's
responsibility to change lanes in a safe man-
ner.
Overview
Position of the BLIS lamp26.
Indicator lamp
BLIS symbol
NOTE
The lamp illuminates on the side of the car
where the system has detected the vehicle. If
the car is overtaken on both sides at the
same time then both lamps illuminate.
Maintenance
The sensors for the BLIS functions are located
inside the rear wing/bumper on each corner of
the car.
Keep this surface clean - also on the left-hand side.
To ensure optimal functionality, the areas in
front of the sensors must be kept clean.
Related information
BLIS - operation (p. 239)
BLIS and CTA - symbols and messages
(p. 242)
CTA* (p. 240)
26 NOTE: The illustration is schematic - details may vary depending on car model.
DRIVER SUPPORT
}}
239
BLIS - operation
BLIS (Blind Spot Information System) is a func-
tion designed for providing support for the driver
when driving in dense traffic on roads with sev-
eral lanes in the same direction.
Activate/deactivate BLIS
BLIS is activated when the engine is started. This
is confirmed by the indicator lamps in the door
panels flashing once.
Button for activating/deactivating.
The BLIS function can be deactivated/activated
by pressing the BLIS button on the centre con-
sole.
Some combinations of the selected equipment
leave no vacant space for a button in the centre
console - in which case the function is handled
by the car's menu system MY CAR27:
Select On or Off at Settings Car
settings BLIS.
When BLIS is deactivated/activated the lamp in
the button goes out/illuminates and the com-
bined instrument panel confirms the change with
a text message. The door panel indicator lamps
flash once upon activation.
To extinguish the message:
Press the left stalk switch OK button.
or
Wait approx. 5 seconds – the message extin-
guishes.
When BLIS operates
Principle for BLIS: 1. Zone in blind spot. 2. Zone for
quickly approaching vehicle.
The BLIS function is active at speeds above
10 km/h (6 mph).
The system is designed to react when:
the vehicle is overtaken by other vehicles
another vehicle is quickly approaching the
vehicle.
When BLIS detects a vehicle in zone 1 or a
quickly approaching vehicle in zone 2, the door
panel BLIS lamp illuminates with a constant glow.
If the driver activates the direction indicator on
the same side as the warning in this situation
then the BLIS lamp will change from a constant
glow to flashing with a more intense light.
27 For information on the menu system - MY CAR (p. 113).
||
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
240
WARNING
BLIS does not work in sharp bends.
BLIS does not work when the car is being
reversed.
Limitations
Dirt, ice and snow covering sensors can
reduce functionality and make it impossible
to provide warnings. BLIS cannot detect haz-
ards if it is covered.
Do not affix any objects, tape or labels in the
area of the sensors.
BLIS is deactivated when a trailer is con-
nected to the car's electrical system.
IMPORTANT
Repair of the BLIS and CTA functions' com-
ponents or repainting the bumpers must only
be performed by a workshop - an authorised
Volvo workshop is recommended.
Related information
BLIS (p. 238)
BLIS and CTA - symbols and messages
(p. 242)
CTA*
The BLIS function CTA (Cross Traffic Alert) is a
driver aid intended to warn about crossing traffic
when the car is reversing. CTA is a supplement
to BLIS (p. 238).
Activate/deactivate CTA
CTA is activated when the engine is started. This
is confirmed by the indicator lamps in the door
panels flashing once.
On/Off for parking assistance and CTA sensors.
In cars equipped with Parking assistance
(p. 254), the CTA function can be deactivated/
activated separately with the parking assistance
On/Off button.
In cars without a button for parking assistance,
the CTA function can be operated in the menu
system MY CAR (p. 113), as follows:
Search for Cross Traffic Alert under BLIS
and uncheck - the CTA function is then
deactivated.
However, the BLIS function remains activated
after the CTA has been deactivated.
WARNING
CTA is a supplementary aid and does not
work in all situations.
CTA is no substitute for a safe driving style
and the use of rearview and door mirrors.
CTA can never replace the driver's responsi-
bility and attention - it is always the driver's
responsibility to reverse in a safe manner.
When CTA operates
Principle for CTA.
CTA supplements the BLIS function by being
able to see crossing traffic from the side during
DRIVER SUPPORT
}}
241
reversing, such as when reversing out of a park-
ing space.
CTA is primarily designed to detect vehicles. In
favourable conditions, it may also be able to
detect smaller objects, such as cyclists and
pedestrians.
CTA is only active during reversing and is acti-
vated automatically when reverse is selected at
the gearbox.
If CTA detects something approaching from
the side, an acoustic warning signal sounds.
The signal comes from either the left or the
right speaker depending on which direction
the approaching object is coming from.
CTA also warns by illuminating the BLIS
lamps.
An additional warning is provided in the form
of an illuminated icon in the display screen's
PAS graphics (p. 254).
Limitations
CTA does not perform optimally in all situations,
but has a certain limitation - for example, the CTA
sensors cannot "see" through other parked vehi-
cles or obstructing objects.
Here are some examples of when CTA's "field of
vision" may be limited from the beginning and
approaching vehicles cannot therefore be
detected until they are very close:
The car is parked deep inside a parking slot.
Blind CTA sector.
Sector where CTA can detect/"see".
In an angled parking slot CTA can be completely "blind"
on one side.
However, when the driver is slowly reversing the
car, the angle is changed in relation to the vehi-
cle/object that is blocking, at which the blind
sector rapidly decreases.
Examples of further limitations:
Dirt, ice and snow covering sensors can
reduce functionality and make it impossible
to provide warnings. CTA cannot detect haz-
ards if it is covered.
CTA is deactivated when a trailer is con-
nected to the car’s electrical system.
IMPORTANT
Repair of the BLIS and CTA functions' com-
ponents or repainting the bumpers must only
be performed by a workshop - an authorised
Volvo workshop is recommended.
Maintenance
The sensors for the BLIS and CTA functions are
located inside the rear wing/bumper on each
corner of the car.
||
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
242
Keep this surface clean - also on the left-hand side.
To ensure optimal functionality, the areas in
front of the sensors must be kept clean.
Do not affix any objects, tape or labels in the
area of the sensors.
Related information
BLIS (p. 238)
BLIS and CTA - symbols and messages
(p. 242)
BLIS and CTA - symbols and
messages
In situations where the BLIS (Blind Spot
Information System) (p. 238) and CTA (p. 240)
functions fail or are interrupted, the combined
instrument panel may show a symbol, supple-
mented by an explanatory message. Follow any
recommendation given.
Message examples:
Message Specification
CTA OFF CTA has been deactivated
manually. BLIS is active.
BLIS and
CTA OFF
Trailer
attached
BLIS and CTA are temporarily
disabled because a trailer is
connected to the car’s electri-
cal system.
BLIS and
CTA Service
required
BLIS and CTA are not work-
ing.
Visit a workshop if the
message remains - an
authorised Volvo work-
shop is recommended.
A text message can be acknowledged by briefly
pressing the OK button on the direction indicator
stalk.
Related information
BLIS (p. 238)
CTA* (p. 240)
DRIVER SUPPORT
}}
* Option/accessory. 243
Road Sign Information (RSI)
The road sign information function (RSI – Road
Sign Information) helps the driver to remember
which road signs the car has passed.
Examples of readable speed related28 signs.
The road sign information function gives informa-
tion on current speed, that a motorway or road is
starting/ending and when overtaking is prohibi-
ted. If both a sign for motorway/road for motor-
ised traffic and a sign showing the maximum per-
mitted speed are passed, RSI decides to show
the sign symbol for maximum permitted speed.
WARNING
RSI does not work in all situations but is
designed merely as a supplementary aid.
The driver always bears ultimate responsibility
for ensuring that the vehicle is driven safely
and that applicable road traffic rules and reg-
ulations are followed.
Related information
Road sign information (RSI)* - operation
(p. 243)
Road sign information (RSI)* - limitations
(p. 245)
Road sign information (RSI)* -
operation
The road sign information function (RSI – Road
Sign Information) helps the driver to remember
which road signs the car has passed. How the
function is operated is described below.
Recorded speed information29.
When RSI has recorded a road sign with an
imposed speed, the combined instrument panel
displays the sign as a symbol.
Together with the symbol for
the current speed limit, a sign
showing that overtaking is pro-
hibited may also be displayed
where appropriate.
28 Road signs shown in the combined instrument panel are market-dependent - the illustrations only show a few examples.
29 Road signs shown in the combined instrument panel are market-dependent - the illustrations only show a few examples.
||
DRIVER SUPPORT
244
End of restriction or motorway
A corresponding road sign is shown in the com-
bined instrument panel for approx. 10 seconds in
situations where RSI detects a sign that involves
the end of a speed limit - or other speed-related
information, e.g. end of a motorway.
Examples of such signs are:
End of all restrictions.
End of motorway.
Following which, the sign information is hidden
until the next speed-related sign is detected.
Additional signs
Examples of additional signs29.
Sometimes different speed limits are signposted
for the same road - an additional sign then indi-
cates the circumstances under which the differ-
ent speeds apply. The road section may be par-
ticularly susceptible to accidents in rain and/or
fog, for example.
An additional sign relating to rain is displayed
only if the windscreen wipers are in use.
The speed applicable on an exit
is indicated in certain markets
by means of an additional sign
containing an arrow.
Speed signs linked to this type
of additional sign are displayed
only if the driver is using the direction indicator.
Some speeds are applicable
only after e.g. a specific dis-
tance or at a certain time of
day. The driver's attention is
drawn to the situation by
means of a symbol for an addi-
tional sign under the symbol
showing speed.
Display of additional information
A symbol for additional sign in
the form of an empty frame
under the combined instrument
panel's speed symbol means
that the RSI has detected an
additional sign with supplemen-
tary information for the current
speed limit.
Road sign information On/Off
29 Road signs shown in the combined instrument panel are market-dependent - the illustrations only show a few examples.
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory. 245
The combined instrument panel's speed symbol
display can be disabled.
To deactivate the RSI function:
Search for the function in the menu system
MY CAR MY CAR (p. 113), uncheck Road
sign information and back out with EXIT.
Speed Alert On/Off
The driver can opt to receive a warning when the
applicable speed limit is exceeded by 5 km/h
(3 mph) or more. This warning is given by the
symbol showing the applicable maximum speed
temporarily flashing when this speed is exceeded.
To activate speed warning:
Search for the function in the menu system
MY CAR MY CAR (p. 113), check Speed
alert and back out with EXIT.
Sensus Navigation
If the car is equipped with Sensus Navigation,
speed information is read from the navigation
unit in the following cases:
On detecting signs that indirectly indicate a
speed limit30, such as motorway and
expressway.
If a previously detected sign is assumed not
to apply any longer, but no new sign has
been detected.
Related information
Road Sign Information (RSI) (p. 243)
Road sign information (RSI)* - limitations
(p. 245)
MY CAR (p. 113)
Road sign information (RSI)* -
limitations
The road sign information function (RSI – Road
Sign Information) helps the driver to remember
which road signs the car has passed. The func-
tion has the following limitations.
The RSI function's camera sensor has limitations
just like the human eye. Find out more about this
in the section on the camera sensor limitations
(p. 235).
Signs which indirectly provide information on a
prevailing speed limit, e.g. name signs for towns/
districts, are not recorded by the RSI function.
Here are some other examples of what can dis-
rupt the function:
Faded signs
Signs positioned on bends
Rotated or damaged signs
Concealed or poorly positioned signs
Signs completely or partly covered with frost,
snow and/or dirt.
Related information
Road Sign Information (RSI) (p. 243)
Road sign information (RSI)* - operation
(p. 243)
30 Variations may occur in different markets.
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
246
Driver Alert System*
The Driver Alert System is intended to assist dri-
vers whose driving ability is deteriorating or who
are inadvertently leaving the lane they are driving
on.
The Driver Alert System consists of different
functions which can either be switched on at the
same time or individually:
Driver Alert Control - DAC (p. 247).
Lane Keeping Aid (p. 251).
A switched-on function is set in standby mode
and is not activated automatically until speed
exceeds 65 km/h (40 mph).
The function is deactivated again when speed
decreases to below 60 km/h (37 mph).
The functions use a camera which is dependent
on the lane having side markings painted on
each side.
WARNING
Driver Alert System does not work in all situa-
tions but is designed merely as a supplemen-
tary aid.
The driver always bears ultimate responsibility
for ensuring that the vehicle is driven safely.
Related information
Driver Alert Control (DAC)* (p. 246)
Lane assistance* (p. 249)
Driver Alert Control (DAC)*
DAC is intended to attract the driver's attention
when he/she starts to drive less consistently,
e.g. if he/she becomes distracted or starts to fall
asleep.
The objective for DAC is to detect slowly deterio-
rating driving ability and it is primarily intended for
major roads.
A camera detects the side markings painted on
the carriageway and compares the section of the
road with the driver's steering wheel movements.
The driver is alerted if the vehicle does not follow
the carriageway evenly.
In some cases driving ability is not affected
despite driver fatigue. In which case there may
not be any warning issued for the driver. For this
reason it is always important to stop and take a
break in the event of any signs of driver fatigue,
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory. 247
irrespective of whether or not DAC issues a
warning.
NOTE
The function must not be used to extend a
period of driving. Always plan breaks at regu-
lar intervals, and make sure you are well
rested.
Limitation
In some cases the system may issue a warning
despite driving ability not deteriorating, for exam-
ple:
in strong side winds
on rutted road surfaces.
DAC is not intended for city traffic.
NOTE
The camera sensor has certain limitations,
see Collision warning system* - camera sen-
sor limitations (p. 235).
Related information
Driver Alert System* (p. 246)
Driver Alert Control (DAC)* - operation
(p. 247)
Driver Alert Control (DAC)* - symbols and
messages (p. 248)
Lane assistance* (p. 249)
Driver Alert Control (DAC)* -
operation
Settings are made from the centre console dis-
play screen and its menu system.
On/Off
The Driver Alert function can be set in standby
mode via the menu system MY CAR (p. 113):
Checked box - function activated.
Unchecked box - the function is deactivated.
Function
Driver Alert is activated when speed exceeds
65 km/h (40 mph) and remains active as long as
the speed is above 60 km/h (37 mph).
If the vehicle is being driven erratically,
the driver is notified by an acoustic sig-
nal plus the text message (p. 248)
Driver Alert Time for a break - the
linked symbol is illuminated in the combined
instrument panel at the same time. The warning
is repeated after a time if driving ability does not
improve.
The warning symbol can go off:
Press the left stalk switch OK button.
WARNING
An alarm should be taken very seriously, as a
sleepy driver is often not aware of his/her
own condition.
In the event of an alarm or a feeling of tired-
ness; stop the car in a safe manner as soon
as possible and rest.
Studies have shown that it is equally as dan-
gerous to drive while tired as it is under the
influence of alcohol.
Related information
Driver Alert System* (p. 246)
Driver Alert Control (DAC)* (p. 246)
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
248
Driver Alert Control (DAC)* -
symbols and messages
Driver Alert Control - DAC (p. 246) can show
symbols and text messages in the combined
instrument panel or in the centre console's
screen in different situations.
Here are some examples:
SymbolAMessage Specification
Driver Alert Time for a
break
The vehicle has been driven inconsistently - the driver is alerted by an acoustic warning signal + text.
Windscreen sensors
blocked See manual
The camera sensor is temporarily disengaged.
Shown in the event of snow, ice or dirt on the windscreen for example.
Clean the windscreen surface in front of the camera sensor.
Read about the limitations of the camera sensor, see Collision warning system* - camera sensor limitations
(p. 235).
Driver Alert system Serv-
ice required
The system is disengaged.
Visit a workshop if the message remains - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.
AThe symbols are schematic.
Related information
Driver Alert System* (p. 246)
Driver Alert Control (DAC)* - operation
(p. 247)
Lane assistance* (p. 249)
DRIVER SUPPORT
}}
* Option/accessory. 249
Lane assistance*
Lane Keeping Aid is one of the functions in the
Driver Alert System - sometimes also referred to
as LKA (Lane Keeping Aid).
The function is intended for use on motorways
and similar major roads in order to reduce the
risk of the vehicle accidentally leaving its own
lane in certain situations.
A camera reads the painted side lines of the
road/lane. If the car is about to cross a side line
then Lane Keeping Aid will actively steer the car
back into the lane with a slight steering torque in
the steering wheel.
If the car reaches or crosses a side line then
Lane Keeping Aid will also alert the driver with
vibration in the steering wheel.
WARNING
LKA is merely a driver's aid and does not
engage in all driving situations or traffic,
weather or road conditions.
The driver always bears ultimate responsibility
for ensuring that the vehicle is driven safely
and that applicable laws and road traffic regu-
lations are followed.
Related information
Lane Keeping Aid - function (p. 249)
Lane Keeping Aid - operation (p. 251)
Lane Keeping Aid - limitations (p. 251)
Lane Keeping Aid - symbols and messages
(p. 253)
Driver Alert System* (p. 246)
Lane Keeping Aid - function
Certain settings can be made for the Lane Keep-
ing Aid (Lane Keeping Aid) function.
Off & On
Lane Keeping Aid is active within the speed
range 65-200 km/h (40-125 mph) on roads with
clearly visible side lines. The function is temporar-
ily deactivated on narrow roads with less than 2.6
metres between the lane side lines.
Press the centre console's button to activate or
deactivate the function. The button's lamp illumi-
nates when the function is switched on.
Some combinations of the selected equipment
leave no vacant space for an On/Off button in
the centre console - in which case, the function
is instead operated in the car's menu system MY
CAR (p. 113). Here, proceed as follows:
||
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
250
Search for Lane Keeping Aid and then
select On or Off.
In addition, the following selections can be made
in MY CAR:
Warning with vibration in the steering wheel:
Vibration only - On or Off.
Active steering: Steering assist only- On or
Off.
Both Warning with vibration in the steering
wheel and Active steering: Full function -
On or Off.
Active steering
Lane Keeping Aid strives to keep the car within
the side lines for the lane.
LKA intervenes and steers away.
If the car approaches the left or right side line of
the lane and the direction indicator is not acti-
vated, the car is steered back into the lane.
Warning with vibration in the steering
wheel
LKA steers and alerts with steering wheel vibration31.
If the car crosses a side line then Lane Keeping
Aid will alert the driver with vibration in the steer-
ing wheel32. This occurs regardless of whether
the car is actively steered back by applying a
slight steering torque.
Dynamic cornering
LKA does not engage in sharp inside curves.
In certain cases Lane assistance will allow the
car to cross lane lines without engaging active
steering or activating a warning. Using an adja-
cent lane for cutting a corner when there is a
clear line of vision is an example of this.
Related information
Lane assistance* (p. 249)
31 The figure shows 3 vibrations when the side line is crossed.
32 Steering wheel vibration varies - the longer the time for which the car has crossed the side line, the more pulses there are.
DRIVER SUPPORT
}}
* Option/accessory. 251
Lane Keeping Aid - operation
Lane Keeping Aid is complemented in the com-
bined instrument panel with intuitive graphics in
different situations. Here are some examples:
NOTE
LKA is temporarily deactivated for as long as
the direction indicator is switched on.
LKA "sees" the following side lines.
If Lane Keeping Aid is active and detects/"sees"
the side lines, the LKA symbol indicates this with
WHITE lines.
GREY side line - Lane Keeping Aid does not
see a line on that side of the car.
LKA engages on the right side.
Lane Keeping Aid intervenes and steers away
from the side line - this is indicated with:
RED line for the side in question.
Related information
Lane assistance* (p. 249)
Lane Keeping Aid - limitations
Lane Keeping Aid's camera sensor has limita-
tions in a similar way to the human eye.
For more information, see Collision warning sys-
tem* - camera sensor limitations (p. 235) and
(p. 233).
NOTE
In certain demanding situations Lane assis-
tance may have difficulty assisting the driver
in the right way - in which case it is recom-
mended to deactivate the function.
Examples of such situations may be:
roadworks
winter road conditions
poor road surface
very sporty driving style
poor weather with reduced visibility.
Hands on the steering wheel
In order for Lane Keeping Aid to operate, the
driver must have his/her hands on the steering
wheel. LKA continually monitors this. If hands are
not detected on the steering wheel then a text
message is shown, prompting the driver to
actively steer the car.
If the driver does not follow the request to begin
steering then Lane Keeping Aid goes into
||
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
252
standby mode and will remain in this mode until
the driver begins to steer the car again.
Related information
Lane assistance* (p. 249)
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory. 253
Lane Keeping Aid - symbols and
messages
In situations where there is no Lane assistance
function, a symbol may be shown in the com-
bined instrument panel in combination with an
explanatory message - follow the recommenda-
tion given if appropriate.
Message examples:
Symbol Message Specification
Windscreen sensors
blocked See manual
The camera sensor is temporarily disengaged.
Shown in the event of snow, ice or dirt on the windscreen for example.
Clean the windscreen in front of the camera sensor.
Read about the limitations of the camera sensor, see Collision warning system* - camera sensor limitations
(p. 235) and (p. 233).
Lane Keeping Aid Service
required
The system is disengaged.
Visit a workshop if the message remains - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.
Lane Keeping Aid Inter-
rupted
LKA has been set to standby mode. The lines of the LKA symbol indicate when the function is active again.
Related information
Lane assistance* (p. 249)
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
254
Park Assist*
Parking assistance is used as an aid to parking.
An acoustic signal as well as symbols on the
centre console's display screen indicate the dis-
tance to the detected obstacle.
Parking assistance sound level can be adjusted
during the ongoing acoustic signal using the cen-
tre console's VOL knob or in the car's menu sys-
tem MY CAR, see MY CAR (p. 113).
Parking assistance is available in two variants:
Rear only
Both front and rear.
NOTE
Since a towbar is configured with the car's
electrical system, towbar protrusion is
included when the function measures the dis-
tance to an object behind the car.
WARNING
Parking assistance does not relinquish
the driver's own responsibility during
parking.
The sensors have blind spots where
obstacles cannot be detected.
Be aware of e.g. people and animals near
the car.
Related information
Park assist syst* - cleaning the sensors
(p. 257)
Park assist syst* - function (p. 254)
Park assist syst* - forward (p. 256)
Park assist syst* - fault indication (p. 257)
Park assist syst* - backward (p. 255)
Park assist camera (p. 258)
Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* (p. 262)
Park assist syst* - function
The parking assistance system is automatically
activated when the engine is started - the
switch's On/Off lamp is illuminated. If parking
assistance is switched off with the button, the
lamp goes out.
On/Off for the sensors for parking assistance and
CTA33.
The centre console's display screen shows an
overview of the relationship between the car and
detected obstacle.
33 Side warning, CTA (Cross Traffic Alert) (p. 240)
DRIVER SUPPORT
}}
* Option/accessory. 255
Display screen view - showing an obstacle left front and
right rear.
Marked sectors show which of the four sensor(s)
detected an obstacle. The closer to the car sym-
bol a selected sector box is, the shorter the dis-
tance between the car and a detected obstacle.
The frequency of the signal increases the shorter
the distance to an obstacle, in front of or behind
the car. Other sound from the audio system is
muted automatically.
When the distance is within 30 cm the tone is
constant and the active sensor's field nearest the
car is filled in. If the detected obstacle is within
the distance for the constant tone both behind
and in front of the car, then the tone sounds
alternately from the loudspeakers.
IMPORTANT
Objects e.g. chains, thin glossy poles or low
barriers may be in the "signal shadow" and
are then temporarily not detected by the sen-
sors - the pulsating tone may then unexpect-
edly stop instead of changing over to the
expected constant tone.
The sensors cannot detect high objects, such
as projecting loading docks.
In such situations, pay extra attention and
manoeuvre/reposition the car particularly
slowly or stop the current parking
manoeuvre - there may be a high risk of
damage to vehicles or other objects since
information from the sensors is not
always reliable in such situations.
Related information
Park Assist* (p. 254)
Park assist syst* - cleaning the sensors
(p. 257)
Park assist syst* - forward (p. 256)
Park assist syst* - fault indication (p. 257)
Park assist syst* - backward (p. 255)
Park assist camera (p. 258)
Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* (p. 262)
Park assist syst* - backward
Parking assistance is used as an aid to parking.
An acoustic signal as well as symbols on the
centre console's display screen indicate the dis-
tance to the detected obstacle.
The distance covered to the rear of the car is
about 1.5 metres. The acoustic signal for obsta-
cles behind comes from one of the rear loud-
speakers.
Rear parking assistance is activated when
reverse gear is engaged.
When reversing with e.g. a trailer on the towbar,
rear parking assistance is switched off automati-
cally - otherwise the sensors would react to the
trailer.
||
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
256
NOTE
When reversing with e.g. a trailer or bike car-
rier on the towbar - without Volvo genuine
trailer wiring - parking assistance may need to
be switched off manually in order that the
sensors do not react to them.
Related information
Park Assist* (p. 254)
Park assist syst* - cleaning the sensors
(p. 257)
Park assist syst* - function (p. 254)
Park assist syst* - forward (p. 256)
Park assist syst* - fault indication (p. 257)
Park assist camera (p. 258)
Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* (p. 262)
Park assist syst* - forward
Parking assistance is used as an aid to parking.
An acoustic signal as well as symbols on the
centre console's screen indicate distance to
detected obstacles.
The parking assistance system is automatically
activated when the engine is started - the
switch's On/Off lamp is illuminated. If parking
assistance is switched off with the button, the
lamp goes out.
The distance covered in front of the car is about
0.8 metres. The acoustic signal for obstacles in
front comes from one of the front loudspeakers.
Forward parking assistance is active up to
10 km/h (6 mph). If the Parking Assistance Sys-
tem is deactivated because the car is moving too
quickly - 11 km/h (7 mph) or above - the func-
tion is reactivated when the speed falls below 10
km/h (6 mph).
IMPORTANT
When auxiliary lamps are fitted: Remember
that these must not obscure the sensors - the
auxiliary lamps may then be perceived as an
obstacle.
Related information
Park Assist* (p. 254)
Park assist syst* - cleaning the sensors
(p. 257)
Park assist syst* - function (p. 254)
Park assist syst* - fault indication (p. 257)
Park assist syst* - backward (p. 255)
Park assist camera (p. 258)
Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* (p. 262)
DRIVER SUPPORT
}}
* Option/accessory. 257
Park assist syst* - fault indication
Parking assistance is used as an aid to parking.
An acoustic signal as well as symbols on the
centre console's display screen indicate the dis-
tance to the detected obstacle.
If the combined instrument panel's
information symbol illuminates with
constant glow and the text message
Park Assist System Service required is
shown then parking assistance is disengaged.
IMPORTANT
Under some circumstances, the parking sen-
sors can give false warning signals due to
external sound sources which emit the same
ultrasound frequencies as those with which
the system works.
Examples of such sources include horns, wet
tyres on asphalt, pneumatic brakes and
exhaust noises from motorcycles etc.
Related information
Park Assist* (p. 254)
Park assist syst* - cleaning the sensors
(p. 257)
Park assist syst* - function (p. 254)
Park assist syst* - forward (p. 256)
Park assist syst* - backward (p. 255)
Park assist camera (p. 258)
Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* (p. 262) Park assist syst* - cleaning the
sensors
Parking assistance is used as an aid to parking.
An acoustic signal as well as symbols on the
centre console's display screen indicate the dis-
tance to the detected obstacle.
The sensors for parking assistance must be
cleaned regularly to ensure that they work prop-
erly. Clean them with water and car shampoo.
Sensor location, front.
||
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
258
Sensor location, rear.
NOTE
Dirt, ice and snow covering the sensors will
reduce their function and may prevent meas-
urement.
Related information
Park Assist* (p. 254)
Park assist syst* - function (p. 254)
Park assist syst* - forward (p. 256)
Park assist syst* - fault indication (p. 257)
Park assist syst* - backward (p. 255)
Park assist camera (p. 258)
Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* (p. 262)
Park assist camera
The parking camera is an auxiliary system and is
activated when the reverse gear is selected.
The camera image is shown on the centre con-
sole's screen.
NOTE
Since a towbar is configured with the car's
electrical system, towbar protrusion is
included when the function measures the dis-
tance to an object behind the car.
WARNING
The parking camera is an aid and can
never replace the responsibilities of the
driver when reversing.
The camera has blind spots where obsta-
cles cannot be detected.
Be aware of people and animals near the
car.
Function and operation
Camera location next to the opening handle.
The camera shows what is behind the car and if
something appears from the sides.
The camera shows a wide area behind the car
and part of the bumper and any towbar.
Objects on the screen may appear to tilt slightly -
this is normal.
NOTE
Objects on the display screen may be closer
to the car than they appear to be on the
screen.
If another view is active then the parking camera
system takes over automatically and its camera
image is displayed on the screen.
DRIVER SUPPORT
}}
* Option/accessory. 259
When reverse gear is selected, two unbroken
lines are shown graphically which illustrate where
the car's rear wheels will roll with the current
steering wheel angle - this facilitates parallel
parking, reversing into tight spaces and for hitch-
ing a trailer. The car's approximate external
dimensions are illustrated by means of dashed
lines. The park assist lines can be deactivated -
see section Settings (p. 261).
If the car is also equipped with Parking assis-
tance sensors * (p. 254) then their information is
shown graphically as coloured areas in order to
illustrate the distance to detected obstacles, see
heading "Cars with reversing sensors" later in the
text.
The camera is active approx. 5 seconds after
reverse gear has been disengaged or until the
car's speed exceeds 10 km/h (6 mph) forward or
35 km/h (22 mph) backward.
Light conditions
The camera image is adjusted automatically
according to prevailing light conditions. Because
of this, the image may vary slightly in brightness
and quality. Poor light conditions can result in a
slightly reduced image quality.
NOTE
Keep the camera lens clear of dirt, snow and
ice to ensure optimum function. This is partic-
ularly important in poor light.
Park assist lines
Examples of how the park assist lines can be displayed
for the driver.
The lines on the screen are projected as if they
were at ground level behind the car and are
directly related to steering wheel movement,
which shows the driver the path the car will then
take - also when the car is turning.
NOTE
When reversing with a trailer which is not
connected electrically to the car, the lines
on the display show the route the car will
take - not the trailer.
The screen shows no lines when a trailer
is connected electrically to the car's elec-
trical system.
The parking camera is deactivated auto-
matically when towing a trailer if a Volvo
genuine trailer cable is used.
IMPORTANT
Remember that the display only shows the
area behind the car - so pay attention to the
sides and front of the car when turning the
steering while reversing.
||
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
260
Boundary lines
Different lines in the system.
Boundary line, free reversing zone
"Wheel tracks"
The dashed line (1) frames in a zone up to
about 1.5 m back from the bumper. It is also the
limit of the car's most protruding parts, such as
door mirrors and corners - also when the car is
turning.
The wide "wheel tracks" (2) between the side
lines indicate where the wheels will roll and can
extend about 3.2 m back from the bumper if no
obstacle is in the way.
Cars with reversing sensors*
Coloured areas (x 4 - one per sensor) show distance.
If the car is also equipped with Parking assis-
tance (p. 254) the distance is shown with col-
oured fields for each sensor that registers an
obstacle.
The colour of the areas changes with decreasing
distance to the obstacle - from light yellow to yel-
low, via orange to red.
Colour / paint Distance (metres)
Light yellow 0,7–1,5
Yellow 0,5–0,7
Orange 0,3–0,5
Red 0–0,3
Related information
Park assist camera - settings (p. 261)
Park assist camera - limitations (p. 262)
Park Assist* (p. 254)
Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* (p. 262)
DRIVER SUPPORT
}}
* Option/accessory. 261
Park assist camera - settings
Activate switched-off camera
If the camera function is switched off when
reverse gear is selected, it is activated in the fol-
lowing way:
Main source menu34.
1. Give one or two long presses on EXIT to
access the main source menu.
2. Turn to the "Camera" option with TUNE and
press OK/MENU.
3. In the following menu: - Turn to the desired
camera view with TUNE and press OK/
MENU - the screen shows the current cam-
era view.
Options*
Cars with the front camera option have a CAM
button on the climate panel.
Button location may vary depending on options for other
equipment.
Press CAM to activate the camera
- the screenshows the current camera view.
To change view between the reversing camera
and front camera:
Press CAM or turn TUNE.
Change setting
The default setting is that the camera is activated
when reverse gear is selected.
The settings for the parking camera can be
changed when the screen shows a camera view:
1. Press OK/MENU when a camera view is
shown - the screenchanges to a menu with
various options.
2. Turn to reach the desired option with TUNE.
3. Highlight the option by pressing OK/MENU
once and go back out with EXIT.
Towbar
The camera can be used to advantage when
hitching a trailer. A park assist line for the tow-
bar's intended "trajectory" toward the trailer can
be shown on the screen - exactly as for the
"wheel tracks".
A choice can be made between showing the
"wheel tracks" or the towbar's trajectory - both
options cannot be shown simultaneously.
1. Press OK/MENU when a camera view is
shown.
2. Turn to reach the Tow bar trajectory guide
line option with TUNE.
3. Highlight the option by pressing OK/MENU
once and go back out with EXIT.
34 See the Sensus Infotainment supplement for more information about the menu system.
||
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
262
Zoom
If precise manoeuvring is required then the cam-
era view can be zoomed in:
Press CAM or turn TUNE - repeated press/
turn changes back to the normal view.
If more options are available, they are in a loop
- press/turn until the desired camera view is
shown.
Related information
Park assist camera (p. 258)
Park assist camera - limitations (p. 262)
Park Assist* (p. 254)
Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* (p. 262)
Park assist camera - limitations
NOTE
Bicycle racks or other accessories mounted
on the back of the car may obscure the line of
sight of the camera.
To bear in mind
Pay attention to the possibility that, even if it only
looks like a relatively small part of the image is
obscured, it could be a relatively large sector that
is hidden from view. Obstacles could thereby go
undetected until they are very close to the car.
Keep the camera lens free from dirt, ice and
snow.
Clean the camera lens regularly with luke-
warm water and car shampoo - take care not
to scratch the lens.
Related information
Park assist camera (p. 258)
Park assist camera - settings (p. 261)
Park Assist* (p. 254)
Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* (p. 262)
Park Assist Pilot (PAP)*
The Park Assist Pilot (PAP – Park Assist Pilot)
helps the driver to park by first checking whether
a space is sufficiently large and then turning the
steering wheel and steering the car into the
space.
The combined instrument panel uses symbols,
graphics and text when elements are to be exe-
cuted.
The On/Off button is on the centre console.
NOTE
Since a towbar is configured with the car's
electrical system, towbar protrusion is
included when the function measures the dis-
tance to an object behind the car.
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory. 263
WARNING
PAP does not work in all situations but is
designed merely as a supplementary aid.
The driver always has the final responsibility
for driving the car in a safe manner and for
paying attention to the surroundings and
other road users approaching or passing
while parking.
Related information
Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* - function (p. 263)
Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* - operation (p. 264)
Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* - limitations
(p. 266)
Active Park Assist (PAP)* - symbols and
messages (p. 267)
Park assist camera (p. 258)
Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* - function
The combined instrument panel uses symbols,
graphics and text when elements are to be exe-
cuted.
NOTE
The PAP function measures the space and
steers the car - the driver's task is to:
keep a close watch around the car
follow the instructions in the combined
instrument panel
change gear (reverse/forward)
control and maintain a safe speed
brake and stop.
PAP can be activated if the following criteria are
met once the engine has been started:
The functions ABS35 or ESC36 must not
intervene when the PAP function is activated
- these can be activated in the event of e.g.
steep and slippery surfaces, see the sections
on Foot brake (p. 289) and Stability system
ESC (p. 186) for more information.
Trailers must not be connected to the car.
Speed must be lower than 50 km/h
(30 mph).
Principle for PAP.
The PAP function parks the car using the follow-
ing steps:
1. The function searches for a parking space
and measures it - during measurement,
speed must not exceed 30 km/h (20 mph).
2. The car is steered into the space during
reversing.
3. The car is positioned in the space by means
of driving forward/backward.
Related information
Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* (p. 262)
Park assist camera (p. 258)
35 (Anti-lock Braking System) - Anti-lock braking system.
36 (Electronic Stability Control) - Stability system.
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
264
Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* - operation
The driver is instructed about how PAP works by
means of simple, clear instructions in the com-
bined instrument panel - using both graphics and
text graphics and text message (p. 267).
NOTE
Remember that certain steering wheel posi-
tions may obstruct the combined instrument
panel's instructions when you turn it during
the parking manoeuvre.
1 - Searching and checking
measurements
NOTE
The PAP function measures the space and
steers the car - the driver's task is to:
keep a close watch around the car
follow the instructions in the combined
instrument panel
change gear (reverse/forward)
control and maintain a safe speed
brake and stop.
NOTE
The distance between the car and parking
spaces should be 0.5-1.5 metres while PAP
is searching for a parking space.
The PAP function searches for a parking space
and checks whether it is big enough. Proceed as
follows:
1. Activate PAP by pressing
this button and do not drive
faster than 30 km/h (20 mph).
2. Keep an eye on the combined instrument
panel and be prepared to stop the car when
the graphics and text message so request.
3. Stop the car when the graphics and text so
request.
NOTE
PAP searches the area for parking, displays
instructions and guides the car in on its pas-
senger side. But if required the car can also
be parked on the driver's side of the street:
Activate the direction indicator to the
driver's side - then the system searches
for a parking space on that side of the
car instead.
2 - Reversing in
During the Reversing step, PAP will steer the car
into the parking space. Proceed as follows:
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory. 265
1. Check that the area behind the car is clear,
then engage reverse gear.
2. Reverse slowly and carefully without touching
the steering wheel - and no faster than
7 km/h (4 mph).
3. Keep an eye on the combined instrument
panel and be prepared to stop the car when
the graphics and text message so request.
NOTE
Keep your hands away from the steering
wheel when the PAP function is acti-
vated.
Make sure that the steering wheel is not
hindered in any way and can rotate freely.
To achieve optimum results - wait until
the steering wheel is fully turned before
starting to drive backward/forward.
3 - Positioning
When the car has reversed into the parking
space, it must be straightened up and stopped.
1. Engage first gear or D position, wait until the
steering wheel has been turned, then drive
slowly forwards.
2. Stop the car when the graphics and text
message so request.
3. Engage reverse gear and drive backwards
slowly until the graphics and text message
tell you to stop.
The function is deactivated automatically and the
graphics and message show that parking is com-
plete. It may be necessary for the driver to correct
the positioning. Only the driver can determine
whether the car is properly parked.
IMPORTANT
The warning distance is shorter when the
sensors are used by PAP compared with
when Park Assist uses the sensors.
Related information
Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* (p. 262)
Park assist camera (p. 258)
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory.
266
Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* - limitations
The PAP sequence is stopped:
if the car is driven too quickly - above 7 km/h
(4 mph)
if the driver touches the steering wheel
if the ABS37 or ESC38 function is engaged -
e.g. if a wheel loses grip on a slippery road
surface.
A text message indicates where the PAP
sequence was stopped.
NOTE
Dirt, ice and snow covering the sensors will
reduce their function and may prevent meas-
urement.
IMPORTANT
Under certain circumstances, PAP is unable
to find parking spaces - one reason for this
may be the fact that there is interference with
the sensors from external sound sources
which emit the same ultrasound frequencies
as those with which the system works.
Examples of such sources include horns, wet
tyres on asphalt, pneumatic brakes and
exhaust noises from motorcycles etc.
To bear in mind
The driver should bear in mind that the Park
Assist Pilot is an aid – not an infallible, fully-auto-
matic function. The driver must therefore be pre-
pared to intervene. There are also a few details to
bear in mind while parking, e.g.:
PAP starts out from the current location of
the parked vehicles - if they are inappropri-
ately parked then the car's tyres and wheel
rims may be damaged against kerbs.
PAP is designed for parking on straight
streets - not sharp curves or bends. For this
reason, make sure the car is parallel to the
parking space when PAP measures the
space.
It is not always possible to find parking
spaces on narrow streets since there is not
enough space for manoeuvring. In such park-
ing situations, it helps the system to drive as
close to the side of the road as possible
where you intend to park.
Bear in mind that the front of the car may
swing out towards oncoming traffic while
being parked.
Objects situated higher than the detection
areas of the sensors are not included when
calculations are made for the parking
manoeuvre. This may cause PAP to swing
into the parking space too early, and hence
such parking spaces should be avoided.
The driver is responsible for determining
whether the space selected by PAP is suita-
ble for parking.
Use approved tyres39 with the correct tyre
pressure - this affects the ability of PAP to
park the car.
Heavy rain or snow may cause the system to
measure the parking space incorrectly.
Do not use PAP if snow chains or a spare
wheel are fitted.
Do not use PAP if loaded objects are pro-
truding from the car.
37 (Anti-lock Braking System) - Anti-lock braking system.
38 (Electronic Stability Control) - Stability and traction control system.
39 "Approved tyres" refers to tyres of the same type and make as those fitted new on delivery from the factory.
DRIVER SUPPORT
* Option/accessory. 267
IMPORTANT
Changing to another approved wheel rim
and/or tyre dimension may involve a changed
tyre circumference, which means that the
PAP system's parameters may then need to
be updated. Consult a workshop - an author-
ised Volvo workshop is recommended.
Maintenance
The PAP sensors are located in the bumpers40 - 6 front
and 4 rear.
For the PAP function to work correctly, its sen-
sors must be cleaned(p. 257) regularly with water
and car shampoo.
Related information
Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* (p. 262)
Park assist camera (p. 258)
Park assist syst* - cleaning the sensors
(p. 257)
Active Park Assist (PAP)* - symbols
and messages
The combined instrument panel can show differ-
ent combinations of symbols and text with varying
content - sometimes with a self-explanatory
piece of advice on appropriate action.
If a message says that the Park Assist Pilot is
disengaged, contact with an authorised Volvo
workshop is recommended.
Related information
Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* (p. 262)
Park assist camera (p. 258)
40 NOTE: The illustration is schematic - details may vary depending on car model.
STARTING AND DRIVING
STARTING AND DRIVING
* Option/accessory.
270
Starting the engine
The engine is started and switched off using the
remote control key and the START/STOP
ENGINE button.
Ignition switch with remote control key extracted/
inserted. and START/STOP ENGINE button.
IMPORTANT
Do not press in the remote control key incor-
rectly turned - Hold the end with the detacha-
ble key blade; see Detachable key blade -
detaching/attaching (p. 167)
1. Insert the remote control key in the ignition
switch and press it in to its end position.
2. Hold the clutch pedal fully depressed1. (For
cars with automatic gearbox - Depress the
brake pedal.)
3. Press the START/STOP ENGINE button
and then release it.
The starter motor works until the engine is
started or until its overheating protection triggers.
IMPORTANT
If the engine fails to start after 3 attempts -
wait for 3 minutes before making a further
attempt. Starting capacity increases if the bat-
tery is allowed to recover.
WARNING
Always remove the remote control key from
the ignition switch when leaving the car, and
make sure that the key position is 0 - in par-
ticular if there are children in the car. For
information on how this works, see Key posi-
tions (p. 80).
NOTE
The idling speed can be noticeably higher
than normal for certain engine types during
cold starting. This is done in order that the
emissions system can reach normal operating
temperature as quickly as possible, which
minimises exhaust emissions and protects the
environment.
Keyless starting (Keyless drive)*
Follow steps 2–3 for keyless (p. 169) starting of
petrol and diesel engines.
NOTE
A prerequisite for the engine to start is that
one of the car's remote control keys with the
keyless start and lock function is in the pas-
senger compartment or cargo area.
WARNING
Never remove the remote control key from
the car while driving or during towing.
Related information
Key positions (p. 80)
1If the car is moving then it is enough to press the START/STOP ENGINE button to start the car.
STARTING AND DRIVING
}}
271
Switching off the engine
The engine is switched off using the START/
STOP ENGINE button.
To switch off the engine:
Press the START/STOP ENGINE button -
the engine stops.
If the car has an automatic gearbox and the
gear selector is not in a position P or if the
car is moving - Press twice or hold the
START/STOP ENGINE button depressed
until the engine stops.
Related information
Key positions (p. 80)
Steering lock
The steering lock makes steering difficult if the
car is e.g. taken unlawfully. A mechanical noise
may be noticed when the steering lock unlocks
or locks.
Function
The steering lock is activated when the driv-
er's door is opened after the engine has
been switched off.
The steering lock is deactivated when the
remote control key is in the ignition switch2
and the START/STOP ENGINE button is
depressed.
Related information
Starting the engine (p. 270)
Key positions (p. 80)
Steering wheel (p. 87)
Jump starting
If the starter battery (p. 358) is discharged then
the car can be started with current from another
battery.
When jump starting the car, the following steps
are recommended to avoid short circuits or other
damage:
1. Set the car's electrical system in key position
0, see Key positions (p. 80).
2. Check that the donor battery has a voltage of
12 V.
3. If the donor battery is installed in another car
- switch off the donor car's engine and make
sure that the two cars do not touch each
other.
2In cars with keyless start and lock system it is enough to have a remote control key inside the passenger compartment.
||
STARTING AND DRIVING
272
4. Connect one of the red jump lead's clamps
to the donor battery's positive terminal (1).
IMPORTANT
Connect the start cable carefully to avoid
short circuits with other components in the
engine compartment.
5. Open the clips on the front cover of the bat-
tery in your car and remove the cover.
6. Connect the red jump lead's other clamp
onto the car's positive terminal (2).
7. Connect one of the black jump lead's clamps
to the donor battery's negative terminal (3).
8. Connect the other clamp to a grounding
point, e.g. right-hand engine mounting at the
top, the outer screw head (4).
9. Check that the jump lead clamps are affixed
securely so that there are no sparks during
the starting attempt.
10. Start the engine of the "donor car" and allow
it to run a few minutes at a speed slightly
higher than idle approx. 1500 rpm.
11. Start the engine in the car with the dis-
charged battery.
IMPORTANT
Do not touch the connections between cable
and car during the starting attempt - this
would involve a risk of sparks.
12. Remove the jump leads in reverse order -
first the black and then the red.
> Make sure that none of the black jump
lead's clamps comes into contact with the
battery's positive terminal or the clamp
connected to the red jump lead.
WARNING
The battery can generate oxyhydrogen
gas, which is highly explosive. A spark can
be formed if a jump lead is connected
incorrectly, and this can be enough for
the battery to explode.
The battery contains sulphuric acid, which
can cause serious burns.
If sulphuric acid comes into contact with
eyes, skin or clothing, flush with large
quantities of water. If acid splashes into
the eyes - seek medical attention imme-
diately.
Related information
Starting the engine (p. 270)
STARTING AND DRIVING
273
Gearboxes
There are two main types of gearbox - Manual
and Automatic.
Manual gearbox (p. 273)
Automatic gearbox, Geartronic (p. 274)
IMPORTANT
To prevent damage to any drive system com-
ponents, the working temperature of the
gearbox is checked. If there is a risk of over-
heating, a warning symbol in the combined
instrument panel lights up and a text mes-
sage is shown. Follow the recommendation
given in the text message.
Manual gearbox
The function of the gearbox is to change the
gear ratio depending on speed and power
requirements.
Gearing pattern.
The manual gearbox has 6 gears, the shifting
pattern is imprinted on the gear lever.
Depress the clutch pedal fully during each
gear change.
Take your foot off the clutch pedal between
gear changes.
WARNING
Always apply the parking brake when parking
on a slope - leaving the car in gear is not suf-
ficient to hold the car in all situations.
Reverse gear inhibitor
The reverse gear inhibitor hinders the possibility
of mistakenly attempting to engage reverse gear
during normal forward travel.
Follow the gearing pattern printed on the
gear lever and start from neutral position, N
before moving it to R position.
Engage reverse gear only when the car is
stationary.
Related information
Transmission fluid - grade and volume
(p. 393)
Gearboxes (p. 273)
STARTING AND DRIVING
* Option/accessory.
274
Gear shift indicator*
The gear shift indicator notifies the driver when it
is appropriate to engage the next higher or lower
gear in order to obtain the lowest possible fuel
consumption.
An essential detail in connection with environ-
mental driving is to drive in the right gear and to
change gear in plenty of time.
An indicator is available as an aid on some vari-
ants - GSI (Gear Shift Indicator) - which notifies
the driver when it is appropriate to engage the
next higher or lower gear in order to obtain the
lowest possible fuel consumption. However, tak-
ing into consideration characteristics such as
performance and vibration-free running, it may be
advantageous to change gear at a higher engine
speed.
Manual gearbox
Gear shift indicator for manual
gearbox. Only one marker is
illuminated at a time - it is illu-
minated in the centre only dur-
ing normal driving.
At the recommended upshift
the cursor illuminates "+", and at the recom-
mended downshift the cursor illuminates "-"
(marked red in the illustration).
Automatic gearbox
Combined instrument panel "Digital" with gear
shift indicator.
The framed number indicates the current gear.
With "Analogue" combined
instrument panel, the gear
positions and indicator arrows
are displayed in its centre.
Related information
Manual gearbox (p. 273)
Automatic gearbox - Geartronic* (p. 274)
Automatic gearbox - Geartronic*
The automatic gearbox Geartronic has a
hydraulic torque converter that transfers power
from engine to gearbox. It has two different gear
modes - Automatic and Manual.
D: Automatic gear positions. +/–: Manual gear positions.
S: Sport mode*.3
The combined instrument panel shows the posi-
tion of the gear selector using the following indi-
cations: P, R, N, D, S*, 1, 2, 3 etc.
Gear positions
Automatic gear positions are
indicated on the right of the
combined instrument panel.
(Only one marker is illuminated
at a time - the one showing the
current gear selector position.)
3The gear lever's gearshift pattern varies depending on engine option.
STARTING AND DRIVING
}}
275
Symbol "S" for Sport mode is ORANGE when the
mode is active.
P – Parking position
Select P when starting the engine or when the
car is parked.
To be able to move the gear selector from the P
position, the brake pedal must be depressed and
the key position (p. 81) must be II.
The gearbox is mechanically blocked when the P
position is engaged. Also apply the parking brake
when the car is parked, see Parking brake
(p. 291).
NOTE
The gear selector must be in P position to
allow the car to be locked and alarmed.
IMPORTANT
The car must be stationary when position P is
selected.
WARNING
Always apply the parking brake when parking
on a slope - the automatic transmission in P
is not sufficient to hold the car in all situa-
tions.
R – Reverse
The car must be stationary when position R is
selected.
N – Neutral
No gear is engaged and the engine can be
started. Apply the parking brake if the car is sta-
tionary with the gear selector in position N.
In order to be able to move the gear selector
from the N position to another gear position, the
brake pedal must be depressed and the key posi-
tion (p. 81) must be II.
D – Drive
D is the normal driving position. Shifting up and
down takes place automatically based on the
level of acceleration and speed. The car must be
stationary when the gear selector is moved to
position D from position R.
Geartronic – Manual gear positions
(+/-)
The driver can also change gear manually using
the Geartronic automatic gearbox. The car
engine-brakes when the accelerator pedal is
released.
The manual gear position is reached by moving
the lever to the side from position D to the end
position at "+/-". The combined instrument pan-
el's symbol "+/-" changes colour from WHITE to
ORANGE and the digits 1, 2, 3 etc. are displayed
in a box which corresponds to the gear that has
just been selected.
Move the lever forwards towards + (plus) to
change up a gear and release the lever,
which returns to its neutral position between
"+" and "".
or
Pull the lever back towards "" (minus) to
change down a gear and release it.
The manual gearshift mode "+/-" can be
selected at any time while driving.
Geartronic automatically shifts down if the driver
allows the speed to decrease lower than a level
suitable for the selected gear, in order to avoid
jerking and stalling.
To return to automatic driving mode:
Move the lever to the side to the end position
at D.
NOTE
f the gearbox has a Sport programme then
the gearbox will only become manual after the
lever has been moved forwards or backwards
in its "+/-" position. The combined instrument
panel then shifts the indication from S to
show which of the gears 1, 2, 3 etc. is
engaged.
||
STARTING AND DRIVING
* Option/accessory.
276
Paddles*
As a supplement to manual gear changing with
the gear selector there are also controls located
on the steering wheel, so-called "paddles".
To be able to change gear with the steering
wheel paddles they must first be activated. This is
by means of pulling one of the paddles toward
the steering wheel - the combined instrument
panel then changes indication from "D" to a fig-
ure, which indicates the current gear.
To then change gear one step:
Pull one of the paddles backwards - towards
the steering wheel - and release.
Both steering wheel "paddles".
"-": Selects the next lower gear.
"+": Selects the next higher gear.
A gear change occurs at each pull of the paddle
provided that the engine speed does not leave
the permitted range.
After each gear change the combined instrument
panel changes figure to show the current gear.
NOTE
Automatic deactivation
If the steering wheel paddles are not used
then they are deactivated after a short time -
this is indicated when the combined instru-
ment panel switches indication, from the fig-
ure for the current gear back to "D".
The exception is during engine braking - then
the paddles are activated as long as engine
braking is in progress.
Manual deactivation
The steering wheel paddle shifters can also
be deactivated manually:
Pull both paddles toward the steering
wheel and hold until the combined instru-
ment panel changes character from the
figure for the current gear to "D".
The paddles can also be used with the gear
selector in Sport mode* - then the paddles are
constantly activated without being deactivated.
Geartronic - Sport mode (S)
The Sport programme provides sportier
characteristics and allows higher
engine speed for the gears. At the
same time it responds more quickly to
acceleration. During active driving, the use of a
lower gear is prioritised, leading to a delayed
upshift.
To activate Sport mode:
Move the gear selector to the side from D
position to the end position at "+S–" - the
combined instrument panel changes indica-
tion from D to S.
Sport mode can be selected at any time while
driving.
Geartronic - Winter mode
It can be easier to pull away on slippery roads if
3rd gear is engaged manually.
1. Depress the brake pedal and move the gear
selector from D position to the end position
at "+/–" - the combined instrument panel
shifts the indication from D to the figure 14.
2. Scroll up to gear 3 by pushing the lever for-
ward towards "+" (plus) twice - the combined
instrument panel shifts the indication from 1
to 3.
3. Release the brake and accelerate carefully.
4If the car has Sport mode* then "S" is shown first.
STARTING AND DRIVING
}}
277
The gearbox "winter mode" means that the car
moves off with a lower engine speed and
reduced engine power on the drive wheels.
Kick-down
When the accelerator pedal is pressed all the
way to the floor (beyond the position normally
regarded as full acceleration) a lower gear is
immediately engaged. This is known as kick-
down.
If the accelerator is released from the kick-down
position, the gearbox automatically changes up.
Kick-down is used when maximum acceleration
is needed, such as for overtaking.
Safety function
To prevent overrevving the engine, the gearbox
control program has a protective downshift inhibi-
tor which prevents the kick-down function.
Geartronic does not permit downshifting/kick-
down which would result in an engine speed high
enough to damage the engine. Nothing happens
if the driver still tries to shift down in this way at
high engine speed – the original gear remains
engaged.
When kick-down is activated the car can change
one or more gears at a time depending on
engine speed. The car changes up when the
engine reaches its maximum speed in order to
prevent damage to the engine.
Towing
If the car has to be towed - see important infor-
mation in the section Towing (p. 310).
Related information
Transmission fluid - grade and volume
(p. 393)
Gearboxes (p. 273)
Gear selector inhibitor
There are two different types of gear selector
inhibitor - mechanical and automatic.
Mechanical gear selector inhibitor
G021351
The gear selector can be moved forward and
back freely between N and D. Other positions are
locked with a latch that is released with the inhib-
itor button on the gear selector.
With the inhibitor button depressed the lever can
be moved forwards or backwards between P, R,
N and D.
Automatic gear selector inhibitor
The automatic gearbox has special safety sys-
tems:
Parking position (P)
Stationary car with engine running:
||
STARTING AND DRIVING
* Option/accessory.
278
Keep your foot on the brake pedal when
moving the gear selector to another position.
Electric gear inhibitor – Shiftlock
Parking position (P)
In order to be able to move the gear selector
from P to other gear positions, the brake pedal
must be depressed and the key position (p. 81)
must be II.
Shiftlock – Neutral (N)
If the gear selector is in the N position and the
car has been stationary for at least 3 seconds
(irrespective of whether the engine is running)
then the gear selector is locked.
In order to be able to move the gear selector
from the N position to another gear position, the
brake pedal must be depressed and the key posi-
tion (p. 81) must be II.
Deactivate automatic gear selector
inhibitor
If the car cannot be driven, e.g. due to a flat bat-
tery, the gear selector must be moved from the P
position so that the car can be moved.
Lift out the contoured insert in the compart-
ment behind the centre console and locate a
spring-loaded button in the bottom of the
compartment.
Press and hold the button.
Move the gear selector from the P position
and release the button.
4. Refit the storage compartment insert.
Related information
Automatic gearbox - Geartronic* (p. 274)
Hill start assist (HSA)*
The foot brake can be released before setting
off or reversing uphill - the HSA (Hill Start
Assist) function means that the car does not roll
backwards.
The function means that the pedal pressure in
the brake system remains for several seconds
while the driver's foot is moved from brake pedal
to accelerator pedal.
The temporary braking effect releases after sev-
eral seconds or when the driver accelerates.
Related information
Starting the engine (p. 270)
STARTING AND DRIVING
}}
* Option/accessory. 279
Start/Stop*
Some engine and gearbox combinations come
fitted with a Start/Stop function which engages
in the event of e.g. stationary traffic or waiting at
traffic lights - the engine is then switched off
temporarily and restarts automatically when the
journey is due to continue.
Environmental care is one of Volvo Car Corpora-
tion's core values and it influences all of our
operations. This target orientation has resulted in
several separate energy-saving functions of
which Start/Stop is one, all with the collective
task of reducing fuel consumption, which in turn
helps to reduce exhaust emissions.
General information on Start/Stop
The engine is switched off - it becomes quieter and
cleaner...
The Start/Stop function gives the driver the
opportunity for a more active environmentally
conscious way of driving the car by means of
being able to allow the engine to stop automati-
cally, whenever appropriate.
The car's menu system MY CAR (p. 113) under
heading Drive-E contains information on Volvo's
Start/Stop system, as well as recommendations
for energy-saving driving techniques.
Manual or automatic gearbox
Note that there are differences in the Start/Stop
function depending on whether the gearbox is
manual or automatic.
Related information
Start/Stop* - function and operation (p. 279)
Starting the engine (p. 270)
Start/Stop* - the engine does not auto-start
(p. 283)
Start/Stop* - the engine auto-starts (p. 282)
Start/Stop* - the engine does not stop
(p. 281)
Start/Stop* - involuntary stop manual gear-
box (p. 284)
Start/Stop* - symbols and messages
(p. 285)
Battery - Start/Stop (p. 361)
Start/Stop* - function and operation
The Start/Stop function is activated automati-
cally when the engine is started with the key.
The Start/Stop function is acti-
vated automatically when the
engine is started with the key.
The driver is made aware of the
function by the function's
On/Off button symbol lighting
up in the combined instrument
panel and the On/Off button
lamp illuminating.
All of the car's normal systems
such as lighting, radio, etc. work as normal even
with an engine that has stopped automatically,
except that some equipment may have the func-
tion temporarily reduced, e.g. the climate control
system's fan speed or extremely high volume on
the audio system.
Auto-stopping the engine
The following is required for the engine to auto-
stop:
||
STARTING AND DRIVING
280
Conditions M/AA
Declutch, set the gear lever in neutral
position and release the clutch pedal -
the engine stops automatically.
M
Stop the car with the foot brake and
then keep your foot on the pedal - the
engine stops automatically.
A
AM = Manual gearbox, A = Automatic gearbox.
If the ECO function is activated
then the engine may auto-stop
before the car is completely
stationary.
For certain engine variants the engine may auto-
stop before the car is stationary regardless of
whether the ECO function is activated.
When the engine is auto-stopped, the
combined instrument panel's symbol
for the Start/Stop function illuminates.
Auto-starting the engine
Conditions M/A
A
With the gear lever in neutral position:
1. Depress the clutch pedal or press
the accelerator pedal - the engine
starts.
2. Engage a suitable gear and drive.
M
Release the foot pressure on the foot
brake - the engine starts automatically
and the journey can continue.
A
Maintain foot pressure on the foot
brake and depress the accelerator
pedal - the engine auto-starts.
A
The following option is also available on
a downhill gradient:
Release the foot brake and let the
car move off - the engine starts
automatically when the speed
exceeds normal walking pace.
M +
A
AM = Manual gearbox, A = Automatic gearbox.
Deactivating the Start/Stop function
In certain situations, it may
advisable to temporarily switch
off the automatic Start/Stop
function - this is carried out
with a push of this button.
Disengaged function is indicated by
the combined instrument panel's
Start/Stop symbols and the button's
lamp extinguishing.
The Start/Stop function is disengaged until it is
reactivated with the button or until the next time
the engine is started with the key.
Start assistance HSA
The foot brake can also be released on an uphill
slope to auto-start the engine - the HSA (p. 278)
(Hill Start Assist) function prevents the car from
rolling backwards.
HSA means that the pressure in the brake sys-
tem remains temporarily available while the driv-
er's foot is moved from the brake pedal to the
accelerator pedal for driving off with the engine
having stopped automatically. The temporary
braking effect releases after a couple of seconds
or when the driver accelerates.
STARTING AND DRIVING
}}
* Option/accessory. 281
Related information
Start/Stop* (p. 279)
Starting the engine (p. 270)
Start/Stop* - the engine does not auto-start
(p. 283)
Start/Stop* - the engine auto-starts (p. 282)
Start/Stop* - the engine does not stop
(p. 281)
Start/Stop* - involuntary stop manual gear-
box (p. 284)
Start/Stop* - symbols and messages
(p. 285)
Battery - Start/Stop (p. 361)
Start/Stop* - the engine does not
stop
Although the Start/Stop function is activated, the
engine does not always stop automatically.
The engine does not auto-stop if:
Conditions M/AA
the car has not first achieved
approx. 10 km/h (6 mph) after a key
start or the last auto-stop.
M +
A
the driver has opened the seatbelt's
buckle.
M +
A
the capacity of the starter battery is
below the minimum permissible level.
M +
A
the engine does not have normal
operating temperature.
M +
A
ambient temperature is around freez-
ing point or above approx. 30 °C.
M +
A
the windscreen's electric heating is
activated.
M +
A
the environment in the passenger
compartment differs from the preset
valuesB - indicated by the ventilation
fan running at a high speed.
M +
A
the car is reversed. M +
A
Conditions M/AA
the starter battery's temperature is
below freezing point or too high.
M +
A
the driver makes greater steering
wheel movements.
M +
A
the exhaust system's particulate filter
is full - the temporarily disengaged
Start/Stop function is reactivated as
soon as an automatic cleaning cycle
has been performed (see Diesel parti-
cle filter (DPF) (p. 300)).
M +
A
the road is very steep. M +
A
a trailer is connected electrically to the
car’s electrical system.
M +
A
the bonnet has been openedC.M +
A
the gearbox does not have normal
operating temperature.
A
the atmospheric air pressure is less
than equivalent to 1500-2500 metres
above sea level - the current air pres-
sure varies with the prevailing weather
conditions.
A
||
STARTING AND DRIVING
* Option/accessory.
282
Conditions M/AA
adaptive cruise control Queue Assist
is activated.
A
the gear selector is moved out of the
D position to R, S positionD or "+/-".
A
AM = Manual gearbox, A = Automatic gearbox.
BCar with ECC.
CWith certain engines only.
DSport mode.
Related information
Start/Stop* (p. 279)
Start/Stop* - function and operation (p. 279)
Starting the engine (p. 270)
Start/Stop* - the engine does not auto-start
(p. 283)
Start/Stop* - the engine auto-starts (p. 282)
Start/Stop* - involuntary stop manual gear-
box (p. 284)
Start/Stop* - symbols and messages
(p. 285)
Battery - Start/Stop (p. 361)
Start/Stop* - the engine auto-starts
An auto-stopped engine may restart in certain
cases without the driver having decided that the
journey should continue.
In the following cases the engine also starts
automatically if the driver has not depressed the
clutch pedal (manual gearbox) or takes his/her
foot off the brake pedal (automatic gearbox):
Conditions M/AA
Misting forms on the windows. M + A
The environment in the passenger
compartment deviates from the preset
valuesB.
M + A
There is a temporarily high current
take-off or battery capacity drops
below the lowest permissible level.
M + A
Repeated pumping of the brake
pedal.
M + A
The bonnet is openedC.M + A
The car starts to roll, or there is a
small increase in speed if the car
auto-stopped without being com-
pletely stationary.
M + A
The driver's seatbelt buckle is opened
with the gear selector in D or N posi-
tion.
A
Conditions M/AA
Steering wheel movementsC.A
The gear selector is moved out of the
D position to S positionD, R or "+/-".
A
The driver's door is opened with the
gear selector in D position - a "ping"
sound and text message inform that
the Start/Stop function is active.
A
AM = Manual gearbox, A = Automatic gearbox.
BCar with ECC.
CWith certain engines only.
DSport mode.
WARNING
Do not open the bonnet when the engine has
stopped automatically - the engine may sud-
denly start automatically. First switch off the
engine as normal using the START/STOP
ENGINE button before opening the bonnet.
Related information
Start/Stop* - function and operation (p. 279)
Starting the engine (p. 270)
Start/Stop* - the engine does not auto-start
(p. 283)
Start/Stop* - the engine does not stop
(p. 281)
Start/Stop* - involuntary stop manual gear-
box (p. 284)
STARTING AND DRIVING
* Option/accessory. 283
Start/Stop* - symbols and messages
(p. 285)
Battery - Start/Stop (p. 361)
Start/Stop* (p. 279)
Start/Stop* - the engine does not
auto-start
The engine does not always auto-start after hav-
ing auto-stopped.
In the following cases the engine does not auto-
start after having auto-stopped:
Conditions M/A
A
A gear is engaged without declutching
- a display text prompts the driver to
set the gear lever in neutral position in
order to enable automatic starting.
M
The driver is unrestrained. M
The driver is unrestrained, the gear
selector is in P position and the driver’s
door is open - a normal engine start
must take place.
A
AM = Manual gearbox, A = Automatic gearbox.
Related information
Start/Stop* (p. 279)
Start/Stop* - function and operation (p. 279)
Starting the engine (p. 270)
Start/Stop* - the engine auto-starts (p. 282)
Start/Stop* - the engine does not stop
(p. 281)
Start/Stop* - involuntary stop manual gear-
box (p. 284)
Start/Stop* - symbols and messages
(p. 285)
Battery - Start/Stop (p. 361)
STARTING AND DRIVING
* Option/accessory.
284
Start/Stop* - involuntary stop
manual gearbox
If a start-up fails and the engine stops, proceed
in accordance with the below:
1. Check that the driver side's seatbelt is locked
in the seatbelt buckle.
2. Depress the clutch pedal again - the engine
starts automatically.
3. In certain cases the gear lever must be set in
neutral position. The combined instrument
panel then shows the text Put gear in
neutral.
Related information
Start/Stop* (p. 279)
Start/Stop* - function and operation (p. 279)
Starting the engine (p. 270)
Start/Stop* - the engine does not auto-start
(p. 283)
Start/Stop* - the engine auto-starts (p. 282)
Start/Stop* - the engine does not stop
(p. 281)
Start/Stop* - symbols and messages
(p. 285)
Battery - Start/Stop (p. 361)
STARTING AND DRIVING
}}
* Option/accessory. 285
Start/Stop* - symbols and
messages
The Start/Stop function can show text messages
in the combined instrument panel.
Text message
In combination with this indicator lamp
the Start/Stop function may display
text messages in the combined instru-
ment panel for certain situations. For some of
them there is a recommended action that should
be performed. The following table shows some
examples.
Symbol Message Info/Action M/AA
Auto Start/Stop Service
required
Start/Stop is not operational. Contact a workshop - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. M + A
Autostart Engine running +
acoustic signal
Activated if the driver's door is opened with auto-stopped engine and the gear selector in D posi-
tion.
A
Press start button The engine will not start automatically - start the engine as normal with the START/STOP ENGINE
button.
M + A
Depress clutch pedal to start The engine is ready to auto-start - waiting for the clutch pedal to be depressed. M
Depress brake and clutch
pedals to start
The engine is ready to auto-start - waiting for the brake or clutch pedal to be depressed. M
Put gear in neutral to start Gear is engaged without declutching - disengage and set the gear lever in neutral position. M
||
STARTING AND DRIVING
* Option/accessory.
286
Symbol Message Info/Action M/AA
Select P or N to start Start/Stop has been deactivated - move the gear selector to N or P position and start the engine
as normal with the START/STOP ENGINE button.
A
Press start button The engine will not start automatically - start the engine as normal with the START/STOP ENGINE
button and the gear selector in P or N.
A
AM = Manual gearbox, A = Automatic gearbox.
If a message does not go out following comple-
tion of the action then a workshop should be
contacted - an authorised Volvo workshop is rec-
ommended.
Related information
Start/Stop* (p. 279)
Start/Stop* - function and operation (p. 279)
Starting the engine (p. 270)
Start/Stop* - the engine does not auto-start
(p. 283)
Start/Stop* - the engine auto-starts (p. 282)
Start/Stop* - the engine does not stop
(p. 281)
Start/Stop* - involuntary stop manual gear-
box (p. 284)
Battery - Start/Stop (p. 361)
STARTING AND DRIVING
}}
* Option/accessory. 287
Drive mode ECO*
ECO5 is an innovative Volvo function for auto-
matic-gearbox cars, capable of reducing fuel
consumption by up to 5%, depending on the
driver's driving style. The function gives the driver
the option of a more active environmentally con-
scious way of driving.
General
The following are changed
upon activation of the ECO
function:
Gearbox gearshift points.
Engine management and response from the
accelerator pedal.
Start/Stop function - the engine can also
auto-stop before the car has stopped down
to being completely stationary.
The Eco Coast function is activated - engine
braking ceases.
Climate control system settings - some elec-
tricity consumers are deactivated or operate
at reduced power.
NOTE
When the ECO function is activated, several
parameters in the climate control system's
settings are changed, and several electricity
consumer functions are reduced. Certain set-
tings can be reset manually, but full function-
ality is only restored by deactivating the ECO
function.
ECO - Operation
ECO On/Off
ECO symbol
The ECO function is deactivated when the engine
is switched off, and must therefore be activated
after each time the engine is started. There are
exceptions for certain engines. However, it is
easily verified by means of both the combined
instrument panel's ECO symbol and the ECO-
button's lamp illuminating when the function is
activated.
ECO function On or Off
Disengaged ECO function is
indicated by the combined
instrument panel ECO symbol
and the ECO button lamp extin-
guishing. The function is then
switched off until it is reactiva-
ted with the ECO button.
Eco Coast - Function
The Eco Coast subfunction means in practice
that engine braking is deactivated, meaning in
turn that the car's kinetic energy is used to coast
for longer distances. When the driver releases
the accelerator pedal the gearbox is automatically
disengaged from the engine whose speed is
reduced to idling speed with minimum consump-
tion.
This function is intended for use in the event of
an anticipated reduction in speed, e.g. to coast
into a zone with a lower speed limit.
Eco Coast enables proactive driving where the
driver can use the so-called "Pulse & Glide"
technique and a minimum of braking.
5Not possible on the V40 CROSS COUNTRY with AWD.
||
STARTING AND DRIVING
288
A combination of Eco Coast and temporarily
deactivated ECO function can also collectively
contribute to reduced consumption. Accordingly:
Active Eco Coast: Long coasting without
engine braking = Low consumption
and
Deactivated ECO function: Short coasting
with engine braking = Minimum consump-
tion.
NOTE
However, to achieve optimal low fuel con-
sumption, Eco Coast in combination with
short coasting distances should generally be
avoided.
Activating Eco Coast
The function is activated when the accelerator
pedal is fully released, in combination with the
following parameters:
ECO button activated
Gear selector in D position
Speed within the range of
approx. 65-140 km/h (40-87 mph)
The road's downhill gradient is not steeper
than approx. 6%.
Deactivate Eco Coast
In certain situations it may be desirable to deacti-
vate the Eco Coast function. Examples of such
situations include:
on steep downhill gradients - to be able to
use engine braking.
before an imminent overtaking manoeuvre -
in order to be able to complete it in the saf-
est possible way.
Deactivating Eco Coast and returning to engine
braking can be performed as follows:
Press the ECO button.
Move the gear lever to manual "S+/-" posi-
tion.
Change gear with the steering wheel paddle
shifters.
Actuate the accelerator or brake pedal.
Eco Coast - Limitations
The function is not available if:
cruise control is activated
the road's downhill gradient is steeper than
approx. 6%
manual gear changing is performed with the
steering wheel paddle shifters*
engine and/or gearbox are not at normal
operating temperature
the gear selector is moved from D- to "S+/-"
position
speed is outside the range of
approx. 65-140 km/h (40-87 mph).
More information and settings
The car's menu system MY CAR contains further
information on the ECO concept - see the sec-
tion MY CAR (p. 113).
Related information
General information on climate control
(p. 126)
STARTING AND DRIVING
}}
* Option/accessory. 289
Foot brake
The foot brake is used to reduce the car's speed
while driving.
The car is equipped with two brake circuits. If a
brake circuit is damaged then the brake pedal will
engage deeper and a higher pressure on the
pedal is needed to produce the normal braking
effect.
The driver's brake pedal pressure is assisted by a
brake servo.
WARNING
The brake servo only works when the engine
is running.
If the brake is used when the engine is switched
off then the pedal will feel stiff and more force
must be used to brake the car.
For cars with the Hill start assist (HSA)* (p. 278)*
function, the pedal returns more slowly than
usual to normal position if the car is parked on a
gradient or on an uneven surface.
In very hilly terrain or when driving with a heavy
load the brakes can be relieved by using engine
braking. Engine braking is most efficiently used if
the same gear is used downhill as up.
For more general information on heavy loads on
the car, Engine oil - adverse driving conditions
(p. 389).
Braking on wet roads
When driving for a long time in heavy rain without
braking, the braking effect may be delayed
slightly when next using the brakes. This may
also be the case after a car wash. It is then nec-
essary to depress the brake harder. For this rea-
son, maintain a greater distance to the traffic
ahead.
Brake the car firmly after driving on wet roads
and after a car wash. The brake discs are then
warmed up, dry more quickly and are protected
against corrosion. Take the prevailing traffic sit-
uation into account when braking.
Braking on salted roads
When driving on salted roads a layer of salt may
form on the brake discs and brake linings. This
may extend braking distance. For this reason,
keep an extra-large safety distance to the vehicle
ahead. Also make sure of the following:
Brake occasionally to remove any layer of
salt. Make sure that other road users are not
put at risk by the braking.
Gently depress the brake pedal when driving
is finished and before the next journey starts.
Maintenance
To keep the car as safe and reliable as possible,
follow the Volvo service intervals as specified in
the Service and Warranty Booklet.
New and replacement brake linings and brake
discs only provide optimal brake performance
after a few hundred kilometres after "wearing-in".
Compensate for the reduced brake performance
by depressing the brake pedal harder. Volvo rec-
ommends only fitting brake linings that are
approved for your Volvo.
IMPORTANT
The wear on the brake system's components
must be checked regularly.
Contact a workshop for information about the
procedure or engage a workshop to carry out
the inspection - an authorised Volvo work-
shop is recommended.
Symbols in the combined instrument
panel
Symbol Specification
Constant glow – Check the brake
fluid level. If the level is low, fill with
brake fluid and check for the cause
of the brake fluid loss.
Constant glow for 2 seconds when
the engine is started – automatic
function check.
||
STARTING AND DRIVING
290
WARNING
If and illuminate at the same
time, there may be a fault in the brake system.
If the level in the brake fluid reservoir is nor-
mal at this stage, drive carefully to the nearest
workshop and have the brake system checked
- an authorised Volvo workshop is recom-
mended.
If the brake fluid is below the MIN level in the
brake fluid reservoir, do not drive further
before topping up the brake fluid.
The reason for the loss of brake fluid must be
investigated.
Related information
Parking brake (p. 291)
Foot brake - emergency brake lights and
automatic hazard warning flashers (p. 290)
Foot brake - emergency brake assistance
(p. 291)
Foot brake - anti-lock braking system
(p. 290)
Foot brake - anti-lock braking
system
The anti-lock braking system, ABS (Anti-lock
Braking System), prevents the wheels from lock-
ing up during braking.
The function allows the steering ability to be
maintained, and it is easier to swerve to avoid a
hazard for example. Vibration may be felt in the
brake pedal when this is engaged and this is nor-
mal.
A short test of the ABS system is made automat-
ically after the engine has been started when the
driver releases the brake pedal. A further auto-
matic test of the ABS system may be made at
low speed. The test may be experienced as pul-
ses in the brake pedal.
Related information
Foot brake (p. 289)
Parking brake (p. 291)
Foot brake - emergency brake lights and
automatic hazard warning flashers (p. 290)
Foot brake - emergency brake assistance
(p. 291)
Foot brake - emergency brake lights
and automatic hazard warning
flashers
Emergency brake lights are activated to alert
vehicles behind about heavy braking. The func-
tion means that the brake light flashes instead of
- as in normal braking - shining with a constant
glow.
Emergency brake lights are activated at speeds
above 50 km/h (31 mph) if the ABS system is
working and/or in the event of heavy braking.
After the car's speed has been slowed below
10 km/h (6 mph) the brake light returns from
flashing to the normal constant glow - while at
the same time the hazard warning flashers(p. 99)
are activated, and they flash until the driver accel-
erates the car to at least 20 km/h (12 mph) or
they are deactivated with their button.
Related information
Foot brake (p. 289)
Parking brake (p. 291)
Foot brake - emergency brake assistance
(p. 291)
Foot brake - anti-lock braking system
(p. 290)
STARTING AND DRIVING
}}
291
Foot brake - emergency brake
assistance
Emergency brake assistance EBA (Emergency
Brake Assist) helps to increase the braking force
and so reduce the braking distance.
EBA detects the driver's braking style and increa-
ses the braking force when necessary. The brake
force can be reinforced up to the level when the
ABS system is engaged. The EBA function is
interrupted when the pressure on the brake pedal
is reduced.
NOTE
When EBA is activated the brake pedal low-
ers slightly more than usual, depress (hold)
the brake pedal as long as necessary. If the
brake pedal is released then all braking
ceases.
Related information
Foot brake (p. 289)
Parking brake (p. 291)
Foot brake - emergency brake lights and
automatic hazard warning flashers (p. 290)
Foot brake - anti-lock braking system
(p. 290)
Parking brake
The parking brake prevents the car from rolling
away from stationary by means of mechanically
locking/blocking two wheels.
WARNING
Always apply the parking brake when parking
on a slope - leaving the car in gear, or in P if it
has automatic transmission, is not sufficient
to hold the car in all situations.
Combined instrument panel warning symbol.
Applying the parking brake
1. Press the foot brake pedal down firmly.
2. Pull the lever firmly.
> The combined instrument panel
warning symbol comes on. The warning
symbol illuminates regardless of whether
the parking brake is applied gently or
firmly.
3. Release the foot brake pedal and make sure
that the car is at a standstill position.
4. If the vehicle moves then the parking brake
lever must be applied at least a little more
firmly.
When parking the vehicle, always engage 1st
gear (for manual gearbox) or put the gear selec-
tor in position P (for automatic gearbox).
Parking on a hill
If the car is parked facing uphill:
Turn the wheels away from the kerb.
If the car is parked facing downhill:
Turn the wheels towards the kerb.
Disengaging the parking brake
1. Press the foot brake pedal down firmly.
2. Pull the lever up slightly, press the button,
release the lever and release the button.
> The combined instrument panel warning
symbol goes off.
If the driver forgets to release the parking brake –
in addition to the illuminated warning lamp – a
pinging sound combined with a message in the
||
STARTING AND DRIVING
292
combined instrument panel alerts the driver of
this when the car's speed exceeds 10 km/h
(6 mph).
Related information
Foot brake (p. 289)
Driving in water
Driving in water means that the car is driven
through deep water on a water-covered road-
way. Fording must be carried out with great cau-
tion.
The car can be driven through water at a maxi-
mum depth of 25 cm at a maximum speed of
walking pace. Extra caution must be exercised
when passing through flowing water.
During driving in water, maintain a low speed and
do not stop the car. When the water has been
passed, depress the brake pedal lightly and
check that full brake function is achieved. Water
and mud for example can make the brake linings
wet resulting in delayed brake function.
If necessary, clean the contacts for the elec-
tric heater and trailer coupling after driving in
water and mud.
Do not let the car stand with water over the
sills for any long period of time - this could
cause electrical malfunctions.
IMPORTANT
Engine damage can occur if water enters the
air filter.
In depths greater than 25 cm, water could
enter the transmission. This reduces the lubri-
cating ability of the oils and shortens the
service life of these systems.
Damage to any component, engine, transmis-
sion, turbocharger, differential or its internal
components caused by flooding, hydrostatic
locking or oil shortage, is not covered by the
warranty.
In the event of the engine stalling in water, do
not try restart - tow the car from the water to
a workshop - an authorised Volvo workshop is
recommended. Risk of engine breakdown.
Related information
Recovery (p. 311)
Towing (p. 310)
STARTING AND DRIVING
293
Overheating
Under special conditions, for example hard driv-
ing in hilly terrain and hot climate, there is a risk
that the engine and drive system may overheat -
in particular with a heavy load.
For information about overheating when driving
with a trailer, see Driving with a trailer (p. 302).
Remove any auxiliary lamps from in front of
the grille when driving in hot climates.
If the temperature in the engine's cooling
system is too high then a warning symbol is
illuminated and a text message High engine
temperature Stop safely is shown in the
combined instrument panel's information dis-
play - stop the car in a safe way and allow
the engine to run at idling speed for several
minutes in order to cool down.
If the text message High engine
temperature Turn off engine or Engine
coolant level low Stop safely is shown
then the engine must be switched off after
stopping the car.
In the event of overheating in the gearbox a
built-in protection function is activated, which
is indicated in the combined instrument
panel with a warning symbol and the text
message Transmission hot Reduce
speed or Transmission hot Stop safely
Wait for cooling - follow the recommenda-
tion given and lower the speed and stop the
car in a safe way and allow the engine to run
at idling speed for a few minutes in order to
allow the gearbox to cool down.
If the car overheats, the air conditioning may
be switched off temporarily.
Do not turn the engine off immediately you
stop after a hard drive.
NOTE
It is normal for the engine's cooling fan to
operate for a time after the engine has been
switched off.
Related information
Driving with a trailer - manual gearbox
(p. 303)
Driving with a trailer - automatic gearbox
(p. 304)
Driving with open tailgate
When driving with the tailgate open, toxic
exhaust fumes can be sucked into the car
through the cargo area.
WARNING
Do not drive with an open tailgate! Toxic
exhaust fumes could be drawn into the car
through the cargo area.
Related information
Loading (p. 153)
STARTING AND DRIVING
* Option/accessory.
294
Overload - starter battery
The electrical functions in the car load the starter
battery to varying degrees. Avoid using the key
position II when the engine is switched off.
Instead use the I mode - which uses less power,
see Key positions - functions at different levels
(p. 81).
Also, be aware of different accessories that load
the electrical system. Do not use functions which
use a lot of power when the engine is switched
off. Examples of such functions are:
ventilation fan
headlamps
windscreen wiper
audio system (high volume).
If the battery voltage is low the information dis-
play shows the text Low battery charge Power
save mode. The energy-saving function then
shuts down certain functions or reduces certain
functions such as the ventilation fan and/or
audio system.
In which case, charge the starter battery by
starting the engine and then running it for at
least 15 minutes - battery charging is more
effective during driving than running the
engine at idling speed while stationary.
Related information
Starter battery - general (p. 358)
Before a long journey
Before a long journey, it makes good sense to
go through the following points:
Check that the engine is working normally
and that fuel consumption (p. 398) is nor-
mal.
Make sure that there are no leaks (fuel, oil or
other fluid).
Check all bulbs and tyre tread depths.
Carrying a warning triangle (p. 325) is a
legal requirement in certain countries.
Related information
Engine oil - checking and filling (p. 343)
Spare wheel* (p. 320)
Lamp replacement - general (p. 347)
Winter driving
For winter driving it is important to perform cer-
tain checks in order to ensure that the car can
be driven safely.
To bear in mind:
Check the following in particular before the cold
season:
The engine coolant (p. 392) must contain
50% glycol. This mixture protects the engine
against frost erosion down to
approximately –35 °C. To avoid health risks,
different types of glycol must not be mixed.
The fuel tank must be kept filled to prevent
condensation.
Engine oil viscosity is important. Oils with
lower viscosity (thinner oils) facilitate starting
in cold weather and also reduce fuel con-
sumption while the engine is cold. For more
information on suitable oils, see Engine oil -
adverse driving conditions (p. 389).
IMPORTANT
Low viscosity oil must not be used for hard
driving or in hot weather.
The condition of the battery and charge level
must be inspected. Cold weather places
STARTING AND DRIVING
295
great demands on the battery and its
capacity is reduced by the cold.
Use washer fluid (p. 357) to avoid ice form-
ing in the washer fluid reservoir.
To achieve optimum roadholding Volvo recom-
mends using winter tyres on all wheels if there is
a risk of snow or ice.
NOTE
The use of winter tyres is a legal requirement
in certain countries. Studded tyres are not
permitted in all countries.
Slippery driving conditions
Practise driving on slippery surfaces under con-
trolled conditions to learn how the car reacts.
Fuel filler flap - Opening/closing
The fuel filler flap can be opened/closed as fol-
lows:
Opening/closing the fuel filler flap
Open the fuel filler flap by slightly pressing in
the rear part of the hatch.
Take out the flap.
Close the flap after fuelling.
For a description of locking and unlocking the
fuel filler flap, see Locking/unlocking - fuel filler
flap (p. 178). The fuel filler flap's lock logic also
follows the locking or unlocking of the keyless
system and the central locking system.
Related information
Filling up with fuel (p. 296)
Fuel filler flap - manual opening
The fuel filler flap can be opened manually when
it cannot be opened from outside.
Open/remove the side hatch in the cargo
area (same side as fuel filler flap).
Carefully pull the line back in a straight line.
The flap can now be opened from outside.
IMPORTANT
Pull the wire gently - minimal force is required
to disengage the hatch lock.
Related information
Locking/unlocking - fuel filler flap (p. 178)
Filling up with fuel (p. 296)
STARTING AND DRIVING
296
Filling up with fuel
The fuel tank is fitted with a capless fuel filler
system. Filling is carried out as follows:
1. Open the fuel filler door.
2. Choose fuel that is approved for use in the
car in accordance with the identifier6 on the
inside of the fuel filler flap.
See information on approved fuels in the
respective section on petrol (p. 297) and
diesel (p. 298).
3. Insert the pump nozzle in the fuel filler open-
ing. Take care to insert the nozzle properly
into the filler pipe. The filler pipe consists of
two opening caps. The nozzle must be
pushed past both caps before refuelling is
started.
4. Do not overfill the tank but stop refuelling
when the pump nozzle cuts out the first time.
NOTE
Overfilled fuel in the tank can overflow in hot
weather.
NOTE
Avoid spilling by waiting approximately
5-8 seconds before carefully removing the
nozzle once refuelling is complete.
Related information
Filling with fuel - with a fuel can (p. 300)
Fuel filler flap - Opening/closing (p. 295)
Fuel - handling
Fuel of a lower quality than that recommended
by Volvo must not be used as engine power and
fuel consumption is negatively affected.
WARNING
Always avoid inhaling fuel vapour and fuel
splashing in the eyes.
In the event of fuel in the eyes, remove any
contact lenses and rinse the eyes in plenty of
water for at least 15 minutes and seek medi-
cal attention.
Never swallow fuel. Fuels such as petrol and
diesel are highly toxic and could cause per-
manent injury or be fatal if swallowed. Seek
medical attention immediately if fuel has been
swallowed.
WARNING
Fuel which spills onto the ground can be igni-
ted.
Switch off the fuel-driven heater before star-
ting to refuel.
Never carry an activated mobile phone when
refuelling. The ring signal could cause spark
build-up and ignite petrol fumes, leading to
fire and injury.
6The identifier, in accordance with the CEN standard prEN16942, is located on the inside of the fuel filler flap, and will soon (within two years) be on corresponding fuel pumps and their nozzles at filling stations
throughout Europe.
STARTING AND DRIVING
}}
297
IMPORTANT
Mixtures of various fuel types or use of fuels
which are not recommended will invalidate
Volvo's guarantees and any supplementary
service agreements; this is applicable to all
engines.
NOTE
Extreme weather conditions, driving with a
trailer or driving at high altitudes in combina-
tion with fuel grade are factors that could
affect the car's performance.
Related information
Economical driving (p. 301)
Fuel - petrol
Petrol is a type of engine fuel that is intended for
cars with a petrol engine.
Only use petrol from well-known producers.
Never use fuel of dubious quality. The petrol must
fulfil the EN 228 standard.
Identifier for petrol
The identifier7 is located on the inside of the fuel
filler flap, and will soon (within two years) be on
corresponding fuel pumps and their nozzles at
filling stations throughout Europe.
These are the identifiers that apply for current
standard fuels in Europe. Petrol with the following
identifiers may be used in cars with petrol engine:
E5 is a petrol with maximum
2.7 % oxygen and maximum
5 volume % ethanol.
E10 is a petrol with maximum
3.7 % oxygen and maximum
10 volume % ethanol.
IMPORTANT
Fuel that contains up to 10 percent by
volume ethanol is permitted.
EN 228 E10 petrol (max
10 percent by volume ethanol) is
approved for use.
Ethanol higher than E10 (max.
10 percent by volume ethanol) is not per-
mitted, e.g. E85 is not permitted.
Octane rating
95 RON can be used for normal driving.
98 RON is recommended for optimum per-
formance and minimum fuel consumption.
When driving in temperatures above +38 °C, fuel
with the highest possible octane rating is recom-
mended for optimum performance and fuel econ-
omy.
IMPORTANT
Use only unleaded petrol to avoid damag-
ing the catalytic converter.
Fuel containing metallic additives must
not be used.
Do not use any additives which have not
been recommended by Volvo.
7In accordance with CEN standard prEN16942.
||
STARTING AND DRIVING
298
Related information
Economical driving (p. 301)
Fuel - handling (p. 296)
Filling up with fuel (p. 296)
Fuel - diesel
Diesel is a type of engine fuel that is intended for
cars with a diesel engine.
Only use diesel fuel from well-known producers.
Never use fuel of dubious quality. Diesel fuel
must fulfil the EN 590 or SS 155435 standard.
Diesel engines are sensitive to contaminants in
the fuel, such as excessively high volumes of sul-
phur and metals.
Identifier
The identifier8 is located on the inside of the fuel
filler flap, and will soon (within two years) be on
corresponding fuel pumps and their nozzles at
filling stations throughout Europe.
This is the identifier that applies for current
standard fuel in Europe. Diesel with the following
identifiers may be used in cars with diesel
engine:
B7 is diesel with maximum
7 volume % fatty acid methyl
ester (FAME).
At low temperatures (lower than 0 °C) a paraffin
precipitate may form in the diesel fuel, which may
lead to ignition problems. The fuel qualities that
are sold must be adapted for season and climate
zone, but in the event of extreme weather condi-
tions, old fuel or moving between climate zones,
paraffin precipitate may occur.
The risk of condensation in the fuel tank is
reduced if the tank is kept well filled. When refu-
elling, check that the area around the fuel filler
pipe is clean. Avoid spilling fuel onto the paint-
work. Wash off any spillage with detergent and
water.
IMPORTANT
Diesel fuel must:
fulfil the EN 590 and/or SS 155435
standards
have a sulphur content not exceeding
10 mg/kg
have a maximum of 7 vol % FAME9 (B7).
8CEN standard prEN16942.
9Fatty Acid Methyl Ester
STARTING AND DRIVING
}}
299
IMPORTANT
Diesel type fuels that must not be used:
Special additives
Marine diesel fuel
Heating oil
FAME10 and vegetable oil.
These fuels do not fulfil the requirements in
accordance with Volvo recommendations and
generate increased wear and engine damage
that is not covered by the Volvo warranty.
Empty tank
Once the engine has stopped due to fuel starva-
tion, the fuel system needs a few moments to
carry out a check. Before starting the engine
after the fuel tank has been filled with diesel -
proceed as follows:
1. Insert the remote control key in the ignition
switch and push it in to the end position, see
Key positions (p. 80).
2. Press the START button without depressing
the brake and/or clutch pedal.
3. Wait approx. one minute.
4. To start the engine: Depress the brake
and/or clutch pedal and then press the
START button again.
NOTE
Before filling with fuel in the event of fuel
shortage:
Stop the car on as flat/level ground as
possible - if the car is tilting there is a risk
of air pockets in the fuel supply.
Service intervals for fuel filter
For optimum performance, it is important to fol-
low the service intervals for fuel filter change as
well as to use genuine parts developed specifi-
cally for this purpose.
Related information
Diesel particle filter (DPF) (p. 300)
Fuel - handling (p. 296)
Economical driving (p. 301)
Catalytic converters
The purpose of the catalytic converters is to
purify exhaust gases. They are located close to
the engine so that operating temperature is
reached quickly.
The catalytic converters consist of a monolith
(ceramic or metal) with channels. The channel
walls are lined with a thin layer of platinum/
rhodium/palladium. These metals act as cata-
lysts, i.e. they participate in and accelerate a
chemical reaction without being used up them-
selves.
Lambda-sondTM oxygen sensor
The Lambda-sond is part of a control system
intended to reduce emissions and improve fuel
economy. For more information, see Fuel con-
sumption and CO2 emissions (p. 398).
An oxygen sensor monitors the oxygen content
of the exhaust gases leaving the engine. This
value is fed into an electronic system that contin-
uously controls the injectors. The ratio of fuel to
air directed to the engine is continuously
adjusted. These adjustments create optimal con-
ditions for efficient combustion, and together with
the three-way catalytic converter reduce harmful
emissions (hydrocarbons, carbon monoxide and
nitrous oxides).
10 Diesel fuel with maximum 7 vol % FAME (B7) is permitted.
||
STARTING AND DRIVING
300
Related information
Economical driving (p. 301)
Fuel - petrol (p. 297)
Fuel - diesel (p. 298)
Filling with fuel - with a fuel can
When filling with fuel (p. 296) from a fuel can,
use the funnel located under the floor hatch in
the cargo area.
IMPORTANT
Statutory provisions relating to storage of
reserve fuel cans in cars vary from country to
country. Check what does apply.
Take care to insert the funnel properly into the
filler pipe. The filler pipe consists of two opening
flaps. The funnel must be pushed past both flaps
before filling is started.
Related information
Locking/unlocking - fuel filler flap (p. 178)
Fuel filler flap - manual opening (p. 295)
Diesel particle filter (DPF)
Diesel cars are equipped with a particle filter,
which results in more efficient emission control.
The particles in the exhaust gases are collected
in the filter during normal driving. So-called
"regeneration" is started in order to burn away
the particles and empty the filter. This requires
the engine to have reached normal operating
temperature.
Filter regeneration takes place automatically and
normally takes 10-20 minutes. It may take a little
longer at a low average speed. Fuel consumption
may increase slightly during regeneration.
Regeneration in cold weather
If the car is frequently driven short distances in
cold weather then the engine does not reach
normal operating temperature. This means that
regeneration of the diesel particle filter does not
take place and the filter is not emptied.
When the filter has become approximately 80%
full of particles, a yellow warning triangle is
shown in the combined instrument panel, and the
message Soot filter full See manual is shown
in the information display.
Start regeneration of the filter by driving the car
until the engine reaches normal operating tem-
perature, preferably on a main road or motorway.
The car should then be driven for approximately
20 minutes more.
STARTING AND DRIVING
}}
* Option/accessory. 301
NOTE
The following may arise during regeneration:
a smaller reduction of engine power may
be noticed temporarily
fuel consumption may increase temporar-
ily
a smell of burning may arise.
When regeneration is complete the warning text
is cleared automatically.
Use the parking heater* in cold weather so that
the engine reaches normal operating tempera-
ture more quickly.
IMPORTANT
If the filter is completely filled with particles, it
may be difficult to start the engine and the fil-
ter is non-functional. Then there is a risk that
the filter will need to be replaced.
Related information
Fuel - diesel (p. 298)
Economical driving (p. 301)
Economical driving
Drive economically and eco-consciously by driv-
ing smoothly, thinking ahead, and adjusting your
driving style and speed to the prevailing condi-
tions.
Use the ECO Guide* (p. 70) which indicates
how fuel-efficiently the car is being driven.
For lower fuel consumption, activate Drive
mode ECO11 which can further reduce fuel
consumption.
Use the Eco Coast12 freewheel function -
engine braking will cease and the car's
kinetic energy can be used to freewheel for
longer distances.
Drive in the highest gear possible, adapted to
the current traffic situation and road - lower
engine speeds result in lower fuel consump-
tion. Use the gear shift indicator (p. 274)13.
Drive at a steady speed and keep a good dis-
tance to other vehicles and objects to mini-
mise braking.
High speed results in increased fuel con-
sumption - the wind resistance increases
with speed.
Do not run the engine to operating tempera-
ture at idling speed, but rather drive with a
normal load right after starting - a cold
engine consumes more fuel than a warm
one.
Drive with the correct air pressure in the
tyres and check this regularly - select ECO
tyre pressure for best results, see Tyres -
approved tyre pressures (p. 405).
Choice of tyres can affect fuel consumption -
seek advice on suitable tyres from a dealer.
Remove unnecessary items from the car -
the greater the load the higher the fuel con-
sumption.
Use engine braking to slow down, when it
can take place without risk to other road
users.
A roof load and space box increase air resis-
tance, leading to higher fuel consumption -
remove the load carriers when not in use.
Avoid driving with open windows.
For more information, see Environmental philoso-
phy (p. 22) and Fuel consumption and CO2 emis-
sions (p. 398).
11 Applies to automatic gearbox.
12 See "Drive mode ECO".
13 Applies to manual gearbox.
STARTING AND DRIVING
302
WARNING
Never switch off the engine while moving,
such as downhill, this deactivates important
systems such as the power steering and
brake servo.
Driving with a trailer
When driving with a trailer there are a number of
important points to think about regarding e.g. the
towing bracket, the trailer and how the load is
positioned in the trailer.
Payload depends on the car's kerb weight. The
total of the weight of the passengers and all
accessories, e.g. towbar, reduces the car's pay-
load by a corresponding weight. For more
detailed information, see Weights (p. 385).
If the towing bracket is mounted by Volvo, then
the car is delivered with the necessary equipment
for driving with a trailer.
The car's towing bracket must be of an
approved type.
If the towbar is retrofitted, check with your
Volvo dealer that the car is fully equipped for
driving with a trailer.
Distribute the load on the trailer so that the
weight on the towing bracket complies with
the specified maximum towball load.
Increase the tyre pressure to the recom-
mended pressure for a full load. For informa-
tion on the tyre pressure, see Tyres -
approved tyre pressures (p. 405).
The engine is loaded more heavily than usual
when driving with a trailer.
Do not tow a heavy trailer when the car is
brand new. Wait until it has been driven at
least 1000 km.
The brakes are loaded much more than usual
on long and steep downhill slopes. Downshift
to a lower gear and adjust your speed.
For safety reasons, the maximum permitted
speed for the car when coupled with a trailer
should not be exceeded. Follow the regula-
tions in force for the permitted speeds and
weights.
Maintain a low speed when driving with a
trailer up long, steep ascents.
Avoid driving with a trailer on inclines of more
than 12%.
Trailer cable
An adapter is required if the car's towing bracket
has a 13 pin connector and the trailer has a 7 pin
connector. Use an adapter cable approved by
Volvo. Make sure the cable does not drag on the
ground.
Direction indicators and brake lights on
the trailer
If any of the trailer's lamps for direction indicators
are broken, the symbol for direction indicators in
the combined instrument panel flashes faster
than normal and the information display shows
the text Trailer indicator malfunction.
STARTING AND DRIVING
* Option/accessory. 303
If any of the trailer's lamps for the brake light are
broken then the Trailer brake light
malfunction text is shown.
Level control*
The rear shock absorbers maintain a constant
height irrespective of the car's load (up to the
maximum permissible weight). When the car is
stationary the rear of the car lowers slightly,
which is normal.
Trailer weights
For information on Volvo's permitted trailer
weights, see Towing capacity and towball load
(p. 386).
NOTE
The stated maximum permitted trailer weights
are those permitted by Volvo. National vehicle
regulations can further limit trailer weights
and speeds. Towbars can be certified for
higher towing weights than the car can
actually tow.
WARNING
Follow the stated recommendations for trailer
weights. Otherwise, the car and trailer may be
difficult to control in the event of sudden
movement and braking.
Related information
Towing bracket (p. 304)
Lamp replacement - general (p. 347)
Driving with a trailer - manual
gearbox
When driving with a trailer (p. 302) in hilly terrain
in a hot climate there may be a risk of overheat-
ing.
Do not run the engine at higher revolutions
than 4500 rpm (diesel engines: 3500 rpm) -
otherwise the oil temperature may become
too high.
Related information
Manual gearbox (p. 273)
STARTING AND DRIVING
* Option/accessory.
304
Driving with a trailer - automatic
gearbox
When driving with a trailer in hilly terrain in a hot
climate there may be a risk of overheating.
An automatic gearbox selects the optimum
gear related to load and engine speed.
In the event of overheating, a warning symbol
is illuminated in the combined instrument
panel and a text message is shown in the
information display - follow the recommenda-
tion given.
Steep inclines
Do not lock the automatic transmission in a
higher gear than the engine "can cope with"
- it is not always a good idea to drive at a
high gear with low engine revolutions.
Parking on a hill
1. Depress the foot brake.
2. Activate the parking brake.
3. Move the gear selector to position P.
4. Release the foot brake.
Move the gear selector to park position P
when parking an automatic car with a hitched
trailer. Always use the parking brake.
Block the wheels with chocks when parking
a car with hitched trailer on a hill.
Starting on a hill
1. Depress the foot brake.
2. Move the gear selector to driving position D.
3. Release the parking brake.
4. Release the foot brake and start driving off.
Related information
Automatic gearbox - Geartronic* (p. 274)
Towing bracket
A towing bracket means that it is possible to e.g.
tow a trailer behind the car.
If the car is equipped with a removable towbar,
the installation instructions for the loose section
must be followed carefully, see Detachable tow-
bar* - attachment/removal (p. 306).
WARNING
If the car is fitted with a Volvo detachable
towbar:
Follow the installation instructions care-
fully.
The detachable section must be locked
with the key before setting off.
Check that the indicator window shows
green.
Important checks
The towbar's towball must be cleaned and
greased regularly.
WARNING
The moving parts of the detachable towbar
must not be lubricated/oiled. This may reduce
safety.
STARTING AND DRIVING
}}
* Option/accessory. 305
NOTE
When a hitch with a vibration damper is used,
the towball must not be lubricated.
This also applies when fitting a bicycle rack
that is clamped in around the towball.
Related information
Driving with a trailer (p. 302)
Detachable towbar* - specifications (p. 305)
Detachable towbar* - storage (p. 305)
Detachable towbar* - storage
Store the detachable towbar in the cargo area.
The detachable towbar must be stored in the foam
block14 under the cargo area floor when not in use.
IMPORTANT
Always remove the detachable towbar after
use and store it in the designated location in
the car.
Related information
Detachable towbar* - specifications (p. 305)
Detachable towbar* - attachment/removal
(p. 306)
Driving with a trailer (p. 302)
Detachable towbar* - specifications
Specifications for detachable towbar.
G021485
14 The figure is schematic, the foam block may have different appearances depending on the car's equipment.
||
STARTING AND DRIVING
* Option/accessory.
306
Dimensions, mounting points (mm)
A 887
B 79
C 881
D 441
E 109
F 306
G Side member
H Ball centre
Related information
Detachable towbar* - attachment/removal
(p. 306)
Detachable towbar* - storage (p. 305)
Driving with a trailer (p. 302) Detachable towbar* - attachment/
removal
The attachment/removal of the detachable tow-
bar is performed in the following way:
Attaching
Remove the protective cover by first pressing
in the catch and then pulling the cover
straight back .
G021487
Ensure that the mechanism is in the
unlocked position by turning the key clock-
wise.
STARTING AND DRIVING
}}
307
G021488
The indicator window must show red.
G021489
Insert the towball section until you hear a
click.
G021490
The indicator window must show green.
G000000
Turn the key anticlockwise to locked position.
Remove the key from the lock.
G021494
Check that the towball section is secure by
pulling it up, down and back.
WARNING
If the towball is not fitted correctly then it
must be detached and reattached in accord-
ance with the previous instructions.
IMPORTANT
Only grease in the ball for the towball hitch,
the remainder of the towbar must be clean
and dry.
NOTE
When a hitch with a vibration damper is used,
the towball must not be lubricated.
||
STARTING AND DRIVING
* Option/accessory.
308
G021495
Safety cable.
WARNING
Take care to secure the trailer's safety cable
in the intended bracket.
Removal of removable towbar
Insert the key and turn it clockwise to the
unlocked position.
Push in the locking wheel and turn it
anticlockwise until you hear a click.
Turn the locking wheel down fully, until it
comes to a stop. Hold it in this position while
pulling the towball rearward and upward.
WARNING
Secure the detachable towbar safely if it is
stored in the car, see Detachable towbar* -
storage (p. 305).
Push the protective cover until it snaps tight.
Related information
Detachable towbar* - storage (p. 305)
Detachable towbar* - specifications (p. 305)
Driving with a trailer (p. 302)
STARTING AND DRIVING
309
Trailer Stability Assist - TSA15
The trailer stability assist TSA (Trailer Stability
Assist) function is designed to stabilise the car
and trailer combination if it begins to snake.
TSA- the function is included in the stability sys-
tem (p. 186) ESC16.
Function
The snaking phenomenon can occur with any
car/trailer combination. Snaking normally occurs
at high speeds. But, there is a risk of it occurring
at lower speeds if the trailer is overloaded or the
load is improperly distributed, e.g. too far back.
In order for snaking to occur, there must be a
triggering factor, e.g.:
Car with trailer subjected to a sudden and
powerful side wind.
Car with trailer drives on an uneven road sur-
face or in a pothole.
Sweeping steering wheel movements.
Operation
If snaking has started, it could be difficult or even
impossible to suppress. This makes the car/
trailer combination difficult to control and there is
a risk that you could, for example, end up in the
wrong lane or leave the carriageway.
The trailer stability assist function continually
monitors car movements, particularly lateral
movements. If snaking is detected, the front
wheels are individually braked. This serves to sta-
bilise the car/trailer combination. This is often
enough to help the driver regain control of the
car.
If snaking is not eliminated the first time the TSA
system comes into action, the car/trailer combi-
nation is braked with all wheels and engine
power is reduced. Once snaking has been gradu-
ally suppressed and the car/trailer combination is
once again stable, the TSA system stops regulat-
ing and the driver once again has full control of
the car. For more information, see Electronic sta-
bility control (ESC) - general (p. 186).
Miscellaneous
Engagement of the TSA system may take place
at higher speeds.
NOTE
TSA function is switched off if the driver
selects Sport mode, see Electronic stability
control (ESC) - general (p. 186).
TSA may fail to engage if the driver uses severe
steering wheel movements to try to rectify the
snaking because in such a situation the TSA sys-
tem cannot determine whether it is the trailer or
the driver that is causing the snaking.
The ESC16 symbol in the combined
instrument panel flashes when the TSA
system is working.
Related information
Electronic stability control (ESC) - general
(p. 186)
15 Included in the installation of Volvo genuine towbar.
16 (Electronic Stability Control) - Electronic stability control.
STARTING AND DRIVING
310
Towing
During towing, one vehicle is towed by another
vehicle using a tow rope.
Find out the statutory maximum speed limit for
towing before the towing begins.
1. Activate the car's hazard warning flashers.
2. Attach the tow rope in the towing eye.
3. Unlock the steering lock (p. 271) by inserting
the remote control key in the ignition switch
and giving a long press on the START/
STOP ENGINE button - key position II
(p. 81) is activated.
4. The remote control key must remain in the
ignition switch while the car is being towed.
5. Keep the towline taut when the towing vehi-
cle reduces speed by holding your foot gen-
tly pressed on the brake pedal - thereby
avoiding unnecessary jerking.
6. Be prepared to brake to stop.
WARNING
Check that the steering lock is unlocked
before towing.
The remote control key must be in key
position II - in position I all airbags are
deactivated.
Never remove the remote control key
from the ignition switch when the car is
being towed.
WARNING
The brake servo and power steering do not
work when the engine is switched off - the
brake pedal needs to be depressed
about 5 times more heavily and the steering is
considerably heavier than normal.
Manual gearbox
Prior to towing:
Move gear lever into neutral and release the
parking brake.
Automatic gearbox Geartronic
IMPORTANT
Note that the car must always be towed with
the wheels rolling forward.
Do not tow cars with automatic transmis-
sion at speeds higher than 80 km/h
(50 mph) or for distances in excess of 80
km.
Prior to towing:
Move the gear selector to position N and
release the parking brake.
Jump starting
Do not tow the car to bump start the engine. Use
a donor battery if the starter battery is discharged
and the engine does not start, see Jump starting
(p. 271).
IMPORTANT
The catalytic converter may be damaged dur-
ing attempts to tow-start the engine.
Related information
Hazard warning flashers (p. 99)
Towing eye (p. 311)
STARTING AND DRIVING
* Option/accessory. 311
Towing eye
Use the towing eye for towing a vehicle. The
towing eye is screwed into a threaded socket
behind a cover on the right-hand side of the
bumper, front or rear.
Attaching the towing eye
1. Take out the towing eye that is stored in the
foam block under the cargo area floor.
2. The cover for the towing eye's attachment
point is opened as follows:
The cover has a marking along one side
or in a corner: Press the marking with a
finger and fold out the opposite side/
corner at the same time - the cover turns
around its axis and can then be removed.
3. Screw the towing eye right in up to its flange.
Turn in the towing eye firmly e.g. using the
wheel wrench*.
IMPORTANT
The towing eye is only designed for towing on
roads - not for pulling the car unstuck or out
of a ditch. Call a recovery service for recovery
assistance.
Removal
1. Unscrew and remove the towing eye after
use. Place the towing eye back in its position
in the foam block.
2. Refit the cover on the bumper.
Related information
Towing (p. 310)
Recovery (p. 311)
Recovery
Recovery means that the vehicle is transported
away by means of another vehicle.
Call a recovery service for recovery assistance.
IMPORTANT
Note that the car must always be transported
with the wheels rolling forward.
Related information
Towing (p. 310)
WHEELS AND TYRES
WHEELS AND TYRES
314
Tyres - maintenance
Amongst other things, the function of the tyres is
to carry load, provide grip on the road surface,
dampen vibration and protect the wheel from
wear.
Driving characteristics
Tyres greatly affect the car's driving characteris-
tics. The type of tyre, dimensions, tyre pressure
and speed rating are important for how the car
performs.
Tyre age
All tyres older than 6 years old should be
checked by an expert even if they seem undam-
aged. Tyres age and decompose, even if they are
hardly ever or never used. The function can
therefore be affected. This applies to all tyres that
are stored for future use. Examples of external
signs which indicate that the tyre is unsuitable for
use are cracks or discoloration.
New tyres
Tyres are perishable. After a few years they begin
to harden at the same time as the friction
capacity/characteristics gradually deteriorate. For
this reason, aim to get as fresh tyres as possible
when you replace them. This is especially impor-
tant with regard to winter tyres. The last four dig-
its in the sequence mean the week and year of
manufacture. This is the tyre's DOT marking
(Department of Transportation), and this is stated
with four digits, for example 1510. The tyre in the
figure was manufactured in week 15 of 2010.
Summer and winter wheels
When summer and winter wheels are changed
the wheels should be marked with which side of
the car they were mounted on, for example L for
left and R for right.
Wear and maintenance
Correct tyre pressure (p. 316) results in more
even wear. Driving style, tyre pressure, climate
and road condition affect how quickly your tyres
age and wear. To avoid differences in tread depth
and to prevent wear patterns (p. 316) arising, the
front and rear wheels can be switched with each
other. A suitable distance for the first change is
approx. 5000 km and then at 10000 km inter-
vals. Volvo recommends the an authorised Volvo
workshop is contacted for checking if you are
uncertain about tread depth. If significant differ-
ences in wear (> 1 mm difference in tread depth)
between tyres have already occurred, then the
least worn tyres must always be fitted on the rear.
Understeer is normally easier to correct than
oversteer, and leads to the car continuing for-
wards in a straight line rather than having the
rear end skidding to one side, resulting in possi-
ble complete loss of control over the car. This is
why it is important for the rear wheels never to
lose grip before the front wheels.
Wheels with tyres fitted must be stored lying
down or hanging up - never standing up.
WARNING
A damaged tyre may lead to loss of control
over the car.
WHEELS AND TYRES
315
Related information
Tyres - dimensions (p. 317)
Tyres - speed ratings (p. 318)
Tyres - direction of rotation (p. 315)
Tyres - direction of rotation
Tyres with a tread pattern which are designed to
only turn in one direction have the direction of
rotation marked with an arrow.
G021778
The arrow shows the tyre's direction of rotation.
The tyre must always rotate in the same direction
throughout its lifespan. Tyres should only be
switched between front and rear positions, never
between left and right-hand sides, or vice versa. If
the tyres are fitted incorrectly, the car's braking
characteristics and capacity to force rain and
slush out of the way are adversely affected. Tyres
with the greatest tread depth should always be
fitted to the rear of the car (to decrease the risk
of skidding).
NOTE
Make sure that both pairs of wheels have the
same type and dimension, and also the same
make.
Follow the recommended tyre pressure (p. 316)
specified in the tyre pressure table.
Related information
Tyres - dimensions (p. 317)
Tyres - speed ratings (p. 318)
Tyres - maintenance (p. 314)
Tyres - tread wear indicators (p. 316)
WHEELS AND TYRES
316
Tyres - tread wear indicators
Tread wear indicators show the status of the
tyre's tread depth.
G021829
Tread wear indicators.
A tread wear indicators is a narrow elevation
across the longitudinal grooves of the tyre's tread
pattern. On the side of the tyre are the letters
TWI (Tread Wear Indicator). When the tyre's tread
depth is down to 1.6 mm, the tread will be level in
height with the tread wear indicators. Change to
new tyres as soon as possible. Remember that
tyres with little tread depth provide very poor grip
in rain and snow.
Related information
Tyres - speed ratings (p. 318)
Tyres - air pressure (p. 316)
Tyres - direction of rotation (p. 315)
Tyres - air pressure
Tyres can have different air pressures which are
measured in bar.
Check the air pressure in the tyres
The air pressure for the tyres should be checked
every month and should be checked on cold
tyres. "Cold tyres" means the tyres are the same
temperature as the ambient temperature. After
several few kilometres of driving, the tyres warm
up and the pressure increases.
Inadequate tyre pressure increases fuel con-
sumption, shortens tyre lifespan and impairs the
car's driving characteristics. Driving on tyres with
tyre pressure that is too low could result in the
tyres overheating and being damaged. Tyre pres-
sure affects travelling comfort, road noise and
driving characteristics.
NOTE
Tyre pressure decreases over time, this is a
natural phenomenon. Tyre pressure also var-
ies depending on ambient temperature.
Tyre pressure label
G021830
The tyre pressure label on the driver's side door
pillar (between frame and rear door) shows which
pressure the tyres should have at different loads
and speed conditions. This is also specified in the
tyre pressure table.
Tyre pressure for the car's recommended tyre
dimension and information about ECO pressure
that results in improved fuel economy can be
found in the printed owner's manual.
NOTE
Temperature differences change the
tyre pressure.
Fuel economy, ECO pressure
When carrying a light load (max. 3 people) and at
speeds of up to 160 km/h (100 mph), the ECO
WHEELS AND TYRES
}}
317
pressure can be selected to give the best possi-
ble fuel economy. If the best possible noise and
travelling comfort conditions are sought, the
lower comfort pressures are recommended
instead.
(See approved tyre pressures(p. 405).)
Related information
Tyres - speed ratings (p. 318)
Tyres - direction of rotation (p. 315)
Tyres - maintenance (p. 314)
Tyres - tread wear indicators (p. 316)
Tyres - approved tyre pressures (p. 405)
Wheel and wheel rim dimensions
Wheel and rim dimensions are designated in
accordance with the examples in the table
below.
The car has an approval for the complete vehicle.
This means that there are certain combinations
of wheels and tyres that are approved.
For information about approved dimensions, see
Wheels and tyres - approved dimensions
(p. 402).
Wheels (rims) have a designation of dimensions,
for example: 7Jx16x50.
7 Rim width in inches
J Rim flange profile
16 Rim diameter in inches
50 Off-set in mm (distance from wheel cen-
tre to wheel contact surface against the
hub)
Related information
Wheel nuts (p. 319)
Tyres - dimensions
The car's tyres have a certain dimension, see the
examples in the table below.
The dimensions are stated on all car tyres. Exam-
ple of designation:215/55R16 97W.
205 Tyre width (mm)
50 Ratio between tyre wall height and tyre
width (%)
R Radial ply
17 Rim diameter in inches (")
93 Codes for the maximum permitted tyre
load, load index (p. 318) (LI)
W Speed rating for maximum permitted
speed, speed rating (p. 318) (SS). (In
this case 270 km/h (168 mph)).
The car has an approval for the complete vehicle
with certain combinations of wheel rims and
tyres.
For information about approved dimensions, see
Wheels and tyres - approved dimensions
(p. 402).
Related information
Tyres - air pressure (p. 316)
Tyres - direction of rotation (p. 315)
WHEELS AND TYRES
318
Tyres - tread wear indicators (p. 316)
Load index and speed rating (p. 404)
Tyres - load index
Load index indicates a tyre's ability to carry a
certain load.
Each tyre has a certain capacity to carry a load, a
load index (LI). The car's weight determines the
load capacity required of the tyres.
Minimum permitted index is specified in the load
index table, see Load index and speed rating
(p. 404).
Related information
Tyres - dimensions (p. 317)
Tyres - speed ratings (p. 318)
Tyres - air pressure (p. 316)
Tyres - tread wear indicators (p. 316)
Tyres - speed ratings
Each tyre can withstand a certain maximum
speed and therefore belongs to a particular
speed rating (SS - Speed Symbol).
Tyre speed class must at least correspond with
the car's top speed. The table below indicates the
maximum permitted speed that applies for each
speed rating (SS). The only exception to these
conditions is winter tyres (p. 320) (both those
with metal studs and those without), where a
lower speed rating may be used. If such a tyre is
chosen, the car must not be driven faster than
the speed rating of the tyre (for example, class Q
can be driven at a maximum of 160 km/h
(100 mph)). Traffic regulations determine how
fast a car can be driven, not the speed rating of
the tyres.
NOTE
The maximum permitted speed is specified in
the table.
Q 160 km/h (100 mph) (only used on win-
ter tyres)
T 190 km/h (118 mph)
H 210 km/h (130 mph)
V 240 km/h (149 mph)
WHEELS AND TYRES
* Option/accessory. 319
W 270 km/h (168 mph)
Y 300 km/h (186 mph)
WARNING
The car must be fitted with tyres which have
the same or a higher load index (p. 318) (LI)
and speed rating (SS) than specified. If a tyre
with too low a load index or speed rating is
used, it may overheat.
Related information
Tyres - dimensions (p. 317)
Tyres - air pressure (p. 316)
Tyres - direction of rotation (p. 315)
Wheel nuts
Wheel nuts are used to fasten the wheels at the
hubs and are available in different versions.
Standard wheel nuts
Bulge acorn wheel nuts
Locking wheel nuts
Tightening torque
Type 1 wheel nut (steel wheel rim): 110
Nm
Type 2 wheel nut (aluminium wheel rim):
130 Nm
Type 3 Lockable wheel nut (steel/alumi-
nium wheel rim): 110 Nm
Only use rims that are tested and approved by
Volvo and which are Volvo genuine accessories.
Check the torque with a torque wrench.
Locking wheel nuts*
Locking wheel nuts can be used on both alumi-
nium and steel rims. Under the cargo area floor
there is space for the sleeve for the lockable
wheel nuts.
Related information
Wheel and wheel rim dimensions (p. 317)
WHEELS AND TYRES
* Option/accessory.
320
Winter tyres
Winter tyres are tyres that are adapted for winter
road conditions.
Winter tyres
Volvo recommends winter tyres with particular
dimensions. Tyre dimensions are dependent on
engine variant. When driving on winter tyres, the
correct type of tyres must be fitted to all four
wheels.
NOTE
Volvo recommends that you consult a Volvo
dealer about which wheel rim and tyre types
are most suitable.
Studded tyres
Studded winter tyres should be run in gently for
500-1000 km so the studs settle properly into
the tyres. This gives the tyre, and especially the
studs, a longer service life.
NOTE
The legal provisions for the use of studded
tyres vary from country to country.
Tread depth
Road conditions with ice, slush and low tempera-
tures place considerably higher demands on tyres
than summer conditions. Volvo therefore recom-
mends not to drive on winter tyres that have a
tread depth of less than 4 mm.
Using snow chains
Snow chains may only be used on the front
wheels (also applies to all-wheel drive cars).
Never drive faster than 50 km/h (30 mph) with
snow chains. Avoid driving on bare ground as this
wears out both the snow chains and tyres.
WARNING
Use Volvo genuine snow chains or equivalent
chains designed for the car model, and tyre
and rim dimensions. In the event of uncer-
tainty Volvo recommends that you consult an
authorised Volvo workshop. The wrong snow
chains may cause serious damage to your car
and lead to an accident.
Related information
Changing wheels - removing wheels (p. 322)
Spare wheel*
A spare wheel (Temporary spare) is used to tem-
porarily replace a punctured normal wheel.
A spare wheel is only intended for use temporar-
ily and must be replaced by a normal wheel as
soon as possible. The car's handling may be
altered by the use of a spare wheel. The spare
wheel is smaller than the normal wheel. The car's
ground clearance is affected accordingly. Pay
attention to high kerbs and do not machine wash
the car. If the spare wheel is fitted on the front
axle, you cannot use snow chains at the same
time. On all-wheel drive cars the drive on the rear
axle can be disconnected. The spare wheel must
not be repaired. The correct tyre pressure for the
spare wheel is stated in the tyre pressure table,
Tyres - air pressure (p. 316).
IMPORTANT
Never drive faster than 80 km/h
(50 mph) with a spare wheel on the car.
The car must never be driven fitted with
more than one "Temporary Spare" wheel.
Related information
Changing wheels - removing wheels (p. 322)
Changing wheels - fitting (p. 324)
Changing wheels - taking out the spare
wheel* (p. 321)
Jack* (p. 326)
WHEELS AND TYRES
* Option/accessory. 321
Warning triangle (p. 325)
Wheel nuts (p. 319)
Changing wheels - taking out the
spare wheel*
The spare wheel* plus jack* and wheel wrench*
are stored under the floor in the cargo area.
1. Lift the rear edge of the luggage compart-
ment floor (or on models with a jointed lug-
gage compartment floor, take hold of the
luggage compartment floor handle, lift and
move the rear part of the floor forwards).
2. Lift out the storage compartment* (only mod-
els with a jointed cargo area floor).
3. Lift out the lower floor (models with a jointed
luggage compartment floor only).
4. Undo the attaching screw and lift out the
foam block containing the jack and tools.
5. Take hold of the far end of the spare wheel,
then lift. Push the spare wheel forwards
slightly and lift it out of the storage compart-
ment.
Related information
Changing wheels - removing wheels (p. 322)
Changing wheels - fitting (p. 324)
Jack* (p. 326)
Spare wheel* (p. 320)
Warning triangle (p. 325)
Wheel nuts (p. 319)
WHEELS AND TYRES
* Option/accessory.
322
Changing wheels - removing wheels
The car's wheels can be changed, e.g. to winter
wheels or a spare wheel.
Set up the warning triangle(p. 325) if a wheel
must be changed in a trafficked location. The car
and jack(p. 326)* must be on a firm horizontal
surface.
1. Apply the parking brake, (p. 291) and
engage reverse gear, or position P if the car
has an automatic gearbox.
WARNING
Check that the jack is not damaged, that the
threads are thoroughly lubricated and that it is
free from dirt.
NOTE
Volvo recommends only using the jack* that
belongs to the car model in question, which is
indicated on the jack's label.
The decal also indicates the jack's maximum
lift capacity at a specified lifting height.
2. Take out the wheel to be fitted as well as the
tools. If it is a spare wheel being fitted then
there is a package in its location containing
gloves and a plastic bag for the punctured
wheel.
3. Place chocks in front of and behind the
wheels which will remain on the ground to
prevent them from rolling. Use heavy wooden
blocks or large stones for example.
4. Cars with steel rims have removable wheel
covers. Use the removal tool to hook in and
pull off any full-wheel wheel covers. Alterna-
tively, the wheel covers can be pulled away by
hand.
5. Screw together the towing eye with the
wheel wrench* to the stop position.
Wheel wrench and towing eye.
IMPORTANT
The towing eye must be screwed into all
threads in the wheel wrench.
WHEELS AND TYRES
* Option/accessory. 323
6. Remove the plastic caps from the wheel nuts
with the intended tool.
7. Loosen the wheel nuts ½-1 turn anticlock-
wise with the wheel wrench*.
WARNING
Never position anything between the ground
and the jack, nor between the jack and the
car's jacking point.
8. There are two jacking points on each side of
the car. Wind up the jack* so that the flange
in the bodywork ends up in the notch in the
head of the jack.
IMPORTANT
The ground under the jack must be firm,
smooth and level.
9. Lift the car so that the wheel is free. Remove
the wheel nuts and lift off the wheel.
WARNING
Never crawl under the car when it is raised on
the jack.
Passengers must leave the car when it is
raised on the jack. If a wheel must be
changed in a trafficked environment, passen-
gers must stand in a safe place.
Related information
Changing wheels - fitting (p. 324)
Changing wheels - taking out the spare
wheel* (p. 321)
Spare wheel* (p. 320)
Warning triangle (p. 325)
Wheel nuts (p. 319)
WHEELS AND TYRES
324
Changing wheels - fitting
It is important that the procedure for fitting the
wheel is carried out correctly.
Installation
WARNING
Never crawl under the car when it is raised on
the jack.
Passengers must leave the car when it is
raised on the jack. If a wheel must be
changed in a trafficked environment, passen-
gers must stand in a safe place.
1. Clean the contact surfaces between wheel
and hub.
2. Put on the wheel. Tighten the wheel nuts
thoroughly.
3. Lower the car so that the wheels cannot
rotate.
4. Tighten the wheel nuts crosswise. It is impor-
tant that the wheel nuts are tightened with
the correct tightening torque. Check the tor-
que with a torque wrench.
5. Refit the plastic caps on the wheel nuts.
6.
Refit any full wheel covers.
NOTE
The wheel cover outlet for the valve must be
positioned over the valve on the wheel rim
during fitting.
Returning the tools to their places
After using the tools they must be returned to
their correct places in the foam block.
If the spare wheel has been used then the punc-
tured wheel can be placed in the plastic bag con-
tained in the package with the gloves. Return the
foam block to its place and press the retaining
screw down into the floor of the storage compart-
ment.
WHEELS AND TYRES
* Option/accessory. 325
IMPORTANT
The tools and jack* must be stored in the
intended location in the car's cargo area
when not in use.
NOTE
After a tyre has been inflated, always refit
the dust cap in order to avoid damage to
the valve from gravel, dirt, etc.
Only use plastic dust caps. Metal dust
caps can rust and become difficult to
unscrew.
When changing to another tyre
dimension
Contact an authorised Volvo workshop to update
the software each time the tyre dimension is
changed. A software download may be necessary
both when changing to larger and smaller dimen-
sions, and also when switching between summer
and winter wheels.
Related information
Changing wheels - taking out the spare
wheel* (p. 321)
Changing wheels - removing wheels (p. 322)
Spare wheel* (p. 320)
Warning triangle (p. 325)
Wheel nuts (p. 319)
Warning triangle
The warning triangle is used to warn other road
users of a stationary vehicle.
Storage and folding up
Lift the floor hatch (or push the rear part of
the luggage compartment floor forwards in
models with a jointed floor and then lift the
lower floor) and remove the warning triangle.
Take the warning triangle from the case, fold
out and assemble the two loose sides.
Fold out the warning triangle's support legs.
Follow the regulations for the use of a warning
triangle. Position the warning triangle in a suita-
ble place with regard to traffic.
Ensure the warning triangle and its case are
properly secured in the cargo area after use.
Related information
Spare wheel* (p. 320)
WHEELS AND TYRES
* Option/accessory.
326
Jack*
Use the jack to raise the car when changing a
wheel.
Only use the original jack when fitting a spare
wheel or when changing between summer and
winter wheels. The jack's thread must always be
well greased.
IMPORTANT
The tools and jack* must be stored in the
intended location in the car's cargo area
when not in use.
NOTE
The normal car jack is only designed for occa-
sional, short-term use, such as when chang-
ing a wheel after a puncture, changing to win-
ter/summer wheels, etc. Only the jack for the
specific car model may be used to raise the
car. If the car is to be jacked up more often, or
for a longer time than is required just to
change a wheel, use of a garage jack is rec-
ommended. In this instance, follow the
instructions for use that come with the equip-
ment.
Related information
Warning triangle (p. 325)
Emergency puncture repair* (p. 328)
First aid kit*
The first aid box contains first aid equipment.
A case containing first aid equipment is located
on the left-hand side of the cargo area.
Tyre monitoring (TM)*1
The TM (Tyre Monitor) system senses the rota-
tion speed of the tyres in order to determine
whether they have the correct tyre pressure.
System description
If the tyre pressure is too low, the tyre's diameter
is changed and, as a result, so is its rotation
speed. By comparing the tyres with each other
the system can determine whether one or more
tyres have pressure that is too low.
The system does not replace normal tyre mainte-
nance.
Messages
If the tyre pressure is too low then an indicator
symbol ( ) illuminates in the combined instru-
ment panel and one of the following messages is
shown:
Tyre pressure low Check, adjust and
calibrate
Tyre pressure system Service required
Tyre pressure system Currently
unavailable
WHEELS AND TYRES
}}
327
IMPORTANT
If a fault occurs in the TM system the indica-
tor symbol in the combined instrument
panel will flash for approx. 1 minute and then
illuminate with a constant glow. A message is
also shown in the combined instrument panel.
Deleting the messages
1. Check the tyre pressure in all tyres with a
tyre pressure gauge.
2. Inflate the tyre/tyres to the correct pressure
in accordance with the tyre pressure label on
the driver's side door pillar (between front
and rear doors).
3. Recalibrate the TM system in MY CAR.
NOTE
To avoid incorrect tyre pressure, the pressure
should be checked on cold tyres. "Cold tyres"
means the tyres are the same temperature as
the ambient temperature (approx. 3 hours
after the car has been driven). After a few kil-
ometres of driving, the tyres warm up and the
pressure increases.
WARNING
Incorrect tyre pressure may lead to tyre
failure, which could result in the driver
losing control of the car.
The system cannot indicate sudden tyre
damage in advance.
TM calibration
In order for TM system to work correctly, a refer-
ence value for the tyre pressure must be deter-
mined. This must be done each time the tyres are
changed or the tyre pressure is adjusted by reca-
librating the system in MY CAR.
For example, the tyre pressure should be
adjusted when driving with a heavy load or for
high-speed driving (above 160 km/h (100 mph)).
Following which, the system must be recalibrated.
Recalibration
Settings are made using the centre console's
controls, see MY CAR (p. 113).
1. Stop the engine.
2. Inflate all tyres to the desired pressure in
accordance with the tyre pressure label on
the driver's side door pillar (between front
and rear doors).
Or see the tyre pressure table.
3. Start the engine and let the car stand still.
4. Open the menu system MY CAR and select
the menu Tyre monitor.
5. Select Start calibration and press OK.
6. Press OK after all tyres have been checked
and adjusted in order to start calibration.
7. Drive the car.
> Recalibration is carried out automatically
while the car is being driven and can be
interrupted at any time. If the engine is
switched off while recalibration is in pro-
gress then it is resumed when the car is
driven again. The system provides no con-
firmation when the calibration is complete.
The new reference value applies until steps 1-7
are repeated.
NOTE
Remember that the TM system must be reca-
librated at each tyre change or if the tyre
pressure is adjusted. If new reference values
are not stored then the system cannot func-
tion properly.
1Standard in certain markets.
||
WHEELS AND TYRES
* Option/accessory.
328
NOTE
After a tyre has been inflated, always refit
the dust cap in order to avoid damage to
the valve from gravel, dirt, etc.
Only use plastic dust caps. Metal dust
caps can rust and become difficult to
unscrew.
System and tyre status
The current status of the system and the tyres
can be checked in the centre console's screen.
1. Open the menu system MY CAR.
2. Select the Tyre monitor menu.
> Status for tyre pressures is shown with a
colour code.
The status is colour-coded for each tyre in
accordance with the following:
All-green: the system is operating normally
and the tyre pressure in all tyres is slightly
above the recommended level.
Yellow wheel: corresponding tyre's pressure
is too low.
All wheels yellow: two or more tyres have
pressure that is too low.
All wheels grey and the message Tyre
pressure system Currently unavailable:
the tyre pressure system is temporarily deac-
tivated. It may be necessary to drive the car
for a short time above 30 km/h (20 mph)
before the system becomes active again.
All wheels grey and the message Tyre
pressure system Service required: an
error has occurred in the system. Contact a
Volvo dealer or workshop.
Related information
Tyres - air pressure (p. 316)
Emergency puncture repair*
The emergency puncture repair kit, Temporary
Mobility Kit (TMK), is used to seal a puncture
and check and adjust the air pressure.
The emergency puncture repair kit consists of a
compressor and a bottle of sealant. The sealing
works as a temporary repair. The sealing fluid
effectively seals tyres punctured in the tread.
The emergency puncture repair kit has limited
capacity to seal tyres which have punctures in the
wall. Do not use the puncture repair kit on tyres
that have larger slits, cracks or similar damage.
NOTE
The emergency puncture repair kit is only
intended for sealing tyres with a puncture in
the tread.
NOTE
The compressor for temporary emergency
puncture repair has been tested and
approved by Volvo.
WHEELS AND TYRES
}}
* Option/accessory. 329
Location
The puncture repair kit is located in the foam
block2 under the floor in the cargo area.
Version 1.
Version 2.
Related information
Emergency puncture repair* - operation
(p. 330)
Emergency puncture repair* - rechecking
(p. 332)
Emergency puncture repair kit* - overview
(p. 329)
Emergency puncture repair kit* -
overview
Overview of the component parts of the emer-
gency puncture repair kit, Temporary Mobility Kit
(TMK).
The parts are stored under the floor in the cargo
area.
Label, maximum permitted speed
Switch
Electrical cable
Bottle holder (orange cap)
Protective cap
Pressure reducing valve
2The foam block may have different appearances depending on the car's equipment.
||
WHEELS AND TYRES
* Option/accessory.
330
Air hose
Sealing fluid bottle
Pressure gauge
Sealing fluid bottle
Replace the bottle with sealing fluid before the
expiration date has passed and after use. Treat
the old bottle as environmentally hazardous
waste.
WARNING
The bottle contains 1.2-Ethanol and natural
rubber-latex.
Harmful if ingested. Could result in allergic
reaction in the event of skin contact.
Avoid contact with the skin and eyes.
Store out of the reach of children.
WARNING
In the event of skin contact with the seal-
ing fluid, it must be washed off immedi-
ately with soap and plenty of water.
Sealing fluid that makes contact with an
eye must be rinsed away immediately with
eye wash fluid or with plenty of water. If
the discomfort persists then the eye
should be examined by a doctor.
Related information
Emergency puncture repair* (p. 328)
Emergency puncture repair* -
operation
Sealing a puncture with the emergency puncture
repair kit, Temporary Mobility Kit (TMK).
Emergency puncture repair
For information on the function of the parts, see Emer-
gency puncture repair kit* - overview (p. 329).
WHEELS AND TYRES
}}
331
1. Set up the warning triangle and activate the
hazard warning lights if a tyre is being sealed
in a trafficked location.
If the puncture was caused by a nail or simi-
lar, allow this to remain in the tyre. It helps to
seal the hole.
2. Detach the label for maximum permitted
speed (which is fitted on one side of the
compressor) and affix it to the steering
wheel. You should not drive faster than
80 km/h (50 mph) after the emergency tyre
repair kit has been used.
3. Check that the switch is in position 0, and
take out the electrical cable and the air hose.
4. Unscrew the orange-coloured cap from the
compressor, and unscrew the cork from the
bottle.
NOTE
Do not break the bottle's seal before use. The
seal is broken automatically when the bottle is
screwed in.
5. Screw in the bottle to the bottom of the bot-
tle holder.
> The bottle and the bottle holder are
equipped with a reverse catch to prevent
sealant leakage. When the bottle is
screwed in it cannot be unscrewed from
the bottle holder again. Bottle removal
must be performed at a workshop, Volvo
recommends an authorised Volvo work-
shop.
WARNING
In the event of skin contact with the seal-
ing fluid, it must be washed off immediately
with soap and plenty of water.
Sealing fluid that makes contact with an
eye must be rinsed away immediately with
eye wash fluid or with plenty of water. If the
discomfort persists then the eye should be
examined by a doctor.
WARNING
Do not unscrew the bottle, it is equipped with
a reverse catch to prevent leakage.
6. Unscrew the tyre's dust cap.
Check that the pressure reducing valve on
the air hose is fully screwed on, and screw in
the air hose's valve connection to the bottom
of the thread on the tyre's air valve.
7. Plug the electrical cable into the closest
12 V socket and start the car.
NOTE
Make sure that none of the other 12 V sock-
ets is in use when the compressor is operat-
ing.
WARNING
Do not leave children in the car without
supervision when the engine is running.
8. Start the compressor by flicking the switch to
position I.
WARNING
Never stand next to the tyre when the com-
pressor is running. If cracks or unevenness
arise then the compressor must be switched
off immediately. The journey should not be
continued. Contacting an authorised tyre cen-
tre is recommended.
NOTE
When the compressor starts, the pressure
can increase up to 6 bar but the pressure
drops after approximately 30 seconds.
||
WHEELS AND TYRES
* Option/accessory.
332
9. Inflate the tyre for 7 minutes.
IMPORTANT
The compressor must not be operated for
longer than 10 minutes - risk of overheating.
10. Switch off the compressor to check the pres-
sure on the pressure gauge. Minimum pres-
sure is 1.8 bar and maximum 3.5 bar.
(Release air with the pressure reducing valve
if the tyre pressure is too high.)
WARNING
If the pressure is below 1.8 bar then the hole
in the tyre is too big. The journey should not
be continued. Contacting an authorised tyre
centre is recommended.
11. Switch off the compressor and unplug the
electrical cable.
12. Unscrew the air hose from the tyre's air valve
and refit the dust cap on the tyre.
13. Fit the protective cap on the air hose in order
to avoid leakage of the remaining sealing
fluid.
14. As soon as possible, drive at least 3 km at a
maximum speed of 80 km/h (50 mph) so
that the sealing fluid can seal the tyre.
NOTE
Sealant will spurt out of the puncture during
the first few rotations of the tyre.
WARNING
Make sure that nobody is standing near the
car and gets the sealing fluid splashed onto
them when the car is driven away. The dis-
tance should be at least two metres.
15. Follow-up inspection:
Connect the air hose on the tyre's air valve
again and check the tyre pressure with the
pressure gauge, see Emergency puncture
repair* - rechecking (p. 332).
Related information
Emergency puncture repair* (p. 328)
Emergency puncture repair* - rechecking
(p. 332)
Emergency puncture repair kit* - overview
(p. 329)
Emergency puncture repair* -
rechecking
When a tyre has been sealed with the emer-
gency puncture repair kit, Temporary Mobility Kit
(TMK), a subsequent check must be made after
approx. 3 kilometres of driving.
Check tyre pressure
Take out the tyre sealing equipment. The com-
pressor must be switched off.
1. Unscrew the tyre's dust cap.
Take out the air hose and screw in the
valve connection to the bottom of the thread
on the tyre's air valve.
2. Read the tyre pressure on the pressure
gauge.
If the tyre pressure is below 1.3 bar then
the tyre is insufficiently sealed. The jour-
ney should not be continued. Contact a
tyre centre.
If the tyre pressure is higher than 1.3 bar,
the tyre must be inflated to the pressure
specified in accordance with the tyre
pressure label on the driver side door pil-
lar (1 bar = 100 kPa).
Release air using the pressure reducing
valve if the tyre pressure is too high.
WHEELS AND TYRES
}}
* Option/accessory. 333
3. If the tyre needs to be inflated:
1. Plug the electrical cable into the closest
12 V socket and start the car.
2. Start the compressor and inflate the tyre
to the pressure specified on the tyre pres-
sure label on the driver side door pillar.
3. Switch off the compressor.
4. Remove the tyre sealing equipment, fit the
protective cap on the air hose and fold the
hose in the box.
WARNING
Do not unscrew the bottle, it is equipped with
a reverse catch to prevent leakage.
5. Refit the dust cap on the tyre.
NOTE
After a tyre has been inflated, always refit
the dust cap in order to avoid damage to
the valve from gravel, dirt, etc.
Only use plastic dust caps. Metal dust
caps can rust and become difficult to
unscrew.
NOTE
The sealing fluid bottle and the hose must be
replaced after use. Volvo recommends that
this replacement is performed by an author-
ised Volvo workshop.
WARNING
Check the tyre pressure regularly.
Volvo recommends that the car is driven to the
nearest authorised Volvo workshop for the
replacement/repair of the damaged tyre. Advise
the workshop that the tyre contains sealing fluid.
WARNING
You should not drive faster than 80 km/h
(50 mph) after the emergency tyre repair kit
has been used. Volvo recommends a visit to
an authorised Volvo workshop for inspection
of the sealed tyre (maximum driving distance
is 200 km). The staff there can determine
whether or not the tyre can be repaired or if it
needs to be replaced.
Related information
Emergency puncture repair* - operation
(p. 330)
Inflating tyres with compressor from
the emergency puncture repair kit*
The car's original tyres can be inflated using the
compressor in the emergency puncture repair kit
(p. 329).
1. The compressor must be switched off. Make
sure that the switch is in position 0 and take
out the electrical cable and air hose.
2. Unscrew the tyre's dust cap and screw in the
air hose's valve connection to the bottom of
the thread on the tyre's air valve.
3. Plug the electrical cable into the closest
12 V socket and start the car.
WARNING
Inhaling car exhaust fumes could result in
danger to life. Never leave the engine running
in sealed areas or areas that lack sufficient
ventilation.
WARNING
Do not leave children in the car without
supervision when the engine is running.
4. Start the compressor by flicking the switch to
position I.
||
WHEELS AND TYRES
* Option/accessory.
334
IMPORTANT
The compressor must not be operated for
longer than 10 minutes - risk of overheating.
5. Inflate the tyre to the pressure specified on
the tyre pressure label on the driver side
door pillar. Release air using the pressure
reducing valve if the tyre pressure is too high.
6. Switch off the compressor. Detach the air
hose and the electrical cable.
7. Refit the dust cap on the tyre.
Related information
Emergency puncture repair* (p. 328)
Emergency puncture repair kit* - overview
(p. 329)
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
* Option/accessory.
336
Volvo service programme
To keep the car as safe and reliable as possible,
follow the Volvo service programme as specified
in the Service and Warranty Booklet.
Volvo recommends engaging an authorised Volvo
workshop to perform the service and mainte-
nance work. Volvo workshops have the personnel,
special tools and service literature to guarantee
the highest quality of service.
IMPORTANT
For the Volvo warranty to apply, check and
follow the instructions in the Service and
Warranty Booklet.
Related information
Climate control system - fault tracing and
repair (p. 347)
Book service and repair*1
Manage service, repair and booking information
directly in your Internet-connected car.
This service1 provides a convenient way to book a
service and workshop visit directly in the car. Car
information is sent to your dealer, who can pre-
pare the workshop visit. The dealer will contact
you to schedule an appointment time. For certain
markets, the system reminds you of a scheduled
appointment time as it approaches and the navi-
gation system2 can also guide you to the work-
shop when the time comes.
Before the service can be used
Volvo ID and my profile
Register a Volvo ID. For more information
and how to create a Volvo ID, see Volvo ID
(p. 21).
Log in to the owner portal My Volvo, go to
your profile and carry out the following:
1. Check that the car is connected to your pro-
file.
2. Check that your contact information is cor-
rect.
3. Select the Volvo dealer you want to contact
for service and repair.
4. Choose preferred communication channel
(phone). Booking information is always sent
to the car and to you via email.
Prerequisite for booking from car
To send and receive booking information
from and to the car, the car must be con-
nected to the Internet, see the Sensus Info-
tainment supplement for information about
how to connect the car to the Internet.
Since the booking information is sent over
your private phone subscription, you will be
asked whether you want to send the informa-
tion. The question is asked once and then
applies to the selected connection for a lim-
ited time.
For the service to work and for the system to
communicate via the car's screen, notifica-
tions/pop-up messages must be accepted.
In the normal view for the MY CAR source,
press OK/MENU and then Service & repair
Display notifications.
Using the service
All menus and settings are accessed from the
normal view in MY CAR by pressing OK/MENU
and then Service & repair.
When it is time for service, and in some cases
when the car is in need of repair, this is notified
1Applies to certain markets.
2Applies to Sensus Navigation.
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
}}
337
in the combined instrument panel (p. 66) and via
a pop-up menu in the screen.
Service message in the screen.
Meaning of the answer options in the screen's
pop-up menu:
Yes - A booking enquiry is sent to your
dealer who then comes back with a booking
proposal. The service lamp and service mes-
sage in the combined instrument panel are
extinguished.
No - No more pop-up messages will be
shown in the screen. The message in the
combined instrument panel remains. After
this option has been selected, it is possible
to start the manual booking in the car, see
below.
Postpone - The pop-up menu is shown the
next time the car is started.
Book a service or repair manually1
1. Press the MY CAR button in the centre con-
sole and select Service & repair Dealer
information Request service or repair.
> Vehicle data is sent automatically to your
dealer.
2. The dealer sends a booking proposal to the
car.
3. Accept or request a new booking proposal.
After the booking has been accepted the book-
ing information is stored in the car, see My book-
ings. The car will automatically communicate with
you via the screen by means of reminders about
the booking and guide you to the workshop visit.
You can also book a workshop visit via My Volvo.
Go to "My bookings" and select "Update" in
order to gain access to bookings from My Volvo.
My bookings1
Show booking information in the car's screen.
Accept or request a new booking proposal.
Select Service & repair My bookings.
Call the dealer1
With a Bluetooth® phone connected to the car,
you can call your dealer. For connecting the
phone, see the Sensus Infotainment supplement.
Select Service & repair Dealer
information Call dealer.
Using the navigation system1, 2
Enter your workshop as destination or waypoint
in the navigation system.
Select Service & repair Dealer
information Set single destination.
Select Service & repair Dealer
information Add as waypoint.
Sending vehicle data1
Vehicle data are sent to a central Volvo database
(not your dealer) from which Volvo dealers can
retrieve vehicle information using the car's identi-
fication number (VIN3). The number is printed in
the car's service and warranty booklet, alterna-
tively inside the windscreen's bottom left-hand
corner.
Select Service & repair Send car data.
1Applies to certain markets.
2Applies to Sensus Navigation.
3Vehicle Identification Number
||
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
338
Booking information and vehicle data
When you decide to book a service from your car,
the booking information and vehicle data will be
sent. Vehicle data information consists of infor-
mation within the following areas:
service requirement
function status
fluid levels
Meter reading
the car's vehicle identification number (VIN3)
The car's software version.
Related information
Volvo ID (p. 21)
3Vehicle Identification Number
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
}}
339
Raising the car
When raising the car it is important that the jack
or lifting arms are fitted in the intended points on
the car's underbody.
NOTE
Volvo recommends only using the jack that
belongs to the car model in question. If a jack
is selected other than the one recommended
by Volvo, follow the instructions supplied with
the equipment.
||
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
340
Jacking points (arrows) for the jack that belongs to the car and lifting points (marked in red).
If the car is raised with a front workshop jack
then this must be positioned under one of the
two lifting points furthest in under the car. If the
car is raised with a rear workshop jack then it
must be positioned under one of the lifting
points. Ensure that the workshop jack is posi-
tioned so that the car cannot slide off the jack.
Always use axle stands or similar.
If the car is raised with a two-pillar workshop lift
then the front and rear lifting arms can be posi-
tioned under the outer lifting points (jacking
points). Alternatively, the inner lifting points can
be used at the front.
Related information
Changing wheels - removing wheels (p. 322)
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
}}
341
Bonnet - opening and closing
The bonnet can be opened when the handle in
the passenger compartment has been turned
clockwise and the lock by the radiator grille has
been moved to the left.
The handle for bonnet opening is always on the left-
hand side.
Turn the handle about 20-25 degrees clock-
wise. You will hear when the catch releases.
Move the catch to the left and open the bon-
net. (The catch hook is located between the
headlamp and radiator grille, see illustration.)
WARNING
Check that the bonnet locks properly when
closed.
Related information
Engine compartment - checking (p. 342)
Engine compartment - overview (p. 341)
Engine compartment - overview
The overview shows some service-related com-
ponents.
Engine compartment
The appearance of the engine compartment may differ
depending on model and engine variant.
Coolant expansion tank
Washer fluid filler pipe
Radiator
Engine oil filler pipe
Reservoir for brake and clutch fluid (located
on the driver's side)
Starter battery
Relay and fuse box
Air filter
||
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
342
WARNING
The ignition system has very high voltage and
output. The voltage in the ignition system is
highly dangerous. The car's electrical system
must always be in key position 0 when work is
being performed in the engine compartment;
see Key positions - functions at different lev-
els (p. 81).
Do not touch the spark plugs or ignition coil
when the car's electrical system is in key
position II or when the engine is hot.
Related information
Bonnet - opening and closing (p. 341)
Engine compartment - checking (p. 342)
Engine compartment - checking
Some oils and fluids should be checked at regu-
lar intervals.
Regular checking
Check the following oils and fluids at regular
intervals, e.g. when refuelling:
Coolant
Engine oil
Washer fluid
WARNING
Remember that the radiator fan (located at
the front of the engine compartment, behind
the radiator) may start automatically some
after the engine has been switched off.
Always have the engine cleaned by a work-
shop - an authorised Volvo workshop is rec-
ommended. There is a risk of fire if the engine
is hot.
Related information
Bonnet - opening and closing (p. 341)
Engine compartment - overview (p. 341)
Coolant - level (p. 345)
Engine oil - checking and filling (p. 343)
Washer fluid - filling (p. 357)
Engine oil - general
An approved engine oil must be used in order
that the recommended service intervals can be
applied.
Volvo recommends:
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
}}
343
When driving under adverse conditions, see
Engine oil - adverse driving conditions (p. 389).
IMPORTANT
In order to fulfil the requirements for the
engine's service intervals all engines are filled
with a specially adapted synthetic engine oil
at the factory. The choice of oil has been
made very carefully with regard to service life,
starting characteristics, fuel consumption and
environmental impact.
An approved engine oil must be used in order
that the recommended service intervals can
be applied. Only use a prescribed grade of oil
for both filling and oil change, otherwise you
will risk affecting service life, starting charac-
teristics, fuel consumption and environmental
impact.
Volvo Car Corporation disclaims all warranty
liability if engine oil of the prescribed grade
and viscosity is not used.
Volvo recommends that oil changes are car-
ried out at an authorised Volvo workshop.
Volvo uses different systems for warning of low/
high oil level or low oil pressure. Certain engine
variants have an oil pressure sensor, and then the
combined instrument panel's warning symbol for
low oil pressure is used . Other variants
have an oil level sensor, when the driver is
informed via the instrument's warning symbol
and display texts. Certain variants have
both systems. Contact a Volvo dealer for more
information.
Change the engine oil and oil filter in accordance
with the intervals specified in the Service and
Warranty Booklet.
Using oil of a higher than specified grade is per-
mitted. If the car is driven in adverse conditions,
Volvo recommends using an oil of a higher grade
than the one specified, see Engine oil - adverse
driving conditions (p. 389).
For filling capacities, see Engine oil - grade and
volume (p. 390).
Related information
Engine oil - checking and filling (p. 343)
Engine oil - checking and filling
The oil level is detected with the electronic oil
level sensor.
||
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
344
Filler pipe4.
In some cases, oil may need to be topped up
between service intervals.
No action needs to be taken on engine oil level
until a message is shown in the combined instru-
ment panel's display, see the following illustra-
tion.
Message and graphic in the display. The left-hand dis-
play is shown in the digital combined instrument panel
and the right-hand in the analogue.
Message
Engine oil level
The oil level is checked using the electronic oil
level gauge with the thumbwheel when the
engine is switched off, see Menu navigation -
combined instrument panel (p. 110).
WARNING
If the message Oil service required is
shown, visit a workshop - an authorised Volvo
workshop is recommended. The oil level may
be too high.
IMPORTANT
If notified of low oil level, only fill with the vol-
ume specified, for example, 0.5 litres.
NOTE
The system cannot directly detect changes
when the oil is filled or drained. The car must
have been driven approx. 30 km and have
been stationary for 5 minutes with the engine
switched off and on level ground before the
oil level indication is correct.
WARNING
Do not spill oil onto the hot exhaust manifold
due to the risk of fire.
4Engines with electronic oil level sensor do not have a dipstick.
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
}}
345
Measuring the oil level
If the oil level needs to be checked then it should
be carried out in accordance with the following
sequence.
1. Activate key position II; see Key positions -
functions at different levels (p. 81).
2. Rotate the thumbwheel on the left-hand
stalk switch to position Oil level.
> You will then see information displayed
about the engine oil level.
For more information on menu navigation,
see Menu navigation - combined instru-
ment panel (p. 110).
NOTE
If the right conditions for measuring the oil
level (time after engine shutdown, the car's
inclination, outside temperature, etc.) are not
met, the message Not available will be
shown. This does not mean that there is
something wrong in the car's systems.
Related information
Engine oil - general (p. 342)
Key positions - functions at different levels
(p. 81)
Coolant - level
The coolant cools the internal combustion
engine to the correct operating temperature. The
heat that is transferred from the engine to the
coolant can be used to heat the passenger com-
partment.
Checking the level
The coolant level must lie between the MIN and
MAX marks on the expansion tank. If the cooling
system is not filled sufficiently, excessively high
temperatures could occur, causing a risk of dam-
age to the engine.
NOTE
Check the coolant level regularly when the
engine is cold.
Filling
When topping up the coolant, follow the instruc-
tions on the packaging. Never top up with water
only. The risk of freezing increases with both too
little and too much coolant concentrate.
If there is coolant under the car, if there is cool-
ant smoke, or if more than 2 litres have been
filled, always call for recovery to avoid the risk of
engine damage when starting due to a defective
cooling system.
WARNING
Coolant can be very hot. If the coolant
requires topping up when the engine is at
operating temperature, unscrew the expan-
sion tank cap slowly to gently release the
overpressure.
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
346
IMPORTANT
A high content of chlorine, chlorides and
other salts may cause corrosion in the
cooling system.
Always use coolant with anti-corrosion
agent as recommended by Volvo.
Ensure that the coolant mixture is 50%
water and 50% coolant.
Mix the coolant with approved quality tap
water. In the event of any doubt about
water quality, used ready-mixed coolant in
accordance with Volvo recommendations.
When changing coolant/replacing cool-
ing system components, flush the cooling
system clean with approved quality tap
water or flush with ready-mixed coolant.
The engine must only be run with a well-
filled cooling system. Otherwise, tempera-
tures that are too high may occur result-
ing in the risk of damage (cracks) in the
cylinder head.
For capacities and for standards regarding water
quality; see Coolant - grade and volume (p. 392).
Brake and clutch fluid - level
Brake and clutch fluid level should be between
the reservoir MIN and MAX marks.
Checking the level
Brake and clutch fluid have a common reservoir.
The level must be between the MIN and MAX
marks that are visible inside the reservoir. Check
the level regularly.
Change the brake fluid every other year or at
every other regular service.
The fluid should be changed annually on cars
driven in conditions requiring hard, frequent brak-
ing, such as driving in mountains or tropical cli-
mates with high humidity.
For capacities and recommended brake fluid
grade, see Brake fluid - grade and volume
(p. 394).
WARNING
If the brake fluid is below the MIN level in the
brake fluid reservoir, do not drive further
before topping up the brake fluid. Volvo rec-
ommends that the reason for the loss of
brake fluid is investigated by an authorised
Volvo workshop.
Filling
The fluid reservoir is located on the driver's side.
Unscrew the reservoir cap and fill the fluid. The
level must be between the MIN and MAX marks,
which are located on the inside of the reservoir.
IMPORTANT
Do not forget to refit the cap.
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
}}
347
Climate control system - fault
tracing and repair
The air conditioning system must only be serv-
iced and repaired by an authorised workshop.
Fault tracing and repair
The air conditioning system contains fluorescent
tracing agents. Ultraviolet light must be used dur-
ing leak detection.
Volvo recommends that you contact an author-
ised Volvo workshop.
Cars with R134a refrigerant
WARNING
The air conditioning system contains pressur-
ised refrigerant R134a. This system must only
be serviced and repaired by an authorised
workshop.
Cars with R1234yf refrigerant
WARNING
The air conditioning system contains pressur-
ised refrigerant R1234yf. In accordance with
SAE J2845 (Technician Training for Safe
Service and Containment of Refrigerants
Used in Mobile A/C System), service and
repair of the refrigerant system must only be
performed by trained and certified technicians
in order to ensure the safety of the system.
Related information
Volvo service programme (p. 336)
Lamp replacement - general
Several of the car's bulbs can be replaced by
the driver. For replacement of LED lamps, please
contact a workshop.
The bulbs are specified (p. 354). The following
list contains locations of bulbs and other light
sources that are specialised, such as LED5
5LED (Light Emitting Diode)
||
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
* Option/accessory.
348
lamps, or are unsuitable for changing for some
other reason, except at a workshop6:
LED headlamps
position lamps, front7
daytime running lights, front bumper7
side direction indicators, door mirrors7
approach lighting, door mirrors
interior and cargo area lighting
glovebox lighting
Position lamps, rear
side marker lamps rear
brake light above the rear windscreen
number plate lighting.
WARNING
The car’s electrical system must be in key
position 0 when replacing bulbs; see Key
positions - functions at different levels (p. 81).
IMPORTANT
Never touch the glass part of the bulbs with
your fingers. Grease from your fingers is
vaporised by the heat, coating the reflector
and then causing damage.
NOTE
If an error message remains after the broken
bulb has been replaced then we recommend
visiting an authorised Volvo workshop.
NOTE
Outside lighting such as headlamps and rear
lamps may temporarily have condensation on
the inside of the lens. This is normal, all exte-
rior lighting is designed to withstand this.
Condensation is normally vented out of the
lamp housing when the lamp has been
switched on for a time.
Related information
Lamps - specifications (p. 354)
Lamp replacement - location of front lamps
(p. 348)
Lamp replacement - location of rear lamps
(p. 352)
Lamp replacement - vanity mirror lighting
(p. 354)
Lamp replacement - location of
front lamps
The overview shows the positioning of the lamps
at the front of a car with halogen headlamps.
Position lamp (p. 351)
Main beam (p. 351)
Dipped beam (p. 350)
Indicator (p. 351)
Daytime running lights (p. 352) (LED* or
bulb depending on variant)
6An authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.
7Certain variants
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
}}
349
Related information
Lamp replacement - general (p. 347)
Lamp replacement - headlamps (p. 349)
Lamps - specifications (p. 354)
Lamp replacement - headlamps
All of the headlamp bulbs are replaced via the
engine compartment. First loosen and remove
the whole headlamp.
NOTE
Applies to cars with halogen headlamps.
1. Lift out the bonnet stop.
2. Loosen the screw with a Torx tool, size
T30.
3. Turn the locking pin anticlockwise.
Pull out the locking pin.
4. Release the headlamp by alternately tilt-
ing and pulling it out.
IMPORTANT
Take care when lifting out the headlamp so
as not to damage any parts.
5. Press down the catch.
Unplug the connector.
Place the headlight on a soft surface so as
not to scratch the lens.
IMPORTANT
Do not pull the electrical cable, only the con-
nector.
6. Replace the relevant bulb as instructed.
The headlamp must be fitted and the contact fit-
ted correctly before switching on the lights or
changing key position.
Related information
Lamp replacement - general (p. 347)
Lamp replacement - location of front lamps
(p. 348)
Lamp replacement - cover for main/dipped
beam bulbs (p. 350)
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
350
Lamp replacement - direction indicators front
(p. 351)
Lamp replacement - position lamps, front
(p. 351)
Lamps - specifications (p. 354)
Lamp replacement - cover for main/
dipped beam bulbs
Main/dipped beam bulbs are accessed by
releasing the headlamp's larger cover.
NOTE
Applies to cars with halogen headlamps.
Before the larger cover can be undone, the head-
lamp has to be undone and removed first, see
Lamp replacement - headlamps (p. 349).
1. Press the hooks together.
Angle out the cover.
2. Replace the relevant bulb as instructed.
Related information
Lamp replacement - dipped beam (p. 350)
Lamp replacement - main beam (p. 351)
Lamp replacement - dipped beam
The dipped beam bulb is fitted inside the head-
lamp's larger cover.
NOTE
Applies to cars with halogen headlamps.
1. Detach the headlamp (p. 349).
2. Undo the cover (p. 350).
3. Press the bulb holder upwards until it
releases.
Pull out the bulb holder.
4. Replace the bulb and put back the parts in
reverse order.
Related information
Lamps - specifications (p. 354)
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
351
Lamp replacement - main beam
The main beam bulb is fitted inside the head-
lamp's larger cover.
NOTE
Applies to cars with halogen headlamps.
1. Detach the headlamp (p. 349).
2. Undo the cover (p. 350).
3. Turn the bulb holder anticlockwise.
Pull out the bulb holder.
4. Replace the bulb and put back the parts in
reverse order.
Related information
Lamps - specifications (p. 354)
Lamp replacement - direction
indicators front
The direction indicator lamp is fitted inside the
headlamp's smaller cover.
NOTE
Applies to cars with halogen headlamps.
1. Detach the headlamp (p. 349).
2. Undo the cover.
3. Push in the catch.
Pull out the bulb holder.
4. Replace the bulb and put back the parts in
reverse order.
Related information
Lamps - specifications (p. 354)
Lamp replacement - position lamps,
front
The position lamp's bulb holder is located on the
side of the headlamp.
NOTE
Applies to cars with halogen headlamps.
1. Detach the headlamp (p. 349).
2. Turn the bulb holder anticlockwise.
Pull out the bulb holder.
3. Replace the bulb and put back the parts in
reverse order.
Related information
Lamps - specifications (p. 354)
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
352
Lamp replacement - daytime
running lights
The daytime running light bulb is fitted inside the
bumper's cover.
NOTE
Applies to cars with halogen headlamps.
Only applies to daytime running lights
with bulbs.
1. Undo the cover.
2. Turn the bulb holder anticlockwise.
Pull out the bulb holder.
3. Replace the bulb and put back the parts in
reverse order.
Related information
Lamps - specifications (p. 354)
Lamp replacement - location of rear
lamps
The overview shows the location of the lamps at
the rear.
Brake light (LED)
Position lamps (LED)
Brake light (p. 353)
Side marker lamps (LED)
Indicator (p. 353)
Reversing lamp (p. 353)
Fog lamp (driver's side) (p. 353)
Related information
Lamp replacement - general (p. 347)
Lamps - specifications (p. 354)
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
}}
353
Lamp replacement - direction
indicators rear, brake lights and
reversing lamp
Bulbs for rear direction indicators, brake lights
and reversing lamps are replaced from inside
the cargo area.
1. Remove the hatch in the upholstery (1) on
the same side as the defective bulb.
2. Press the catch sideways.
Pull out the bulb holder.
3. Remove the blown bulb by pressing it in and
turning anticlockwise.
4. Replace the bulb and put back the parts in
reverse order.
Related information
Lamp replacement - location of rear lamps
(p. 352)
Lamps - specifications (p. 354)
Lamp replacement - rear fog lamp
The bulb for the rear fog lamp is fitted in the
bumper's bulb holder.
Left-hand drive cars have the fog lamp on the
left-hand side, while right-hand drive cars have
the fog lamp on the right-hand side.
Lamp housing on the left-hand side.
||
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
354
Insert (approx. 20 mm) a blunt, knife-like
object, e.g. a table knife, at the triangle.
Carefully prise until the lug releases.
IMPORTANT
Take care not to damage any parts.
Turn the bulb holder anticlockwise.
Pull out the bulb holder.
3. Push in the lamp and turn it anticlockwise.
4. Replace the bulb and put back the parts in
reverse order.
Related information
Lamps - specifications (p. 354)
Lamp replacement - vanity mirror
lighting
The vanity mirror's lamps are fitted inside the
lamp lenses.
1. Insert a screwdriver under the lamp lens and
gently prize up the lug on the edge.
2. Carefully detach and lift aside the lamp lens.
3. Using needle-nose pliers, pull the bulb
straight out to the side. Do not squeeze the
bulb too hard with the pliers. Otherwise, the
bulb glass could then break.
4. Replace the bulb and put back the parts in
reverse order.
Related information
Lamps - specifications (p. 354)
Lamps - specifications
The specifications apply to bulbs. For replace-
ment of LED lamps, please contact a workshop.
Lighting WAType
Dipped beamB55 H7 LL
Main beamB65 H9
Front direction indica-
tors
21 HY21W
Position lamps, frontB5 W5W LL
Daytime running lights,
front bumperC
19 PW19W
Side direction indica-
tors, door mirrorsC
5 WY5W LL
Direction indicators,
rear
21 PY21W LL
Brake light 21 P21W LL
Reversing lamp 21 P21W LL
Rear fog lamp 21 H21W LL
Vanity mirror lighting 1.2 T5 Socket
W2x4.6d
AWatt
BCars with halogen headlights
CCertain variants
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
}}
355
Related information
Lamp replacement - general (p. 347)
Lamp replacement - location of front lamps
(p. 348)
Lamp replacement - location of rear lamps
(p. 352)
Lamp replacement - vanity mirror lighting
(p. 354)
Wiper blades
The wiper blades sweep water away from the
windscreen and rear window. Together with the
washer fluid they clean the windows and ensure
visibility for driving.
The windscreen wiper blades must be in service
position when they are to be replaced.
Service position
Wiper blades in service position.
In order to change, clean or lift the wiper blades
(for scraping off ice from the windscreen, for
example) they must be in service position.
IMPORTANT
Before placing the wiper blades in the service
position, make sure that they are not frozen
down.
1. Insert the remote control key in the ignition
switch8 and briefly press the START/STOP
ENGINE button to set the car's electrical
system to key position I. For detailed infor-
mation on key positions, see Key positions -
functions at different levels (p. 81).
2. Briefly press the START/STOP ENGINE
button again to set the car’s electrical system
in key position 0.
3. Within 3 seconds, move the right stalk switch
up and hold it in position for
approx. 1 second.
> The wipers then move to standing straight
up.
The wipers return to their starting position when
you briefly press the START/STOP ENGINE
button to set the car’s electrical system to key
position I (or when the car is started).
8Not required in cars with keyless start and lock system.
||
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
356
IMPORTANT
If the wiper arms in service position have
been folded up from the windscreen, they
must be folded back down onto the wind-
screen before the wipers are activated. This is
to avoid scraping the paint on the bonnet.
Replacing the wiper blades
Fold up the wiper arm when it is in service
position. Press the button located on the
wiper blade mounting and pull straight out
parallel with the wiper arm.
Slide in the new wiper blade until a "click" is
heard.
Check that the blade is firmly installed.
4. Fold the wiper arm back towards the wind-
screen.
The wipers return from service position to their
starting position when you briefly press the
START/STOP ENGINE button to set the car’s
electrical system to key position I (or when the
car is started).
G021763
NOTE
The wiper blades are different lengths. The
blade on the driver's side is longer than on
the passenger side.
WARNING
Since the car is equipped with airbag
Pedestrian Airbag Volvo recommends that the
wiper arms should be genuine parts and that
only genuine parts are used for them.
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
}}
357
Replacing the wiper blades, rear
window
1. Fold out the wiper arm.
2. Grip the inner section of the blade (by the
arrow).
3. Turn anticlockwise to use the blade's end
position against the wiper arm as a lever to
detach the blade more easily.
4. Press the new wiper blade into position.
Check that it is firmly installed.
5. Lower the wiper arm.
Cleaning
For cleaning wiper blades and windscreen, see
Car wash (p. 372).
IMPORTANT
Check the blades regularly. Neglected main-
tenance shortens the service life of the wiper
blades.
Related information
Washer fluid - filling (p. 357)
Washer fluid - filling
Washer fluid is used for cleaning the headlamps
and windows. Washer fluid with antifreeze must
be used when the temperature is below freezing
point.
Topping up the washer fluid takes place by open-
ing the blue cap.
The windscreen and headlamp washers share a
common reservoir.
NOTE
When there is approx. 1 litre of washer fluid
remaining in the reservoir, a message to top
up the washer fluid will be shown in the com-
bined instrument panel, together with the
symbol .
||
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
358
Prescribed grade: Washer fluid recommended
by Volvo - with frost protection during cold
weather and below freezing point.
IMPORTANT
Use Volvo genuine washer fluid or equivalent
with a recommended pH of between 6 and 8,
in working dilution (e.g. 1:1 with neutral
water).
IMPORTANT
Use washer fluid with antifreeze when the
temperature is below freezing to avoid freez-
ing in the pump, reservoir and hoses.
Volume:
Cars with headlamp washing: 5.5 litres.
Cars without headlamp washing: 3.2 litres.
Related information
Wiper blades (p. 355)
Wipers and washers (p. 102)
Bonnet - opening and closing (p. 341)
Starter battery - general
The starter battery is used to drive the starter
motor and other electrical equipment in the car.
The starter battery is a traditional 12 V battery.
The service life and function of the starter battery
is influenced by factors such as the number of
starts, discharging, driving style, driving condi-
tions, climatic conditions etc.
Never disconnect the starter battery when
the engine is running.
Check that the cables to the starter battery
are correctly connected and properly tight-
ened.
The following table shows specifications for the
starter battery.
Voltage (V) 12
Cold start capacityA - CCAB
(A) 720
Size , L×W×H (mm) 278×175×190
Capacity (Ah) 70
AAccording to EN standard.
BCold Cranking Amperes.
IMPORTANT
When replacing the starter battery in cars
with the Start/Stop function, a battery of
EFB9 type or stronger must be installed.
When replacing the support battery, a battery
of AGM10 type must be fitted.
IMPORTANT
If the starter battery is replaced, make sure
you replace it with a battery with the same
cold starting capacity and type as the original
battery (see the label on the battery).
NOTE
When replacing the battery, the size of
the new battery must correspond with the
dimensions of the original battery.
9Enhanced Flooded Battery.
10 Absorbed Glass Mat.
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
359
WARNING
The battery can generate oxyhydrogen
gas, which is highly explosive. A spark can
be formed if a jump lead is connected
incorrectly, and this can be enough for
the battery to explode.
The battery contains sulphuric acid, which
can cause serious burns.
If sulphuric acid comes into contact with
eyes, skin or clothing, flush with large
quantities of water. If acid splashes into
the eyes - seek medical attention imme-
diately.
IMPORTANT
When charging the starter battery or the sup-
port battery (p. 361), only use a modern bat-
tery charger with controlled charging voltage.
Fast charging function must not be used
since it may damage the battery.
IMPORTANT
If the following instruction is not observed
then the energy saving function for infotain-
ment system may be temporarily disengaged,
and/or the message in the combined instru-
ment panel's information display about the
starter battery's state of charge may be tem-
porarily inapplicable, following the connection
of an external battery or battery charger:
The negative battery terminal on the car's
starter battery must never be used for
connecting an external battery or battery
charger - only the car chassis may be
used as the grounding point.
See Jump starting (p. 271) for a description
of how the cable clamps must be attached.
NOTE
The life of the battery is shortened if it
becomes discharged repeatedly.
The life of the battery is affected by several
factors, including driving conditions and cli-
mate. Battery starting capacity decreases
gradually with time and therefore needs to be
recharged if the car is not used for a longer
time or when it is only driven short distances.
Extreme cold further limits starting capacity.
To maintain the battery in good condition, at
least 15 minutes of driving/week is recom-
mended or that the battery is connected to a
battery charger with automatic trickle charg-
ing.
A battery that is kept fully charged has a
maximum service life.
Related information
Battery - symbols (p. 360)
Starter battery - replacement (p. 360)
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
360
Battery - symbols
There are information and warning symbols on
the batteries.
Symbols on the batteries
Use protective goggles.
Further information in the
owner's manual for the car.
Store the battery out of the
reach of children.
The battery contains corro-
sive acid.
Avoid sparks and naked
flames.
Risk of explosion.
Must be taken for recycling.
NOTE
An expended starter battery or support bat-
tery must be recycled in an environmentally
safe manner since it contains lead.
Related information
Starter battery - general (p. 358)
Battery - Start/Stop (p. 361)
Starter battery - replacement
The starter battery should be replaced by an
authorised workshop.
Volvo recommends that you allow an authorised
workshop to replace the batteries - an authorised
Volvo workshop is recommended.
For more information on the car's starter battery,
see Starter battery - general (p. 358) and Jump
starting (p. 271).
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
}}
* Option/accessory. 361
Battery - Start/Stop
Cars with Start/Stop function, in addition to the
starter battery, are equipped with a support bat-
tery.
Cars with the Start/Stop function are equipped
with two 12 V batteries - one extra powerful
starter battery for starting and one support bat-
tery that helps during the Start/Stop function's
starting sequence.
For more information on the Start/Stop function,
see Start/Stop* (p. 279).
For more information on the car's starter battery,
see Jump starting (p. 271).
The following table shows specifications for the
support battery.
Voltage (V) 12
Cold start capacityA - CCAB
(A)
120C
170D
Size , L×W×H (mm) 150×90×106C
150×90×130D
Capacity (Ah) 8C
10D
AAccording to EN standard.
BCold Cranking Amperes.
CManual gearbox in combination with Start/Stop function that
only auto-stops when the car is completely stationary.
DOthers.
IMPORTANT
When replacing the starter battery in cars
with the Start/Stop function, a battery of
EFB11 type or stronger must be installed.
When replacing the support battery, a battery
of AGM12 type must be fitted.
NOTE
The higher the current take-off in the car,
the more the alternator must be working
and the batteries charging = Increased
fuel consumption.
When the capacity of the starter battery
has fallen below the lowest permissible
level then the Start/Stop function is dis-
engaged.
Temporarily reduced Start/Stop function due to
high current take-off means:
The engine starts automatically13 without the
driver depressing the clutch pedal (manual
gearbox).
The engine starts automatically without the
driver lifting his/her foot off the foot brake
pedal (automatic gearbox).
11 Enhanced Flooded Battery.
12 Absorbed Glass Mat.
13 Automatic starting can only take place if the gear lever is in neutral position.
||
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
362
Location of the batteries
Starter battery14
Support battery
The support battery normally requires no more
service than the normal starter battery. A work-
shop should be contacted in the event of ques-
tions or problems - an authorised Volvo workshop
is recommended.
IMPORTANT
If the following instruction is not observed
then the Start/Stop function may temporarily
cease to work after the connection of an
external battery or battery charger:
The negative battery terminal on the car's
starter battery must never be used for
connecting an external battery or battery
charger - only the car chassis may be
used as the grounding point.
See Jump starting (p. 271) for a description
of how the cable clamps must be attached.
NOTE
If the starter battery has been discharged so
much that the car has no normal electrical
functions and the engine is then jump-started
with an external battery or a battery charger,
the Start/Stop function will continue to be
activated. If the Start/Stop function then
auto-stops the engine shortly after, there is a
great risk that engine auto-start will fail due
to insufficient battery capacity, because the
battery has not had the opportunity to
recharge.
If the car has been jump-started, or if there is
insufficient time to charge the battery with a
battery charger, the recommendation is to
temporarily deactivate the Start/Stop function
until the battery has been recharged by the
car. In an outside temperature of +15 °C, the
battery needs to be charged for at least
1 hour by the car. In a lower outside tempera-
ture, the charging time may increase to
3-4 hours. The recommendation is to charge
the battery using an external battery charger.
For more information on charging the starter
battery, see Starter battery - general (p. 358).
Related information
Battery - symbols (p. 360)
14 See Starter battery - general (p. 358) for a detailed description of the starter battery.
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
363
Electrical system
The electrical system is single-pole and uses the
chassis and engine casing as a conductor.
The car has a voltage-regulated AC alternator.
The size, type and performance of the starter bat-
tery depend on the car's equipment and function.
IMPORTANT
If the starter battery is replaced, make sure
you replace it with a battery with the same
cold starting capacity and type as the original
battery (see the label on the battery).
Related information
Starter battery - replacement (p. 360)
Starter battery - general (p. 358)
Fuses - general
All electrical functions and components are pro-
tected by a number of fuses in order to protect
the car's electrical system from damage by short
circuiting or overloading.
If an electrical component or function does not
work, it may be because the component's fuse
was temporarily overloaded and failed. If the
same fuse fails repeatedly then there is a fault in
the circuit. Volvo recommends that you visit an
authorised Volvo workshop for checking.
Changing
1. Look in the fuse diagram to locate the fuse.
2. Pull out the fuse and check from the side to
see whether the curved wire has blown.
3. If this is the case, replace it with a new fuse
of the same colour and amperage.
WARNING
Never use a foreign object or a fuse with an
amperage higher than that specified when
replacing a fuse. This could cause significant
damage to the electrical system and possibly
lead to fire.
Location of central electrical units
Fuse box locations in a left-hand drive car. In a
right-hand drive car the fuse box under the glove-
box changes sides.
Engine compartment
Under the glovebox
Under the right-hand front seat
Related information
Fuses - in engine compartment (p. 364)
Fuses - under glovebox (p. 367)
Fuses - under the right-hand front seat
(p. 370)
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
364
Fuses - in engine compartment
Fuses in the engine compartment protect engine
and brake functions, amongst other things.
On the inside of the cover there are tweezers that
facilitate the procedure for the removal and fitting
of fuses.
The fuse box also provides space for several
spare fuses.
Replacing fuses
The fuses can be accessed following the removal
of the cover fitted on the starter battery and the
cover for the electrical distribution unit.
Removing the covers
Fold out the locking catches that are fit-
ted on the sides of the cover on the starter
battery.
Lift the cover straight up.
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
}}
* Option/accessory. 365
Fold out the locking catch that is fitted on
the side of the electrical distribution unit.
Rotate the cover upward until the lock
lugs (1) are released.
Fold the cover toward the engine to access
the fuses.
Refitting the covers
Reinstall the parts in reverse order.
Positions
The label on the inside of the cover shows the
positions of the fuses.
Fuses 7-18 and 46 are of the "JCASE" type
and should be replaced by a workshop15.
Fuses 19-45 and 47-48 are of "Mini Fuse"
type.
Function AA
ABS pump 40
ABS valves 30
Headlamp washers*20
Ventilation fan 40
- -
Primary fuse for fuses 32-36 30
- -
Heated windscreen, right-hand
side*
40
- -
Heated windscreen, left-hand side*40
Parking heater*20
Function AA
Windscreen wipers 20
Central electronic module, refer-
ence voltage, support battery
5
Horn 15
Brake light 5
- -
Headlamp control 5
Internal relay coils 5
12 V socket, tunnel console front 15
Transmission control module 15
- -
12 V socket, tunnel console rear 15
- -
Engine Control Module (ECM) 5
Power seat, right*20
Lambda-sonds; Relay coil in relay
for cooling fan
15
15 An authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.
||
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
* Option/accessory.
366
Function AA
Vacuum regulators; Valves; Control
module, radiator roller cover; Con-
trol module, spoiler roller cover
(diesel); Compressor A/C; Solenoid
for engine oil pump; Cooling valve
for climate control system (diesel);
Glow control module (diesel); Relay
coils in relays for Start/Stop func-
tions
10
EGR valve (diesel); EVAP valve
(petrol); Engine control module;
Thermostat for engine cooling sys-
tem (petrol); Cooling pump for EGR
(diesel)
15
Ignition coils (petrol) 15
Diesel filter heater (diesel) 25
Engine Control Module (ECM) 15
ABS 5
Engine control module; Transmis-
sion control module; Airbags
7.5
Headlamp levelling*10
Electric control servo 5
Central electronic module 15
Function AA
- -
- -
Collision warning system 5
Accelerator pedal sensor 5
- -
- -
Coolant pump (when no parking
heater is available)
10
AAmpere
Related information
Fuses - under glovebox (p. 367)
Fuses - under the right-hand front seat
(p. 370)
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
}}
367
Fuses - under glovebox
Fuses under the glovebox protect the airbag and
passenger compartment lighting functions,
amongst other things.
On the inside of the cover for the fuse box in
the engine compartment there are tweezers
that facilitate the procedure for the removal and
fitting of fuses.
The fuse box in the engine compartment also
provides space for several spare fuses.
Replacing fuses
The fuses can be accessed when a protective
cover has been removed from the fuse box.
||
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
* Option/accessory.
368
Cover removal
Take hold of the recess and pull until the
locking lugs in the lower edge of the cover
are released from the fuse box.
Remove the cover.
NOTE
A relatively large amount of tensile force is
required to release the locking lugs at the top
edge of the cover from the electrical distribu-
tion unit.
Cover refitting
Guide in the lower lugs.
Turn the cover upwards until the upper lugs
engage.
NOTE
Make sure that the upper locking lugs are
seated properly in the grooves of the electri-
cal distribution unit.
Positions
The fuses are of "Mini Fuse" type.
Function AA
Fuel pump 20
- -
Function AA
Rear window wiper 15
Display in roof console (Seatbelt
reminder/Indicator for airbag on
the front passenger seat)
5
Interior lighting, Controls in roof
console for front reading lamps
and passenger compartment light-
ing; Power seats*
7.5
Power operated roller blind for
glass roof*
10
Rain sensor*; Dimming, interior
rearview mirror*; Moisture sensor*
5
Collision warning system*5
- -
Unlocking, tailgateB10
- -
Reserve position 3, constant volt-
age
5
Steering lock 15
Combined instrument panel 5
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
* Option/accessory. 369
Function AA
Central locking system, fuel filler
flapC
10
Climate panel 7.5
Steering wheel module 7.5
Siren*; Data link connector OBDII 5
Main beam 15
- -
Reversing lamp 7.5
Windscreen wipersD; Rear wind-
screen wiperD
20
Immobiliser 5
Reserve position 1, constant volt-
age
15
Reserve position 2, constant volt-
age
20
Movement detector for alarm*;
Remote receiver
5
Windscreen wipersE; Rear wind-
screen wiperE
20
Function AA
Central locking system, fuel filler
flapF
10
Unlocking, tailgateG10
Electric additional heater*; Button
seat heating rear*
7.5
Airbags; Pedestrian airbag*7.5
Reserve position 4, constant volt-
age
7.5
- -
- -
AAmpere
BSee also fuse 84.
CSee also fuse 83.
DSee also fuse 82.
ESee also fuse 77.
FSee also fuse 70.
GSee also fuse 65.
Related information
Fuses - in engine compartment (p. 364)
Fuses - under the right-hand front seat
(p. 370)
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
* Option/accessory.
370
Fuses - under the right-hand front
seat
Fuses under the right-hand front seat protect the
infotainment system and seat heating, amongst
other things.
On the inside of the cover for the fuse box in
the engine compartment there are tweezers
that facilitate the procedure for the removal and
fitting of fuses.
The fuse box in the engine compartment also
provides space for several spare fuses.
Positions
Fuses 24-28 are of "JCASE" type and
should be replaced by a workshop16.
Fuses 1-23 and 29-46 are of "Mini Fuse"
type.
Function AA
- -
Keyless system*10
Door handles, keyless system*5
Control panel, left front door 25
16 An authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
* Option/accessory. 371
Function AA
Control panel, right front door 25
Control panel, left rear door 25
Control panel, right rear door 25
Primary fuse for fuses 12-16: Info-
tainment
25
Power seat, left*20
- -
Internal relay coil 5
- -
- -
- -
- -
- -
12 V socket, cargo area 15
- -
- -
- -
Function AA
- -
- -
Trailer socket 2*20
Audio control unit (amplifier)*30
- -
Trailer socket 1*40
Rear window defroster 30
- -
BLIS*5
Parking assistance*5
Parking camera*5
- -
- -
Seat heating, front driver's side 15
Seat heating, front passenger side 15
- -
- -
Function AA
- -
Seat heating, rear right*15
Seat heating, rear left*15
- -
- -
- -
- -
Audio control module (amplifier)*,
signal for diagnosis; Audio control
module or Control module SensusB;
Infotainment control module or
ScreenB; Digital radio*; TV*
15
Telematics*; Bluetooth*5
AAmpere
BCertain model variants.
Related information
Fuses - in engine compartment (p. 364)
Fuses - under glovebox (p. 367)
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
372
Car wash
The car should be washed as soon as it
becomes dirty. Wash the car in a car wash with
oil separator. Use car shampoo.
Handwashing
Remove bird droppings from the paintwork
as soon as possible. Bird droppings contain
chemicals that affect and discolour paintwork
very quickly. An authorised Volvo workshop is
recommended for the removal of any discol-
oration.
Hose down the underbody.
Rinse the entire car until the dissolved dirt
has been removed so as to reduce the risk of
scratches from washing. Do not spray directly
onto the locks.
If necessary, use cold degreasing agent on
very dirty surfaces. Note that in this case, the
surfaces must not be hot from the sun!
Wash using a sponge, car shampoo and
plenty of lukewarm water.
Clean the wiper blades with a lukewarm soap
solution or car shampoo.
Dry the car using a clean, soft chamois or a
water scraper. If you avoid allowing drops of
water to dry in strong sunlight, you reduce
the risk of water drying stains which may
need to be polished out.
WARNING
Always have the engine cleaned by a work-
shop. There is a risk of fire if the engine is hot.
IMPORTANT
Dirty headlamps have impaired functionality.
Clean them regularly, when refuelling for
example.
Do not use any corrosive cleaning agents or
cleaning agents with a pH value lower than
3.5 or higher than 11.5. Use water and a non-
scratching sponge.
NOTE
Outside lighting such as headlamps and rear
lamps may temporarily have condensation on
the inside of the lens. This is normal, all exte-
rior lighting is designed to withstand this.
Condensation is normally vented out of the
lamp housing when the lamp has been
switched on for a time.
Automatic car washes
An automatic car wash is a simple and quick way
of washing the car, but it cannot reach every-
where. Handwashing the car is recommended for
achieving optimum results.
NOTE
The car must only be washed by hand over
the first few months. This is because the paint
is more delicate when it is new.
IMPORTANT
If the car is painted with a matte clear coat,
never use a washing program that finishes
with hot wax treatment.
High-pressure washing
When using high-pressure washing, use sweep-
ing movements and make sure that the nozzle
does not come closer than 30 cm to the surface
of the car (the distance applies to all exterior
parts). Do not spray directly onto the locks.
Testing the brakes
WARNING
Always test the brakes after washing the car,
including the parking brake, to ensure that
moisture and corrosion do not attack the
brake linings and reduce braking perform-
ance.
Lightly depress the brake pedal now and then
when driving long distances in rain or slush. The
heat from the friction causes the brake linings to
warm up and dry. Do the same thing after starting
in very damp or cold weather.
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
* Option/accessory. 373
Wiper blades
Asphalt, dust and salt residue on wiper blades, as
well as insects, ice etc. on the windscreen, impair
the service life of wiper blades.
For cleaning:
Set the wiper blades to the service position;
see Wiper blades (p. 355).
NOTE
Wash the wiper blades and windscreen regu-
larly with lukewarm soap solution or car
shampoo.
Do not use any strong solvents.
Exterior plastic, rubber and trim
components
A special cleaning agent available from Volvo
dealers is recommended for the cleaning and
care of coloured plastic parts, rubber and trim
components, such as glossy trim mouldings.
When using such a cleaning agent the instruc-
tions must be followed carefully.
The frames around the side windows, the car's
roof rails and the door frames at the windows*
are produced in anodised aluminium. This means
that they should only be washed using a cleaning
agent with a pH value between 3.5 and 11.5.
This is in order to avoid discolouration.
Parts that should be washed using a cleaning agent with
a pH value between 3.5 and 11.5.
IMPORTANT
Avoid waxing and polishing on plastic, rubber
and on parts painted in matte or semi-matte
version.
When using degreasant on plastic and rubber,
only rub with light pressure if it is necessary.
Use a soft washing sponge.
Polishing glossy trim mouldings could wear
away or damage the glossy surface layer.
Polishing agent that contains abrasive must
not be used.
IMPORTANT
Avoid washing the car with cleaning agent
with a pH value lower than 3.5 or higher than
11.5. This may result in discolouration of ano-
dised aluminium parts such as roof rack and
around the side windows.
Never use metal polishing agent on anodised
aluminium parts, this can result in discoloura-
tion and destroy the surface treatment.
Rims
Only use rim cleaning agent recommended by
Volvo.
After washing, discolouration at the base of the
spokes may remain due to metal dust from the
brake discs attaching in the wheel rim's paint.
Paint cleaner works in many cases, with very fine
polishing using a soft cloth.
Strong rim cleaning agents can damage the sur-
face and cause stains on chrome-plated alumi-
nium rims.
Related information
Polishing and waxing (p. 374)
Cleaning the interior (p. 376)
Water and dirt-repellent coating (p. 375)
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
374
Polishing and waxing
Polish and wax the car if the paintwork is dull or
to give the paintwork extra protection.
The car does not need to be polished until it is
at least one year old. However, the car can be
waxed during this time. Do not polish or wax the
car in direct sunlight.
Wash and dry the car thoroughly before you
begin polishing or waxing. Clean off asphalt and
tar stains using tar remover or white spirit. More
stubborn stains can be removed using fine rub-
bing paste designed for car paintwork.
Polish first with a polish and then wax with liquid
or solid wax. Follow the instructions on the pack-
aging carefully. Many preparations contain both
polish and wax.
IMPORTANT
Avoid waxing and polishing on plastic, rubber
and on parts painted in matte or semi-matte
version.
When using degreasant on plastic and rubber,
only rub with light pressure if it is necessary.
Use a soft washing sponge.
Polishing glossy trim mouldings could wear
away or damage the glossy surface layer.
Polishing agent that contains abrasive must
not be used.
IMPORTANT
Only paint treatment recommended by Volvo
should be used. Other treatment such as pre-
serving, sealing, protection, lustre sealing or
similar could damage the paintwork. Paint-
work damage caused by such treatments is
not covered by Volvo warranty.
Matte clear coat
When the car is painted in a matte clear coat, the
following must be considered in order to avoid
paint damage due to incorrect treatment.
IMPORTANT
Never polish a matte clear coat. Polishing
leads to the paint becoming shiny.
Do not use paint cleaner, grinding agents,
polishing products or sheen preservation, e.g.
wax. These products are only intended for
glossy surfaces. If they are used on matte
paint then there will be significant damage to
the surfaces (glossy spots).
IMPORTANT
If wax gets onto the matte paint surface
then it must be removed immediately
using standard type white benzene.
Make sure you do not get resin, grease or
oil on the car's paint. They may leave resi-
dues. Remove immediately using stand-
ard type white benzene.
Proceed with caution and do not press too
hard on the painted surface.
Related information
Car wash (p. 372)
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
* Option/accessory. 375
Water and dirt-repellent coating
The windows are treated with a surface coating
that improves visibility in difficult weather condi-
tions.
Water and dirt-repellent coating*
There is natural wear of the water-
repellent coating.
Maintenance:
Never use products such as car wax,
degreaser or similar on glass surfaces as this
could ruin their water-repellent properties.
Take care when cleaning so as not to dam-
age the glass surface.
To avoid damaging glass surfaces when
removing ice – only use plastic ice scrapers.
Treatment with a special finishing agent
available from Volvo dealers is recommended
in order to maintain the water-repellent prop-
erties on the side windows. This should be
used first after three years and then each
year.
IMPORTANT
Do not use a metal ice scraper to remove ice
from the windows. Use the heating to remove
ice from the door mirrors; see Windows and
door mirrors - heating (p. 107).
Related information
Car wash (p. 372)
Rustproofing
The car received a thorough and complete rust-
proofing at the factory. Parts of the body are
made of galvanised sheet metal. The underbody
is protected by a wear-resistant anti-corrosion
compound. A thin, penetrating rustproofing fluid
was sprayed into the exposed members, cavi-
ties, closed sections and side doors.
Inspection and maintenance
The car's anti-corrosion protection does not nor-
mally need to be maintained, but keeping the car
clean always helps to further reduce the risk of
corrosion. Strong alkaline or acidic cleaning solu-
tions must always be avoided on the glossy trim
components. Any stone chips should be rectified
as soon as they are discovered.
Related information
Paint damage (p. 377)
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
376
Cleaning the interior
Only use cleaning agents and car care products
recommended by Volvo. Clean regularly and
treat stains at once for best results. Vacuuming
is important prior to using cleaning agents.
IMPORTANT
Certain items of coloured clothing (e.g.
dark jeans and suede garments) may
stain the upholstery. If this occurs, it is
important to clean and treat these parts
of the upholstery as soon as possible.
Never use strong solvents such as
washer fluid, pure petrol or white spirit to
clean the interior, since this may damage
the upholstery as well as other interior
materials.
Never spray the cleaning agent directly
onto components that have electrical but-
tons and controls. Wipe them instead
using a moistened cloth containing the
cleaning agent.
Sharp objects and Velcro may damage
the fabric upholstery.
Fabric upholstery and ceiling upholstery
Volvo offers a comprehensive fabric care product
for fabric upholstery and ceiling upholstery which,
when used in accordance with the instructions,
preserves the properties of the upholstery. The
fabric care product is available for purchase from
a Volvo dealer.
Leather upholstery
Volvo's leather upholstery is treated to preserve
its original appearance.
Leather upholstery is a natural product that
changes and acquires a beautiful patina over
time. Regular cleaning and treatment are
required in order that the properties and colours
of the leather shall be preserved. Volvo offers a
comprehensive product, Volvo Leather Care Kit/
Wipes, for the cleaning and treatment of leather
upholstery which, when used in accordance with
the instructions, preserves the leather's protective
coating.
To achieve best results, Volvo recommends the
cleaning and application of the protective cream
once to four times per year (or more if required).
The Volvo Leather Care Kit/Wipes is available for
purchase from a Volvo dealer.
Leather steering wheel
Leather needs to breathe. Never cover the
leather steering wheel with protective plastic.
Volvo Leather Care Kit/Wipes is recommended
for cleaning the leather steering wheel.
Interior plastic, metal and wood parts
A fibrillated fibre or microfibre cloth, lightly mois-
tened with water, available from a Volvo dealer, is
recommended for cleaning interior parts and sur-
faces.
Do not scrape or rub stains. Never use strong
stain removers. A special cleaning agent available
from Volvo dealers can be used for more difficult
cleaning.
Seatbelts
Use water and a synthetic detergent. A special
textile cleaning agent is available from a Volvo
dealer. Ensure that the seatbelt is dry before
allowing it to retract.
Inlay mats and floor mat
Remove inlaid carpets for separate cleaning of
the floor carpet and the inlaid carpets. Use a vac-
uum cleaner to remove dust and dirt. Each inlay
mat is secured with pins.
Remove the inlay mat by taking hold of the inlay
mat at each pin and lifting the mat straight up.
Fit the inlay mat in place by pressing it in at each
pin.
WARNING
Only use one inlaid mat at each seat, and
check before setting off that the mat by the
driver's seat is firmly affixed and secured in
the pins so that it does not get caught adja-
cent to and under the pedals.
A special textile cleaner is recommended for
stains on the floor mat after vacuuming. Floor
mats must be cleaned with agents recommended
by a Volvo dealer.
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
}}
377
Related information
Car wash (p. 372)
Paint damage
Paint is an important part of the car's rustproof-
ing and should therefore be checked regularly.
The most common types of paintwork damage
are stone chips, scratches, and marks on the
edges of wings, doors and bumpers.
IMPORTANT
When the car is painted in a matte clear coat:
Only allow an authorised workshop to carry
out paint repairs. An authorised Volvo work-
shop is recommended.
Touching up minor paintwork damage
To avoid the onset of rust, damaged paintwork
should be rectified immediately.
Materials that may be needed
Primer17 - a special adhesive primer in a
spray can is available for e.g. plastic-coated
bumpers.
Base coat and clear coat - are available in
spray cans or as touch-up pens/sticks18.
Masking tape.
Fine sand paper17.
Colour code
The label for colour code is located on the car's
door pillar and is visible when the right-hand rear
door is opened.
Exterior colour code
Any secondary exterior colour code
It is important that the correct colour is used. For
product label location, see Type designations
(p. 380).
17 If required.
18 Follow the instructions that are included with the package for the touch-up pen/stick.
||
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
378
Repair minor paintwork damage such
as stone chips and scratches
G021832
Before work is begun, the car must be clean and
dry and at a temperature above 15 °C.
1. Apply a piece of masking tape over the dam-
aged surface. Then remove the tape to
remove any loose paint.
If the damage is down to the metal, use of a
primer is appropriate. In the event of damage
to a plastic surface, an adhesive primer
should be used to give better results - spray
into the lid of the spray can and brush on
thinly.
2. Before painting, gentle polishing using a very
fine polishing agent may be carried out
locally if required (e.g. if there are any uneven
edges). The surface is cleaned thoroughly
and left to dry.
3. Stir the primer well and apply using a fine
brush, a matchstick or similar. Finish off with
a basecoat and clearcoat once the primer
has dried.
4. For scratches, proceed as above, but mask
around the damaged area to protect the
undamaged paintwork.
NOTE
If the stone chip has not penetrated down to
the meal and an undamaged layer of paint
remains in place, fill in with basecoat and
clearcoat as soon as the surface has been
cleaned.
Related information
Rustproofing (p. 375)
SPECIFICATIONS
SPECIFICATIONS
380
Type designations Type designation, vehicle identification number,
etc., i.e. information unique to the car, can be
read on a label in the car.
SPECIFICATIONS
}}
381
Label location
The illustration is schematic - details may vary depending on market and model.
Knowing the car's type designation, vehicle iden-
tification and engine numbers can facilitate all
||
SPECIFICATIONS
382
contact with an authorised Volvo dealer regarding
the car and when ordering spare parts and
accessories.
Decal for type designation, vehicle identifica-
tion number, permissible maximum weights
and code designation for exterior colour and
type approval number. The decal is posi-
tioned on the door pillar, and will be visible
when the right-hand rear door is opened.
Label for A/C system.
Label for parking heater.
Decal for engine code and the engine's
serial number.
Label for engine oil.
Decal for gearbox type designation and serial
number.
Manual gearbox
Automatic gearbox
Decal for the car's identification number -
VIN (Vehicle Identification Number).
Further information on the car is presented in the
registration document.
NOTE
It is not intended that the decals illustrated in
the owner's manual should be exact replicas
of those in the car. They are included to show
their approximate appearance and locations
in the car. The information that applies to your
particular car can be found on the decal on
the car.
Related information
Weights (p. 385)
Engine specifications (p. 388)
SPECIFICATIONS
}}
383
Dimensions
Measurement of car length, height, etc. can be
read in the table.
V40.
Dimensions mm
A Wheelbase 2647
B Length 4370
C Load length, floor, folded rear
seat 1508
D Load length, floor 684
E Height 1420
Dimensions mm
F Load height 532
G Front track 1546A
1551B
1559C
Dimensions mm
H Rear track 1533A
1538B
1546C
I Load width, floor 960
J Width 1802
||
SPECIFICATIONS
384
Dimensions mm
K Width including door mirrors 2041
L Width including folded-in door
mirrors 1857
AOffset 52.5 mm.
BOffset 50 mm.
COffset 46 mm.
SPECIFICATIONS
385
Weights
Max. gross vehicle weight, etc. can be read on a
label in the car.
Kerb weight includes the driver, the fuel tank
90% full and all fluids.
The weight of passengers and accessories, and
towball load (p. 386) (when a trailer is hitched)
influence the load capacity and are not included
in the kerb weight.
Permitted max. load = Gross vehicle weight -
Kerb weight.
NOTE
The documented kerb weight applies to cars
in the standard version - i.e. a car without
extra equipment or accessories. This means
that for every accessory added the loading
capacity of the car is reduced correspondingly
by the weight of the accessory.
Examples of accessories that reduce load
capacity are the different equipment levels
(e.g. Kinetic, Momentum, Summum), as well
as other accessories such as towbar, load
carrier, space box, audio system, auxiliary
lamps, GPS, fuel-driven heater, safety grille,
carpets, cargo cover, power seats, etc.
Weighing the car is a certain way of ascer-
taining the kerb weight of your own particular
car.
WARNING
The car's driving characteristics change
depending on how heavily it is loaded and
how the load is distributed.
For information on label location, see Type designations
(p. 380).
Max. gross vehicle weight
Max. train weight (car+trailer)
Max. front axle load
Max. rear axle load
Equipment level
Max. load: See registration document.
Max. roof load: 75 kg.
Related information
Towing capacity and towball load (p. 386)
SPECIFICATIONS
386
Towing capacity and towball load
Towing capacity and towball load for driving with
a trailer can be read in the tables.
Max. weight braked trailer
NOTE
Not all engines are available in all markets.
V40
Engine
Engine codeAGearbox Max. weight braked trailer (kg) Max. towball load (kg)
T2 B4204T38 Manual, M76 1500 75
T2 B4154T5 Automatic, TF-71SC 1500 75
T3 B4204T37 Manual, M76 1500 75
T3 B4154T4 Automatic, TF-71SC 1500 75
T3 B4154T6 Automatic, TF-71SC 1500 75
T4 B4204T19 Manual, M76 1500 75
T4 B4204T19 Automatic, TF-71SC 1500 75
T4 B4204T41 Automatic, TG-81SC 1500 75
T5 B4204T11 Automatic, TG-81SC 1500 75
D2 D4204T8 Manual, M76 1500 75
D2 D4204T8 Automatic, TF-71SC 1500 75
D3 D4204T9 Manual, M76 1500 75
D3 D4204T9 Automatic, TF-71SC 1500 75
SPECIFICATIONS
387
V40
Engine
Engine codeAGearbox Max. weight braked trailer (kg) Max. towball load (kg)
D4 D4204T14 Manual, M66 1500 75
D4 D4204T14 Automatic, TG-81SC 1500 75
AEngine code, component and serial number can be read on the engine; see Type designations (p. 380).
Max. weight unbraked trailer
V40
Engine
Max. weight unbraked trailer (kg) Max. towball load (kg)
D2 (D4204T8) with manual gearbox 650 50
other 700 50
Related information
Weights (p. 385)
Driving with a trailer (p. 302)
Trailer Stability Assist - TSA (p. 309)
SPECIFICATIONS
388
Engine specifications
Engine specifications (output etc.) for each
respective engine alternative can be read in the
table.
NOTE
Not all engines are available in all markets.
V40
Engine
Engine codeAOutput (kW/
rpm)
Output (hp/rpm) Torque (Nm/rpm) No. of cylin-
ders
Bore
(mm)
Stroke
(mm)
Swept vol-
ume (litres)
Compres-
sion ratio
T2 B4154T5 90/5000 122/5000 220/1600-3500 4 82.0 70.9 1.498 10.5:1
T2 B4204T38 90/5000 122/5000 220/1100-3500 4 82.0 93.2 1.969 11.3:1
T3 B4154T4 112/5000 152/5000 250/1700–4000 4 82.0 70.9 1.498 10.5:1
T3 B4204T37 112/5000 152/5000 250/1300–4000 4 82.0 93.2 1.969 11.3:1
T3 B4154T6 112/5000 152/5000 250/1700–4000 4 82.0 70.9 1.498 8,8:1
T4 B4204T19 140/4700 190/4700 300/1300–4000 4 82.0 93.2 1.969 11.3:1
T4 B4204T41 180/5500 245/5500 350/1500–4800 4 82.0 93.2 1.969 8.6:1
T5 B4204T11 180/5500 245/5500 350/1500–4800 4 82.0 93.2 1.969 10.8:1
D2 D4204T8 88/3750 120/3750 280/1500-2250 4 82.0 93.2 1.969 16.0:1
D3 D4204T9 110/3750 150/3750 320/1750-3000 4 82.0 93.2 1.969 16.0:1
D4 D4204T14 140/4250 190/4250 400/1750-2500 4 82.0 93.2 1.969 15.8:1
AEngine code, component and serial number can be read on the engine; see Type designations (p. 380).
Related information
Coolant - grade and volume (p. 392)
Engine oil - grade and volume (p. 390)
SPECIFICATIONS
389
Engine oil - adverse driving
conditions
Adverse driving conditions can lead to abnor-
mally high oil temperature or oil consumption.
Below are some examples of adverse driving
conditions.
Check the oil level (p. 343), more frequently for
long journeys:
towing a caravan or trailer
in mountainous regions
at high speeds
in temperatures colder than -30 °C or hotter
than +40 °C
The above also apply to shorter driving distances
at low temperatures.
Choose a fully synthetic engine oil for adverse
driving conditions. It provides extra protection for
the engine.
Volvo recommends:
IMPORTANT
In order to fulfil the requirements for the
engine's service intervals all engines are filled
with a specially adapted synthetic engine oil
at the factory. The choice of oil has been
made very carefully with regard to service life,
starting characteristics, fuel consumption and
environmental impact.
An approved engine oil must be used in order
that the recommended service intervals can
be applied. Only use a prescribed grade of oil
for both filling and oil change, otherwise you
will risk affecting service life, starting charac-
teristics, fuel consumption and environmental
impact.
Volvo Car Corporation disclaims all warranty
liability if engine oil of the prescribed grade
and viscosity is not used.
Volvo recommends that oil changes are car-
ried out at an authorised Volvo workshop.
Related information
Engine oil - grade and volume (p. 390)
Engine oil - general (p. 342)
SPECIFICATIONS
390
Engine oil - grade and volume
Recommended engine oil grade and volume for
each respective engine alternative can be read
in the table.
Volvo recommends:
NOTE
Not all engines are available in all markets.
V40
Engine
Engine codeAOil grade Volume, incl. oil filter
(litres)
T2 B4204T38 Castrol Edge Professional V 0W-20 or VCC RBS0-2AE 0W-20 approx. 5.9
T2 B4154T5 approx. 5.9
T3 B4154T4 approx. 5.9
T3 B4154T6 approx. 5.9
SPECIFICATIONS
391
V40
Engine
Engine codeAOil grade Volume, incl. oil filter
(litres)
T3 B4204T37 Castrol Edge Professional V 0W-20 or VCC RBS0-2AE 0W-20 approx. 5.9
T4 B4204T19 approx. 5.9
T4 B4204T41 approx. 5.9
T5 B4204T11 approx. 5.9
D2 D4204T8 Castrol Edge Professional V 0W-20 or VCC RBS0-2AE 0W-20 approx 5.2
D3 D4204T9 approx 5.2
D4 D4204T14 approx 5.2
AEngine code, component and serial number can be read on the engine; see Type designations (p. 380).
Related information
Engine oil - adverse driving conditions
(p. 389)
Engine oil - checking and filling (p. 343)
SPECIFICATIONS
392
Coolant - grade and volume
Approved coolant volume for each respective
engine alternative can be read in the table.
Prescribed grade: Coolant recommended by
Volvo mixed with 50% water1, see the packaging.
NOTE
Not all engines are available in all markets.
V40
EngineA
Volume
(litres)
T2 B4154T5
7.5 (7,8B)
T2 B4204T38
T3 B4154T4
T3 B4154T6
T3 B4204T37
T4 B4204T19
T4 B4204T41
T5 B4204T11
V40
EngineA
Volume
(litres)
D2 D4204T8
8,0 (8,4B)
D3 D4204T9
D4 D4204T14
AEngine code, component and serial number can be read on the
engine; see Type designations (p. 380).
BApplies to cars with fuel-driven heater.
Related information
Coolant - level (p. 345)
1Water quality must fulfil the standard STD 1285.1.
SPECIFICATIONS
393
Transmission fluid - grade and
volume
The prescribed transmission fluid and volume for
each respective gearbox alternative can be read
in the table.
Manual gearbox
Manual gearbox Volume (litres) Prescribed transmission fluid
M66 approx. 1.45 BOT 350M3
M76 approx 1.6 BOT 352 B1
Automatic gearbox
Automatic gearbox Volume (litres) Prescribed transmission fluid
TF-71SC approx 6.8 AW1
TG-81SC approx. 6.6A
approx. 7.5BAW1
APetrol engines
BDiesel engines
NOTE
The transmission fluid does not need to be
changed under normal driving conditions.
However, it may be necessary under adverse
driving conditions.
Related information
Engine oil - adverse driving conditions
(p. 389)
Type designations (p. 380)
SPECIFICATIONS
394
Brake fluid - grade and volume
Brake fluid is the term for the medium in a
hydraulic brake system that is used to transfer
pressure from the master brake cylinder to the
mechanical brakes.
Prescribed grade: Volvo Original Dot 4 class 6
or equivalent.
Volume: 0.6 litres
Related information
Brake and clutch fluid - level (p. 346)
SPECIFICATIONS
395
Fuel tank - volume
Fuel tank volume for each respective engine
alternative can be read in the table.
V40
Engine
Volume (litres) Prescribed grade
Petrol approx. 62 Fuel - petrol (p. 297)
Diesel approx. 62A (approx. 40B)Fuel - diesel (p. 298)
AOption for D2 (D4204T8) with manual gearbox.
BApplies to D2 (D4204T8) with manual gearbox.
Related information
Filling up with fuel (p. 296)
Engine specifications (p. 388)
SPECIFICATIONS
396
Air conditioning, fluid - volume and
grade
The climate control system in the car uses a
refrigerant, either R1234yf or R134a, depend-
ing on market. Information about which refriger-
ant the car's climate control system uses can be
seen on a decal, located on the inside of the
bonnet.
Prescribed grades and volumes of fluids and
lubricants in the air conditioning system can be
read in the tables below.
A/C decal
Decal for R134a
The label is fitted on the inside of the bonnet.
Decal for R1234yf
The label is fitted on the inside of the bonnet.
Symbol explanation R1234yf
Symbol Meaning
Caution
Mobile air conditioning system
(MAC)
Lubricant type
Symbol Meaning
A trained and certified technician is
required in order to service the
mobile air conditioning system
(MAC)
Flammable refrigerants
Refrigerant
Cars with refrigerant R134a
Weight Prescribed grade
625 g R134a
WARNING
The air conditioning system contains pressur-
ised refrigerant R134a. This system must only
be serviced and repaired by an authorised
workshop.
SPECIFICATIONS
397
Cars with refrigerant R1234yf
Weight Prescribed grade
575 g R1234yf
WARNING
The air conditioning system contains pressur-
ised refrigerant R1234yf. In accordance with
SAE J2845 (Technician Training for Safe
Service and Containment of Refrigerants
Used in Mobile A/C System), service and
repair of the refrigerant system must only be
performed by trained and certified technicians
in order to ensure the safety of the system.
Compressor oil
Volume Prescribed grade
60 ml PAG oil
Evaporator
IMPORTANT
The A/C system's evaporator must never be
repaired or replaced with a previously used
evaporator. A new evaporator must be certi-
fied and labelled in accordance with SAE
J2842.
Related information
Climate control system - fault tracing and
repair (p. 347)
SPECIFICATIONS
398
Fuel consumption and CO2
emissions
Fuel consumption in a vehicle is measured in
litres per 100 km and CO2 emissions in grams
CO2 per km.
Explanation
gram CO2/km
litre/100 km
urban driving
extra-urban driving
combined driving
manual gearbox
Automatic gearbox
NOTE
If the consumption and emission data is miss-
ing then it is included in the enclosed supple-
ment.
NOTE
Not all engines are available in all markets.
V40
T2A (B4204T38) - - - - - -
T2B (B4204T38) - - - - - -
T2A (B4154T5) 170 7.3 106 4.5 129 5.5
T2B (B4154T5) 168 7.2 101 4.4 125 5.4
T3 (B4204T37) - - - - - -
T3 (B4154T4) 170 7.3 106 4.5 129 5.5
SPECIFICATIONS
}}
399
V40
T4 (B4204T19) - - - - - -
T4 (B4204T19) 165 7.2 107 4.6 128 5.5
T5 (B4204T11) 185 7.9 110 4.8 137 5.9
D2A (D4204T8) - - - - - -
D2B (D4204T8) - - - - - -
D2A (D4204T8) 116 4.4 93 3.5 101 3.8
D2B (D4204T8) 110 4.3 90 3.4 97 3.7
D3A (D4204T9) - - - - - -
D3B (D4204T9) - - - - - -
D3A (D4204T9) 117 4.6 97 3.7 104 4.0
D3B (D4204T9) 116 4.5 93 3.6 101 3.9
D4A (D4204T14) 110 4.2 93 3.6 99 3.8
||
SPECIFICATIONS
400
V40
D4B (D4204T14) 108 4.1 89 3.5 96 3.7
D4A (D4204T14) 132 5.0 96 3.7 109 4.2
D4B (D4204T14) 129 4.9 93 3.5 106 4.0
ADoes not apply to the low-emission variant.
BThis only applies to the low-emissions variant.
Fuel consumption
Fuel consumption and emission values in the
table above are based on specific EU driving
cycles (see below), that apply to cars with kerb
weight in the basic version and without extra
equipment. The car's weight may increase
depending on equipment. This, as well as how
heavily the car is loaded, increases fuel consump-
tion and carbon dioxide emissions.
There are several reasons for increased fuel con-
sumption compared with the table's values.
Examples of this are:
If the car is equipped with extra equipment
that affects the car's weight.
The driver's driving style.
If the customer chooses wheels other than
those fitted as standard on the model's basic
version then rolling resistance may increase.
High speed results in increased wind resis-
tance.
Fuel quality, road and traffic conditions,
weather and the condition of the car.
A combination of the above-mentioned examples
can result in significantly increased consumption.
Large deviations in fuel consumption may arise in
a comparison with the EU driving cycles (see
below) which are used in the certification of the
car and on which the consumption figures in the
table are based. For further information, please
refer to the regulations referred to.
Consumption is higher and power output lower
for fuel with an octane rating of 91 RON.
NOTE
Extreme weather conditions, driving with a
trailer or driving at high altitudes in combina-
tion with fuel quality are factors that consider-
ably increase the car's fuel consumption.
SPECIFICATIONS
401
EU driving cycles
Official fuel consumption figures are based on
two standardised driving cycles in a laboratory
environment ("EU driving cycles") all in accord-
ance with EU Regulation no 692/2008 and
715/2007 (Euro 5 / Euro 6) and UN ECE
Regulation no 101. Since the driving cycles are
also used for quality control, there are significant
requirements for repeatability of the tests. For
this reason the tests are carried out under close
scrutiny and only with the car's basic functions
(e.g. air conditioning, radio, etc. switched off). As
a consequence of this the results from the official
figures are not obviously representative of what
the customer sees during actual usage.
The regulations cover the driving cycles for
"Urban driving" and "Extra-urban driving":
Urban driving - the measurement starts with
cold starting the engine. The driving is simu-
lated.
Extra-urban driving - the car is accelerated
and braked at speeds between 0-120 km/h
(0-75 mph). The driving is simulated.
Cars with manual gearbox are started in 2nd
gear.
The official value for combined driving, which is
reported in the table, is a combination of the
results from the "Urban driving" and "Extra-urban
driving" driving cycles, in accordance with legal
requirements.
The exhaust gases are collected in order to
extrapolate the carbon dioxide emissions (CO2
emissions) during the two driving cycles. These
are then analysed and give the value for CO2
emissions.
Related information
Economical driving (p. 301)
Fuel - petrol (p. 297)
Fuel - diesel (p. 298)
Weights (p. 385)
SPECIFICATIONS
402
Wheels and tyres - approved
dimensions
In certain countries not all approved dimensions
are indicated by the registration document or
other documents. The following table shows all
approved combinations of wheel rims and tyres.
Information on engine and type of gearbox is
required to read the table. For information with
respect to these details, see Type designations
(p. 380).
For information on the minimum permitted load
index (LI) and the minimum permitted speed rat-
ing (SS), see Load index and speed rating
(p. 404).
= Approved
V40
Engine
man/
aut
205/55R16
7x16x50
6,5x16x52,5
205/50R17
7x17x50
7x17x52.5
225/45R17
7,5x17x52,5
7x17x50
225/40R18
7,5x18x52,5
235/35R19A
8x19x50
T2BB4154T5 aut - - - -
T2CB4154T5 aut -
T2BB4204T38 man - - - -
T2CB4204T38 man -
T3 B4154T4 aut -
T3 B4204T37 man -
T4 B4204T19 man/aut
T5 B4204T11 aut
D2BD4204T8 man/aut - - - -
D2CD4204T8 man/aut -
D3BD4204T9 man/aut - - - -
D3CD4204T9 man/aut
SPECIFICATIONS
403
V40
Engine
man/
aut
205/55R16
7x16x50
6,5x16x52,5
205/50R17
7x17x50
7x17x52.5
225/45R17
7,5x17x52,5
7x17x50
225/40R18
7,5x18x52,5
235/35R19A
8x19x50
D4BD4204T14 man/aut - - - -
D4CD4204T14 man/aut
AOnly approved for cars equipped with 19" tyres from the factory.
BThis only applies to the low-emissions variant.
CDoes not apply to the low-emission variant.
Related information
Tyres - dimensions (p. 317)
Tyres - speed ratings (p. 318)
Tyres - load index (p. 318)
Wheel and wheel rim dimensions (p. 317)
SPECIFICATIONS
404
Load index and speed rating
The table below shows the minimum permitted
load index (LI) and speed rating (SS). Informa-
tion on engine and type of gearbox is required to
read the table. For information with respect to
these details, see Type designations (p. 380).
V40
Engine
man/
aut Minimum permitted load index (LI)AMinimum permitted speed rating (SS)B
T2 B4154T5 aut 91 H
T2 B4204T38 man 91 H
T3 B4154T4 aut 91 H
T3 B4204T37 man 91 H
T4 B4204T19 man/aut 91 H
T5 B4204T11 aut 91 W
D2 D4204T8 man/aut 91 H
D3 D4204T9 man/aut 91 H
D4 D4204T14 man/aut 91 V
AThe tyre's load index must be at least equal to or greater than indicated in the table.
BThe tyre's speed rating must be at least equal to or greater than indicated in the table.
Related information
Wheels and tyres - approved dimensions
(p. 402)
Tyres - approved tyre pressures (p. 405)
Tyres - load index (p. 318)
Tyres - speed ratings (p. 318)
SPECIFICATIONS
405
Tyres - approved tyre pressures
Approved tyre pressures for each respective
engine alternative can be read in the table.
V40
Engine
Tyre size Speed
(km/h)
Load, 1-3 persons Max. load ECO pressureA
Front
(kPa)B
Rear
(kPa)
Front
(kPa)
Rear
(kPa)
Front/rear
(kPa)
All engines
205/55 R16
205/50 R17
225/45 R17
0 - 160C230 230 260 260 260 (280D)
160+E250 250 300 280 -
225/40 R18
235/35 R19
0 - 160C230 230 260 260 260
160+E270 270 320 300 -
Temporary Spare Tyre max. 80F420 420 420 420 -
AEconomical driving.
BIn certain countries there is the "bar" unit beside the SI unit "Pascal": 1 bar = 100 kPa.
C0 - 100 mph
DOnly applies to 16" wheels for D2/D4 manual, low emission variant.
E100+ mph
Fmax 50 mph
NOTE
All engines, tyres or combinations of these
are not always available in all markets.
Related information
Wheels and tyres - approved dimensions
(p. 402)
Tyres - dimensions (p. 317)
Tyres - air pressure (p. 316)
Type designations (p. 380)
ALPHABETICAL INDEX
407
A
ACC – Adaptive cruise control 203
Active bending lights 94
Active main beam 92
Active Park Assist 262
function 263
Limitations 266
operation 264
Symbols and messages 267
Active Yaw Control 186
Adaptation of headlamp beam 95
Adapting driving characteristics 186
Adaptive Cruise Control 203
change cruise control functionality 212
deactivate 209
fault tracing 213
function 204
managing speed 206
overtaking 209
overview 205
radar sensor 216
setting the time interval 207
standby mode 208
temporary deactivation 208
Additional heater
electric 144, 145
fuel-driven 144
Adjusting the steering wheel 87
Airbag
activating/deactivating, PACOS 36
driver's side 34
passenger side 35, 36
AIRBAG 34, 35
Airbag system 33
warning symbol 32
Air cleaning
material 129
passenger compartment 127, 128, 129
Air conditioning 135
Air conditioning, fluid
volume and grade 396
Air conditioning system
repair 347
Air distribution 129
Recirculation 137
table 138
Air quality system IAQS 128
Alarm 181, 182, 183
alarm indicator 182
alarm signals 183
automatic activation 183
automatic re-arming 182
checking the alarm 165
reduced alarm level 184
remote control key not working 183
Allergy and asthma inducing substances. 128
Approach lighting 102, 164
Automatic car washes 372
Automatic gearbox 274
manual gear positions (Geartronic) 275
towing and recovery 310
trailer 304
Automatic relocking 174
B
Backrest 83
front seat, lowering 83
rear seat, folding 86
Bag holder 155
folding 155
Battery 271, 294, 358
jump starting 271
maintenance 358
overload 294
remote control key/PCC 168
start 358
support 361
symbols on the battery 360
warning symbols 360
BLIS 238, 239
Bonnet, opening 341
ALPHABETICAL INDEX
ALPHABETICAL INDEX
408
Book service and repair 336
Brake and clutch fluid 346
Brake fluid
grade and volume 394
Brake light 98
Brakes 289, 290
Anti-lock braking system, ABS 290
brake light 98
brake system 289, 290
Emergency Brake Assistance, EBA 291
filling brake fluid 346
handbrake 291
symbols in the combined instrument
panel 289
bulbs, specifications 354
C
Camera sensor 223, 235
Car care 372
Leather upholstery 376
Cargo area
cargo net 157
lighting 101
loading 153
mounting points 155
parcel shelf 158
Car key memory 161
Car upholstery 376
Car washing 372
Catalytic converter 299
Recovery 310
Changing wheels 321
Checking the engine oil level 343
Children
child safety locks 46
child seat and airbag 52
child seats and side airbags 38
location in car 52
safety 46
Child safety locks 180
Child seat
ISOFIX fixture system for child seats 53
Child seats 46
recommended 47
size classes for child seats with ISOFIX
fixture system 53
types 55
upper mounting points for child seats 57
City Safety221
Cleaning
automatic car wash 372
car washing 372
rims 373
seatbelts 376
upholstery 376
Clean Zone Interior Package (CZIP) 128
Climate control
actual temperature 127
auto-regulation 134
general 126
personal preferences 129
sensors 127
temperature control 135
Clock, adjustment 75
CO2 emissions 398
Collision 42
Collision warning 228, 229
Collision warning system
function 229
general limitations 234
operation 232
Pedestrian detection 231
Radar sensor 216, 222
Collision Warning System with Auto
Brake 228
Colour code, paint 377
Combined instrument panel 66, 67
Compass 109
calibration 110
Condensation in headlamps 372
ALPHABETICAL INDEX
409
Controls lighting 89
Control symbols 67, 69
Coolant
volume and grade 392
Coolant, checking and filling 345
Cooling system 293
overheating 293
Corner Traction Control 187
Crash, see Collision 42
Cruise control 194
deactivate 199
managing speed 195
resume set speed 198
temporary deactivation 197
CTA 240
Cyclist detection 230
CZIP (Clear Zone Interior Package) 128
D
Daytime running lights 90
Deadlock 178
deactivation 178
temporary deactivation 179
Defroster 136
Detachable towbar
storage 305
Diesel 298
run out of fuel 299
Diesel particle filter 300
Dimensions 383
Dipstick, electronic 344
Direction indicator 99
Direction indicators 99
direction of rotation 315
Disengaging the gear selector inhibitor 277
Display lighting 89
Distance Warning 199
Limitations 201
Symbols and messages 202
Door mirrors 106
resetting 107
Drive mode ECO 287
Driver Alert Control 246
operation 247
Driver Alert System 246
Driving 294
cooling system 293
with the tailgate open 293
Driving in water 292
Driving with a trailer 302
towball load 386
towing capacity 386
E
ECC, electronic climate control 131
Eco Cruise 287
EcoGuide 70
Ecolabelling, FSC, owner's manual 25
ECO mode 287
Economical driving 301
ECO pressure 316, 405
Electrical socket 152
cargo area 156
Electrical system 363
Electronic climate control - ECC 131
Electronic temperature control - ETC 132
Emergency equipment
first aid kit 326
warning triangle 325
Emergency puncture repair 328
action 330
inflating the tyres 333
rechecking 332
ALPHABETICAL INDEX
410
Emergency puncture repair kit
location 328
overview 329
sealing fluid 329
Emissions of carbon dioxide 398
Engine
deactivate 271
overheating 293
start 270
Start/Stop 279
Engine and passenger compartment heater
messages 143
timer 142
Engine block heater 140
Engine block heater and passenger com-
partment heater
direct start 141
immediate stop 142
Engine compartment
Brake and clutch fluid 346
Check 342
coolant 345
Engine oil 342
overview 341
Engine drag control 187
Engine oil 342, 389
adverse driving conditions 389
filter 342
grade and volume 390
Engine oil, filling 343
Engine specifications 388
Error messages
Adaptive Cruise Control 214
Driver Alert Control 248
LKA 253
see Messages and symbols 214
Error messages in BLIS 242
ETC, electronic temperature control 132
Ethanol content
maximum 10 percent by volume 297
External dimensions 383
F
Fan
ECC 134
ETC 134
Fault tracing for the camera sensor 224
First aid 326
First aid kit 326
Fluids, capacities 357, 392, 393, 394,
395, 396
Fluids and oils 392, 393, 394, 396
Fog lamp
rear 98
Foot brake 289, 290
Front bulbs
location 348
Front seat
head restraint 83
FSC, ecolabelling 25
Fuel 296, 297, 298
fuel consumption 398
fuel economy 316
fuel filter 299
identifier 297, 298
Fuel-driven heater
timer 142
Fuelling 178, 300
filling 296
filling with reserve fuel can 300
fuel filler flap 295
fuel filler flap, locking 178
fuel filler flap, manual opening 295
Fuel tank
volume 395
Fuse box 363
Fuses
changing 363
General 363
in engine compartment 364
ALPHABETICAL INDEX
411
under glovebox 367
under the right-hand front seat 370
G
Gearbox 273
automatic 274
manual 273
Gear selector inhibitor 277
Gear selector inhibitor, mechanical disen-
gagement 277
Gear shift indicator 274
Geartronic 275
Glass
laminated/reinforced 25
Glass roof, power operated roller blind 109
Glovebox 151
locking 176
Gross vehicle weight 385
GSI - Gear selector assistance 274
H
Handbrake 291
Hazard warning flashers 99
Headlamp beam
adaptation 95
height adjustment 89
Headlamp control 88
Headlamp levelling of headlamps 89
Headlamp pattern, adjusting 95
Headlamp pattern adjustment 95
Headlamps 349
head restraint
centre seat, rear 85
front seat 83
lowering 85
Heating
rearview and door mirrors 107
rear window 107
seats 133
windscreen 107
Heat-reflecting windscreen 20
High engine temperature 293
High-pressure headlamp washing 104
Hill Start Assist 278
Home safe light duration 102
Horn 88
I
IAQS - Interior Air Quality System 128
Immobiliser 163
Indicator symbols 71
Inflatable curtain 39
Information button, PCC 165
Information display 66, 67
Inlaid mats 151
Instrument lighting 89
Instrument overview
left-hand drive car 60
right-hand drive car 63
Instruments and controls 60, 63
Interior Air Quality System (IAQS)
Air cleaning 128
Interior lighting 100
Interior rearview mirror 108
automatic dimming 108
Intermittent wiping 103
Internet-connected car
book service and repair 336
ALPHABETICAL INDEX
412
J
Jack 326
Journey statistics 123
Jump starting 271
K
Kerb weight 385
Key 160, 162
Key blade 167, 168
Keyless drive 169, 170, 171, 172, 173, 270
Keyless - locking 171
Keyless start (keyless drive) 169, 170,
171, 172, 173, 270
Keyless - unlocking 172
Keypad in the steering wheel 87
Key positions 80
L
Labels 380
Laminated glass 25
Lamps 347
Lane assistance
operation 251
Lane Keeping Aid - LKA 249
Laser sensor 225
Leather upholstery, washing instructions 376
Lifting tool 326
Light indications, PCC 165
Lighting
active bending lights 94
approach lighting 102, 164
automatic lighting, passenger compart-
ment 101
Automatic main beam 92
bulbs, specifications 354
controls 88, 100
controls lighting 89
daytime running lights 90
display lighting 89
headlamp levelling 89
home safe lighting 102
instrument lighting 89
in the passenger compartment 100
main/dipped beam 91
position lamps 90
rear fog lamp 98
tunnel detection 91
Lighting, bulb replacement 347
daytime running lights 352
dipped beam (cars with halogen head-
lamps) 350
direction indicators, front 351
front position lamp 351
main beam (cars with halogen head-
lamps) 351
rear bulb holder: direction indicators,
brake lamps and reversing lamps 353
rear fog lamp 353
vanity mirror 354
LKA - Lane Keeping Aid 249
Loading
cargo area 153, 155
General 153, 155
long load 154
mounting points 155
roof load 154
Lock
locking 174
manual locking 174
unlocking 174, 175
Lockable wheel bolts 319
Lock confirmation 162
Lock indicator 162, 182
Locking/unlocking
inside 175
tailgate 176
ALPHABETICAL INDEX
413
M
Main/dipped beam 91
Main beam, automatic activation 92
maintenance
Rustproofing 375
Manual gearbox 273
GSI - Gear selector assistance 274
Towing and recovery 310
trailer 303
Manual gear positions (Geartronic) 275
Max. roof load 385
Memory function in seat 84
Menus
Combined instrument panel 110
menu overview, analogue 111
menu overview, digital 111
Messages 113
Messages and symbols
Adaptive Cruise Control 214
Collision Warning with Auto
Brake 227, 236
Driver Alert Control 248
Engine block heater and passenger
compartment heater 143
LKA 253
Messages in BLIS 242
Messages in the information display 112
Meters
fuel gauge 66, 67
speedometer 66, 67
tachometer 66, 67
Mileage 114
misting
attending to the windows 126
Misting
condensation in headlamps 372
Mood lighting 101
MY CAR 113
O
octane rating 297
Oil, see also Engine oil 389, 390
Oil level low 343
Option/accessory 16
Output 388
outside temperature gauge 75
Overheating 293, 302
Owner's manual, ecolabelling 25
P
PACOS 36
Paintwork
colour code 377
damage and touch-up 377
Panic function 164
PAP - Active Park Assist 262
Parcel shelf 158
Park Assist 254
backward 255
fault indicator 257
function 254
parking assistance sensors 257
Park assist camera 258
settings 261
Parking brake 291
Passenger compartment filter 128
Passenger compartment heater 140
Passenger compartment lighting
automatic 101
PCC – Personal Car Communicator
functions 164
range 166
Pedestrian airbag 44
folding up 45
moving the car 45
ALPHABETICAL INDEX
414
Pedestrian detection 228
Personal Car Communicator 166
Petrol grade 297
Pocket park assist - PAP 262
Polishing 374
Position lamp 90
Power guide 70
Power operated roller blind for glass roof 109
Power seat 84
Power windows 104
resetting 106
Puncture 328
Q
Queue Assist 210
Queue assistance 210
R
Radar sensor 204
Limitations 216
Rain sensor 103
Raising the car 339
Rear bulbs
location 352
Rear seat
Heating 133
Rearview and door mirrors
compass 109
door 106
electrically retractable 107
heating 107
interior 108
Rear window
heating 107
Recommendations during driving 294
Recommended child seats
table 47
Recovery 311
Refrigerant 347
Regeneration 300
Remote control immobiliser 163
Remote control key 160, 161, 162
battery replacement 168
detachable key blade 167, 168
functions 164
loss 160
range 165, 170
Remote control key system, type approval 184
Remote control key with PCC
range 166
Resetting, trip meter 117, 121
Resetting the door mirrors 107
Resetting the power windows 106
Retractable power door mirrors 107
Reverse gear inhibitor 273
Road sign information 243
Limitations 245
operation 243
Roof load, max. weight 385
Rustproofing 375
S
Safety lock
children 46
Safety mode 42
moving the car 43
start attempt 43
Sealing fluid 329
Seat, see Seats 82
Seatbelt 28
loosen 30
pregnancy 30
putting on 29
ALPHABETICAL INDEX
415
rear seat 31
seatbelt reminder 31
seatbelt tensioner 31
Seatbelt reminder 31
Seatbelt tensioner 31
Seats 82
head restraints, rear 85
heating 133
Heating 133
lowering the front backrest 83
lowering the rear backrest 86
power 84
Securing loads (Loading) 155
Sensus 79
Service position 355
Service programme 336
Set time interval 200
Side airbag SIPS 38
SIPS airbag 38
Skidding 294, 295
slippery driving conditions 295
Soot filter 300
SOOT FILTER FULL 300
spare wheel 320, 321
installation 324
taking out 321
Speed limiter 191
alarm for speed exceeded 194
deactivation 194
getting started 191, 192
temporary deactivation 193
Speed ratings, tyres 318
Spin control 186
Stability and traction control system 186
Stability system 186
Stains 376
Start/Stop 279
function and operation 279
the engine does not stop 281
Starter battery
changing 360
Steering force, speed related 186
Steering force level, see Steering force 186
Steering lock 271
Steering wheel 87
keypad 87
steering wheel adjustment 87
Stone chips and scratches 377
Storage spaces
driver's side 150
glovebox 151
tunnel console 150
Storage spaces in the passenger compart-
ment 148
Support 15
Support battery 361
Switching off the engine 271
Symbols
indicator symbols 67, 69, 71
warning symbols 67, 69
Symbols and messages
Adaptive Cruise Control 214
Collision Warning with Auto
Brake 227, 236
Driver Alert Control 248
LKA 253
T
Tailgate
Locking/unlocking 176
Temperature
actual temperature 127
Temperature control 135
Total airing function 126, 176
Towbar
detachable, attachment 306
detachable, removal 308
Towbar, see Towing equipment 304
ALPHABETICAL INDEX
416
Towbar - detachable
attachment/removal 306, 308
Towing 310
towing eye 311
Towing bracket 304, 305
specifications 305
Towing capacity and towball load 386
Towing eye 311
Traction control 186
Trailer 302
cable 302
driving with a trailer 302
snaking 309
Trailer stability assist 187
Trailer Stability Assist 309
Transmission 273
Transmission oil
volume and grade 393
Transponder 20
Tread depth 320
Tread wear indicators 316
Trip computer 114, 120, 123
analogue instrument panel 116
Trip meter 75, 114
Trip meter, resetting 117, 121
Troubleshooting
Adaptive Cruise Control 213
TSA - trailer stability assist 187, 309
Tunnel console 150
12 V socket 152
armrest 150
cigarette lighter and ashtray 151
Tunnel detection 91
Type approval
radar system 218
remote control key system 184
Type designations 380
Tyre dimension 317
Tyre load index 318
Tyre monitoring 326
Tyre pressure label 316
Tyre pressure monitoring 326
Tyres
dimensions 402, 404
direction of rotation 315
maintenance 314
pressure 316, 405
puncture repair 328
specifications 402, 404, 405
tread depth 320
tread wear indicators 316
tyre pressure monitoring 326
winter tyres 320
U
Unlocking
from the inside 175
from the outside 174
Unlocking with the key blade 172
V
Vanity mirror 152
lighting 101
Ventilation 129
Vibration damper 304
Volvo ID 21
Volvo Sensus 79
ALPHABETICAL INDEX
417
W
Warning lamp
Adaptive Cruise Control 204
collision warning system 232
stability and traction control system 186
Warning lamps
Airbags – SRS 73
alternator not charging 73
Fault in brake system 73
Low oil pressure 73
Parking brake applied 73
seatbelt reminder 31, 73
Warning 73
Warning sound
collision warning system 232
Warning symbols 67, 69, 73
Warning triangle 325
Washer fluid 357
Washers
rear window 104
washer fluid, filling 357
windscreen 103
Water and dirt-repellent coating 375
Water-repellent surface, cleaning 375
Waxing 374
Weights
kerb weight 385
Wheel bolts 319
lockable 319
Wheel change 322
Wheel rim, dimensions 317
Wheel rims
cleaning 373
Wheels
removal 322
snow chains 320
spare wheel 320
Wheels and tyres 320
approved dimensions 402
tyre load index and speed rating 404
Whiplash injury, WHIPS 40
WHIPS
child seat/booster cushion 40
seating position 41
whiplash protection 40
Windows, rearview and door mirrors 375
Windscreen
heating 107, 136
Windscreen washing 103
Windscreen wiper 102
rain sensor 103
Winter driving 294
Winter tyres 320
Winter wheels 320
Wiper blades 355
changing 356
Cleaning 357
replacing, rear window 357
Service position 355
Wipers and washing 102
ALPHABETICAL INDEX
418
TP 22065 (English), AT 1646, MY17, Printed in Sweden, Göteborg 2016, Copyright © 2000-2016 Volvo Car Corporation
419

Hulp nodig? Stel uw vraag in het forum

Spelregels
1

Forum

Volvo-V40---2017

Misbruik melden

Gebruikershandleiding.com neemt misbruik van zijn services uitermate serieus. U kunt hieronder aangeven waarom deze vraag ongepast is. Wij controleren de vraag en zonodig wordt deze verwijderd.

Product:

Bijvoorbeeld antisemitische inhoud, racistische inhoud, of materiaal dat gewelddadige fysieke handelingen tot gevolg kan hebben.

Bijvoorbeeld een creditcardnummer, een persoonlijk identificatienummer, of een geheim adres. E-mailadressen en volledige namen worden niet als privégegevens beschouwd.

Spelregels forum

Om tot zinvolle vragen te komen hanteren wij de volgende spelregels:

Belangrijk! Als er een antwoord wordt gegeven op uw vraag, dan is het voor de gever van het antwoord nuttig om te weten als u er wel (of niet) mee geholpen bent! Wij vragen u dus ook te reageren op een antwoord.

Belangrijk! Antwoorden worden ook per e-mail naar abonnees gestuurd. Laat uw emailadres achter op deze site, zodat u op de hoogte blijft. U krijgt dan ook andere vragen en antwoorden te zien.

Abonneren

Abonneer u voor het ontvangen van emails voor uw Volvo V40 - 2017 bij:


U ontvangt een email met instructies om u voor één of beide opties in te schrijven.


Ontvang uw handleiding per email

Vul uw emailadres in en ontvang de handleiding van Volvo V40 - 2017 in de taal/talen: Engels als bijlage per email.

De handleiding is 12,29 mb groot.

 

U ontvangt de handleiding per email binnen enkele minuten. Als u geen email heeft ontvangen, dan heeft u waarschijnlijk een verkeerd emailadres ingevuld of is uw mailbox te vol. Daarnaast kan het zijn dat uw internetprovider een maximum heeft aan de grootte per email. Omdat hier een handleiding wordt meegestuurd, kan het voorkomen dat de email groter is dan toegestaan bij uw provider.

Stel vragen via chat aan uw handleiding

Stel uw vraag over deze PDF

Andere handleiding(en) van Volvo V40 - 2017

Volvo V40 - 2017 Gebruiksaanwijzing - Nederlands - 432 pagina's

Volvo V40 - 2017 Gebruiksaanwijzing - Deutsch - 448 pagina's


Uw handleiding is per email verstuurd. Controleer uw email

Als u niet binnen een kwartier uw email met handleiding ontvangen heeft, kan het zijn dat u een verkeerd emailadres heeft ingevuld of dat uw emailprovider een maximum grootte per email heeft ingesteld die kleiner is dan de grootte van de handleiding.

Er is een email naar u verstuurd om uw inschrijving definitief te maken.

Controleer uw email en volg de aanwijzingen op om uw inschrijving definitief te maken

U heeft geen emailadres opgegeven

Als u de handleiding per email wilt ontvangen, vul dan een geldig emailadres in.

Uw vraag is op deze pagina toegevoegd

Wilt u een email ontvangen bij een antwoord en/of nieuwe vragen? Vul dan hier uw emailadres in.



Info